Follow CNAME chains only one step. Bug 2264
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
... / ...
CommitLineData
1. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2. This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3. converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4. formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5. The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6.
7. WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8. adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9. unwanted vertical space.
10. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12.include stdflags
13.include stdmacs
14
15. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16. This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19.docbook
20
21. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22. These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23. Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24. PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25. processors.
26. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28.literal xml
29<?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34?>
35.literal off
36
37. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38. This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41.book
42
43. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44. These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45. Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48.set previousversion "4.91"
49.include ./local_params
50
51.set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52.set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54.macro copyyear
552018
56.endmacro
57
58. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59. Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60. provided in the xfpt library.
61. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63. --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
64
65.flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67. --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68. --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
69
70.flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71.flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73. --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74. --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75. --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76. --- index entry.
77
78.macro option
79.arg 5
80.oindex "&%$5%&"
81.endarg
82.arg -5
83.oindex "&%$1%&"
84.endarg
85.itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86.row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87.endtable
88.endmacro
89
90. --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91. --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92. --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94.macro table2 196pt 254pt
95.itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96.endmacro
97
98. --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99. --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100. --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102.macro irow
103.arg 4
104.row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105.endarg
106.arg -4
107.arg 3
108.row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109.endarg
110.arg -3
111.row "&I;$1" "$2"
112.endarg
113.endarg
114.endmacro
115
116. --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117. --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118. --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119. --- ID that ties them together.
120
121.macro cindex
122&<indexterm role="concept">&
123&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124.arg 2
125&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126.endarg
127&</indexterm>&
128.endmacro
129
130.macro scindex
131&<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132&<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133.arg 3
134&<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135.endarg
136&</indexterm>&
137.endmacro
138
139.macro ecindex
140&<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141.endmacro
142
143.macro oindex
144&<indexterm role="option">&
145&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146.arg 2
147&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148.endarg
149&</indexterm>&
150.endmacro
151
152.macro vindex
153&<indexterm role="variable">&
154&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155.arg 2
156&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157.endarg
158&</indexterm>&
159.endmacro
160
161.macro index
162.echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163.endmacro
164. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168. The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
169. output formats.
170. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172.literal xml
173<bookinfo>
174<title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175<titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176<date>
177.fulldate
178</date>
179<author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180<authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181<revhistory><revision>
182.versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184</revision></revhistory>
185<copyright><year>
186.copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188</bookinfo>
189.literal off
190
191
192. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193. This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194. "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195. at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198.chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199.literal xml
200
201<indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204</indexterm>
205<indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209</indexterm>
210<indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213</indexterm>
214<indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217</indexterm>
218<indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221</indexterm>
222<indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225</indexterm>
226<indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230</indexterm>
231<indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234</indexterm>
235<indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238</indexterm>
239<indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242</indexterm>
243<indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246</indexterm>
247<indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251</indexterm>
252<indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255</indexterm>
256<indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259</indexterm>
260<indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263</indexterm>
264<indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267</indexterm>
268<indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271</indexterm>
272<indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275</indexterm>
276<indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279</indexterm>
280<indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283</indexterm>
284<indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287</indexterm>
288<indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291</indexterm>
292<indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295</indexterm>
296<indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299</indexterm>
300<indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303</indexterm>
304<indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308</indexterm>
309<indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312</indexterm>
313<indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316</indexterm>
317<indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320</indexterm>
321
322.literal off
323
324
325. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326. This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327. we can't have the .chapter line here.
328. chapter "Introduction"
329. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
341Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
354which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367&_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368contributors.
369
370
371.section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372. Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374.new
375.cindex "documentation"
376This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379capable of showing a change indicator.
380.wen
381
382This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389very wide interest.
390
391.cindex "books about Exim"
392An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395(&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
396
397This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
401
402.cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404Debian-specific features in the file
405&_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407information.
408
409.cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410.cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
411.cindex "change log"
412As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416&_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
417
418Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
422
423All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
425
426.cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
429directory are:
430
431.table2 100pt
432.row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433.row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434.row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435.row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436.row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437.row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438.row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439.row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
440.endtable
441
442The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
443available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
444&<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
445
446
447
448.section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
449.cindex "web site"
450.cindex "FTP site"
451The primary site for Exim source distributions is the &%exim.org%& FTP site,
452available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP. These services, and the &%exim.org%&
453website, are hosted at the University of Cambridge.
454
455.cindex "wiki"
456.cindex "FAQ"
457As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
458differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
459online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
460which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
461examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
462The wiki site should always redirect to the correct place, which is currently
463provided by GitHub, and is open to editing by anyone with a GitHub account.
464
465.cindex Bugzilla
466An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
467this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
468first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
469Please do not ask for configuration help in the bug-tracker.
470
471
472.section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
473.cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
474The following Exim mailing lists exist:
475
476.table2 140pt
477.row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
478.row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
479.row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
480.row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
481.endtable
482
483You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
484or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
485.cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
486If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
487the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
488via this web page:
489.display
490&url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
491.endd
492Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
493lists.
494
495.section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
496.cindex "bug reports"
497.cindex "reporting bugs"
498Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
499via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
500whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
501message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
502
503
504
505.section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
506.cindex "FTP site"
507.cindex "HTTPS download site"
508.cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
509.cindex "distribution" "https site"
510The master distribution site for the Exim distribution is
511.display
512&*https://downloads.exim.org/*&
513.endd
514The service is available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP.
515We encourage people to migrate to HTTPS.
516
517The content served at &'https://downloads.exim.org/'& is identical to the
518content served at &'https://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim'& and
519&'ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim'&.
520
521If accessing via a hostname containing &'ftp'&, then the file references that
522follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at these sites.
523If accessing via the hostname &'downloads'& then the subdirectories described
524here are top-level directories.
525
526There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
527the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
528
529Within the top exim directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
530previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
531distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
532subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
533.display
534&_exim-n.nn.tar.xz_&
535&_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
536&_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
537.endd
538where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The three
539files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
540The &_.xz_& file is usually the smallest, while the &_.gz_& file is the
541most portable to old systems.
542
543.cindex "distribution" "signing details"
544.cindex "distribution" "public key"
545.cindex "public key for signed distribution"
546The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
547Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
548&'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
549other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
550PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
551PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
552&_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
553such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
554
555At time of last update, releases were being made by Jeremy Harris and signed
556with key &'0xBCE58C8CE41F32DF'&. Other recent keys used for signing are those
557of Heiko Schlittermann, &'0x26101B62F69376CE'&,
558and of Phil Pennock, &'0x4D1E900E14C1CC04'&.
559
560The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
561.display
562&_exim-n.nn.tar.xz.asc_&
563&_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
564&_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
565.endd
566For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
567separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
568find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
569
570.cindex "documentation" "available formats"
571The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
572documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
573inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
574.display
575&_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576&_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577&_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
578&_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
579.endd
580These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
581distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& and &_.xz_& forms.
582
583
584.section "Limitations" "SECID6"
585.ilist
586.cindex "limitations of Exim"
587.cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
588Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
589RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
590simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
591configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
592UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
593.next
594.cindex "domainless addresses"
595.cindex "address" "without domain"
596Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
597local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
598configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
599systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
600arrival.
601.next
602.cindex "transport" "external"
603.cindex "external transports"
604The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
605and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
606transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
607and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
608to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
609handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
610.next
611Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
612such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
613(that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
614other means.
615.next
616Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
617are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
618are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
619compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
620a number of common scanners are provided.
621.endlist
622
623
624.section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
625Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
626into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
627values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
628file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
629distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
630
631
632.section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
633.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
634Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
635can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
636&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
637about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
638Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
639example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
640format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
6413, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
642documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
643made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
644
645Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
646line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
647which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
648interface to Exim's command line administration options.
649
650
651
652.section "Terminology" "SECID9"
653.cindex "terminology definitions"
654.cindex "body of message" "definition of"
655The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
656It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
657below) by a blank line.
658
659.cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
660When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
661delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
662&'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
663called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
664failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
665message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
666rise to further bounce messages.
667
668The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
669value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
670also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
671otherwise.
672
673The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
674destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
675down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
676until a later time.
677
678The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
679host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
680the part of an email address following the @ sign.
681
682.cindex "envelope, definition of"
683.cindex "sender" "definition of"
684A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
685body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
686be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
687sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
688envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
689messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
690
691.cindex "message" "header, definition of"
692.cindex "header section" "definition of"
693The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
694of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
695&'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
696indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
697line.
698
699.cindex "local part" "definition of"
700.cindex "domain" "definition of"
701The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
702part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
703@ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
704
705.cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
706.cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
707The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
708delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
709TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
710host it is running on are &'remote'&.
711
712.cindex "return path" "definition of"
713&'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
714message's envelope.
715
716.cindex "queue" "definition of"
717The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
718because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
719Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
720normally no ordering of waiting messages.
721
722.cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
723The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
724and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
725is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
726the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
727
728.cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
729The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
730messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
731delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
732mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
733the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
734
735
736
737
738
739
740. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
741. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
742
743.chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
744.cindex "incorporated code"
745.cindex "regular expressions" "library"
746.cindex "PCRE"
747.cindex "OpenDMARC"
748A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
749
750.ilist
751Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
752Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
753&copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
754Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
755or obtain and install the full version of the library from
756&url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
757.next
758.cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
759Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
760contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
761Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
762It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
763following statements:
764
765.blockquote
766Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
767
768This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
769the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
770Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
771version.
772This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
773the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
774&url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
775some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
776restrictions applied to it).
777.endblockquote
778.next
779.cindex "SPA authentication"
780.cindex "Samba project"
781.cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
782Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
783by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
784Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
785under the Gnu GPL.
786.next
787.cindex "Cyrus"
788.cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
789.cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
790Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
791by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
792Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
793conditions expressed therein.
794
795.blockquote
796Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
797
798Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
799modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
800are met:
801
802.olist
803Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
804notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
805.next
806Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
807notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
808the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
809distribution.
810.next
811The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
812endorse or promote products derived from this software without
813prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
814details, please contact
815.display
816 Office of Technology Transfer
817 Carnegie Mellon University
818 5000 Forbes Avenue
819 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
820 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
821 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
822.endd
823.next
824Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
825acknowledgment:
826
827&"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
828at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
829
830CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
831THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
832AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
833FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
834WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
835AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
836OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
837.endlist
838.endblockquote
839
840.next
841.cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
842.cindex "X-windows"
843.cindex "Athena"
844The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
845modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
846This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
847below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
848
849.blockquote
850Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
851and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
852
853All Rights Reserved
854
855Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
856documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
857provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
858both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
859supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
860used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
861software without specific, written prior permission.
862
863DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
864ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
865DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
866ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
867WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
868ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
869SOFTWARE.
870.endblockquote
871
872.next
873.cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
874The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
875The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
876derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
877license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
878source code.
879
880.next
881Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
882not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
883contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
884.endlist
885
886
887
888
889
890. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
891. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
892
893.chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
894 "Receiving and delivering mail"
895
896
897.section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
898.cindex "design philosophy"
899Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
900to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
901most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
902maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
903it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
904has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
905
906
907.section "Policy control" "SECID11"
908.cindex "policy control" "overview"
909Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
910Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
911&"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
912unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
913facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
914
915.ilist
916.cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
917Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
918incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
919series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
920several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
921host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
922very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
923rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
924two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
925error code.
926.next
927An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
928case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
929.next
930When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
931provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
932spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
933which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
934.next
935When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
936host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
937function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
938whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
939is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
940.next
941Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
942software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
943Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
944.next
945After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
946the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
947runs at the start of every delivery process.
948.endlist
949
950
951
952.section "User filters" "SECID12"
953.cindex "filter" "introduction"
954.cindex "Sieve filter"
955In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
956setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
957chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
958configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
959&'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
960of filtering are available:
961
962.ilist
963Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
964by RFC 3028.
965.next
966Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
967powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
968.endlist
969
970User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
971
972
973
974.section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
975.cindex "message ids" "details of format"
976.cindex "format" "of message id"
977.cindex "id of message"
978.cindex "base62"
979.cindex "base36"
980.cindex "Darwin"
981.cindex "Cygwin"
982Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
983characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
984example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
985normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
986system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
987(avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
988id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
989not always case-sensitive.
990
991.cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
992The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
993Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
994within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
995be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
996the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
997somewhat eccentric:
998
999.ilist
1000The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1001started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1002contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1003way of representing the date and time of day).
1004.next
1005After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1006received the message.
1007.next
1008There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1009.olist
1010.oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1011If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1012time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1013that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1014systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1015.next
1016If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1017the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1018(1/100) of a second.
1019.endlist
1020.endlist
1021
1022After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1023appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1024received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1025pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1026will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1027
1028
1029.section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1030.cindex "receiving mail"
1031.cindex "message" "reception"
1032The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1033TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1034SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1035there are several possibilities:
1036
1037.ilist
1038If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1039non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1040command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1041.next
1042If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1043non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1044the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1045command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1046but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1047envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1048.next
1049If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1050interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1051passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1052This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1053example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1054.next
1055A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1056(127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1057does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1058in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1059.endlist
1060
1061
1062.cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1063.cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1064In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1065constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1066qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1067option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1068SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1069certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1070unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1071address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1072different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1073users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1074users to change sender addresses.
1075
1076Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1077checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1078(either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1079number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1080individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1081requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1082&<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1083
1084Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1085received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1086connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1087queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1088configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1089message is received.
1090
1091
1092
1093
1094
1095.section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1096.cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1097.cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1098When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1099first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1100the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1101the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1102file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1103
1104.cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1105By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1106&_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1107not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1108improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1109used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1110whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1111processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1112overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1113affect file system performance.
1114
1115The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1116the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1117any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1118a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1119first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1120
1121.cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1122Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1123(see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1124both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1125If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1126example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1127generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1128rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1129different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1130addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1131delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1132&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1133
1134
1135
1136.section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1137.cindex "message" "life of"
1138.cindex "message" "frozen"
1139A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1140its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1141administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1142cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1143recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1144spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1145
1146.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1147.cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1148An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1149corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1150addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1151to be sent.
1152
1153.oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1154.oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1155There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1156&%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1157The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1158
1159.cindex "message" "log file for"
1160.cindex "log" "file for each message"
1161While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1162attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1163delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1164lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1165These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1166deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1167The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1168&%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1169systems.
1170
1171.cindex "journal file"
1172.cindex "file" "journal"
1173All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1174spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1175address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1176message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1177addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1178is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1179Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1180minimize the possibility of data loss.
1181
1182Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1183the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1184time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1185updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1186deliveries caused by crashes.
1187
1188
1189
1190.section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1191.cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1192.cindex "router" "definition of"
1193.cindex "transport" "definition of"
1194The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1195&'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1196number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1197specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1198ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1199
1200.cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1201Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1202of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1203you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1204option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1205instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1206instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1207configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1208the driver's features in general.
1209
1210A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1211its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1212converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1213alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1214to be bounced.
1215
1216A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1217spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1218transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1219&'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1220to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1221several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1222
1223.cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1224An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1225turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1226specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1227detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1228address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1229
1230To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1231routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1232routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1233configuration.
1234
1235The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1236addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1237are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1238is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1239its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1240match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1241find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1242assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1243configured to fail the address.
1244
1245The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1246&"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1247aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1248original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1249router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1250address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1251
1252The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1253address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1254see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1255local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1256the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1257the address is bounced.
1258
1259
1260
1261.section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1262.cindex "router" "for verification"
1263.cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1264As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1265are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1266one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1267sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1268&%-bvs%& command line options.
1269
1270When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1271does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1272detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1273when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1274sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1275previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1276checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1277would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1278
1279
1280
1281
1282.section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1283.cindex "router" "running details"
1284.cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1285.cindex "router" "result of running"
1286As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1287running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1288passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1289the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1290the following:
1291
1292.ilist
1293&'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1294transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1295original address ceases,
1296.oindex "&%unseen%&"
1297unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1298can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1299for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1300passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1301end of routing.
1302
1303Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1304starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1305setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1306child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1307&%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1308.next
1309&'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1310requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1311is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1312&%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1313must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1314.next
1315&'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1316recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1317this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1318set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1319&'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1320.next
1321&'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1322the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1323original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1324.next
1325&'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1326database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1327processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1328next time the message is considered for delivery.
1329.next
1330&'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1331its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1332.endlist
1333
1334If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1335any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1336situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1337making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1338router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1339
1340Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1341met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1342You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1343when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1344facility for this purpose.
1345
1346
1347.section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1348.cindex "case of local parts"
1349.cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1350.cindex "duplicate addresses"
1351Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1352and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1353check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1354actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1355routed addresses are shown.
1356
1357
1358
1359.section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1360.cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1361.cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1362The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1363order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1364described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1365
1366.ilist
1367The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1368the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1369suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1370skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1371removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1372of any other conditions.
1373.next
1374Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1375only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1376&%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1377address.
1378Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1379&%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1380sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1381you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1382Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1383.next
1384If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1385run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1386when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1387makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1388having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1389.next
1390Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1391opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1392Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1393.next
1394Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1395check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1396.next
1397If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1398of domains that it defines.
1399.next
1400.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1401.vindex "&$local_part$&"
1402.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1403If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1404the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1405&%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1406part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1407that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1408that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1409&$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1410.next
1411.vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1412.vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1413.vindex "&$home$&"
1414If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1415an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1416local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1417user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1418remaining preconditions.
1419.next
1420If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1421because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1422later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1423subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1424could lead to confusion.
1425.next
1426If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1427set of addresses that it defines.
1428.next
1429If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1430specified files is tested.
1431.next
1432.cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1433If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1434uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1435Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1436.endlist
1437
1438
1439Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1440it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1441part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1442&%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1443&%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1444going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1445example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1446
1447
1448
1449.section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1450.cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1451When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1452
1453.ilist
1454If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1455filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1456message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1457fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1458files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1459filtering'&.
1460.cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1461(&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1462
1463Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1464&<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1465filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1466if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1467be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1468condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1469filter.
1470.next
1471Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1472its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1473address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1474can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1475processed entirely independently of each other.
1476.next
1477.cindex "routing" "loops in"
1478.cindex "loop" "while routing"
1479A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1480transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1481is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1482Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1483from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1484process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1485which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1486.next
1487When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1488handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1489doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1490local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1491collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1492addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1493address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1494addresses to the same domain.
1495.next
1496Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1497non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1498deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1499to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1500run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1501one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1502The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1503deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1504.next
1505.cindex "queue runner"
1506When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1507database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1508address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1509Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1510reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1511queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1512follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1513better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1514causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1515.next
1516.cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1517Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1518deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1519retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1520reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1521not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1522.next
1523If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1524appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1525for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1526messages to other addresses.
1527.next
1528.cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1529If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1530the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1531&'deferred'&.
1532.next
1533When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1534handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1535deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1536.endlist
1537
1538
1539
1540
1541.section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1542.cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1543.cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1544.cindex "queue runner"
1545Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1546attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1547uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1548intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1549not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1550first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1551its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1552passed its retry time.
1553You can run several queue runners at once.
1554
1555Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1556address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1557should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1558bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1559error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1560as permanent.
1561
1562
1563
1564.section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1565.cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1566There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1567particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1568connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1569detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1570Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1571is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1572impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1573also apply.
1574
1575If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1576waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1577connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1578deferred,
1579.cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1580Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1581SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1582for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1583connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1584one connection.
1585
1586
1587
1588.section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1589.cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1590.cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1591When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1592bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1593errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1594delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1595many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1596attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1597message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1598See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1599
1600.cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1601Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1602failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1603automatically.
1604
1605.cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1606A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1607obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1608address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1609forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1610failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1611&<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1612of the list.
1613
1614
1615
1616.section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1617.cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1618If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1619itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1620but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1621that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1622for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1623&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1624
1625
1626
1627
1628
1629. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1630. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1631
1632.chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1633.scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1634
1635.section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1636Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1637creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1638&_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1639
1640.table2 140pt
1641.irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1642.irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1643 documented"
1644.irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1645.irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1646.irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1647.irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1648 instructions"
1649.endtable
1650
1651Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1652following subdirectories are created:
1653
1654.table2 140pt
1655.irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1656.irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1657.irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1658.irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1659.irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1660.irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1661.irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1662.endtable
1663
1664The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1665with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1666that may be useful to some sites.
1667
1668
1669.section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1670.cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1671The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1672a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1673source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1674Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1675system.
1676.cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1677Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1678the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1679architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1680overridden if necessary.
1681.cindex compiler requirements
1682.cindex compiler version
1683A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1684
1685
1686.section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1687.cindex "PCRE library"
1688Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1689modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1690to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1691system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1692process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1693headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1694and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1695or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1696If your operating system has no
1697PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1698from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1699More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1700
1701.section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1702.cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1703.cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1704Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1705DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1706databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1707different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1708
1709.cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1710.cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1711.cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1712.cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1713If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1714Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1715may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1716you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1717
1718.cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1719Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1720via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1721versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1722some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1723distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1724versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1725Berkeley DB library.
1726
1727Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1728use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1729possibilities:
1730
1731.olist
1732A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1733Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1734.next
1735.cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1736The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1737compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1738&_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1739file name is used unmodified.
1740.next
1741.cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1742The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1743operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1744programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1745.next
1746If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1747file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1748the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1749.next
1750To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1751Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
17522.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1753numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1754versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1755&url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1756.next
1757.cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1758Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1759&url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1760operates on a single file.
1761.endlist
1762
1763.cindex "USE_DB"
1764.cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1765Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1766to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1767USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1768&_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1769.code
1770USE_DB=yes
1771.endd
1772Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1773error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1774
1775At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1776thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1777configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1778Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1779configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1780&_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1781
1782As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1783necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1784in one of these lines:
1785.code
1786DBMLIB = -ldb
1787DBMLIB = -ltdb
1788.endd
1789Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1790place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1791the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1792file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1793this example:
1794.code
1795INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1796DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1797.endd
1798There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1799file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1800
1801
1802
1803.section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1804.cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1805.cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1806.cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1807.cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1808Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1809independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1810&_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1811&_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1812therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1813building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1814&_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1815
1816There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1817without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1818(CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1819(BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1820maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1821a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1822
1823There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1824at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1825machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1826directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1827you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1828detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1829be logged.
1830
1831.cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1832Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1833access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1834facilities, you need to set
1835.code
1836WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1837.endd
1838in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1839chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1840
1841
1842.cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1843.cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1844If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1845required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1846your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1847happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1848&_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1849
1850This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1851operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1852to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1853configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1854defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1855do this.
1856
1857
1858
1859.section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1860.cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1861.cindex "RFC 2047"
1862The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1863described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1864in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1865character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1866mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1867(default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1868supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1869
1870However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1871very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1872&url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1873systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1874&[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1875.code
1876HAVE_ICONV=yes
1877.endd
1878to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1879
1880
1881
1882.section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1883.cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1884.cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1885.cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1886.cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1887.cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1888Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1889command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1890start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1891&%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1892line option).
1893
1894If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1895OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1896implementing SSL.
1897
1898If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1899.code
1900SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1901TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1902.endd
1903in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1904OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1905.code
1906SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1907TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1908TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1909.endd
1910.cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1911If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1912.code
1913SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1914USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1915.endd
1916.cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1917If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1918.code
1919SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1920USE_GNUTLS=yes
1921TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1922.endd
1923in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1924library and include files. For example:
1925.code
1926SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1927USE_GNUTLS=yes
1928TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1929TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1930.endd
1931.cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1932If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1933.code
1934SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1935USE_GNUTLS=yes
1936USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1937.endd
1938
1939You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1940specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1941given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1942
1943
1944
1945
1946.section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1947
1948.cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1949.cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1950.cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1951.cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1952Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1953SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1954alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1955already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1956should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1957&_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1958&_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1959EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1960you might have
1961.code
1962USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1963CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1964EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1965.endd
1966in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1967files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1968.code
1969exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1970.endd
1971in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1972the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1973All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1974can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1975&_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1976configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1977further details.
1978
1979
1980.section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1981.cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1982Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1983&`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1984it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1985where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1986library files.
1987
1988Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1989defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1990currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1991as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1992over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
1993Exim used to
1994have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
1995withdrawn.
1996
1997
1998
1999.section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
2000.cindex "lookup modules"
2001.cindex "dynamic modules"
2002.cindex ".so building"
2003On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2004the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2005on demand.
2006This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2007library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2008dependencies.
2009Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2010
2011Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2012installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2013measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2014for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2015Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2016see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2017
2018Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2019&`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2020For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2021on demand:
2022.code
2023LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2024LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2025LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2026.endd
2027
2028
2029.section "The building process" "SECID29"
2030.cindex "build directory"
2031Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2032created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2033operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2034For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2035&_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2036.cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2037Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2038
2039If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2040a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2041&_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2042&'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2043then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2044number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2045makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2046directory, should this ever be necessary.
2047
2048If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2049&_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2050FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2051
2052
2053
2054.section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2055The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2056unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2057output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2058appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2059each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2060get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2061.code
2062FULLECHO='' make -e
2063.endd
2064The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2065command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2066given in addition to the short output.
2067
2068
2069
2070.section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2071.cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2072The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2073consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2074values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2075more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2076convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2077order:
2078.display
2079&_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2080&_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2081&_Local/Makefile_&
2082&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2083&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2084&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2085&_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2086.endd
2087.cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2088.cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2089.cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2090where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2091architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2092process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2093and are often not needed.
2094
2095The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2096called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2097the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2098values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2099Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2100fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2101of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2102that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2103to find out what values are being used on your system.
2104
2105
2106&_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2107therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2108needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2109file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2110default values are.
2111
2112
2113.cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2114If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2115or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2116need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2117putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2118.cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2119when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2120formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2121compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2122called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2123Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2124default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2125containing the lines
2126.code
2127CC=cc
2128CFLAGS=-std1
2129.endd
2130If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2131these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2132
2133Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2134files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2135the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2136
2137
2138.cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2139.cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2140.cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2141.cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2142Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2143lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2144not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2145and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2146which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2147case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2148.code
2149LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2150LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2151LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2152.endd
2153and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2154&_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2155libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2156.cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2157However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2158the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2159files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2160binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2161errors.
2162
2163.cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2164.cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2165Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2166about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2167being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2168makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2169variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2170name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2171&'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2172with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2173syntax. For instance:
2174.code
2175LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2176LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2177AUTH_GSASL=yes
2178AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2179AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2180AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2181.endd
2182
2183.cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2184Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2185subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2186.code
2187EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2188.endd
2189must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2190chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2191
2192.cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2193The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2194operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2195with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2196monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2197The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2198.code
2199X11=/usr/X11R6
2200XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2201XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2202.endd
2203These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2204example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2205.code
2206X11=/usr/openwin
2207XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2208XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2209.endd
2210If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2211definition of all three of these variables into your
2212&_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2213
2214.cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2215If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2216variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2217default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2218command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2219
2220.cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2221There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2222use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2223EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2224binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2225libraries.
2226
2227.cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2228The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2229files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2230necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2231&_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2232
2233
2234.section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2235.cindex "&_os.h_&"
2236.cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2237The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2238&_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2239normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2240recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2241are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2242
2243
2244
2245.section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2246.cindex "building Eximon"
2247A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2248where the files that are involved are
2249.display
2250&_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2251&_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2252&_Local/eximon.conf_&
2253&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2254&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2255&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2256.endd
2257.cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2258As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2259&_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2260&_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2261variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2262EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2263LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2264.ecindex IIDbuex
2265
2266
2267.section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2268.cindex "installing Exim"
2269.cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2270The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2271arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2272whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2273.cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2274The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2275going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2276&'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2277install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2278some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2279it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2280chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2281
2282.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2283Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2284in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2285exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2286by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2287is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2288alternative files, no default is installed.
2289
2290.cindex "system aliases file"
2291.cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2292One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2293default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2294The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2295SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2296If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2297and outputs a comment to the user.
2298
2299The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2300aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2301kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2302&_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2303Exim's configuration if necessary.
2304
2305The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2306and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2307running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2308directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2309other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2310over SMTP.
2311
2312It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2313distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2314command such as
2315.code
2316make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2317.endd
2318This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2319paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2320configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2321For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2322but this usage is deprecated.
2323
2324.cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2325Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2326&'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2327upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2328directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2329INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2330
2331For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2332to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2333installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2334for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2335called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2336of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2337from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2338
2339.cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2340If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2341real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2342command:
2343.code
2344make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2345.endd
2346The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2347script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2348the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2349directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2350command:
2351.code
2352(cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2353.endd
2354.cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2355There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2356
2357.ilist
2358&%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2359to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2360.next
2361&%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2362installed binary.
2363.endlist
2364
2365INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2366.code
2367make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2368.endd
2369The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2370to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2371without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2372.code
2373make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2374.endd
2375
2376
2377
2378.section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2379.cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2380Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2381reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2382distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2383&<<SECTavail>>&).
2384
2385If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2386source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2387install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2388
2389
2390
2391.section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2392.cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2393When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2394exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2395directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2396necessary.
2397
2398
2399
2400
2401.section "Testing" "SECID34"
2402.cindex "testing" "installation"
2403Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2404syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2405Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2406.code
2407exim -bV
2408.endd
2409If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2410Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2411the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2412other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2413Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2414example,
2415.display
2416&`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2417.endd
2418should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2419.display
2420&`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2421.endd
2422a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2423This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2424user agent. For example:
2425.code
2426exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2427From: user@your.domain.example
2428To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2429Subject: Testing Exim
2430
2431This is a test message.
2432^D
2433.endd
2434The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2435In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2436arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2437
2438.cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2439If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2440&'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2441of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2442&%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2443with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2444.display
2445&`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2446.endd
2447You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2448produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2449For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2450relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2451&<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2452
2453.cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2454.cindex "lock files"
2455One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2456local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2457&"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2458writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2459is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2460directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2461that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2462&(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2463approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2464&[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2465agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2466see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2467
2468One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2469the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2470&%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2471port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2472&'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2473incoming SMTP mail.
2474
2475Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2476be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2477within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2478that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2479production version.
2480
2481
2482.section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2483.cindex "replacing another MTA"
2484Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2485general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2486is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2487operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2488binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2489normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2490or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2491.cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2492a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2493privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2494and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2495
2496.cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2497.cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2498Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2499example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2500&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2501described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2502as follows:
2503.code
2504sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2505send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2506mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2507newaliases /usr/bin/true
2508.endd
2509Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2510your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2511favourite user agent.
2512
2513You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2514have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2515various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2516command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2517use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2518&'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2519
2520
2521
2522.section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2523.cindex "upgrading Exim"
2524If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2525version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2526call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2527to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2528new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2529version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2530configuration file.
2531
2532
2533
2534
2535.section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2536.cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2537The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2538.code
2539/etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2540.endd
2541If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2542fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2543for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2544(that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2545solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2546.code
2547pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2548.endd
2549to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2550
2551Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2552still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2553(the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2554
2555
2556
2557
2558. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2559. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2560
2561.chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2562.scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2563.scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2564Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2565each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2566options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2567some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2568combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2569The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2570
2571
2572.section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2573.cindex "&'mailq'&"
2574If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2575were present before any other options.
2576The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2577standard output.
2578This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2579that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2580&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2581
2582.cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2583If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2584were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2585&%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2586format.
2587
2588.cindex "&'rmail'&"
2589If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2590&%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2591Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2592
2593.cindex "&'runq'&"
2594.cindex "queue runner"
2595If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2596were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2597option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2598
2599.cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2600.cindex "alias file" "building"
2601.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2602If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2603&%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2604This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2605the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2606command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2607
2608
2609.section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2610Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2611available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2612user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2613EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2614&%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2615
2616.ilist
2617.cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2618.cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2619The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2620&%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2621supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2622configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2623
2624.cindex '&"From"& line'
2625.cindex "envelope sender"
2626Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2627&"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2628Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2629See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2630users to set envelope senders.
2631
2632.cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2633.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2634.cindex "header lines" "From:"
2635.cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
2636For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2637header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2638&'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2639
2640Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2641protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2642locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2643have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2644users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2645that are available to trusted users.
2646.next
2647.cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2648.cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2649The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2650Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2651The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2652
2653Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2654operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2655necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2656the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2657
2658By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2659Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2660However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2661option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2662
2663Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2664is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2665false.
2666.endlist
2667
2668
2669&*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2670edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2671getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2672&<<CHAPconf>>&.
2673
2674
2675
2676
2677.section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2678Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2679of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2680a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2681format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2682on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2683with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2684outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2685
2686. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2687. Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2688. options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2689. creates a man page for the options.
2690. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2691
2692.literal xml
2693<!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2694.literal off
2695
2696
2697.vlist
2698.vitem &%--%&
2699.oindex "--"
2700.cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2701This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2702therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2703rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2704
2705.vitem &%--help%&
2706.oindex "&%--help%&"
2707This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2708The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2709no arguments.
2710
2711.vitem &%--version%&
2712.oindex "&%--version%&"
2713This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2714displayed.
2715
2716.vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2717 &%-Am%&
2718.oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2719.oindex "&%-Am%&"
2720These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2721ignored by Exim.
2722
2723.vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2724.oindex "&%-B%&"
2725.cindex "8-bit characters"
2726.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2727This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2728clean; it ignores this option.
2729
2730.vitem &%-bd%&
2731.oindex "&%-bd%&"
2732.cindex "daemon"
2733.cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2734.cindex "queue runner"
2735This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2736the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2737that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2738
2739The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2740(debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2741disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2742stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2743
2744By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2745all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2746ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2747&<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2748
2749When a listening daemon
2750.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2751.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2752is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2753configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2754in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2755PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2756running as root.
2757
2758When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2759process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2760used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2761
2762The SIGHUP signal
2763.cindex "SIGHUP"
2764.cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2765can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2766whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2767means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2768of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2769referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2770because these are reread each time they are used.
2771
2772.vitem &%-bdf%&
2773.oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2774This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2775from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2776
2777.vitem &%-be%&
2778.oindex "&%-be%&"
2779.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2780.cindex "expansion" "testing"
2781Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2782prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2783files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2784of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2785
2786If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2787to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2788used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2789function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2790test data. A line history is supported.
2791
2792Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2793continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2794continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2795string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2796configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2797message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2798is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2799
2800&*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2801files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2802the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2803of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2804
2805Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2806defined and macros will be expanded.
2807Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2808available to admin users.
2809
2810.vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2811.oindex "&%-bem%&"
2812.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2813.cindex "expansion" "testing"
2814This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2815of a file. For example:
2816.code
2817exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2818.endd
2819The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2820message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2821variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2822no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2823recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2824&$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2825line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2826&%-be%&).
2827
2828.vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2829.oindex "&%-bF%&"
2830.cindex "system filter" "testing"
2831.cindex "testing" "system filter"
2832This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2833tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2834system filters are recognized.
2835
2836.vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2837.oindex "&%-bf%&"
2838.cindex "filter" "testing"
2839.cindex "testing" "filter file"
2840.cindex "forward file" "testing"
2841.cindex "testing" "forward file"
2842.cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2843This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2844to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2845there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2846supplied.
2847
2848If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2849can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2850filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2851.code
2852exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2853.endd
2854This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2855variables that are used by the user filter.
2856
2857If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2858.code
2859# Exim filter
2860# Sieve filter
2861.endd
2862it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2863that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2864&<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2865redirection lists.
2866
2867The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2868detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2869with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2870separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2871
2872When testing a filter file,
2873.cindex "&""From""& line"
2874.cindex "envelope sender"
2875.oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2876the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2877or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2878that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2879can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2880options).
2881
2882.vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2883.oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2884.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2885This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2886tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2887&$qualify_domain$&.
2888
2889.vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2890.oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2891This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2892tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2893process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2894suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2895actually being delivered.
2896
2897.vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2898.oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2899This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2900file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2901prefix.
2902
2903.vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2904.oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2905This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2906file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2907suffix.
2908
2909.vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2910.oindex "&%-bh%&"
2911.cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2912.cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2913.cindex "testing" "relay control"
2914.cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2915.cindex "policy control" "testing"
2916.cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2917This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2918standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2919after a full stop. For example:
2920.code
2921exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2922exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2923.endd
2924When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2925of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2926conversion to the canonical form is
2927&`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2928
2929Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2930include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2931This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2932messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2933test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2934
2935&*Warning 1*&:
2936.cindex "RFC 1413"
2937You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2938information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2939an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2940connection.
2941
2942&*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2943are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2944occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2945
2946Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2947written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2948lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2949can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2950and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2951session were authenticated.
2952
2953The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2954output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2955acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2956
2957Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2958plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2959specialized SMTP test program such as
2960&url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2961
2962.vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2963.oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2964This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2965verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2966updating the callout cache database.
2967
2968.vitem &%-bi%&
2969.oindex "&%-bi%&"
2970.cindex "alias file" "building"
2971.cindex "building alias file"
2972.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2973Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2974Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2975this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2976tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2977recognized.
2978
2979If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2980configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2981the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2982The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2983use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2984if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2985&%-bi%& is a no-op.
2986
2987. // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2988.vitem &%-bI:help%&
2989.oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2990.cindex "querying exim information"
2991We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2992information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2993consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2994synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2995options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2996
2997.vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
2998.oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2999.cindex "DSCP" "values"
3000This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
3001recognised DSCP names.
3002
3003.vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
3004.oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
3005.cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
3006This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
3007Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3008useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3009&`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3010compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3011way to guarantee a correct response.
3012
3013.vitem &%-bm%&
3014.oindex "&%-bm%&"
3015.cindex "local message reception"
3016This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3017locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3018command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3019argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3020default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3021if no other conflicting option is present.
3022
3023If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3024qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3025options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3026suppressing this for special cases.
3027
3028Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3029the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3030
3031.cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3032The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3033action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3034
3035The format
3036.cindex "message" "format"
3037.cindex "format" "message"
3038.cindex "&""From""& line"
3039.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3040.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3041of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3042compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3043.code
3044From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3045From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3046.endd
3047(with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3048is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3049authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3050matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3051option, which can be changed if necessary.
3052
3053.oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3054The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3055&%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3056preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3057trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3058
3059.vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3060.oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3061.cindex "testing", "malware"
3062.cindex "malware scan test"
3063This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3064(depending on the used scanner interface),
3065using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3066this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3067the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3068not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3069will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3070
3071Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3072using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3073user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3074This option requires admin privileges.
3075
3076The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3077there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3078administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3079
3080.vitem &%-bnq%&
3081.oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3082.cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3083By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3084without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3085is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3086envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3087&%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3088defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3089
3090Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3091being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3092content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3093header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3094syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3095
3096The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3097messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3098addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3099unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3100
3101
3102.vitem &%-bP%&
3103.oindex "&%-bP%&"
3104.cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3105.cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3106If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3107main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3108of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3109arguments, for example:
3110.code
3111exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3112.endd
3113.cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3114.cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3115.cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3116However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3117configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3118users, the output is as in this example:
3119.code
3120mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3121.endd
3122If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3123output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3124
3125If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3126configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3127backward compatibility.)
3128If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3129is the name of the file that was actually used.
3130
3131.cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3132If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3133name will not be output.
3134
3135.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3136.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3137If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3138directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3139respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3140sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3141written directly into the spool directory.
3142
3143If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3144.code
3145exim -bP +local_domains
3146.endd
3147it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3148local part) and outputs what it finds.
3149
3150.cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3151.cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3152.cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3153If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3154followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3155that driver are output. For example:
3156.code
3157exim -bP transport local_delivery
3158.endd
3159The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3160options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3161using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3162&%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3163settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3164&%authenticators%&.
3165
3166.cindex "environment"
3167If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3168variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3169variables.
3170
3171.cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3172If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3173are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3174for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3175The output format is one item per line.
3176For the "-bP macro <name>" form, if no such macro is found
3177the exit status will be nonzero.
3178
3179.vitem &%-bp%&
3180.oindex "&%-bp%&"
3181.cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3182.cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3183This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3184standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3185just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3186admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3187to allow any user to see the queue.
3188
3189Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3190.code
319125m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3192 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3193 <other addresses>
3194.endd
3195.cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3196.cindex "size" "of message"
3197The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3198(in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3199identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3200envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3201&"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3202the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3203before the sender address.
3204
3205.cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3206If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3207&"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3208
3209The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3210displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3211been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3212expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3213displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3214complete.
3215
3216
3217.vitem &%-bpa%&
3218.oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3219This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3220that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3221alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3222of just &"D"&.
3223
3224
3225.vitem &%-bpc%&
3226.oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3227.cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3228This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3229to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3230&%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3231
3232
3233.vitem &%-bpr%&
3234.oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3235This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3236chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3237lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3238going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3239
3240.vitem &%-bpra%&
3241.oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3242This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3243
3244.vitem &%-bpru%&
3245.oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3246This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3247
3248
3249.vitem &%-bpu%&
3250.oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3251This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3252addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3253forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3254router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3255
3256
3257.vitem &%-brt%&
3258.oindex "&%-brt%&"
3259.cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3260.cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3261This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3262arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3263and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3264.code
3265exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3266Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3267.endd
3268See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3269argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3270&'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3271contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3272retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3273with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3274rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3275sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3276used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3277.code
3278exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3279Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3280.endd
3281
3282.vitem &%-brw%&
3283.oindex "&%-brw%&"
3284.cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3285.cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3286This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3287a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3288complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3289would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3290&<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3291
3292.vitem &%-bS%&
3293.oindex "&%-bS%&"
3294.cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3295.cindex "batched SMTP input"
3296This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3297for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3298submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3299input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3300input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3301&%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3302believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3303
3304The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3305dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3306provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3307
3308As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3309messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3310Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3311&%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3312
3313Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3314as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3315QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3316
3317.cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3318If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3319error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3320was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3321was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3322
3323More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3324&<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3325
3326.vitem &%-bs%&
3327.oindex "&%-bs%&"
3328.cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3329.cindex "local SMTP input"
3330This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3331on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3332policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3333Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3334messages to the MTA.
3335
3336In
3337.cindex "sender" "source of"
3338this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3339set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3340Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3341the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3342&%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3343&%-bnq%& option is used.
3344
3345.cindex "inetd"
3346The
3347&%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3348using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3349whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3350&'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3351above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3352Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3353the listening daemon.
3354
3355.vitem &%-bt%&
3356.oindex "&%-bt%&"
3357.cindex "testing" "addresses"
3358.cindex "address" "testing"
3359This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3360as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3361written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3362user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3363sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3364
3365If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3366right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3367
3368Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3369&[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3370security issues.
3371
3372Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3373(compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3374written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3375&%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3376genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3377program.
3378
3379.cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3380The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3381failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3382code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3383
3384.cindex "duplicate addresses"
3385&*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3386addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3387This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3388always shown.
3389
3390&*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3391routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3392message,
3393.oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3394you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3395&%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3396default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3397whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3398those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3399doing such tests.
3400
3401.vitem &%-bV%&
3402.oindex "&%-bV%&"
3403.cindex "version number of Exim"
3404This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3405number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3406It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3407specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3408name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3409
3410As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3411configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3412values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3413detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3414alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3415realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3416dynamic testing facilities.
3417
3418.vitem &%-bv%&
3419.oindex "&%-bv%&"
3420.cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3421.cindex "address" "verification"
3422This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3423taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3424not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3425happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3426(see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3427including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3428
3429If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3430failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3431usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3432
3433If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3434right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3435
3436Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3437&[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3438security issues.
3439
3440Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3441that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3442router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3443verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3444address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3445
3446If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3447address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3448latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3449causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3450addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3451and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3452to succeed.
3453
3454When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3455and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3456considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3457
3458The
3459.cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3460return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3461failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3462code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3463
3464If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3465address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3466sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3467calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3468
3469.vitem &%-bvs%&
3470.oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3471This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3472than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3473might happen.
3474
3475.vitem &%-bw%&
3476.oindex "&%-bw%&"
3477.cindex "daemon"
3478.cindex "inetd"
3479.cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3480This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3481similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3482and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3483
3484In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3485listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3486inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3487each port only when the first connection is received.
3488
3489If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3490which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3491
3492.vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3493.oindex "&%-C%&"
3494.cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3495.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3496.cindex "alternate configuration file"
3497This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3498list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3499compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3500name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3501file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3502proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3503
3504When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3505from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3506runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3507However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3508file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3509which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3510listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3511CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3512not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3513
3514Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3515configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3516even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3517running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3518delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3519test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3520on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3521
3522If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3523prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3524must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3525However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3526CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3527usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3528unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3529
3530ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3531to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3532broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3533configuration file.
3534
3535The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3536syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3537caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3538require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3539specified by this option.
3540
3541
3542.vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3543.oindex "&%-D%&"
3544.cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3545This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3546(see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3547unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3548If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3549completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3550
3551If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3552colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3553supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3554not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3555the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3556to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3557regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3558
3559The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3560command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3561string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3562synonymous:
3563.code
3564exim -DABC ...
3565exim -DABC= ...
3566.endd
3567To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3568quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3569example:
3570.code
3571exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3572.endd
3573&%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3574Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3575
3576
3577.vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3578.oindex "&%-d%&"
3579.cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3580.cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3581This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3582error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3583database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3584filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3585writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3586return code.
3587
3588When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3589standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3590some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3591made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3592of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3593debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3594no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3595are:
3596.display
3597&`acl `& ACL interpretation
3598&`auth `& authenticators
3599&`deliver `& general delivery logic
3600&`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3601&`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3602&`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3603&`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3604&`filter `& filter handling
3605&`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3606&`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3607&`ident `& ident lookup
3608&`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3609&`lists `& matching things in lists
3610&`load `& system load checks
3611&`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3612 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3613&`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3614&`memory `& memory handling
3615&`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3616&`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3617&`queue_run `& queue runs
3618&`receive `& general message reception logic
3619&`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3620&`retry `& retry handling
3621&`rewrite `& address rewriting
3622&`route `& address routing
3623&`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3624&`tls `& TLS logic
3625&`transport `& transports
3626&`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3627&`verify `& address verification logic
3628&`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3629.endd
3630The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3631for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3632tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3633is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3634generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3635turn everything off.
3636
3637.cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3638.cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3639The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3640with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3641unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3642rather than stderr.
3643
3644The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3645&`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3646However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3647daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3648automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3649run in parallel.
3650
3651The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3652of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3653in processing.
3654
3655If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3656any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3657
3658.vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3659.oindex "&%-dd%&"
3660This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3661starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3662subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3663behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3664
3665.vitem &%-dropcr%&
3666.oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3667This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3668handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3669described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3670
3671.vitem &%-E%&
3672.oindex "&%-E%&"
3673.cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3674This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3675failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3676and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3677generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3678could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3679follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3680new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3681
3682.vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3683.oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3684There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3685called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3686example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3687form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3688
3689.vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3690.oindex "&%-F%&"
3691.cindex "sender" "name"
3692.cindex "name" "of sender"
3693This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3694message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3695entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3696their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3697between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3698
3699.vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3700.oindex "&%-f%&"
3701.cindex "sender" "address"
3702.cindex "address" "sender"
3703.cindex "trusted users"
3704.cindex "envelope sender"
3705.cindex "user" "trusted"
3706This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3707message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3708by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3709users to use it.
3710
3711Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3712trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3713options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3714of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3715domain.
3716
3717There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3718can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3719never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3720string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3721examples of shell commands:
3722.code
3723exim -f '<>' user@domain
3724exim -f "" user@domain
3725.endd
3726In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3727with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3728&%-bv%& options.
3729
3730Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3731it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3732refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3733though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3734
3735White
3736.cindex "&""From""& line"
3737space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3738given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3739locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3740&"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3741if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3742
3743.vitem &%-G%&
3744.oindex "&%-G%&"
3745.cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3746This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3747.code
3748control = suppress_local_fixups
3749.endd
3750for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3751bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3752in future.
3753
3754As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3755this option.
3756
3757.vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3758.oindex "&%-h%&"
3759.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3760This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3761Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3762headers.)
3763
3764.vitem &%-i%&
3765.oindex "&%-i%&"
3766.cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3767.cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3768This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3769line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3770no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3771command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3772
3773.vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3774.oindex "&%-L%&"
3775.cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3776This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3777file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3778Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3779read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3780effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3781
3782The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3783
3784.vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3785.oindex "&%-M%&"
3786.cindex "forcing delivery"
3787.cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3788.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3789This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3790any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3791delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3792and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3793
3794Retry
3795.cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3796hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3797the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3798to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3799which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3800for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3801
3802The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3803not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3804produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3805use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3806
3807.vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3808.oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3809.cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3810.cindex "recipient" "adding"
3811This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3812message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3813id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3814active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3815can be used only by an admin user.
3816
3817.vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3818 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3819.oindex "&%-MC%&"
3820.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3821.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3822.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3823This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3824by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3825an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3826given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3827must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3828
3829.vitem &%-MCA%&
3830.oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3831This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3832by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3833connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3834
3835.vitem &%-MCD%&
3836.oindex "&%-MCD%&"
3837This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3838by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3839remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3840
3841.vitem &%-MCG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>
3842.oindex "&%-MCG%&"
3843This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3844by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3845alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3846
3847.vitem &%-MCK%&
3848.oindex "&%-MCK%&"
3849This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3850by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that a
3851remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3852
3853.vitem &%-MCP%&
3854.oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3855This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3856by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3857which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3858
3859.vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3860.oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3861This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3862by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3863started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3864together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3865signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3866messages through the same SMTP connection.
3867
3868.vitem &%-MCS%&
3869.oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3870This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3871by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3872SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3873connection.
3874
3875.vitem &%-MCT%&
3876.oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3877This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3878by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3879host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3880
3881.vitem &%-MCt%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
3882.oindex "&%-MCt%&"
3883This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3884by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3885connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
3886The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
3887
3888.vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3889.oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3890.cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3891.cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3892This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3893but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3894that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3895provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3896order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3897However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3898respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3899overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3900If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3901&%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3902and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3903
3904.vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3905.oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3906.cindex "message" "changing sender"
3907.cindex "sender" "changing"
3908This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3909given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3910&"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3911be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3912is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3913This option can be used only by an admin user.
3914
3915.vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3916.oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3917.cindex "freezing messages"
3918.cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3919This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3920prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3921either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3922However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3923attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3924user.
3925
3926.vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3927.oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3928.cindex "giving up on messages"
3929.cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3930.cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3931This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3932including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3933their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3934is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3935Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3936user.
3937
3938.vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3939.oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3940.cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3941This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3942as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3943message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3944altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3945
3946.vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3947.oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3948.cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3949.cindex "recipient" "removing"
3950.cindex "removing recipients"
3951This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3952(&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3953the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3954addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3955(in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3956can be used only by an admin user.
3957
3958.vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3959.oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3960.cindex "removing messages"
3961.cindex "abandoning mail"
3962.cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3963This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3964bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3965the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3966only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3967placed on the queue.
3968
3969.vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3970.oindex "&%-Mset%&
3971.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3972.cindex "expansion" "testing"
3973This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3974string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3975the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3976&$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3977available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3978make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3979user. See also &%-bem%&.
3980
3981.vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3982.oindex "&%-Mt%&"
3983.cindex "thawing messages"
3984.cindex "unfreezing messages"
3985.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3986.cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3987This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3988&"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3989messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3990by an admin user.
3991
3992.vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3993.oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
3994.cindex "listing" "message body"
3995.cindex "message" "listing body of"
3996This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3997written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3998
3999.vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4000.oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
4001.cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
4002.cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
4003This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
4004be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
4005only by an admin user.
4006
4007.vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4008.oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
4009.cindex "listing" "message headers"
4010.cindex "header lines" "listing"
4011.cindex "message" "listing header lines"
4012This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4013written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4014
4015.vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4016.oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
4017.cindex "listing" "message log"
4018.cindex "message" "listing message log"
4019This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4020the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4021
4022.vitem &%-m%&
4023.oindex "&%-m%&"
4024This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
4025treats it that way too.
4026
4027.vitem &%-N%&
4028.oindex "&%-N%&"
4029.cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4030.cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4031This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4032level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4033it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4034had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4035database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4036than &"=>"&.
4037
4038Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4039user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4040words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4041which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4042address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4043routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4044the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4045for that message.
4046
4047.vitem &%-n%&
4048.oindex "&%-n%&"
4049This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4050For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4051When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4052option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4053
4054.vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4055.oindex "&%-O%&"
4056This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4057Exim.
4058
4059.vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4060.oindex "&%-oA%&"
4061.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4062This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4063alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4064description above.
4065
4066.vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4067.oindex "&%-oB%&"
4068.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4069.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4070.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4071This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4072be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4073transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4074
4075.vitem &%-odb%&
4076.oindex "&%-odb%&"
4077.cindex "background delivery"
4078.cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4079This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4080including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4081messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4082delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4083processes to finish.
4084
4085When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4086leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4087and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4088This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4089
4090If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4091(&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4092overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4093setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4094
4095.vitem &%-odf%&
4096.oindex "&%-odf%&"
4097.cindex "foreground delivery"
4098.cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4099This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4100accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4101&%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4102and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4103
4104The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4105process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4106during deliveries.
4107
4108However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4109false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4110
4111If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4112message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4113process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4114restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4115
4116
4117.vitem &%-odi%&
4118.oindex "&%-odi%&"
4119This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4120Sendmail.
4121
4122.vitem &%-odq%&
4123.oindex "&%-odq%&"
4124.cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4125.cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4126.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4127This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4128including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4129not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4130are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4131process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4132&%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4133conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4134forces queueing.
4135
4136.vitem &%-odqs%&
4137.oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4138.cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4139This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4140However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4141&%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4142configuration file is in effect.
4143
4144When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4145message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4146also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4147in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4148done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4149runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4150messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4151host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4152configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4153&%-qq%& option.
4154
4155.vitem &%-oee%&
4156.oindex "&%-oee%&"
4157.cindex "error" "reporting"
4158If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4159example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4160message.
4161
4162.cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4163Provided
4164this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4165exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4166is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4167This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4168
4169.vitem &%-oem%&
4170.oindex "&%-oem%&"
4171.cindex "error" "reporting"
4172.cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4173This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4174return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4175This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4176
4177.vitem &%-oep%&
4178.oindex "&%-oep%&"
4179.cindex "error" "reporting"
4180If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4181error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4182.cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4183The return code is 1 for all errors.
4184
4185.vitem &%-oeq%&
4186.oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4187.cindex "error" "reporting"
4188This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4189effect as &%-oep%&.
4190
4191.vitem &%-oew%&
4192.oindex "&%-oew%&"
4193.cindex "error" "reporting"
4194This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4195effect as &%-oem%&.
4196
4197.vitem &%-oi%&
4198.oindex "&%-oi%&"
4199.cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4200This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4201line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4202single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4203lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4204&'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4205
4206.vitem &%-oitrue%&
4207.oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4208This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4209
4210.vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4211.oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4212.cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4213A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4214with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4215over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4216&%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4217other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4218
4219The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4220number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4221.code
4222exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4223.endd
4224An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4225followed by a colon and the port number:
4226.code
4227exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4228.endd
4229The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4230port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4231are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4232whichever one is last.
4233
4234.vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4235.oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4236.cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4237See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4238option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4239name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4240This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4241authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4242
4243.vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4244.oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4245.cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4246See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4247option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4248This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4249where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4250&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4251
4252.vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4253.oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4254.cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4255See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4256option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4257overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4258messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4259default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4260specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4261&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4262
4263.vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4264.oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4265.cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4266See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4267option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4268using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4269&$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4270
4271.vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4272.oindex "&%-oMm%&"
4273.cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4274See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4275option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4276delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4277messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4278abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4279running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4280
4281The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4282The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4283is sending the bounce.
4284
4285.vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4286.oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4287.cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4288.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4289See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4290option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4291&$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4292or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4293SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4294&<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4295one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4296be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4297
4298.vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4299.oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4300.cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4301See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4302option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4303present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4304uses the name it is given.
4305
4306.vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4307.oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4308.cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4309See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4310option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4311local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4312used, when there is no default.
4313
4314.vitem &%-om%&
4315.oindex "&%-om%&"
4316.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4317In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4318message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4319expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4320
4321.vitem &%-oo%&
4322.oindex "&%-oo%&"
4323.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4324This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4325whatever that means.
4326
4327.vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4328.oindex "&%-oP%&"
4329.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4330.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4331This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4332value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4333written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4334without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4335because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4336
4337.vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4338.oindex "&%-or%&"
4339.cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4340This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4341set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4342by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4343described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4344
4345.vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4346.oindex "&%-os%&"
4347.cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4348.cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4349This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4350applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4351the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4352for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4353
4354.vitem &%-ov%&
4355.oindex "&%-ov%&"
4356This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4357
4358.vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4359.oindex "&%-oX%&"
4360.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4361.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4362.cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4363This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4364is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4365of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4366in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4367file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4368
4369.vitem &%-pd%&
4370.oindex "&%-pd%&"
4371.cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4372This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4373chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4374option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4375needed.
4376
4377.vitem &%-ps%&
4378.oindex "&%-ps%&"
4379.cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4380This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4381chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4382option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4383started.
4384
4385.vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4386.oindex "&%-p%&"
4387For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4388.display
4389&`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4390.endd
4391It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4392host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4393Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4394to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4395or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4396Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4397
4398.vitem &%-q%&
4399.oindex "&%-q%&"
4400.cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4401This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4402configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4403relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4404and &%-S%& options).
4405
4406.cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4407If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4408the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4409waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4410for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4411process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4412have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4413
4414If
4415.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4416.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4417.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4418the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4419passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4420proceeding.
4421
4422When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4423process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4424mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4425this to be repeated periodically.
4426
4427Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4428random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4429If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4430MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4431
4432It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4433order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4434&%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4435
4436.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4437The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4438behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4439appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4440
4441.vitem &%-qq...%&
4442.oindex "&%-qq%&"
4443.cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4444.cindex "queue" "routing"
4445.cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4446An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4447stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4448every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4449transports are run.
4450
4451.cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4452The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4453is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4454complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4455place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4456delivered down a single SMTP
4457.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4458.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4459.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4460connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4461This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4462intermittently.
4463
4464.vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4465.oindex "&%-qi%&"
4466.cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4467If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4468those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4469delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4470&%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4471
4472.vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4473.oindex "&%-qf%&"
4474.cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4475.cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4476If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4477message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4478their retry times are tried.
4479
4480.vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4481.oindex "&%-qff%&"
4482.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4483If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4484frozen or not.
4485
4486.vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4487.oindex "&%-ql%&"
4488.cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4489The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4490be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4491for later delivery.
4492
4493.vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4494.oindex "&%-qG%&"
4495.cindex queue named
4496.cindex "named queues"
4497.cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4498If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4499queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4500The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4501For a periodic queue run (see below)
4502append to the name a slash and a time value.
4503
4504If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4505will specify a queue to operate on.
4506For example:
4507.code
4508exim -bp -qGquarantine
4509mailq -qGquarantine
4510exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4511.endd
4512
4513.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4514When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4515lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4516starting message id. For example:
4517.code
4518exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4519.endd
4520Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4521second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4522are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4523.code
4524exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4525.endd
4526just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4527&%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4528that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4529mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4530are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4531queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4532
4533.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4534.cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4535.cindex "periodic queue running"
4536When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4537starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4538(whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4539&%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4540single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4541combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4542.code
4543/usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4544.endd
4545Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4546process every 30 minutes.
4547
4548When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4549pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4550
4551.vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4552.oindex "&%-qR%&"
4553This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4554compatibility.
4555
4556.vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4557.oindex "&%-qS%&"
4558This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4559
4560.vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4561.oindex "&%-R%&"
4562.cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4563.cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4564.cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4565The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4566is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4567which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4568<&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4569
4570This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4571perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4572queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4573address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4574way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4575regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4576
4577If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4578you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4579.code
4580exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4581.endd
4582This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4583every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4584applied to each queue run.
4585
4586Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4587are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4588information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4589means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4590existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4591address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4592will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4593information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4594address will be skipped.
4595
4596.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4597If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4598all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4599&'ff'& is present.
4600
4601The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4602to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4603command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4604effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4605an arbitrary command instead.
4606
4607.vitem &%-r%&
4608.oindex "&%-r%&"
4609This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4610
4611.vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4612.oindex "&%-S%&"
4613.cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4614.cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4615This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4616message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4617conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4618has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4619
4620.vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4621.oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4622This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4623recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4624&"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4625
4626.vitem &%-t%&
4627.oindex "&%-t%&"
4628.cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4629.cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4630.cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4631.cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4632When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4633input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4634from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4635from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4636takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4637
4638.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4639If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4640is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4641the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4642and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4643Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4644Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4645argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4646Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4647instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4648&%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4649
4650.cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4651If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4652recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4653lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4654with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4655&%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4656
4657RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4658message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4659added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4660not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4661nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4662In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4663are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4664once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4665&%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4666
4667.vitem &%-ti%&
4668.oindex "&%-ti%&"
4669This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4670compatibility with Sendmail.
4671
4672.vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4673.oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4674.cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4675.cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4676This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4677incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4678&%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4679&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4680
4681
4682.vitem &%-U%&
4683.oindex "&%-U%&"
4684.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4685Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4686documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4687syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4688set. Exim ignores this option.
4689
4690.vitem &%-v%&
4691.oindex "&%-v%&"
4692This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4693describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4694receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4695dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4696the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4697selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4698unconditional.
4699
4700.vitem &%-x%&
4701.oindex "&%-x%&"
4702AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4703National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4704It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4705this option.
4706
4707.vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4708.oindex "&%-X%&"
4709This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4710to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4711
4712.vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4713.oindex "&%-z%&"
4714This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4715Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4716Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4717under most shells.
4718.endlist
4719
4720.ecindex IIDclo1
4721.ecindex IIDclo2
4722
4723
4724. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4725. Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4726. line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4727. creates a man page for the options.
4728. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4729
4730.literal xml
4731<!-- === End of command line options === -->
4732.literal off
4733
4734
4735
4736
4737
4738. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4739. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4740
4741
4742.chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4743 "The runtime configuration file"
4744
4745.cindex "run time configuration"
4746.cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4747.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4748.cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4749.cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4750.cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4751Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4752binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4753because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4754control.
4755
4756If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4757writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4758The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4759errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4760not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4761actually alter the string.
4762
4763The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4764reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4765most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4766give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4767existing file in the list.
4768
4769.cindex "EXIM_USER"
4770.cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4771.cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4772.cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4773.cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4774.cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4775The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4776specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4777configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4778group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4779CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4780
4781&*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4782to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4783easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4784CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4785who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4786
4787Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4788be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4789since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4790compromise the Exim user account.
4791
4792A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4793is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4794defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4795configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4796CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4797&<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4798configuration.
4799
4800
4801
4802.section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4803.cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4804A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4805option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4806&%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4807unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4808CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4809is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4810is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4811installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4812specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4813
4814Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4815with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4816listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4817testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4818delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4819Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4820the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4821can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4822message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4823&%-M%&).
4824
4825If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4826prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4827start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4828There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4829name can be used with &%-C%&.
4830
4831One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4832option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4833configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4834non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4835If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4836completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4837
4838The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4839to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4840necessarily be discarded.
4841WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4842considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4843values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4844is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4845transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4846values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4847
4848Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4849share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4850If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4851looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4852and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4853file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4854each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4855
4856In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4857different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4858help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4859
4860
4861
4862.section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4863.cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4864.cindex "format" "configuration file"
4865Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4866option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4867are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4868is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4869space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4870
4871.ilist
4872&'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4873&<<CHAPACL>>&).
4874.next
4875.cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4876&'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4877are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4878.next
4879&'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4880addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4881&<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4882.next
4883&'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4884define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4885&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4886.next
4887&'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4888If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4889defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4890are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4891&<<CHAPretry>>&.
4892.next
4893&'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4894when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4895chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4896.next
4897&'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4898want to use this feature, you must set
4899.code
4900LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4901.endd
4902in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4903facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4904.endlist
4905
4906.cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4907.cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4908.cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4909Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4910
4911Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4912leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4913# character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4914and does not introduce a comment.
4915
4916Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4917the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4918backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4919lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4920appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4921
4922A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4923default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4924change settings as required.
4925
4926The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4927described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4928respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4929items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4930onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4931described.
4932
4933
4934
4935.section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4936.cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4937.cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4938.cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4939.cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4940You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4941using this syntax:
4942.display
4943&`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4944&`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4945.endd
4946on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4947the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4948second form does nothing for non-existent files.
4949The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
4950the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute file
4951name is required.
4952
4953Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4954configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4955If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4956because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4957
4958The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4959comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4960for example:
4961.code
4962hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4963 .include /some/file
4964.endd
4965Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4966process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4967inclusion appears.
4968
4969
4970
4971.section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4972.cindex "macro" "description of"
4973.cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4974If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4975&"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4976definition, and must be of the form
4977.display
4978<&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4979.endd
4980The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4981in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4982continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4983space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4984a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4985
4986Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4987definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4988ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4989
4990.section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4991Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4992files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4993scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4994replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4995for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4996the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4997define
4998.display
4999&`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
5000&`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
5001.endd
5002but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
5003error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
5004before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
5005consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
5006line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
5007comment line or a &`.include`& line.
5008
5009
5010.section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
5011Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
5012(or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5013&'='&. For example:
5014.code
5015MAC = initial value
5016...
5017MAC == updated value
5018.endd
5019Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5020subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5021the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5022Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5023.code
5024MAC = initial value
5025...
5026MAC == MAC and something added
5027.endd
5028This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5029from a number of other files.
5030
5031.section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5032The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5033&%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5034used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5035using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5036file to be ignored.
5037
5038
5039
5040.section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5041As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5042up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5043strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5044.code
5045ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5046 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5047.endd
5048This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5049.code
5050data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5051.endd
5052In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5053address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5054section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5055
5056
5057.section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5058Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5059differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5060All of these macros start with an underscore.
5061They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5062(see below).
5063
5064The following classes of macros are defined:
5065.display
5066&` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5067&` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5068&` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5069&` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5070&` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5071&` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5072&` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5073&` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5074&` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5075&` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5076&` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5077.endd
5078
5079Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5080
5081
5082.section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5083.cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5084.cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5085You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5086&`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5087portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5088read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5089
5090The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5091be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5092that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5093line. Thus:
5094.code
5095.ifdef AAA
5096message_size_limit = 50M
5097.else
5098message_size_limit = 100M
5099.endif
5100.endd
5101sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5102(or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5103otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5104is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5105obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5106
5107Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5108it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5109in this line"& will always be true.
5110
5111Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5112to clarify complicated nestings.
5113
5114
5115
5116.section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5117.cindex "common option syntax"
5118.cindex "syntax of common options"
5119.cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5120For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5121each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5122lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5123these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5124space) and then the value. For example:
5125.code
5126qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5127.endd
5128.cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5129.cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5130.cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5131Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5132accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5133line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5134word &"hide"&. For example:
5135.code
5136hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5137.endd
5138For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5139.code
5140mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5141.endd
5142If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5143all instances of the same driver.
5144
5145The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5146that are found in option settings.
5147
5148
5149.section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5150.cindex "format" "boolean"
5151.cindex "boolean configuration values"
5152.oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5153.oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5154Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5155different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5156the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5157if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5158boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5159&"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5160the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5161.code
5162queue_only
5163queue_only = true
5164.endd
5165The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5166.code
5167no_queue_only
5168queue_only = false
5169.endd
5170You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5171
5172
5173
5174
5175.section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5176.cindex "integer configuration values"
5177.cindex "format" "integer"
5178If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5179hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5180number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5181with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5182hexadecimal number.
5183
5184If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5185it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5186if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5187When the values
5188of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
51891024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5190and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5191used.
5192
5193
5194.section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5195.cindex "integer format"
5196.cindex "format" "octal integer"
5197If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5198interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5199Such options are always output in octal.
5200
5201
5202.section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5203.cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5204.cindex "format" "fixed point"
5205If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5206integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5207
5208
5209
5210.section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5211.cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5212.cindex "format" "time interval"
5213A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5214the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5215
5216.table2 30pt
5217.irow &%s%& seconds
5218.irow &%m%& minutes
5219.irow &%h%& hours
5220.irow &%d%& days
5221.irow &%w%& weeks
5222.endtable
5223
5224For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5225intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5226is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5227
5228
5229
5230.section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5231.cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5232.cindex "format" "string"
5233If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5234or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5235consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5236the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5237removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5238Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5239appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5240therefore equivalent:
5241.code
5242trusted_users = uucp:mail
5243trusted_users = uucp:\
5244 # This comment line is ignored
5245 mail
5246.endd
5247.cindex "string" "quoted"
5248.cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5249If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5250double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5251continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5252
5253.table2 100pt
5254.irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5255.irow &`\n`& "newline"
5256.irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5257.irow &`\t`& "tab"
5258.irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5259.irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5260 character"
5261.endtable
5262
5263If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5264character, that character replaces the pair.
5265
5266Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5267insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5268trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5269current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5270in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5271and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5272
5273
5274.section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5275.cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5276Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5277by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5278circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5279is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5280strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5281However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5282backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5283within a quoted configuration string.
5284
5285
5286.section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5287.cindex "user name" "format of"
5288.cindex "format" "user name"
5289.cindex "groups" "name format"
5290.cindex "format" "group name"
5291User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5292above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5293either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5294&[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5295
5296
5297.section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5298.cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5299.cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5300.cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5301The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5302default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5303the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5304&"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5305are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5306particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5307&<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5308
5309In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5310input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5311&<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5312in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5313on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5314start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5315example, the list
5316.code
5317local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5318.endd
5319contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5320
5321&*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5322list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5323colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5324be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5325
5326.section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5327.cindex "list separator" "changing"
5328.cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5329Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5330introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5331with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5332character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5333above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5334.code
5335local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5336.endd
5337This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5338&%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5339confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5340
5341.cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5342.cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5343It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5344code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5345must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5346are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5347sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5348interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5349generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5350.code
5351domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5352.endd
5353This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5354to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5355expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5356the value in quotes. For example:
5357.code
5358local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5359.endd
5360Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5361doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5362set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5363enclosing an empty list item.
5364
5365
5366
5367.section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5368.cindex "list" "empty item in"
5369An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5370separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5371.code
5372senders = user@domain :
5373.endd
5374contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5375in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5376items, the second of which is empty:
5377.code
5378senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5379.endd
5380&*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5381are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5382would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5383just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5384.code
5385senders = :
5386.endd
5387In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5388is at the end of the list.
5389
5390
5391
5392
5393.section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5394.cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5395There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5396and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5397instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5398a sequence of lines like this:
5399.display
5400<&'instance name'&>:
5401 <&'option'&>
5402 ...
5403 <&'option'&>
5404.endd
5405In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5406followed by three options settings:
5407.code
5408localuser:
5409 driver = accept
5410 check_local_user
5411 transport = local_delivery
5412.endd
5413For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5414setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5415settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5416deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5417a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5418described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5419
5420You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5421the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5422
5423The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5424passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5425transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5426authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5427them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5428server.
5429
5430.cindex "generic options"
5431.cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5432Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5433and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5434same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5435&%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5436.cindex "private options"
5437The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5438they all have default values.
5439
5440The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5441precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5442this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5443
5444Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5445elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5446with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5447a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5448instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5449confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5450configuration lines:
5451.code
5452remote_smtp:
5453 driver = smtp
5454.endd
5455create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5456&(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5457different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5458instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5459thus:
5460.code
5461special_smtp:
5462 driver = smtp
5463 port = 1234
5464 command_timeout = 10s
5465.endd
5466The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5467these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5468lines.
5469
5470Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5471list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5472defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5473option.
5474
5475
5476
5477
5478
5479
5480. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5481. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5482
5483.chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5484.scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5485.cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5486The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5487is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5488the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5489configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5490of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5491itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5492initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5493mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5494
5495
5496
5497.section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5498The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5499file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5500the line
5501.code
5502# primary_hostname =
5503.endd
5504This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5505to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5506can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5507it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5508
5509The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5510.code
5511domainlist local_domains = @
5512domainlist relay_to_domains =
5513hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5514.endd
5515These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5516domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5517domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5518configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5519
5520The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5521later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5522on the local host.
5523
5524.cindex "@ in a domain list"
5525There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5526of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5527called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5528be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5529the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5530
5531The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5532list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5533controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5534domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5535domain is permitted.
5536
5537The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5538used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5539that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5540loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5541submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5542hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5543
5544Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5545we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5546and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5547
5548The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5549.code
5550acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5551acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5552.endd
5553These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5554during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5555command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5556respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5557&'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5558section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5559accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5560to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5561contents of a message to be checked.
5562
5563Two commented-out option settings are next:
5564.code
5565# av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5566# spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5567.endd
5568These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5569content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5570scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5571details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5572
5573Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5574.code
5575# tls_advertise_hosts = *
5576# tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5577# tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5578.endd
5579These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5580support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5581first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5582connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5583other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5584key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5585More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5586
5587Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5588.code
5589# daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5590# tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5591.endd
5592.cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5593.cindex "port" "for message submission"
5594.cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5595.cindex "submissions protocol"
5596.cindex "smtps protocol"
5597.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5598.cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5599.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5600.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5601These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5602server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5603TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5604more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5605Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5606to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5607much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5608consequences).
5609RFC 6409 (previously 4409) specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5610which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5611RFC 8314 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5612which should be used in preference to 587.
5613You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5614these ports.
5615Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5616
5617Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5618.code
5619# qualify_domain =
5620# qualify_recipient =
5621.endd
5622The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5623complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5624receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5625the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5626you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5627addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5628
5629.cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5630The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5631addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5632(an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5633.code
5634# allow_domain_literals
5635.endd
5636The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5637Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5638quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5639try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5640people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5641&'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5642
5643The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5644.code
5645never_users = root
5646.endd
5647It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5648convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5649setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5650The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5651list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5652FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5653contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5654FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5655
5656When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5657Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5658line,
5659.code
5660host_lookup = *
5661.endd
5662specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5663in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5664information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5665or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5666Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5667because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5668unreachable.
5669
5670The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
56711413 (hence their names):
5672.code
5673rfc1413_hosts = *
5674rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5675.endd
5676These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5677Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5678terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5679of an incoming SMTP connection.
5680If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5681information, you can change this.
5682
5683This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5684and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5685.code
5686prdr_enable = true
5687.endd
5688
5689When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5690be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5691if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5692find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5693.code
5694# sender_unqualified_hosts =
5695# recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5696.endd
5697show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5698and recipient addresses, respectively.
5699
5700The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5701over the default:
5702.code
5703log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5704 +tls_certificate_verified
5705.endd
5706
5707The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5708.code
5709# percent_hack_domains =
5710.endd
5711It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5712This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5713anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5714
5715The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5716concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5717message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5718occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5719address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5720bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5721are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5722always bounce messages.
5723.code
5724ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5725timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5726.endd
5727The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5728discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5729message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5730after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5731bounce message ever lasts a week.
5732
5733Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5734large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5735directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5736many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5737Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5738not often needed).
5739.code
5740# split_spool_directory = true
5741.endd
5742
5743In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5744messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5745characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5746violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5747In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5748problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5749check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5750.code
5751# check_rfc2047_length = false
5752.endd
5753
5754If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
57558BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5756that are not 8-bit clean.
5757.code
5758# accept_8bitmime = false
5759.endd
5760
5761Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5762imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5763&%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5764&%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5765Note that TZ is handled separately, by the $%timezone%$ runtime
5766option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5767.code
5768# keep_environment = ^LDAP
5769# add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5770.endd
5771
5772
5773.section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5774.cindex "default" "ACLs"
5775.cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5776In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5777It starts with the line
5778.code
5779begin acl
5780.endd
5781and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5782&'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5783and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5784
5785.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5786The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5787RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5788are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5789rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5790result of the ACL processing.
5791.code
5792acl_check_rcpt:
5793.endd
5794This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5795ACL, and names it.
5796.code
5797accept hosts = :
5798.endd
5799This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5800But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5801names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5802list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5803host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5804important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5805
5806What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5807messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5808input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5809manner.
5810.code
5811deny message = Restricted characters in address
5812 domains = +local_domains
5813 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5814
5815deny message = Restricted characters in address
5816 domains = !+local_domains
5817 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5818.endd
5819These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5820characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5821Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5822&"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5823in Internet mail addresses.
5824
5825The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5826addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5827option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5828in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5829programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5830at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5831characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5832policy of being as safe as possible.
5833
5834The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5835to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5836first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5837&'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5838reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5839&'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5840
5841The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5842block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5843or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5844have to modify this rule.
5845
5846Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5847allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5848common convention of local parts constructed as
5849&"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5850the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5851with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5852file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5853that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5854is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5855
5856The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5857allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5858and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5859with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5860local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5861and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5862(or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5863.code
5864accept local_parts = postmaster
5865 domains = +local_domains
5866.endd
5867This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5868local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5869&'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5870reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5871&'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5872
5873The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5874by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5875in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5876.code
5877require verify = sender
5878.endd
5879This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5880ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5881address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5882see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5883addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5884used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5885discusses the details of address verification.
5886.code
5887accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5888 control = submission
5889.endd
5890This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5891hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5892verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5893that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5894second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5895is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5896messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5897&'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5898probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5899.code
5900accept authenticated = *
5901 control = submission
5902.endd
5903This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5904Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5905likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5906authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5907examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5908fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5909.code
5910require message = relay not permitted
5911 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5912.endd
5913This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5914one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5915.code
5916require verify = recipient
5917.endd
5918This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5919fails, the address is rejected.
5920.code
5921# deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5922# is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5923# $dnslist_text
5924# dnslists = black.list.example
5925#
5926# warn dnslists = black.list.example
5927# add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5928# a black list at $dnslist_domain
5929# log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5930.endd
5931These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5932sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5933from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5934line.
5935.code
5936# require verify = csa
5937.endd
5938This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5939authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5940records.
5941.code
5942accept
5943.endd
5944The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5945address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5946.code
5947acl_check_data:
5948.endd
5949This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5950of this ACL are commented out:
5951.code
5952# deny malware = *
5953# message = This message contains a virus \
5954# ($malware_name).
5955.endd
5956These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5957viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5958suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5959virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5960.code
5961# warn spam = nobody
5962# message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5963# X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5964# X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5965# X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5966.endd
5967These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5968SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5969and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5970&`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5971series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5972whatever the spam score.
5973.code
5974accept
5975.endd
5976This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5977
5978
5979.section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5980.cindex "default" "routers"
5981.cindex "routers" "default"
5982The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5983by the line
5984.code
5985begin routers
5986.endd
5987Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5988messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5989accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5990matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5991manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5992.code
5993# domain_literal:
5994# driver = ipliteral
5995# domains = !+local_domains
5996# transport = remote_smtp
5997.endd
5998.cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5999This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
6000support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
6001you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
6002&%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
6003.code
6004dnslookup:
6005 driver = dnslookup
6006 domains = ! +local_domains
6007 transport = remote_smtp
6008 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
6009 no_more
6010.endd
6011The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
6012domains. This is specified by the line
6013.code
6014domains = ! +local_domains
6015.endd
6016The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6017exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6018that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6019the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6020indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6021passed on to the following routers.
6022
6023The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6024and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6025the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6026instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6027one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6028
6029The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6030DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6031router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6032specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6033in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6034the address fails and is bounced.
6035
6036The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6037be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6038encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6039whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6040Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6041email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6042continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6043out.
6044.code
6045system_aliases:
6046 driver = redirect
6047 allow_fail
6048 allow_defer
6049 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6050# user = exim
6051 file_transport = address_file
6052 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6053.endd
6054Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6055domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6056alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6057data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6058the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6059the next router.
6060
6061&_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6062often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6063file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6064&_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6065.code
6066userforward:
6067 driver = redirect
6068 check_local_user
6069# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6070# local_part_suffix_optional
6071 file = $home/.forward
6072# allow_filter
6073 no_verify
6074 no_expn
6075 check_ancestor
6076 file_transport = address_file
6077 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6078 reply_transport = address_reply
6079.endd
6080This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6081redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6082individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6083local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6084router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6085namely:
6086.code
6087# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6088# local_part_suffix_optional
6089.endd
6090.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6091show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6092is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6093by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6094variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6095presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6096the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6097
6098When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6099home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6100declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6101redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6102
6103.cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6104Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6105files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6106is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6107of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6108filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6109separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6110
6111The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6112verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6113There are two reasons for doing this:
6114
6115.olist
6116Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6117checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6118unnecessary work.
6119.next
6120More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6121command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6122The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6123It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6124this time.
6125.endlist
6126
6127The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6128address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6129works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6130forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6131
6132The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6133forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6134auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6135.code
6136a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6137.endd
6138the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6139transport.
6140.code
6141localuser:
6142 driver = accept
6143 check_local_user
6144# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6145# local_part_suffix_optional
6146 transport = local_delivery
6147.endd
6148The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6149part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6150the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6151routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6152same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6153
6154
6155.section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6156.cindex "default" "transports"
6157.cindex "transports" "default"
6158Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6159only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6160not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6161.code
6162begin transports
6163.endd
6164One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
6165.code
6166remote_smtp:
6167 driver = smtp
6168 hosts_try_prdr = *
6169.endd
6170This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6171The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6172The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option.
6173It is negotiated between client and server
6174and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
6175All other options are defaulted.
6176.code
6177local_delivery:
6178 driver = appendfile
6179 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6180 delivery_date_add
6181 envelope_to_add
6182 return_path_add
6183# group = mail
6184# mode = 0660
6185.endd
6186This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6187traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6188local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6189directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6190under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6191show how this can be done.
6192
6193Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6194&'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6195similarly-named options above.
6196.code
6197address_pipe:
6198 driver = pipe
6199 return_output
6200.endd
6201This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6202redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6203option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6204be returned to the sender.
6205.code
6206address_file:
6207 driver = appendfile
6208 delivery_date_add
6209 envelope_to_add
6210 return_path_add
6211.endd
6212This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6213redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6214&(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6215.code
6216address_reply:
6217 driver = autoreply
6218.endd
6219This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6220filter files.
6221
6222
6223
6224.section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6225.cindex "retry" "default rule"
6226.cindex "default" "retry rule"
6227The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6228Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6229introduced by the line
6230.code
6231begin retry
6232.endd
6233In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6234errors:
6235.code
6236* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6237.endd
6238This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
62392 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
62401.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6241is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6242measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6243
6244If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6245if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6246temporary errors into permanent errors.
6247
6248
6249.section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6250The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6251.code
6252begin rewrite
6253.endd
6254contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6255rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6256
6257
6258
6259.section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6260.cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6261The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6262.code
6263begin authenticators
6264.endd
6265defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6266configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6267which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6268standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6269mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6270to support most MUA software.
6271
6272The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6273.code
6274#PLAIN:
6275# driver = plaintext
6276# server_set_id = $auth2
6277# server_prompts = :
6278# server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6279# server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6280.endd
6281And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6282.code
6283#LOGIN:
6284# driver = plaintext
6285# server_set_id = $auth1
6286# server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6287# server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6288# server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6289.endd
6290
6291The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6292in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6293&%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6294that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6295i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6296when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6297when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6298need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6299
6300The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6301password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6302To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6303expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6304
6305Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6306usercode and password are in different positions.
6307Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6308
6309.ecindex IIDconfiwal
6310
6311
6312
6313. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6314. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6315
6316.chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6317
6318.cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6319.cindex "PCRE"
6320Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6321uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6322matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6323regular expressions is discussed in
6324online Perl manpages, in
6325many Perl reference books, and also in
6326Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6327O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6328
6329The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6330are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6331description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6332the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6333the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6334case-insensitive.
6335
6336In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6337it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6338or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6339second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6340.code
6341domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6342.endd
6343The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6344precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6345of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6346regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6347backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6348normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6349matched.
6350
6351There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6352recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6353string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6354these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6355it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6356match anywhere in the subject string.
6357
6358In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6359you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6360.code
6361domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6362.endd
6363matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6364You need to use:
6365.code
6366domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6367.endd
6368if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6369$ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6370
6371
6372
6373. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6374. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6375
6376.chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6377.scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6378.scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6379.cindex "lookup" "description of"
6380Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6381messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6382
6383.olist
6384A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6385cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6386lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6387can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6388&<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6389The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6390.next
6391Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6392way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6393returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6394succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6395chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6396The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6397.endlist
6398
6399String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6400that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6401involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6402if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6403time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6404chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6405
6406.section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6407It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6408lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6409processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6410Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6411.code
6412domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6413domains = lsearch;/some/file
6414.endd
6415The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6416No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6417defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6418The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6419file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6420.code
6421192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6422192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6423.endd
6424When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6425possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6426
6427In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6428Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6429in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6430.code
6431domain1:
6432domain2:
6433.endd
6434Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6435matches the list item.
6436
6437It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6438Consider a file containing lines like this:
6439.code
6440192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6441.endd
6442If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6443first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6444causes a second lookup to occur.
6445
6446The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6447available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6448lookup is permitted.
6449
6450
6451.section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6452.cindex "lookup" "types of"
6453.cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6454Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6455
6456.ilist
6457The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6458and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6459lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6460.next
6461.cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6462The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6463key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6464Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6465.endlist
6466
6467The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6468the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6469default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6470.code
6471LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6472LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6473.endd
6474which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6475For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6476libraries and header files before building Exim.
6477
6478
6479
6480
6481.section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6482.cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6483.cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6484The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6485
6486.ilist
6487.cindex "cdb" "description of"
6488.cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6489.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6490&(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6491string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6492indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6493re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6494aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6495be found in several places:
6496.display
6497&url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6498&url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6499&url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6500.endd
6501A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6502because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6503However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6504you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6505.next
6506.cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6507.cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6508.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6509&(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6510DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6511zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6512&<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6513
6514.cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6515For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6516when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6517using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6518the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6519that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6520other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6521.next
6522.cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6523.cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6524.cindex "sasldb2"
6525.cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6526&(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6527interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6528ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6529authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6530&_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6531&(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6532.next
6533.cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6534.cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6535.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6536.cindex "Courier"
6537.cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6538.cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6539&(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6540is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6541if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6542other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6543use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6544calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6545utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6546by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6547.next
6548.cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6549.cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6550&(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6551whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6552contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6553the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6554symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6555lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6556&<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6557.next
6558.cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6559.cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6560&(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6561terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6562file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6563IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6564being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6565.code
65661.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6567192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6568"abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6569"abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6570.endd
6571The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6572file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6573key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6574&"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6575&(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6576
6577&*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6578&(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6579lookup types support only literal keys.
6580
6581&*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6582the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6583&<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6584.next
6585.cindex "linear search"
6586.cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6587.cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6588.cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6589&(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6590line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6591end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6592letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6593in the file is used.
6594
6595White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6596line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6597continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6598space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6599junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6600colon, for example:
6601.code
6602baduser: :fail:
6603.endd
6604Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6605middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6606that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6607wildcarding of any kind.
6608
6609.cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6610.cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6611In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6612characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6613If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6614matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6615contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6616quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6617quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6618
6619.next
6620.cindex "NIS lookup type"
6621.cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6622.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6623&(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6624the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6625&(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6626reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6627aliases; the full map names must be used.
6628
6629.next
6630.cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6631.cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6632.cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6633.cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6634&(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6635&(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6636the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6637that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6638used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6639
6640.cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6641Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6642file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6643&`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6644
6645. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6646. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6647
6648.olist
6649The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6650.code
6651 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6652 *fish data for anythingfish
6653.endd
6654.next
6655The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6656example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6657.code
6658 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6659.endd
6660Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6661expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6662string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6663.code
6664 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6665.endd
6666The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6667expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6668For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6669.code
6670 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6671.endd
6672
6673If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6674either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6675ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6676colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6677escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6678
6679&*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6680match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6681is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6682takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6683&((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6684
6685.next
6686Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6687is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6688lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6689example:
6690.code
6691 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6692.endd
6693The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6694.endlist olist
6695
6696Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6697continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6698be followed by optional colons.
6699
6700&*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6701&((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6702lookup types support only literal keys.
6703.endlist ilist
6704
6705
6706.section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
6707.cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6708.cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6709The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6710many of them are given in later sections.
6711
6712.ilist
6713.cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6714.cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6715&(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6716are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6717records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6718.next
6719.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6720.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6721&(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6722.next
6723.cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6724.cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6725&(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6726returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6727that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6728called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6729any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6730.next
6731.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6732.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6733&(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6734MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6735.next
6736.cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6737.cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6738&(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6739the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6740.next
6741.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6742.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6743&(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6744Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6745.next
6746.cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6747.cindex "passwd lookup type"
6748.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6749&(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6750lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6751success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6752lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6753password value. For example:
6754.code
6755*:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6756.endd
6757.next
6758.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6759.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6760&(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6761PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6762
6763.next
6764.cindex "Redis lookup type"
6765.cindex lookup Redis
6766&(redis)&: The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
6767passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6768
6769.next
6770.cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6771.cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6772&(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6773that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6774
6775.next
6776&(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6777not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6778.next
6779.cindex "whoson lookup type"
6780.cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6781&(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6782allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6783address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6784obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6785at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6786superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6787&"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6788.code
6789require condition = \
6790 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6791.endd
6792The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6793the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6794this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6795one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6796.endlist
6797
6798
6799
6800.section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6801.cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6802Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6803completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6804reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6805options such as a list of local domains.
6806
6807When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6808of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6809temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6810or may give up altogether.
6811
6812
6813
6814.section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6815.cindex "wildcard lookups"
6816.cindex "lookup" "default values"
6817.cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6818.cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6819.cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6820In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6821that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6822
6823&*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6824lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6825specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6826
6827If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6828and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6829provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6830
6831.cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6832.cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6833.cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6834Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6835&%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6836character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6837by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6838that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6839take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6840For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6841.code
6842data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6843.endd
6844Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6845looks up these keys, in this order:
6846.code
6847jane@eyre.example
6848*@eyre.example
6849*
6850.endd
6851The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6852&(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6853complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6854Exim move on to try the next key.
6855
6856
6857
6858.section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6859.cindex "partial matching"
6860.cindex "wildcard lookups"
6861.cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6862.cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6863.cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6864The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6865match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6866being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6867information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6868domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6869a key in a DBM file is
6870.code
6871*.dates.fict.example
6872.endd
6873then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6874&'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6875by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6876file.
6877
6878&*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6879also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6880&<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6881
6882Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6883keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6884be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6885partial matching keys
6886beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6887Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6888unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6889
6890Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6891the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6892is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6893is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6894fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6895start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6896remains.
6897
6898A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6899by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6900&%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6901modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6902subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6903up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6904.code
69052250.dates.fict.example
6906*.2250.dates.fict.example
6907*.dates.fict.example
6908*.fict.example
6909.endd
6910As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6911finishes.
6912
6913.cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6914.cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6915The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6916changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6917formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6918parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6919.code
6920domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6921.endd
6922In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6923&`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6924components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6925other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6926.code
6927domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6928.endd
6929For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6930&`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6931
6932If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6933just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6934down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6935
6936.ilist
6937If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6938.next
6939If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6940example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6941.next
6942Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6943remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6944for &"*"& on its own.
6945.next
6946Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6947.endlist
6948
6949
6950If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6951&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6952this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6953specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6954prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6955lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6956&"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6957
6958The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6959in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6960dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6961in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6962subject key is always followed by a dot.
6963
6964
6965
6966
6967.section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6968.cindex "lookup" "caching"
6969.cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6970Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6971lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6972of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6973single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6974
6975For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6976another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6977many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6978the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6979closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6980own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6981
6982The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6983strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6984complete.
6985
6986
6987
6988
6989.section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6990.cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6991.cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6992When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6993is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6994the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6995.code
6996[name=$local_part]
6997.endd
6998will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6999For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
7000.code
7001[name="$local_part"]
7002.endd
7003but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
7004NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
7005rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
7006of the following form is provided:
7007.code
7008${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
7009.endd
7010For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
7011.code
7012[name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7013.endd
7014See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7015operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7016lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7017
7018
7019
7020
7021.section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7022.cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7023.cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7024.cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7025The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7026of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7027an expansion string could contain:
7028.code
7029${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7030.endd
7031If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7032is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7033&`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7034&<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7035
7036The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7037and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7038If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7039
7040For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7041concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7042depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7043between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7044by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7045.code
7046${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7047.endd
7048It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7049white space is ignored.
7050For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7051an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7052separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7053
7054.cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7055When the type is PTR,
7056the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7057&%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7058.code
7059${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7060.endd
7061If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7062altered and nothing is added.
7063
7064.cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7065.cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7066For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7067each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7068port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7069The field separator can be modified as above.
7070
7071.cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7072.cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7073For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7074unless a field separator is specified.
7075To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7076For SPF records the
7077default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7078.code
7079${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7080${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7081${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7082.endd
7083It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7084white space is ignored.
7085
7086.cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7087For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7088successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7089Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7090specified.
7091.code
7092${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7093.endd
7094
7095.section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
7096.cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7097.cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7098.cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7099Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7100each followed by a comma,
7101that may appear before the record type.
7102
7103The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7104temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7105a defer-option modifier.
7106The possible keywords are
7107&"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7108With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7109whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7110ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7111With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7112error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7113succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7114.code
7115${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7116${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7117.endd
7118Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7119yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7120
7121.cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7122Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7123The possible keywords are
7124&"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7125With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7126with the lookup.
7127With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7128is not labelled as authenticated data
7129is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7130The default is &"never"&.
7131
7132See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7133
7134.cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7135.cindex "DNS" timeout
7136Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7137The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7138(e.g. &"5s"&).
7139The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7140
7141Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7142The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7143The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7144
7145.cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7146.cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7147.cindex DNS TTL
7148Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7149The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7150value of the set of returned DNS records.
7151
7152
7153.section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7154.cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7155By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7156each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7157the pseudo-type MXH:
7158.code
7159${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7160.endd
7161In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7162returned.
7163
7164.cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7165Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7166records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7167component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7168records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7169error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7170but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7171top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7172.code
7173${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7174${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7175.endd
7176Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7177the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7178the name servers for &%edu%&.
7179
7180You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7181top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7182sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7183given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7184for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7185such a list.
7186
7187.cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7188A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7189records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7190&<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7191not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7192result of a successful lookup such as:
7193.code
7194${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7195.endd
7196has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7197The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7198authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7199
7200.cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7201The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7202and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7203(see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7204.code
7205${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7206.endd
7207
7208
7209.section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7210In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7211However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7212&(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7213the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7214.code
7215${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7216${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7217${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7218.endd
7219In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7220the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7221to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7222case, it does not treat it as a list.
7223
7224The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7225in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7226different separator can be specified, as described above.
7227
7228
7229
7230
7231.section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7232.cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7233.cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7234.cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7235The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7236become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7237implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7238contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7239the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7240it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7241indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7242your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7243.code
7244LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7245LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7246LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7247LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7248LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7249.endd
7250If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7251same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7252
7253There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7254the way they handle the results of a query:
7255
7256.ilist
7257&(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7258gives an error.
7259.next
7260&(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7261Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7262.next
7263&(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7264from all of them are returned.
7265.endlist
7266
7267
7268For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7269Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7270the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7271First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7272
7273
7274.section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7275.cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7276An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7277the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7278.code
7279data = ${lookup ldap \
7280 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7281 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7282.endd
7283.cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7284The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7285secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7286encrypted TLS connection is used.
7287
7288With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7289LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7290See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7291
7292Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7293controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7294&_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7295your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7296&_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7297certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7298running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7299methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7300&_exim.conf_&.
7301
7302
7303.section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7304.cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7305Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7306and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7307within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7308reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7309
7310The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7311filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7312the string:
7313.code
7314* => \2A
7315( => \28
7316) => \29
7317\ => \5C
7318.endd
7319in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7320to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7321.code
7322! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7323.endd
7324are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7325.code
7326${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7327.endd
7328yields
7329.code
7330%20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7331.endd
7332Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7333.code
7334a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7335.endd
7336The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7337base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7338by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7339.code
7340, + " \ < > ;
7341.endd
7342It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7343before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7344is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7345.code
7346${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7347.endd
7348yields
7349.code
7350%5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7351.endd
7352Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7353.code
7354\ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7355.endd
7356There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7357authentication below.
7358
7359
7360.section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7361.cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7362The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7363is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7364an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7365by starting it with
7366.code
7367ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7368.endd
7369If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7370used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7371taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7372colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7373handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7374returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7375are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7376Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7377failures, and timeouts.
7378
7379For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7380of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7381&%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7382doubled. For example
7383.code
7384ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7385.endd
7386If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7387to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7388the local host) is used.
7389
7390If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7391a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7392&`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7393to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7394not available.
7395
7396For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7397for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7398can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7399the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7400.code
7401ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7402.endd
7403When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7404&`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7405.code
7406${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7407.endd
7408When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7409a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7410specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7411socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7412&%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7413or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7414the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7415backup host.
7416
7417If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7418specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7419&%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7420
7421.ilist
7422Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7423interface.
7424.next
7425Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7426.endlist
7427
7428
7429Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7430&%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7431
7432
7433
7434.section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7435.cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7436The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7437information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7438be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7439spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7440when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7441them. The following names are recognized:
7442.display
7443&`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7444&`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7445&`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7446&`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7447&`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7448&`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7449&`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7450&`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7451.endd
7452The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7453&"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7454must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7455library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7456
7457.cindex LDAP timeout
7458.cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7459The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7460backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7461enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7462network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7463&'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7464LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7465if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7466SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7467Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7468
7469The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7470set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7471
7472The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7473to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7474default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7475server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7476different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7477different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7478alternate list (colon-separated).
7479
7480Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7481values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7482.code
7483${lookup ldap
7484 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7485 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7486 {$value}fail}
7487.endd
7488The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7489any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7490which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7491non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7492
7493The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7494connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7495on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7496
7497When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7498removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7499some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7500quoting has two advantages:
7501
7502.ilist
7503It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7504DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7505.next
7506It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7507.endlist
7508
7509For example, a setting such as
7510.code
7511USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7512.endd
7513should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7514
7515Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7516expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7517field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7518does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7519.code
7520PASS=${quote:$3}
7521.endd
7522The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7523SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7524&<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7525
7526
7527
7528.section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7529.cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7530The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7531as a sequence of values, for example
7532.code
7533cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7534.endd
7535The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7536search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7537the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7538values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7539you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7540directory.
7541
7542In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7543result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7544has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7545part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7546
7547If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7548strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7549quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7550backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7551Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7552(permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7553Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7554output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7555same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7556
7557Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7558LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7559&%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7560&%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7561(they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7562
7563.code
7564ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7565value1.1,value1,,2
7566
7567ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7568value two
7569
7570ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7571value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7572
7573ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7574attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7575
7576ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7577objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7578.endd
7579You can
7580make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7581results of LDAP lookups.
7582The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7583individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7584The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7585of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7586The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7587comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7588
7589
7590
7591
7592.section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7593.cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7594.cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7595NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7596and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7597contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7598of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7599values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7600.code
7601[name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7602.endd
7603might return the string
7604.code
7605name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7606home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7607.endd
7608(split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7609.code
7610[name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7611.endd
7612would just return
7613.code
7614Martin Guerre
7615.endd
7616with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7617for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7618operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7619
7620
7621
7622.section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7623.cindex "SQL lookup types"
7624.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7625.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7626.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7627.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7628.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7629.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7630.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7631.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7632.cindex "Redis lookup type"
7633.cindex lookup Redis
7634Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
7635and SQLite
7636databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7637might be
7638.code
7639${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7640 {$value}fail}
7641.endd
7642If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7643field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7644.code
7645${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7646 {$value}}
7647.endd
7648might be
7649.code
7650home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7651.endd
7652Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7653quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7654field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7655.code
7656Mister X
7657.endd
7658If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7659with a newline between the data for each row.
7660
7661
7662.section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" "SECID72"
7663.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7664.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7665.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7666.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7667.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7668.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7669.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7670.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7671.cindex "Redis lookup type"
7672.cindex lookup Redis
7673If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
7674&%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
7675or &%redis_servers%&
7676option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7677information.
7678(For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
7679queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7680&<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
7681For all but Redis
7682each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7683items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7684Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7685name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7686.code
7687hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7688.endd
7689Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7690&"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7691option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7692.code
7693hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7694 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7695.endd
7696For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7697because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7698query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7699a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7700found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7701servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7702
7703For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
7704own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
7705If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7706information.
7707Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
7708host, database number, and password.
7709.olist
7710The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
7711port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
7712higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
7713.next
7714The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
7715.next
7716The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
7717.endlist
7718
7719The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7720convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7721respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7722itself are escaped with backslashes.
7723
7724The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
7725escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
7726
7727.section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7728For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7729it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7730done by starting the query with
7731.display
7732&`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7733.endd
7734Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7735.olist
7736If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7737global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7738of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7739taken from there.
7740.next
7741If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7742.endlist
7743The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7744Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7745successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7746
7747This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7748are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7749master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7750like this:
7751.code
7752mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7753 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7754 master/db/name/pw
7755.endd
7756In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7757.code
7758${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7759.endd
7760That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7761the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7762option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7763.code
7764${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7765.endd
7766
7767
7768.section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7769For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7770causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7771socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
7772An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
7773the default value is &"exim"&.
7774The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7775.display
7776<&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
7777 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7778.endd
7779Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7780the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7781
7782No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7783the queries.
7784
7785If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7786or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7787
7788&*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7789anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7790is zero because no rows are affected.
7791
7792
7793.section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7794PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7795This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7796However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7797database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7798looks like this:
7799.code
7800hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7801.endd
7802In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7803given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7804visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7805
7806If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7807update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7808affected.
7809
7810.section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7811.cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7812.cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7813SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7814addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7815daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7816of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7817separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7818contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7819.code
7820${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7821 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7822.endd
7823In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7824.code
7825domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7826 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7827.endd
7828The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7829quote, which it doubles.
7830
7831.cindex timeout SQLite
7832.cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
7833The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7834internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7835update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7836are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7837waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7838to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7839option.
7840
7841.section "More about Redis" "SECTredis"
7842.cindex "lookup" "Redis"
7843.cindex "redis lookup type"
7844Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
7845Examples:
7846.code
7847${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
7848${lookup redis{get keyname}}
7849.endd
7850
7851As of release 4.91, "lightweight" support for Redis Cluster is available.
7852Requires &%redis_servers%& list to contain all the servers in the cluster, all
7853of which must be reachable from the running exim instance. If the cluster has
7854master/slave replication, the list must contain all the master and slave
7855servers.
7856
7857When the Redis Cluster returns a "MOVED" response to a query, Exim does not
7858immediately follow the redirection but treats the response as a DEFER, moving on
7859to the next server in the &%redis_servers%& list until the correct server is
7860reached.
7861
7862.ecindex IIDfidalo1
7863.ecindex IIDfidalo2
7864
7865
7866. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7867. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7868
7869.chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7870 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7871 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7872.scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7873A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7874email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7875contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7876are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7877arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7878
7879Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7880host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7881different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7882general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7883
7884Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
7885support all the complexity available in
7886domain, host, address and local part lists.
7887
7888
7889
7890.section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
7891.cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7892Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
7893
7894&'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
7895splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
7896
7897The result of
7898expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7899into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7900but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7901&<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7902discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7903
7904
7905If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7906testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7907expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7908
7909If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7910other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7911misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7912the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7913expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7914.code
7915deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7916 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7917.endd
7918The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7919&`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7920senders based on the receiving domain.
7921
7922
7923
7924
7925.section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7926.cindex "list" "negation"
7927.cindex "negation" "in lists"
7928Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7929leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7930defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7931it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7932(respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7933
7934The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7935subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7936subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7937subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7938was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7939.code
7940domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7941.endd
7942matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7943neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7944list is positive. However, if the setting were
7945.code
7946domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7947.endd
7948then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7949list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7950as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7951
7952Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7953the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7954item.
7955
7956
7957
7958.section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7959.cindex "list" "file name in"
7960If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7961name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7962processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7963file names are not allowed,
7964and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7965Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7966lines:
7967
7968.ilist
7969For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7970file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7971.next
7972Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7973address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7974white space or the start of the line. For example:
7975.code
7976not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7977.endd
7978.endlist
7979
7980Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7981file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7982is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7983so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7984
7985If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7986within the file is inverted. For example, if
7987.code
7988hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7989.endd
7990and the file contains the lines
7991.code
7992!a.b.c
7993*.b.c
7994.endd
7995then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7996any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7997
7998
7999
8000.section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
8001As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
8002to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
8003confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
8004an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
8005sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
8006non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
8007always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
8008
8009If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
8010list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
8011in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
8012&(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
8013
8014
8015
8016
8017.section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
8018.cindex "named lists"
8019.cindex "list" "named"
8020A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
8021which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
8022particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
8023places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8024the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8025a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8026locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8027.code
8028domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8029.endd
8030Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8031for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8032configured with the line
8033.code
8034domains = +local_domains
8035.endd
8036The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8037except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8038.code
8039dnslookup:
8040 driver = dnslookup
8041 domains = ! +local_domains
8042 transport = remote_smtp
8043 no_more
8044.endd
8045The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8046the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8047respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8048equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8049.code
8050hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8051addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8052.endd
8053A named list may refer to other named lists:
8054.code
8055domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8056domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8057domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8058.endd
8059&*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8060effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8061out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8062.code
8063domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8064domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8065.endd
8066The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8067list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8068means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8069.code
8070domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8071.endd
8072where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8073referenced lists if you can.
8074
8075Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8076address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8077lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8078.code
8079domains = +local_domains
8080.endd
8081on several of your routers
8082or in several ACL statements,
8083the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8084if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8085references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8086the same each time they are referenced.
8087
8088By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8089extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8090is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8091hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8092
8093
8094
8095.section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
8096.cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8097.cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8098At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8099configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8100write
8101.code
8102ALIST = host1 : host2
8103auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8104.endd
8105it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8106.code
8107auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8108.endd
8109Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8110list, and write
8111.code
8112hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8113auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8114.endd
8115the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8116.code
8117auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8118.endd
8119
8120
8121.section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
8122.cindex "list" "caching of named"
8123.cindex "caching" "named lists"
8124While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8125it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8126the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8127that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8128an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8129message. For example:
8130.code
8131domainlist special_domains = \
8132 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8133.endd
8134This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8135address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8136in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8137cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8138same list each time.
8139
8140By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8141cache the result anyway. For example:
8142.code
8143domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8144.endd
8145If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8146the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8147
8148
8149
8150.section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8151.cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8152.cindex "list" "domain list"
8153Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8154The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8155
8156.ilist
8157.cindex "primary host name"
8158.cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8159.oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8160.cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8161.cindex "@ in a domain list"
8162If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8163as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8164possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8165differ only in their names.
8166.next
8167.cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8168.cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8169.cindex "domain literal"
8170If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8171in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8172only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8173&%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8174control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8175In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
8176.next
8177.cindex "@mx_any"
8178.cindex "@mx_primary"
8179.cindex "@mx_secondary"
8180.cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8181If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8182has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8183.oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8184&%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8185are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8186local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8187but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8188preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8189
8190The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8191performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8192example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8193resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8194options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8195
8196Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8197patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8198list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8199ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8200on a router). For example:
8201.code
8202domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8203.endd
8204This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8205the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8206
8207The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8208host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8209contain negative items.
8210
8211Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8212be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8213list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8214.code
8215domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8216 an.other.domain : ...
8217.endd
8218so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8219involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8220.code
8221domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8222 an.other.domain ? ...
8223.endd
8224.next
8225.cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8226.cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8227.cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8228If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8229are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8230domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8231list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8232matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8233list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8234&'cipher.key.ex'&.
8235
8236.next
8237.cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8238.cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8239If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8240expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8241function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8242Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8243default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8244with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8245are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8246
8247&*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8248must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8249use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8250it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8251expression by expansion, of course).
8252.next
8253.cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8254.cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8255If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8256semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8257must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8258&"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8259.code
8260domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8261.endd
8262The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8263key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8264only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8265is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8266or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8267&$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8268other statements in the same ACL.
8269
8270.next
8271Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8272&`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8273.code
8274domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8275.endd
8276This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8277works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8278
8279.next
8280.cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8281Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8282a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8283original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8284select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8285value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8286expansion variable.
8287.next
8288If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8289semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8290pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8291chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8292.code
8293hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8294 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8295.endd
8296In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8297example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8298whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8299&%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8300variable and can be referred to in other options.
8301.next
8302.cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8303If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8304between the pattern and the domain.
8305.endlist
8306
8307Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8308.code
8309domainlist funny_domains = \
8310 @ : \
8311 lib.unseen.edu : \
8312 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8313 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8314 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8315 nis;domains.byname : \
8316 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8317.endd
8318There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8319an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8320explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8321but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8322patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8323patterns earlier.
8324
8325
8326
8327.section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8328.cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8329.cindex "list" "host list"
8330Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8331example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8332may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8333two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8334pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8335You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8336involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8337
8338
8339.section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8340.cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8341.cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8342If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8343involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8344process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8345not used.
8346
8347.cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8348The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8349the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8350
8351
8352
8353.section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8354.cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8355If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8356the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8357&`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8358list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8359systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8360concerns.)
8361
8362The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8363inspecting its IP address:
8364
8365.ilist
8366If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8367with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8368to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8369&[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8370This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8371with the IP address of the subject host.
8372
8373If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8374lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8375ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8376temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8377what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8378
8379.next
8380.cindex "@ in a host list"
8381If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8382domain name, as just described.
8383
8384.next
8385If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8386subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8387IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8388be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8389separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8390without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8391IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8392that can never match a client host.
8393
8394.next
8395.cindex "@[] in a host list"
8396If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8397the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8398interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8399.code
8400accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8401accept hosts = @[]
8402.endd
8403.next
8404.cindex "CIDR notation"
8405If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8406example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8407host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8408included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8409specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8410significant end of the address.
8411
8412&*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8413of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8414address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8415addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8416.code
8417192.168.23.236/31
8418.endd
8419matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
842032 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8421matches.
8422
8423Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8424.code
8425recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8426 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8427.endd
8428The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8429appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8430For example:
8431.code
8432recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8433.endd
8434could make use of a file containing
8435.code
8436172.16.0.0/12
84373ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8438.endd
8439to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8440addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8441changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8442.code
8443recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8444 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8445.endd
8446The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8447list.
8448.endlist
8449
8450
8451
8452.section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8453 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8454.cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8455When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8456address, the pattern takes this form:
8457.display
8458&`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8459.endd
8460For example:
8461.code
8462hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8463.endd
8464The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8465IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8466letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8467&(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8468quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8469returned by the lookup is not used.
8470
8471.cindex "IP address" "masking"
8472.cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8473Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8474patterns of this form:
8475.display
8476&`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8477.endd
8478For example:
8479.code
8480net24-dbm;/networks.db
8481.endd
8482The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8483length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8484mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8485is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8486&"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8487
8488When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8489of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8490terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8491to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8492recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8493(notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8494For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8495converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8496addresses are always used.
8497
8498Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8499colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8500However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8501configurations.
8502
8503&*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8504IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8505the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8506case the IP address is used on its own.
8507
8508
8509
8510.section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8511.cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8512.cindex "unknown host name"
8513.cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8514There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8515remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8516complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8517address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8518above.)
8519
8520If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8521patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8522Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8523DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8524Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8525effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8526Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8527
8528Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8529against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8530
8531By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8532if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8533&[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8534are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8535security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8536for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8537Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8538discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8539found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8540
8541There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8542found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8543
8544.cindex "host" "alias for"
8545.cindex "alias for host"
8546As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8547of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8548
8549.ilist
8550.cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8551If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8552the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8553&'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8554requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8555expression.
8556.next
8557.cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8558.cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8559If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8560matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8561expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8562case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8563syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8564example,
8565.code
8566^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8567.endd
8568is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8569&'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8570that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8571string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8572part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8573.code
8574sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8575.endd
8576&*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8577&`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8578example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8579required.
8580.endlist
8581
8582
8583
8584
8585.section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8586.cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8587While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8588name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8589from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8590behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8591
8592&*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8593apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8594
8595.cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8596.cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8597Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8598lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8599Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8600does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8601To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8602&`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8603not recognized in an indirected file).
8604
8605.ilist
8606If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8607cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8608.code
8609host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8610.endd
8611rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8612any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8613
8614.next
8615If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8616be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8617example:
8618.code
8619accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8620 192.168.4.5
8621.endd
8622accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8623whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8624name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8625.endlist
8626
8627Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8628list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8629list.
8630
8631.section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8632 "SECTmixwilhos"
8633.cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8634
8635This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8636as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8637wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8638
8639.ilist
8640If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8641IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8642addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8643.code
8644accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8645.endd
8646The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8647left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8648without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8649a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8650pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8651&%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8652if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8653
8654.next
8655If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8656address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8657.code
8658accept hosts = *.friend.example
8659accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8660.endd
8661If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8662&<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8663&`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8664this section.
8665.endlist
8666
8667
8668.section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8669 "SECTtemdnserr"
8670.cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8671.cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8672.cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8673A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8674&%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8675host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8676&`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8677section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8678host lists such as whitelists.
8679
8680
8681
8682.section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8683 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8684.cindex "unknown host name"
8685.cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8686If a pattern is of the form
8687.display
8688<&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8689.endd
8690for example
8691.code
8692dbm;/host/accept/list
8693.endd
8694a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8695lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8696is not used.
8697
8698&*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8699keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8700addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8701&<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8702two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8703lookup, both using the same file.
8704
8705
8706
8707.section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8708If a pattern is of the form
8709.display
8710<&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8711.endd
8712the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8713data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8714&$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8715.code
8716hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8717 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8718.endd
8719The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8720can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8721use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8722operator.
8723
8724If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8725looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8726&<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8727
8728Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8729host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8730&`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8731still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8732effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8733See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8734
8735
8736
8737
8738
8739.section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8740.cindex "list" "address list"
8741.cindex "address list" "empty item"
8742.cindex "address list" "patterns"
8743Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8744is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8745always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8746list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8747using this option setting:
8748.code
8749senders = :
8750.endd
8751The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8752data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8753detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8754and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8755
8756Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8757example:
8758.code
8759senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8760.endd
8761A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8762character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8763semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8764subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8765with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8766the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8767wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8768.code
8769deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8770 *@+hostile_domains:\
8771 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8772 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8773.endd
8774.cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8775.cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8776If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8777specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8778treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8779
8780If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8781contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8782address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8783domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8784is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8785.code
8786deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8787.endd
8788
8789The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8790address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8791senders:
8792
8793.ilist
8794.cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8795.cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8796If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8797done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8798You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8799as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8800to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8801.code
8802deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8803 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8804.endd
8805The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8806start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8807
8808.next
8809.cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8810Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8811lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8812example:
8813.code
8814deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8815 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8816 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8817.endd
8818Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8819lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8820not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8821always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8822
8823Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8824cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8825panic log.
8826.cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8827However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8828&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8829default. For example, with this lookup:
8830.code
8831accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8832.endd
8833the file could contains lines like this:
8834.code
8835user1@domain1.example
8836*@domain2.example
8837.endd
8838and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8839that are tried is:
8840.code
8841nimrod@jaeger.example
8842*@jaeger.example
8843*
8844.endd
8845&*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8846would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8847
8848&*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8849.code
8850deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8851deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8852.endd
8853The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8854because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8855domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8856.endlist
8857
8858
8859The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8860If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8861always fails.
8862
8863
8864.ilist
8865.cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8866.cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8867.cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8868If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8869(for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8870split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8871it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8872from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8873of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8874
8875.cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8876The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8877keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8878patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8879even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8880with
8881.code
8882deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8883.endd
8884the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8885.code
8886baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8887.endd
8888to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8889
8890.cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8891If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8892has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8893may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8894but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8895surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8896.code
8897aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8898 spammer3 : spammer4
8899.endd
8900As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8901doubling.
8902
8903If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8904of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8905list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8906might have entries like
8907.code
8908aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8909xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8910*: ^\d{8}$
8911.endd
8912in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8913local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8914each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8915chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8916
8917.cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8918It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8919them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8920
8921.next
8922The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8923lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8924can only return a single list of local parts.
8925.endlist
8926
8927&*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8928in these two examples:
8929.code
8930senders = +my_list
8931senders = *@+my_list
8932.endd
8933In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8934example it is a named domain list.
8935
8936
8937
8938
8939.section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8940.cindex "case of local parts"
8941.cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8942.cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8943Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8944case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8945Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8946Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8947blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8948lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8949default.
8950
8951The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8952address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8953comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8954the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8955that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8956keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8957works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8958case-independent.
8959
8960.cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8961To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8962an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8963part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8964longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8965lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8966performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8967become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8968
8969
8970
8971.section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8972.cindex "list" "local part list"
8973.cindex "local part" "list"
8974Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8975lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8976setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8977set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8978case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8979matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8980&%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8981option is case-sensitive from the start.
8982
8983If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8984comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8985only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8986Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8987that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8988&`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8989Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8990types.
8991.ecindex IIDdohoadli
8992
8993
8994
8995
8996. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8997. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8998
8999.chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
9000.scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
9001Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
9002them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
9003
9004When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
9005when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
9006start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
9007below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
9008escape character, as described in the following section.
9009
9010Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
9011dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
9012options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
9013the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
9014conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
9015reasons.
9016
9017
9018
9019.section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
9020.cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
9021An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
9022backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
9023character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9024If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9025required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9026the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9027
9028.cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9029A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9030two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9031expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9032.code
9033deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9034.endd
9035On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9036without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9037string.
9038
9039
9040
9041.section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9042.cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9043A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9044expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9045carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9046octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9047backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9048encoding.
9049
9050These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9051in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9052and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9053
9054
9055.section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9056.cindex "expansion" "testing"
9057.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9058.oindex "&%-be%&"
9059Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9060takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9061arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9062to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9063since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9064value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9065database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9066and &%nhash%&.
9067
9068Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9069instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9070using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9071
9072.oindex "&%-bem%&"
9073If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9074from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9075option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
9076read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9077.code
9078exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9079.endd
9080The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9081Exim message identifier. For example:
9082.code
9083exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9084.endd
9085This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9086is therefore restricted to admin users.
9087
9088
9089.section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9090.cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9091A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9092alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9093(which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9094used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9095instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9096the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9097that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9098its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9099from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9100taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9101being expanded.
9102
9103
9104
9105
9106.section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9107The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9108between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9109outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9110white space is significant.
9111
9112.vlist
9113.vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9114.cindex "expansion" "variables"
9115Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9116.code
9117$local_part
9118${domain}
9119.endd
9120The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9121characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9122&'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9123section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9124given, the expansion fails.
9125
9126.vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9127.cindex "expansion" "operators"
9128The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9129<&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9130.code
9131${lc:$local_part}
9132.endd
9133The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9134leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9135below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9136one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9137string easier to understand.
9138
9139.vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9140This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9141expansion item below.
9142
9143
9144.vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9145.cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9146.cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9147The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9148arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9149Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9150arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9151and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9152are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9153a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9154the result of the expansion.
9155If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9156the expansion result is an empty string.
9157If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9158
9159
9160.vitem "&*${authresults{*&<&'authserv-id'&>&*}}*&"
9161.cindex authentication "results header"
9162.cindex headers "authentication-results:"
9163.cindex authentication "expansion item"
9164This item returns a string suitable for insertion as an
9165&'Authentication-Results"'&
9166header line.
9167The given <&'authserv-id'&> is included in the result; typically this
9168will be a domain name identifying the system performing the authentications.
9169Methods that might be present in the result include:
9170.code
9171none
9172iprev
9173auth
9174spf
9175dkim
9176.endd
9177
9178Example use (as an ACL modifier):
9179.code
9180 add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
9181.endd
9182This is safe even if no authentication results are available.
9183
9184
9185.vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9186 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9187.cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9188.cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9189.cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9190The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9191The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9192the certificate. Supported fields are:
9193.display
9194&`version `&
9195&`serial_number `&
9196&`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9197&`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9198&`notbefore `& time
9199&`notafter `& time
9200&`sig_algorithm `&
9201&`signature `&
9202&`subj_altname `& tagged list
9203&`ocsp_uri `& list
9204&`crl_uri `& list
9205.endd
9206If the field is found,
9207<&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9208otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9209variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9210is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9211
9212If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9213key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9214extracted is used.
9215
9216Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9217
9218The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9219output a Distinguished Name string which is
9220not quite
9221parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9222(the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9223RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9224a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9225result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9226The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9227a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9228Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9229
9230The field selectors marked as "time" above
9231take an optional modifier of "int"
9232for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9233Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9234in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9235
9236The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9237newline-separated by default,
9238(embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9239The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9240a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9241
9242The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9243prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9244Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9245which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9246if so the element tags are omitted.
9247
9248If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9249
9250.vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9251 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9252.cindex &%dlfunc%&
9253This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9254This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9255.code
9256EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
9257.endd
9258set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9259object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9260(but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9261
9262There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9263a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9264included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9265are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9266must have the following type:
9267.code
9268int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9269.endd
9270Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9271function should return one of the following values:
9272
9273&`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9274into the expanded string that is being built.
9275
9276&`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9277from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9278
9279&`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9280taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9281
9282&`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9283
9284When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9285you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9286configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9287
9288
9289.vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9290.cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9291.cindex "environment" "values from"
9292The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9293removed.
9294This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9295If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9296and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9297
9298Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9299appear, for example:
9300.code
9301${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9302.endd
9303This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9304{<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9305
9306If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9307search failure.
9308If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9309search success.
9310
9311The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9312&%add_environment%& main section options.
9313
9314
9315.vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9316 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9317.cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9318.cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9319The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9320white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9321must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9322The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9323.display
9324<&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9325.endd
9326.vindex "&$value$&"
9327where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9328values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9329values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9330described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9331for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9332the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9333otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9334variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9335is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9336
9337If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9338key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9339extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9340yield &"2001"&:
9341.code
9342${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9343${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9344.endd
9345Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9346appear, for example:
9347.code
9348${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9349.endd
9350This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9351{<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9352
9353
9354.vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9355 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9356.cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9357.cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9358The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9359apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9360This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9361behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9362extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9363argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9364<&'string3'&> as before.
9365
9366The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9367separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9368The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9369counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9370number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9371number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9372expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9373provided. For example:
9374.code
9375${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9376.endd
9377yields &"42"&, and
9378.code
9379${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9380.endd
9381yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9382empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9383
9384
9385.vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9386.cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9387.cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9388.vindex "&$item$&"
9389After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9390default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9391in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9392evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9393item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9394separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9395input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9396.code
9397${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}}
9398.endd
9399yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9400to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9401
9402
9403.vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9404.cindex "hash function" "textual"
9405.cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9406This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9407early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9408(numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9409
9410The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9411<&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9412<&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9413use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9414.code
9415${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9416.endd
9417The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9418or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9419Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9420function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9421first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9422.code
9423abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9424.endd
9425If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9426letters appear. For example:
9427.display
9428&`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9429&`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9430&`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9431.endd
9432
9433.vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9434 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9435 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9436 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9437 "&*$lheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9438 &*$lh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9439 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9440 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9441.cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9442.vindex "&$header_$&"
9443.vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9444.vindex "&$lheader_$&"
9445.vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9446.cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9447.cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9448.cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9449Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9450.code
9451$header_reply-to:
9452.endd
9453The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9454internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9455lines) may be present.
9456
9457The difference between the four pairs of expansions is in the way
9458the data in the header line is interpreted.
9459
9460.ilist
9461.cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9462&%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9463processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9464
9465.next
9466.cindex "list" "of header lines"
9467&%lheader%& gives a colon-separated list, one element per header when there
9468are multiple headers with a given name.
9469Any embedded colon characters within an element are doubled, so normal Exim
9470list-processing facilities can be used.
9471The terminating newline of each element is removed; in other respects
9472the content is &"raw"&.
9473
9474.next
9475.cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9476&%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9477or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9478character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9479&"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9480.cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9481produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9482what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9483
9484.next
9485&%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9486standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9487be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9488returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9489&[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9490a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9491.endlist ilist
9492
9493In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9494command of the following form:
9495.code
9496headers charset "UTF-8"
9497.endd
9498This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9499subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9500character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9501option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9502value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9503ISO-8859-1.
9504
9505Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9506any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9507&'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9508if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9509
9510Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9511this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9512message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9513filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9514router or transport are not accessible.
9515
9516For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
9517ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
9518because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
9519They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
9520Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9521are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9522point they are added.
9523When any of the above ACLs ar
9524running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
9525
9526Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9527following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9528this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9529white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9530expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9531expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9532section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9533header.)
9534
9535If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9536to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9537&%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9538each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9539newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9540newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9541those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9542junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9543
9544
9545.vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9546.cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9547.cindex &%hmac%&
9548This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9549shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9550RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9551&`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9552cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9553or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9554present. For example:
9555.code
9556${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9557.endd
9558For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9559produces:
9560.code
9561dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9562.endd
9563As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9564an Exim configuration:
9565.code
9566SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9567.endd
9568In a router or a transport you could then have:
9569.code
9570headers_add = \
9571 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9572 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9573 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9574.endd
9575Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9576&'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9577this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9578host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9579using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9580&'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9581
9582
9583.vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9584.cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9585.cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9586If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9587item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9588in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9589.code
9590${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9591.endd
9592The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9593true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9594be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9595case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9596&<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9597
9598If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9599is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9600cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9601.code
9602condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9603.endd
9604you can use
9605.code
9606condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9607.endd
9608
9609
9610
9611.vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
9612.cindex expansion "imap folder"
9613.cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
9614This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
9615folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
9616For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
9617
9618
9619
9620.vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9621.cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9622.cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9623The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9624strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9625you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9626change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9627some of the braces:
9628.code
9629${length_<n>:<string>}
9630.endd
9631The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9632of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9633&%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9634
9635
9636.vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9637 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9638.cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9639.cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9640.cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9641The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9642apart from an optional leading minus,
9643and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9644
9645After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9646default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9647
9648The first field of the list is numbered one.
9649If the number is negative, the fields are
9650counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9651The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9652then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9653
9654If the modulus of the
9655number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9656the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9657
9658For example:
9659.code
9660${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9661.endd
9662yields &"42"&, and
9663.code
9664${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9665.endd
9666yields &"result: 42"&.
9667
9668If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9669If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9670extracted is used.
9671You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9672
9673
9674.vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9675 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9676This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9677described in the next item.
9678
9679.vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9680 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9681.cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9682.cindex "file" "lookups"
9683.cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9684The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9685discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9686lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9687<&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9688
9689If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9690a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9691other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9692in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9693out by the system administrator.
9694
9695.vindex "&$value$&"
9696If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9697During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9698lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9699level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9700the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9701string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9702lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9703original lookup fails.
9704
9705If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9706data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9707expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9708the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9709appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9710to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9711{<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9712successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9713
9714For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9715search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9716type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9717&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9718
9719.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9720If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9721and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9722They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9723
9724This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9725.code
9726${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9727.endd
9728This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9729the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9730.code
9731${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9732 {$value}fail}
9733.endd
9734
9735
9736.vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9737.cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9738.vindex "&$item$&"
9739After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9740default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9741in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9742expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9743for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9744setting is not included in the output. For example:
9745.code
9746${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9747.endd
9748expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9749value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9750and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9751
9752.vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9753.cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9754.cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9755The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9756<&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9757if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9758can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9759.code
9760${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9761.endd
9762The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9763the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9764processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9765slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9766example,
9767.code
9768${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9769.endd
9770returns the string &"6/33"&.
9771
9772
9773
9774.vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9775.cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9776.cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9777This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9778interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9779expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9780additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9781name of the subroutine, is nine.
9782
9783The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9784the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9785way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9786Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9787return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9788not its contents.
9789
9790If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9791with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9792Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9793
9794The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9795out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9796
9797
9798.vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9799.cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9800The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9801keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9802it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9803to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9804as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9805and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9806
9807.vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9808 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9809.cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9810This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9811checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9812yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9813empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9814prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9815version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9816variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9817
9818These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9819retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9820against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9821which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9822
9823The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9824string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9825result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9826whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9827is the expansion of the third argument.
9828
9829All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9830However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9831For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9832
9833.vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9834.cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9835.cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9836.cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9837The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9838then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9839the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9840newlines are left in the string.
9841String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9842you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9843the string expansion fails.
9844
9845The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9846locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9847
9848
9849
9850.vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9851 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9852.cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9853.cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9854.cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9855This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
9856string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9857examples:
9858.code
9859${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9860${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9861.endd
9862For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9863For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9864a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9865number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9866optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9867example:
9868.code
9869${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9870.endd
9871Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9872one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9873both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9874unless it is an empty string; and no terminating NUL is ever sent)
9875and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9876is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9877extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9878.code
9879${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9880.endd
9881The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
9882and must be present if the argument is given.
9883Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
9884One option type is currently recognised, defining whether (the default)
9885or not a shutdown is done on the connection after sending the request.
9886Example, to not do so (preferred, eg. by some webservers):
9887.code
9888${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
9889.endd
9890A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9891that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9892turns them into spaces:
9893.code
9894${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9895.endd
9896As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9897happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9898addition, the following errors can occur:
9899
9900.ilist
9901Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9902.next
9903Failure to connect the socket;
9904.next
9905Failure to write the request string;
9906.next
9907Timeout on reading from the socket.
9908.endlist
9909
9910By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9911you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9912errors occurs. For example:
9913.code
9914${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9915 {socket failure}}
9916.endd
9917You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9918expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9919and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9920if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9921non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9922
9923The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9924locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9925
9926
9927.vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9928.cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9929.cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9930.vindex "&$value$&"
9931.vindex "&$item$&"
9932This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9933<&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9934separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9935assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9936list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9937them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9938iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9939added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9940number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9941.code
9942${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9943.endd
9944The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9945can be found:
9946.code
9947${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9948.endd
9949At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9950restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9951expansion items.
9952
9953.vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9954This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9955expansion item above.
9956
9957.vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9958 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9959.cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9960.cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9961The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
9962split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
9963in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
9964executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
9965a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9966
9967Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
9968which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
9969simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
9970script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
9971variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
9972quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
9973in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
9974around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
9975variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
9976character.
9977
9978The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9979and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9980.cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9981.vindex "&$value$&"
9982If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9983and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9984from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9985<&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9986expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9987&$value$&.
9988
9989If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9990can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9991command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9992of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9993
9994.vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
9995The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
9996In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
9997troubleshoot:
9998.code
9999warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
10000 log_message = Output of id: $value
10001.endd
10002If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
10003shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
10004.code
10005${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
10006.endd
10007
10008.vindex "&$runrc$&"
10009The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
10010remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
10011.code
10012if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
10013 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
10014 ...
10015endif
10016.endd
10017If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
10018the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
10019commands.
10020
10021&*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10022option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
10023testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
10024by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10025
10026The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
10027out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10028
10029
10030.vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
10031.cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
10032.cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
10033This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
10034option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
10035modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
10036into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
10037a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
10038.code
10039${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
10040.endd
10041yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
10042if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
10043substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
10044.code
10045${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
10046.endd
10047yields &"defabc"&, and
10048.code
10049${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
10050.endd
10051yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
10052the regular expression from string expansion.
10053
10054
10055
10056.vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
10057.cindex sorting "a list"
10058.cindex list sorting
10059.cindex expansion "list sorting"
10060After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10061default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
10062The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10063of a two-argument expansion condition.
10064The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10065The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10066if the first value should sort before the second value.
10067The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10068the element being placed in &$item$&,
10069to give values for comparison.
10070
10071The item result is a sorted list,
10072with the original list separator,
10073of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10074
10075Examples:
10076.code
10077${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10078.endd
10079sorts a list of numbers, and
10080.code
10081${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10082.endd
10083will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10084
10085
10086.vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10087.cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10088.cindex "substring extraction"
10089.cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10090The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10091<&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10092if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10093can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10094.code
10095${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10096.endd
10097The second number is optional (in both notations).
10098If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10099omitted.
10100
10101The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10102&%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10103length required. For example
10104.code
10105${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10106.endd
10107If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10108null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10109length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10110given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
10111
10112The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10113from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
10114second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10115.code
10116${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10117.endd
10118yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10119length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10120the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10121.code
10122${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10123.endd
10124yields an empty string, but
10125.code
10126${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10127.endd
10128yields &"1"&.
10129
10130When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10131is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
10132string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10133no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10134.code
10135${substr_-1:abcde}
10136${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10137.endd
10138yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10139
10140
10141
10142.vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10143 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10144.cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10145.cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10146This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
10147argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10148matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10149replacement list. For example
10150.code
10151${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10152.endd
10153yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10154last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10155last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10156place.
10157.endlist
10158
10159
10160
10161.section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10162.cindex "expansion" "operators"
10163For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10164the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10165The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10166following operations can be performed:
10167
10168.vlist
10169.vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10170.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10171.cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10172The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10173header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10174not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10175
10176
10177.vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10178.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10179.cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10180The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
101812822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10182operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10183result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10184doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10185Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10186
10187It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10188separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10189character. For example:
10190.code
10191${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10192.endd
10193expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
10194first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
10195separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
10196separator explicitly:
10197.code
10198${addresses:>:$h_from:}
10199.endd
10200
10201Compare the &*address*& (singular)
10202expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10203address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
10204processing lists.
10205
10206To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10207a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10208unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10209email address separator. For the example header line:
10210.code
10211From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10212.endd
10213The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10214properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10215It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10216example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10217de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10218The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10219quoted.
10220.code
10221# exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10222=?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10223user@example.com
10224# exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10225Last:user@example.com
10226# exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10227user@example.com
10228.endd
10229
10230.vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10231.cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10232.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10233The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10234base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10235Only lowercase letters are used.
10236
10237.vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10238.cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10239.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10240The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10241The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10242
10243.vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10244.cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10245.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10246The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10247base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10248the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10249its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
10250names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
10251be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10252
10253.vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10254.cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10255.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10256The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10257environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10258identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10259string.
10260
10261.vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10262.cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10263.cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10264.cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10265.cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10266This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10267
10268If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10269returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10270
10271
10272.vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10273.cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10274.cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10275.cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10276This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10277
10278
10279.vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10280.cindex "domain" "extraction"
10281.cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10282The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10283from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10284
10285
10286.vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10287.cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10288.cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10289If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10290escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10291significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10292is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10293
10294.vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10295.cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
10296.cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
10297If the string contains and characters with the most significant bit set,
10298they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
10299Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
10300
10301
10302.vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10303.cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10304.cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10305.cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10306These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10307expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10308arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10309logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10310integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10311C programming language):
10312.table2 70pt 300pt
10313.irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10314.irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10315.irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10316.irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10317.irow "" "and (&&)"
10318.irow "" "xor (^)"
10319.irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10320.endtable
10321Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10322space is permitted before or after operators.
10323
10324For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10325hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10326decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10327permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10328times, which often do have leading zeros.
10329
10330A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10331or 1024*1024*1024,
10332respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10333a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10334
10335.display
10336&`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10337&`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10338&`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10339&`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10340&`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
10341&`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10342&`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10343&`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10344&`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10345&`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
10346&`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10347.endd
10348
10349As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10350.code
10351deny message = Too many bad recipients
10352 condition = \
10353 ${if and { \
10354 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10355 { \
10356 < \
10357 {$recipients_count} \
10358 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10359 } \
10360 }{yes}{no}}
10361.endd
10362The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10363fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10364
10365
10366.vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10367.cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10368The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10369example,
10370.code
10371${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10372.endd
10373first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10374and then re-expands what it has found.
10375
10376
10377.vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10378.cindex "Unicode"
10379.cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10380.cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10381.cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10382The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10383email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10384to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10385UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10386converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10387the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10388
10389Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10390ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10391For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10392way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10393characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10394single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10395translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10396
10397
10398.vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10399.cindex "hash function" "textual"
10400.cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10401The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10402be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10403change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10404.code
10405${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10406.endd
10407See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10408abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10409
10410
10411
10412.vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10413.cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10414.cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10415.cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10416This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10417be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
10418
10419
10420
10421.vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10422.cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10423.cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10424This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10425escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10426as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example a
10427byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10428
10429
10430.vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10431.cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10432.cindex "IP address" normalisation
10433This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10434of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10435A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10436Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10437
10438.vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10439.cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10440.cindex "IP address" normalisation
10441.cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10442This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10443Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10444set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10445A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10446Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10447
10448
10449.vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10450.cindex "case forcing in strings"
10451.cindex "string" "case forcing"
10452.cindex "lower casing"
10453.cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10454.cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10455This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10456.code
10457${lc:$local_part}
10458.endd
10459
10460.vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10461.cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10462.cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10463The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10464can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10465changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10466.code
10467${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10468.endd
10469See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10470&%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10471when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10472
10473
10474.vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10475.cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10476.cindex "list" "item count"
10477.cindex "list" "count of items"
10478.cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10479The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10480
10481
10482.vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10483.cindex "expansion" "named list"
10484.cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10485The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10486expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10487If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10488and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10489Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10490matching list is returned.
10491
10492
10493.vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10494.cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10495.cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10496The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10497extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10498empty.
10499
10500
10501.vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10502.cindex "masked IP address"
10503.cindex "IP address" "masking"
10504.cindex "CIDR notation"
10505.cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10506.cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10507If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10508slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10509expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10510masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10511the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10512.code
10513${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10514.endd
10515returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10516be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10517address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10518terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10519.code
10520${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10521.endd
10522returns the string
10523.code
105243ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10525.endd
10526Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10527
10528
10529.vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10530.cindex "MD5 hash"
10531.cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10532.cindex certificate fingerprint
10533.cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10534The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10535as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10536
10537If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10538returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10539
10540
10541.vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10542.cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10543.cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10544The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10545that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10546strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10547.code
10548${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10549.endd
10550See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10551
10552
10553.vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10554.cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10555.cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10556.cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10557The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10558is an empty string or
10559contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10560Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10561Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10562respectively For example,
10563.code
10564${quote:ab"*"cd}
10565.endd
10566becomes
10567.code
10568"ab\"*\"cd"
10569.endd
10570The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10571variable or a message header.
10572
10573.vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10574.cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10575This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10576required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10577example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10578If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10579(or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10580
10581
10582.vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10583.cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10584This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10585query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10586the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10587.code
10588${quote_ldap:two * two}
10589.endd
10590returns
10591.code
10592two%20%5C2A%20two
10593.endd
10594For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10595yields an unchanged string.
10596
10597
10598.vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10599.cindex "random number"
10600This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10601supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10602on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10603If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10604If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10605for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10606Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10607srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10608random().
10609
10610
10611.vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10612.cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10613This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10614dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10615dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10616for DNS. For example,
10617.code
10618${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10619${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10620.endd
10621returns
10622.code
106234.2.0.192
10624f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10625.endd
10626
10627
10628.vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10629.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10630.cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10631.cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10632This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10633encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10634assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10635&%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
10636contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10637characters
10638.code
10639? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10640.endd
10641it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10642string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10643characters.
10644
10645
10646.vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10647.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10648.cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10649.cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10650This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10651bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10652character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10653not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10654
10655&*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10656access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10657to use this operator as well.
10658
10659
10660
10661.vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10662.cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10663.cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10664.cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10665The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10666characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10667variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10668
10669
10670.vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10671.cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10672.cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10673.cindex certificate fingerprint
10674.cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
10675The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10676it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10677
10678If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10679returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10680
10681
10682.vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10683.cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10684.cindex certificate fingerprint
10685.cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10686.cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10687The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
10688and returns
10689it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10690
10691If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10692returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10693
10694
10695.vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10696 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10697.cindex "SHA3 hash"
10698.cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
10699.cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
10700The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
10701and returns
10702it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10703
10704If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
10705the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
10706with 256 being the default.
10707
10708The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
10709compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
10710or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
10711The macro "_CRYPTO_HASH_SHA3" will be defined if it is supported.
10712
10713
10714.vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10715.cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10716.cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10717.cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10718The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10719function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10720expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10721series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10722except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10723a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
1072410-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10725&"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10726can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10727
10728The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10729the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10730systems for files larger than 2GB.
10731
10732.vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10733.cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10734Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
10735
10736
10737
10738.vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10739.cindex "expansion" "string length"
10740.cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10741.cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10742The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10743decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10744
10745
10746.vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10747.cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10748.cindex "substring extraction"
10749.cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10750The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10751can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10752that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10753.code
10754${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10755.endd
10756See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10757abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10758
10759.vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10760.cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10761.cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10762This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10763seconds.
10764
10765.vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10766.cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10767.cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10768The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10769represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10770number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10771&`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
10772
10773.vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10774.cindex "case forcing in strings"
10775.cindex "string" "case forcing"
10776.cindex "upper casing"
10777.cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10778.cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10779This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10780
10781.vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10782.cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
10783.cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
10784.cindex "incorrect utf-8"
10785.cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
10786.cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
10787This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
10788
10789.vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10790 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10791 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10792 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
10793.cindex expansion UTF-8
10794.cindex UTF-8 expansion
10795.cindex EAI
10796.cindex internationalisation
10797.cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
10798.cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
10799.cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
10800.cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
10801These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
10802For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
10803.endlist
10804
10805
10806
10807
10808
10809
10810.section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10811.scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10812The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10813while expanding strings:
10814
10815.vlist
10816.vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10817.cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10818.cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10819Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10820condition.
10821
10822.vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10823.cindex "numeric comparison"
10824.cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10825There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10826are:
10827.display
10828&`= `& equal
10829&`== `& equal
10830&`> `& greater
10831&`>= `& greater or equal
10832&`< `& less
10833&`<= `& less or equal
10834.endd
10835For example:
10836.code
10837${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10838.endd
10839Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10840two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10841optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10842lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10843As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10844zero.
10845
10846In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10847<&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
1084810M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10849
10850
10851.vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10852 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10853.cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10854.cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10855The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10856arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10857Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10858arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10859and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10860are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10861a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10862the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10863If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10864If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10865
10866.vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10867.cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10868.cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10869This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10870a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10871(case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10872false if zero.
10873An empty string is treated as false.
10874Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10875thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10876All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10877
10878When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10879make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10880For example:
10881.code
10882${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10883.endd
10884
10885
10886.vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10887.cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10888.cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10889Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10890where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10891loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10892and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10893true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10894
10895Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10896
10897.vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10898.cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10899.cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10900.cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10901This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10902authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10903necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10904included in the binary.
10905
10906The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10907compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10908be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10909encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10910does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10911&[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10912Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10913string in LDAP form is:
10914.code
10915{md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10916.endd
10917If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10918be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10919.code
10920${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10921.endd
10922The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10923supported:
10924
10925.ilist
10926.cindex "MD5 hash"
10927.cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10928&%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10929printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10930length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10931(as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10932hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10933comparison fails.
10934
10935.next
10936.cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10937&%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10938printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10939length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10940If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10941SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10942
10943.next
10944.cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10945&%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10946only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10947systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10948whatever its length.
10949
10950.next
10951.cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10952&%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10953use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10954modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10955.endlist
10956Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10957&[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10958HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10959operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10960the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10961support &[crypt16()]&.
10962
10963Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10964it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10965turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10966&[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10967algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10968
10969However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10970functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10971Exim is seen as very low priority.
10972
10973If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10974comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10975determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10976default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10977function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10978
10979.vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10980.cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10981.cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10982The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10983variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10984variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10985.code
10986${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10987.endd
10988Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10989variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10990
10991.vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10992 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10993.cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10994This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10995exists in the message. For example,
10996.code
10997${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10998.endd
10999&*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
11000the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
11001
11002.vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11003 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11004.cindex "string" "comparison"
11005.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11006.cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
11007.cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
11008The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
11009resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
11010letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
11011
11012.vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
11013.cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
11014.cindex "file" "existence test"
11015.cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
11016The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
11017condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
11018is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
11019users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
11020
11021.vitem &*first_delivery*&
11022.cindex "delivery" "first"
11023.cindex "first delivery"
11024.cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
11025.cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
11026This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
11027attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
11028
11029
11030.vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11031 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11032.cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11033.cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
11034.cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
11035.vindex "&$item$&"
11036These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
11037the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
11038the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
11039be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
11040condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
11041.ilist
11042For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
11043the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
11044items in the list, the overall condition is false.
11045.next
11046For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
11047and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
11048all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
11049.endlist
11050Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
11051items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
11052that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
11053list separator is changed to a comma:
11054.code
11055${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
11056.endd
11057The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
11058being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
11059
11060To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
11061
11062
11063.vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11064 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11065.cindex "string" "comparison"
11066.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11067.cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
11068.cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
11069The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11070string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
11071comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
11072case-independent.
11073
11074.vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11075 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11076.cindex "string" "comparison"
11077.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11078.cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
11079.cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
11080The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11081string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
11082includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
11083case-independent.
11084
11085.vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11086 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11087.cindex "string" "comparison"
11088.cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11089Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11090strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11091is true.
11092
11093These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11094Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11095.code
11096${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11097 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11098${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11099 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11100.endd
11101
11102.vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11103 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11104 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11105.cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11106.cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11107.cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11108.cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11109.cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11110The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11111an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11112&%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11113
11114For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11115which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11116colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11117hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11118component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11119
11120&*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11121values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11122check.
11123This is no longer the case.
11124
11125The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11126host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11127.code
11128${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11129.endd
11130to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11131
11132.vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11133.cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11134.cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11135.cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
11136This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
11137&<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
11138queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
11139query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
11140password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
11141server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
11142with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
11143will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
11144of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
11145this can be used.
11146
11147
11148.vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11149 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11150.cindex "string" "comparison"
11151.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11152.cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
11153.cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
11154The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11155string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
11156comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
11157case-independent.
11158
11159.vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11160 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11161.cindex "string" "comparison"
11162.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11163.cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
11164.cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
11165The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11166string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
11167includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
11168case-independent.
11169
11170
11171.vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11172.cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
11173.cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
11174.cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
11175The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
11176expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
11177regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
11178escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
11179(curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
11180premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
11181&`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
11182For example,
11183.code
11184${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
11185.endd
11186If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
11187backslashes is also required.
11188
11189The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
11190The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
11191metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
11192and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
11193the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
11194metacharacter at an appropriate point.
11195
11196.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
11197At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
11198substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
11199succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
11200will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
11201of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
11202combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
11203variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
11204
11205.vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11206.cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
11207See &*match_local_part*&.
11208
11209.vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11210.cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
11211See &*match_local_part*&.
11212
11213.vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11214.cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
11215This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
11216be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
11217address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
11218list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
11219.code
11220${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
11221.endd
11222The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
11223
11224.ilist
11225An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
11226.next
11227A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
11228.next
11229An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
11230useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
11231in a single test such as
11232. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11233. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
11234. ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
11235. ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
11236.code
11237 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
11238.endd
11239where the first item in the list is the empty string.
11240.next
11241The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
11242.next
11243Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
11244even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
11245address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
11246&*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
11247masks. For example:
11248.code
11249 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
11250.endd
11251It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
11252do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
11253address mask, for example:
11254.code
11255 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
11256.endd
11257However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
11258just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
11259.code
11260 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
11261.endd
11262.endlist ilist
11263
11264Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11265Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11266
11267Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
11268
11269.vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11270.cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
11271.cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
11272.cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
11273.cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
11274This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
11275possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
11276condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
11277example is:
11278.code
11279${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
11280.endd
11281In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
11282list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
11283is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
11284Thus, you can use conditions like this:
11285.code
11286${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
11287.endd
11288.cindex "&`+caseful`&"
11289For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
11290item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
11291have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
11292caselessly.
11293
11294Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11295Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11296
11297&*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
11298hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
11299how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
11300matched using &%match_ip%&.
11301
11302.vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
11303.cindex "PAM authentication"
11304.cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
11305.cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
11306.cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
11307.cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
11308&'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
11309(&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
11310available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
11311distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
11312the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
11313.code
11314SUPPORT_PAM=yes
11315.endd
11316in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
11317in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
11318
11319The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
11320colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
11321The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
11322taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
11323The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
11324from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
11325request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
11326
11327There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
11328characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
11329separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
11330item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
11331of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
11332.code
11333server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
11334.endd
11335For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
11336.code
11337server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
11338.endd
11339In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
11340running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
11341messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
11342A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
11343Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
11344The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
11345to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
11346group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
11347
11348
11349.vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11350.cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11351.cindex "Cyrus"
11352.cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11353.cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11354This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11355This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11356that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11357deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11358
11359The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11360the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11361building Exim. For example:
11362.code
11363CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11364.endd
11365You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11366the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11367from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11368access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11369
11370The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11371password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11372configuration, you might have this:
11373.code
11374server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11375.endd
11376Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11377.code
11378server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11379.endd
11380.vitem &*queue_running*&
11381.cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11382.cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11383.cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11384This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11385initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11386
11387
11388.vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11389.cindex "Radius"
11390.cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11391.cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11392Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11393set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11394the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11395support.
11396
11397With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11398library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11399this library, you need to set
11400.code
11401RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11402.endd
11403in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11404&%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11405.code
11406RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11407.endd
11408in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11409You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11410Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11411
11412The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11413Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11414the authentication is successful. For example:
11415.code
11416server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11417.endd
11418
11419
11420.vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11421 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11422.cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11423.cindex "Cyrus"
11424.cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11425.cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11426This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11427daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11428Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11429by a process that is not running as root.
11430
11431The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11432the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11433building Exim. For example:
11434.code
11435CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11436.endd
11437You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11438the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11439from the Cyrus SASL library.
11440
11441Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11442two are mandatory. For example:
11443.code
11444server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11445.endd
11446The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11447in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11448realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11449.endlist vlist
11450
11451
11452
11453.section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11454.cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11455Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11456and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11457conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11458sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11459the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11460
11461
11462.vlist
11463.vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11464.cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11465.cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11466The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11467any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11468For example,
11469.code
11470${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11471.endd
11472When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11473evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11474numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11475
11476.vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11477.cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11478.cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11479The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11480all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11481sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11482the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11483parsed but not evaluated.
11484.endlist
11485.ecindex IIDexpcond
11486
11487
11488
11489
11490.section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11491.cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11492This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11493of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11494support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11495
11496.vlist
11497.vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11498.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11499When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11500captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11501processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11502In the expansion condition case
11503they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11504values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11505variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11506precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11507Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11508matching condition.
11509
11510.vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11511Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11512any arguments are copied to these variables,
11513any unused variables being made empty.
11514
11515.vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11516Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11517can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11518long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11519example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11520variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11521used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11522same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11523with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11524during subsequent delivery.
11525
11526.vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11527These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11528are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11529received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11530message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11531also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11532message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11533and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11534delivery.
11535
11536.vitem &$acl_narg$&
11537Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11538this variable has the number of arguments.
11539
11540.vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11541.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11542After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11543message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11544be preserved by coding like this:
11545.code
11546warn !verify = sender
11547 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11548.endd
11549You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11550&%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11551failure.
11552
11553.vitem &$address_data$&
11554.vindex "&$address_data$&"
11555This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11556value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11557and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11558the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11559for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11560user filter files.
11561
11562If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11563a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11564conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11565to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11566of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11567from the child's routing.
11568
11569If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11570sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11571&$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11572address.
11573
11574In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11575after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11576these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11577
11578.vitem &$address_file$&
11579.vindex "&$address_file$&"
11580When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11581to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11582is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11583default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11584.code
11585/home/r2d2/savemail
11586.endd
11587then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11588contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11589.cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11590For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11591then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11592to the relevant file.
11593
11594.vitem &$address_pipe$&
11595.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11596When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11597this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11598
11599.vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11600.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11601These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11602&<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11603
11604.vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11605.cindex "authentication" "id"
11606.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11607When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11608preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11609&$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11610user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11611in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11612&$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11613
11614When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11615the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11616process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11617command line option.
11618This second case also sets up inforamtion used by the
11619&$authresults$& expansion item.
11620
11621.vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11622.cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11623.vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11624When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11625will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11626id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11627available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11628A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11629authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11630the ACL's as well.
11631
11632
11633.vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11634.cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11635.cindex "authentication" "sender"
11636.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11637.vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11638When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11639SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11640described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11641&"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11642available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11643sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11644
11645.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11646When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11647value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11648name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11649can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11650
11651
11652.vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11653.cindex "authentication" "failure"
11654.vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11655This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11656command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11657possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11658(&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11659&"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11660is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11661negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11662an undefined mechanism.
11663
11664.vitem &$av_failed$&
11665.cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11666This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11667extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11668problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11669the ACL malware condition.
11670
11671.vitem &$body_linecount$&
11672.cindex "message body" "line count"
11673.cindex "body of message" "line count"
11674.vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11675When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11676number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11677
11678.vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11679.cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11680.cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11681.cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11682.vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11683When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11684number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11685
11686.vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
11687.vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
11688This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
11689it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
11690chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11691
11692.vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
11693.vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
11694This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11695up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
11696file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11697
11698.vitem &$caller_gid$&
11699.cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
11700.vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11701The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11702not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
11703&$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11704incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
11705
11706.vitem &$caller_uid$&
11707.cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
11708.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11709The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11710not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
11711&$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11712incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
11713
11714.vitem &$callout_address$&
11715.vindex "&$callout_address$&"
11716After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
11717address that was connected to.
11718
11719.vitem &$compile_number$&
11720.vindex "&$compile_number$&"
11721The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
11722of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
11723compilations of the same version of the program.
11724
11725.vitem &$config_dir$&
11726.vindex "&$config_dir$&"
11727The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
11728&$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
11729contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
11730&$config_dir$& is ".".
11731
11732.vitem &$config_file$&
11733.vindex "&$config_file$&"
11734The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
11735
11736.vitem &$dkim_verify_status$&
11737Results of DKIM verification.
11738For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
11739
11740.vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
11741 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
11742 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
11743 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
11744 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
11745 &$dkim_algo$& &&&
11746 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
11747 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
11748 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
11749 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
11750 &$dkim_created$& &&&
11751 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
11752 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
11753 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
11754 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
11755 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
11756 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
11757 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
11758 &$dkim_key_length$&
11759These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
11760For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
11761
11762.vitem &$dkim_signers$&
11763.vindex &$dkim_signers$&
11764When a message has been received this variable contains
11765a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
11766For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
11767
11768.vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
11769 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
11770 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
11771 &$dnslist_value$&
11772.vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
11773.vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
11774.vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
11775.vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
11776.cindex "black list (DNS)"
11777When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
11778the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
11779looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
11780main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
11781
11782.vitem &$domain$&
11783.vindex "&$domain$&"
11784When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
11785contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
11786case for &$domain$&.
11787
11788Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11789&$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
11790is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
11791message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
11792
11793When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
11794RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
11795have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
11796at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
11797the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
11798which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
11799
11800.oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
11801At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11802set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11803
11804The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11805
11806.ilist
11807When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11808the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11809&$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11810normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11811is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11812&$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11813the &(smtp)& transport.
11814
11815.next
11816When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11817&$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11818it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11819rewrite domains by file lookup.
11820
11821.next
11822With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11823&$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11824a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11825is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11826that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11827recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11828
11829.next
11830.cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11831.oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11832When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11833the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11834.endlist
11835
11836
11837.vitem &$domain_data$&
11838.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11839When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11840means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11841of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11842address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11843transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11844used.
11845
11846&$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11847domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11848the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11849to nothing.
11850
11851.vitem &$exim_gid$&
11852.vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11853This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11854
11855.vitem &$exim_path$&
11856.vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11857This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11858
11859.vitem &$exim_uid$&
11860.vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11861This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11862
11863.vitem &$exim_version$&
11864.vindex "&$exim_version$&"
11865This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
11866The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
11867Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
11868There may be other characters following the minor version.
11869
11870.vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11871This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11872inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11873be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11874characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11875
11876.vitem &$headers_added$&
11877.vindex "&$headers_added$&"
11878Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
11879the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
11880The headers are a newline-separated list.
11881
11882.vitem &$home$&
11883.vindex "&$home$&"
11884When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11885directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11886means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11887explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11888by a setting on the transport itself.
11889
11890When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11891of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
11892&%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
11893
11894.vitem &$host$&
11895.vindex "&$host$&"
11896If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11897list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11898to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11899to local and remote transports.
11900
11901.cindex "transport" "filter"
11902.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11903For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11904&$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11905particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11906using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11907&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11908is connected.
11909
11910When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11911&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11912client is connected.
11913
11914
11915.vitem &$host_address$&
11916.vindex "&$host_address$&"
11917This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11918for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11919when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11920
11921.vitem &$host_data$&
11922.vindex "&$host_data$&"
11923If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11924result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11925allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11926.code
11927deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11928message = $host_data
11929.endd
11930.vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11931.cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11932.vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11933This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11934message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11935name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11936variables is set to &"1"&.
11937
11938.ilist
11939If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11940succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11941
11942.next
11943If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11944tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11945lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11946.endlist ilist
11947
11948Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11949single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11950names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11951is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11952&$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11953IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11954sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11955lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11956the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11957&"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11958
11959.cindex authentication "expansion item"
11960Performing these checks sets up information used by the
11961&$authresults$& expansion item.
11962
11963
11964.vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11965.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11966See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11967
11968.vitem &$host_port$&
11969.vindex "&$host_port$&"
11970This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
11971for an outbound connection.
11972
11973.vitem &$initial_cwd$&
11974.vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
11975This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
11976directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
11977working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
11978to &$spool_directory$& later.
11979
11980.vitem &$inode$&
11981.vindex "&$inode$&"
11982The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11983option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11984of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11985a unique name for the file.
11986
11987.vitem &$interface_address$&
11988.vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11989This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11990
11991.vitem &$interface_port$&
11992.vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11993This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11994
11995.vitem &$item$&
11996.vindex "&$item$&"
11997This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11998conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11999&*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
12000empty.
12001
12002.vitem &$ldap_dn$&
12003.vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
12004This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
12005contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
12006lookup.
12007
12008.vitem &$load_average$&
12009.vindex "&$load_average$&"
12010This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
12011is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
12012variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
12013
12014.vitem &$local_part$&
12015.vindex "&$local_part$&"
12016When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
12017variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
12018delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
12019session), &$local_part$& is not set.
12020
12021Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12022&$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
12023&$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
12024because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
12025once.
12026
12027.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12028.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12029If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
12030value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
12031any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
12032&$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
12033
12034When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
12035result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
12036the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
12037&$address_pipe$&).
12038
12039When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
12040local part of the recipient address.
12041
12042When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12043&$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
12044it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
12045
12046In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
12047the addresses
12048.code
12049"abc:xyz"@test.example
12050abc\:xyz@test.example
12051.endd
12052the value of &$local_part$& is
12053.code
12054abc:xyz
12055.endd
12056If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
12057inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
12058have:
12059.code
12060data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
12061.endd
12062&*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
12063to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
12064&%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
12065
12066.vitem &$local_part_data$&
12067.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
12068When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
12069lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
12070router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
12071to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
12072handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
12073
12074&$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
12075matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
12076available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
12077variable expands to nothing.
12078
12079.vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
12080.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12081When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12082specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12083variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12084
12085.vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
12086.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12087When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12088specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12089variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12090
12091.vitem &$local_scan_data$&
12092.vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
12093This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
12094a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
12095
12096.vitem &$local_user_gid$&
12097.vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
12098See &$local_user_uid$&.
12099
12100.vitem &$local_user_uid$&
12101.vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
12102This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
12103&%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
12104are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
12105and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
12106router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
12107are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
12108
12109.vitem &$localhost_number$&
12110.vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
12111This contains the expanded value of the
12112&%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
12113been read.
12114
12115.vitem &$log_inodes$&
12116.vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12117The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
12118log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
12119referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
12120the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
12121
12122.vitem &$log_space$&
12123.vindex "&$log_space$&"
12124The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
12125partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
12126whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
12127ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
12128the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
12129
12130
12131.vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
12132.vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
12133This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
12134a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
12135.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12136It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
12137&"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
12138and &"yes"& if it was.
12139Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
12140the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
12141as authenticated data.
12142
12143.vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
12144.vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
12145This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
12146&(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
12147&%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
12148contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
12149without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
12150variable is empty.
12151
12152.vitem &$malware_name$&
12153.vindex "&$malware_name$&"
12154This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
12155content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
12156when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
12157
12158.vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
12159.vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
12160.cindex "maximum" "line length"
12161.cindex "line length" "maximum"
12162This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
12163received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
12164character(s).
12165It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12166
12167.vitem &$message_age$&
12168.cindex "message" "age of"
12169.vindex "&$message_age$&"
12170This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
12171of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
12172delivery attempt.
12173
12174.vitem &$message_body$&
12175.cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12176.cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12177.cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12178.vindex "&$message_body$&"
12179.oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
12180This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
12181being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
12182number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
12183&%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
12184
12185.oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
12186By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
12187easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
12188this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
12189zeros are always converted into spaces.
12190
12191.vitem &$message_body_end$&
12192.cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12193.cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12194.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
12195This variable contains the final portion of a message's
12196body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
12197&$message_body$&.
12198
12199.vitem &$message_body_size$&
12200.cindex "body of message" "size"
12201.cindex "message body" "size"
12202.vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
12203When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
12204in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
12205separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
12206also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12207
12208If the spool file is wireformat
12209(see the &%spool_files_wireformat%& main option)
12210the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
12211
12212.vitem &$message_exim_id$&
12213.vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
12214When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12215unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
12216An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
12217received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
12218line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
12219&`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
12220
12221.vitem &$message_headers$&
12222.vindex &$message_headers$&
12223This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
12224is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
12225lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
12226same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
12227
12228.vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
12229.vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
12230This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
12231contents of header lines is done.
12232
12233.vitem &$message_id$&
12234This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
12235
12236.vitem &$message_linecount$&
12237.vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
12238This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
12239message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
12240During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
12241number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
12242routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
12243&'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
12244lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
12245from the body is not counted.
12246
12247As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
12248appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
12249&$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
12250file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
12251header and the body).
12252
12253Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
12254.code
12255deny message = Too many lines in message header
12256 condition = \
12257 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
12258.endd
12259In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
12260message has not yet been received.
12261
12262This variable is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12263
12264.vitem &$message_size$&
12265.cindex "size" "of message"
12266.cindex "message" "size"
12267.vindex "&$message_size$&"
12268When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
12269most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
12270message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
12271deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
12272expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
12273doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
12274precise size of the file that has been written. See also
12275&$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12276
12277.cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
12278While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
12279contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
12280value may not, of course, be truthful.
12281
12282.vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
12283A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
12284available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
12285details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
12286
12287.vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
12288These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
12289of the &%add%& command in filter files.
12290
12291.vitem &$original_domain$&
12292.vindex "&$domain$&"
12293.vindex "&$original_domain$&"
12294When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12295same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
12296generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
12297variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
12298differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
12299aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
12300single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
12301
12302If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12303filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12304part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12305
12306.vitem &$original_local_part$&
12307.vindex "&$local_part$&"
12308.vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
12309When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12310same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
12311local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
12312part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
12313filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
12314the original address.
12315
12316If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
12317case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
12318This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
12319one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
12320delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
12321
12322If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12323filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12324part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12325
12326.vitem &$originator_gid$&
12327.cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
12328.cindex "sender" "gid"
12329.vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12330.vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
12331This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
12332message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
12333gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
12334normally the gid of the Exim user.
12335
12336.vitem &$originator_uid$&
12337.cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
12338.cindex "sender" "uid"
12339.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12340.vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
12341The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
12342messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
12343For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
12344user.
12345
12346.vitem &$parent_domain$&
12347.vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
12348This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
12349above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12350
12351.vitem &$parent_local_part$&
12352.vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
12353This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
12354(see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12355
12356.vitem &$pid$&
12357.cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
12358.vindex "&$pid$&"
12359This variable contains the current process id.
12360
12361.vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
12362.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12363.cindex "transport" "filter"
12364.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12365This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12366&`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12367&(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12368(described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12369It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12370variable"& error if encountered.
12371
12372.vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12373.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12374This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12375configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12376a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12377&[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12378qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12379
12380
12381.vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
12382 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
12383 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
12384 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
12385 &$proxy_session$&
12386These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
12387or SOCKS5 support.
12388For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
12389
12390.vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12391.cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12392This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12393current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12394
12395.vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12396This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12397which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12398&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12399
12400.vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12401This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12402which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12403&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12404
12405.vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12406This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12407which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12408&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12409
12410.vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12411.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12412The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12413
12414.vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12415.vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12416The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12417or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12418
12419.vitem &$queue_name$&
12420.vindex &$queue_name$&
12421.cindex "named queues"
12422.cindex queues named
12423The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
12424
12425.vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12426.vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12427When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12428RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12429RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12430
12431.vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12432.vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12433.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12434When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12435RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12436temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12437
12438.vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12439.vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12440When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12441RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12442permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12443
12444.vitem &$received_count$&
12445.vindex "&$received_count$&"
12446This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12447including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12448is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12449delivering.
12450
12451.vitem &$received_for$&
12452.vindex "&$received_for$&"
12453If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12454variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12455built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12456the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12457
12458.vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12459.vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12460As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12461variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12462is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12463&$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12464the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12465option.
12466
12467As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12468could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
12469on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12470values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12471messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12472time.
12473For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12474
12475.vitem &$received_port$&
12476.vindex "&$received_port$&"
12477See &$received_ip_address$&.
12478
12479.vitem &$received_protocol$&
12480.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12481When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12482protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12483by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12484&"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12485(encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12486is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12487connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12488
12489Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12490automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12491&%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12492encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12493where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12494STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12495
12496The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12497messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12498identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12499
12500.vitem &$received_time$&
12501.vindex "&$received_time$&"
12502This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12503as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12504
12505.vitem &$recipient_data$&
12506.vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12507This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12508condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12509until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12510.display
12511&`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12512&`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12513.endd
12514&*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12515method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12516The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12517expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12518
12519.vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12520.vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12521In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12522information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12523
12524.ilist
12525&"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12526was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12527
12528.next
12529&"route"&: Routing failed.
12530
12531.next
12532&"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12533or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12534MAIL).
12535
12536.next
12537&"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12538.next
12539
12540&"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12541.endlist
12542
12543The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12544rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12545
12546.vitem &$recipients$&
12547.vindex "&$recipients$&"
12548This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12549a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12550is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12551unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12552cases:
12553
12554.olist
12555In a system filter file.
12556.next
12557In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12558is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12559&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12560&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12561.next
12562From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12563.endlist
12564
12565
12566.vitem &$recipients_count$&
12567.vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12568When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12569envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12570from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12571increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12572
12573
12574.vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12575.vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12576This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12577&%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12578
12579.vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
12580.cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
12581When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
12582these variables contain the
12583captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
12584
12585
12586.vitem &$reply_address$&
12587.vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12588When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12589&'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12590contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12591white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12592decoding or character code translation takes place.
12593
12594.vitem &$return_path$&
12595.vindex "&$return_path$&"
12596When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12597the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12598in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12599same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12600mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12601for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12602address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12603that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12604the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12605envelope sender.
12606
12607.vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12608.vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12609This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12610
12611.vitem &$router_name$&
12612.cindex "router" "name"
12613.cindex "name" "of router"
12614.vindex "&$router_name$&"
12615During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12616
12617.vitem &$runrc$&
12618.cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12619.vindex "&$runrc$&"
12620This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12621&%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12622assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12623preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12624reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12625another.
12626
12627.vitem &$self_hostname$&
12628.oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12629.vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12630When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12631local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12632One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12633happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12634original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12635
12636.vitem &$sender_address$&
12637.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12638When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12639that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12640is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12641value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12642
12643.vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12644.vindex "&$address_data$&"
12645.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12646If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12647sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
12648distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
12649after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
12650longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
12651
12652.vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
12653.vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
12654The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
12655
12656.vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
12657.vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
12658The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
12659
12660.vitem &$sender_data$&
12661.vindex "&$sender_data$&"
12662This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
12663in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
12664value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
12665this:
12666.display
12667&`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12668&`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
12669.endd
12670&*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12671method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12672The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12673expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12674
12675.vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
12676.vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
12677When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
12678name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
12679brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
12680enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
12681issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
12682looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
12683&%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
12684start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
12685verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
12686the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
12687the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
12688
12689.vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
12690.vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
12691This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
12692.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12693done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
12694
12695.vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
12696.vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
12697When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
12698command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
12699set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
12700the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
12701
12702.vitem &$sender_host_address$&
12703.vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
12704When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
12705this variable contains that
12706host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
12707
12708.vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
12709.vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
12710This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
12711driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
12712received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
12713&$authenticated_id$&.
12714
12715.vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
12716.vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
12717If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
12718(by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
12719otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
12720resolver library states that both
12721the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
12722other times, this variable is false.
12723
12724.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12725It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
12726library, by setting:
12727.code
12728dns_dnssec_ok = 1
12729.endd
12730
12731Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
12732validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
12733
12734If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
12735mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
12736
12737This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
12738DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
12739all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
12740is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
12741
12742
12743.vitem &$sender_host_name$&
12744.vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
12745When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12746host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
12747other means, this variable is empty.
12748
12749.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12750If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
12751&$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
12752A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
12753via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
12754any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
12755&$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12756
12757.vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12758However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
12759DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
12760&$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
12761
12762Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
12763host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
12764in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12765is set to &"1"&.
12766
12767Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
12768maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
12769these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
12770following are true:
12771
12772.ilist
12773A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
12774.next
12775The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
12776configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
12777to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
12778.next
12779Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
12780that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
12781&<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
12782.next
12783The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
12784In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
12785EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
12786.next
12787The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
12788domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
12789. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12790. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
12791.code
12792 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
12793.endd
12794which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
12795IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
12796.endlist
12797
12798
12799.vitem &$sender_host_port$&
12800.vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
12801When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
12802number that was used on the remote host.
12803
12804.vitem &$sender_ident$&
12805.vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
12806When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12807identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
12808been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
12809called Exim.
12810
12811.vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
12812A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
12813&%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
12814&<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
12815
12816.vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
12817.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
12818.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
12819.vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
12820This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
12821either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
12822there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
12823there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
12824the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
12825followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
12826first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
12827the parentheses.
12828
12829There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
12830was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
12831address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
12832all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
12833into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
12834
12835.vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
12836.vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
12837In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
12838about the failure. The details are the same as for
12839&$recipient_verify_failure$&.
12840
12841.vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
12842.vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
12843This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12844been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
12845used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
12846on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
12847connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
12848
12849.vitem &$sending_port$&
12850.vindex "&$sending_port$&"
12851This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12852been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
12853connections, see &$received_port$&.
12854
12855.vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
12856.vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
12857During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
12858host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
12859&$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
12860value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
12861
12862.vitem &$smtp_command$&
12863.vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
12864During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
12865entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
12866the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
12867.code
12868MAIL FROM:<>
12869MAIL FROM: <>
12870.endd
12871For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
12872command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
12873rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
12874the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
12875
12876.vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
12877.cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
12878.vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
12879While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
12880argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
12881space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
12882somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
12883
12884.vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
12885.cindex SMTP "command history"
12886.vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
12887A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
12888received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
12889are remembered.
12890
12891.vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
12892.vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
12893This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
12894daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
12895in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
12896connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
12897the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
12898never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
12899there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
12900single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
12901daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
12902
12903.vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
12904These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
12905that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
12906filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
12907example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
12908message is junk mail.
12909
12910.vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
12911A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
12912is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
12913&<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
12914
12915.vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
12916 &$spf_received$& &&&
12917 &$spf_result$& &&&
12918 &$spf_result_guessed$& &&&
12919 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
12920These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
12921For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
12922
12923.vitem &$spool_directory$&
12924.vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
12925The name of Exim's spool directory.
12926
12927.vitem &$spool_inodes$&
12928.vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12929The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
12930being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
12931If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
12932is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
12933
12934.vitem &$spool_space$&
12935.vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12936The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
12937Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
12938variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
12939find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
12940value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
12941megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
12942.code
12943condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
12944.endd
12945See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
12946
12947
12948.vitem &$thisaddress$&
12949.vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
12950This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
12951command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
12952command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
12953interfaces to mail filtering'&.
12954
12955.vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
12956.vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
12957Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12958on the inbound connection; the meaning of
12959this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12960If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12961The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
12962when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
12963
12964The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
12965except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12966the outbound.
12967
12968.vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
12969.vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
12970Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12971on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
12972this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12973If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12974
12975.vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
12976.vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
12977.cindex certificate variables
12978This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12979inbound connection when the message was received.
12980It is only useful as the argument of a
12981&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12982or a &%def%& condition.
12983
12984&*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
12985when a list of more than one
12986file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
12987
12988.vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
12989.vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
12990This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12991inbound connection when the message was received.
12992It is only useful as the argument of a
12993&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12994or a &%def%& condition.
12995If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12996which is not the leaf.
12997
12998.vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
12999.vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
13000This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13001outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13002&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13003or a &%def%& condition.
13004
13005.vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
13006.vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
13007This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13008outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13009&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13010or a &%def%& condition.
13011If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13012which is not the leaf.
13013
13014.vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
13015.vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
13016This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
13017message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
13018
13019The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
13020except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13021the outbound.
13022
13023.vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
13024.vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
13025This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
13026outbound SMTP connection was made,
13027and &"0"& otherwise.
13028
13029.vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
13030.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13031.vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
13032When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13033connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
13034example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
13035received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
13036&$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
13037non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
13038
13039The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
13040but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
13041becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
13042
13043.vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
13044.vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
13045This variable is
13046cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
13047and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
13048&<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
13049details of the &(smtp)& transport.
13050
13051.vitem &$tls_out_dane$&
13052.vindex &$tls_out_dane$&
13053DANE active status. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13054
13055.vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
13056.vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
13057When a message is received from a remote client connection
13058the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
13059.code
130600 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
130611 No response to request
130622 Response not verified
130633 Verification failed
130644 Verification succeeded
13065.endd
13066
13067.vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
13068.vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
13069When a message is sent to a remote host connection
13070the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
13071See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
13072
13073.vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
13074.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
13075.vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
13076.cindex certificate "extracting fields"
13077When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13078connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
13079the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13080&$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13081If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13082which is not the leaf.
13083
13084The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
13085except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13086the outbound.
13087
13088.vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
13089.vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
13090When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13091connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
13092the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13093&$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13094If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13095which is not the leaf.
13096
13097.vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
13098.vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
13099.vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
13100.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13101When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
13102Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
13103If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
13104some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
13105will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
13106a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
13107used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
13108
13109The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
13110except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13111the outbound.
13112
13113.vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
13114.vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
13115.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13116During outbound
13117SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
13118the transport.
13119
13120.vitem &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13121.vindex &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13122Bitfield of TLSA record types found. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13123
13124.vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
13125.vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
13126The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
13127files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
13128
13129.vitem &$tod_epoch$&
13130.vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
13131The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13132
13133.vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
13134.vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
13135The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13136
13137.vitem &$tod_full$&
13138.vindex "&$tod_full$&"
13139A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
13140+0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
13141positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
13142values for those that are behind (west).
13143
13144.vitem &$tod_log$&
13145.vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13146The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
131471995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
13148
13149.vitem &$tod_logfile$&
13150.vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
13151This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
13152is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
13153flag.
13154
13155.vitem &$tod_zone$&
13156.vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13157This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
13158-0500.
13159
13160.vitem &$tod_zulu$&
13161.vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
13162This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
13163by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
13164
13165.vitem &$transport_name$&
13166.cindex "transport" "name"
13167.cindex "name" "of transport"
13168.vindex "&$transport_name$&"
13169During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
13170
13171.vitem &$value$&
13172.vindex "&$value$&"
13173This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
13174or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
13175&*reduce*& expansion.
13176
13177.vitem &$verify_mode$&
13178.vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
13179While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
13180contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
13181Otherwise, empty.
13182
13183.vitem &$version_number$&
13184.vindex "&$version_number$&"
13185The version number of Exim.
13186
13187.vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
13188.vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
13189This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13190delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13191
13192.vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
13193.vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
13194This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13195delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13196.endlist
13197.ecindex IIDstrexp
13198
13199
13200
13201. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13202. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13203
13204.chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
13205.scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
13206Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
13207Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
13208use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
13209your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
13210the line
13211.code
13212EXIM_PERL = perl.o
13213.endd
13214in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
13215
13216
13217.section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
13218.oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
13219Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
13220&%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
13221no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
13222interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
13223the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
13224option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
13225a newly created Perl interpreter.
13226
13227The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
13228need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
13229should usually be something like
13230.code
13231perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
13232.endd
13233where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
13234use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
13235soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
13236the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
13237its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
13238fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
13239necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
13240the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
13241two ways:
13242
13243.ilist
13244.oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
13245Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
13246a startup when Exim is entered.
13247.next
13248The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
13249overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
13250.endlist
13251
13252There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
13253initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
13254
13255.ilist
13256.oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
13257.cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
13258To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
13259interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
13260taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
13261option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
13262defaults to false.
13263
13264
13265.section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
13266When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
13267of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
13268by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
13269forms:
13270.code
13271${perl{foo}}
13272${perl{foo}{argument}}
13273${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
13274.endd
13275which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
13276arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
13277with an error message of the form
13278.code
13279Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
13280.endd
13281The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
13282it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
13283return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
13284an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
13285by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
13286that was passed to &%die%&.
13287
13288
13289.section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
13290Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
13291is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
13292the Perl code
13293.code
13294my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
13295.endd
13296makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
13297Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
13298&$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
13299
13300If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
13301&'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
13302expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
13303an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
13304
13305.cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
13306.cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
13307Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
13308&'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
13309debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
13310&'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
13311timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
13312
13313
13314.section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
13315.cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
13316You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
13317Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
13318before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
13319SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
13320is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
13321error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
13322avoided, but the output is lost.
13323
13324.cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
13325The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
13326Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
13327you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
13328output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
13329change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
13330For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
13331.code
13332$SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
13333.endd
13334Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
13335example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
13336include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
13337as the first subroutine argument.
13338.ecindex IIDperl
13339
13340
13341. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13342. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13343
13344.chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
13345 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
13346 "Starting the daemon"
13347.cindex "daemon" "starting"
13348.cindex "interface" "listening"
13349.cindex "network interface"
13350.cindex "interface" "network"
13351.cindex "IP address" "for listening"
13352.cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
13353.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
13354.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13355A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
13356hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
13357or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
13358works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
13359In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
13360IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
13361knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
13362
13363.olist
13364When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
13365and ports to listen on.
13366.next
13367When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
13368are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
13369processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
13370same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
13371when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
13372local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
13373option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
13374as an error situation.
13375.next
13376When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
13377for the outgoing connection.
13378.endlist
13379
13380
13381Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
13382of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
13383addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
13384standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
13385rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
13386
13387In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
13388interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
13389options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
13390chapter describes how they operate.
13391
13392When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
13393actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
13394
13395
13396
13397.section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
13398When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
13399option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
13400following options:
13401
13402.ilist
13403&%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
13404or service names.
13405(For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
13406.next
13407&%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
13408listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
13409.endlist
13410
13411The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
13412described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
13413it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
13414colons. For example:
13415.code
13416local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
13417 192.168.23.65 ; \
13418 ::1 ; \
13419 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
13420.endd
13421There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13422in &%local_interfaces%&:
13423
13424.olist
13425The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13426on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13427.code
13428local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13429 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13430.endd
13431.next
13432The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13433with a colon separator, for example:
13434.code
13435local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13436 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13437.endd
13438.endlist
13439
13440When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13441default setting contains just one port:
13442.code
13443daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13444.endd
13445If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13446specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13447&%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13448&_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13449IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13450
13451
13452
13453.section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13454The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13455as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13456case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13457instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13458default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13459.code
13460local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13461.endd
13462when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13463.code
13464local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13465.endd
13466Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13467
13468
13469
13470.section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13471The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13472&%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13473instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13474option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13475the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13476exim.
13477
13478The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13479changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
13480contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13481&%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13482items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13483replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13484.code
13485-oX 1225
13486.endd
13487overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13488whereas
13489.code
13490-oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13491.endd
13492overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13493(However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13494value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13495
13496
13497
13498.section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13499.cindex "submissions protocol"
13500.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13501.cindex "smtps protocol"
13502.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13503.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13504Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
13505&"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
13506For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
13507STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
13508the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
13509If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
13510(Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
13511the 465 TCP ports.
13512
13513If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
13514service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
13515proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
13516
13517The common use of this option is expected to be
13518.code
13519tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13520.endd
13521per RFC 8314.
13522There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
13523to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
13524
13525&*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13526daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13527&%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13528because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13529connections via the daemon.)
13530
13531
13532
13533
13534.section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13535.cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13536IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13537can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13538interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13539address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13540percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13541adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13542.code
13543fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13544.endd
13545To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13546allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13547to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13548percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13549address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13550&[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13551.code
13552IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13553.endd
13554is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13555Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13556instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13557function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13558&[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13559
13560.section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13561.cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13562Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13563run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13564using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13565connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13566.oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13567&%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13568activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13569that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13570etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13571to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13572
13573On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13574disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13575option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13576and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13577IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13578
13579
13580
13581.section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13582The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13583.code
13584daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13585local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13586.endd
13587This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13588Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13589the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13590read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13591
13592To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13593.code
13594daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13595.endd
13596(leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13597.code
13598local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13599 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13600.endd
13601To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13602IPv4 loopback address only:
13603.code
13604local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13605.endd
13606To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13607.code
13608local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13609.endd
13610&*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13611
13612
13613
13614.section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13615The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13616whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13617addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13618treated as local.
13619
13620For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13621the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13622available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13623(that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13624
13625Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
13626many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
13627email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
13628interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
13629&%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
13630&"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
13631used for listening. Consider this example:
13632.code
13633local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
13634 192.168.53.235 ; \
13635 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
13636
13637extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13638.endd
13639The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
13640address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
13641Exim is routing.
13642
13643In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
13644address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
13645desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
13646these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
13647This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
13648during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
13649host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
13650addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
13651
13652
13653
13654.section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
13655Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
13656allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
13657there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
13658&%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
13659description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
13660details.
13661
13662
13663
13664
13665. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13666. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13667
13668.chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
13669.scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
13670.scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
13671The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
13672
13673.ilist
13674Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
13675&<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
13676.next
13677Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
13678&"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
13679section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
13680.next
13681Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
13682(with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
13683&"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
13684only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
13685settings.
13686.endlist
13687
13688This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
13689types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
13690in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
13691are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
13692an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
13693listed in more than one group.
13694
13695.section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
13696.table2
13697.row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
13698.row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
13699.row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13700.row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
13701.row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
13702.row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
13703.row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
13704.row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
13705.row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
13706.row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
13707.row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
13708.endtable
13709
13710
13711.section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
13712.table2
13713.row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
13714.row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13715.row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
13716.row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
13717.row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
13718.row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
13719.endtable
13720
13721
13722
13723.section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
13724.table2
13725.row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
13726.row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
13727.row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
13728.row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
13729.row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13730.row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13731.row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
13732.row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
13733.row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
13734.row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
13735.row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
13736.row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
13737.endtable
13738
13739
13740
13741.section "Logging" "SECID99"
13742.table2
13743.row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
13744.row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
13745.row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13746.row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
13747.row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
13748.row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
13749.row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
13750.row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
13751.row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
13752.row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
13753.row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
13754.row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
13755.row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
13756.row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
13757.row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
13758.endtable
13759
13760
13761
13762.section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
13763.table2
13764.row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
13765.row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
13766.row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
13767.row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
13768.endtable
13769
13770
13771
13772.section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
13773.table2
13774.row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
13775.row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13776.row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13777.row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
13778.row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
13779.row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
13780.row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
13781.row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
13782.row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
13783.row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
13784.row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
13785.row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
13786.row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
13787.row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
13788.row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
13789.endtable
13790
13791
13792
13793.section "Message ids" "SECID102"
13794.table2
13795.row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
13796.row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
13797.endtable
13798
13799
13800
13801.section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
13802.table2
13803.row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
13804.row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
13805.row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
13806.endtable
13807
13808
13809
13810.section "Daemon" "SECID104"
13811.table2
13812.row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
13813.row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
13814.row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
13815.row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
13816.row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
13817.row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13818.row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13819.endtable
13820
13821
13822
13823.section "Resource control" "SECID105"
13824.table2
13825.row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13826.row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
13827.row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13828.row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
13829.row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
13830.row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
13831.row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13832.row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13833.row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13834.row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13835.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13836.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13837.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13838.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13839.row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13840.row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13841 connection"
13842.row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13843.row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13844.row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13845.row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
13846.row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13847.endtable
13848
13849
13850
13851.section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
13852.table2
13853.row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
13854.row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
13855.row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
13856.row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
13857.row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
13858.row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
13859.row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
13860.row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
13861.row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
13862.row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
13863.row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
13864.row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
13865.row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
13866.row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
13867.row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
13868.row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
13869.row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
13870.row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
13871.row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
13872.row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
13873.row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
13874.row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13875 words""&"
13876.row &%dns_cname_loops%& "follow CNAMEs returned by resolver"
13877.row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
13878.row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
13879.row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13880.row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13881.row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
13882.row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
13883.row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
13884.row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
13885.row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
13886.row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13887.row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13888.row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
13889.row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
13890.row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
13891.row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
13892.row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
13893.row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13894.row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
13895.row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
13896.endtable
13897
13898
13899
13900.section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
13901.table2
13902.row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
13903 item"
13904.row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
13905 item"
13906.row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
13907.row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
13908.row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
13909.endtable
13910
13911
13912
13913.section "TLS" "SECID108"
13914.table2
13915.row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
13916.row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
13917.row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
13918.row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13919.row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
13920.row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
13921.row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
13922.row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
13923.row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
13924.row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
13925.row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
13926.row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
13927.row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
13928.row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
13929.row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
13930.row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
13931.row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
13932.endtable
13933
13934
13935
13936.section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
13937.table2
13938.row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
13939.row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
13940.row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
13941.row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
13942.row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
13943.row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
13944.row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
13945.row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
13946.endtable
13947
13948
13949
13950.section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
13951.table2
13952.row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13953.row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13954.row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
13955.row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13956.row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
13957.row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
13958.row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
13959.row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
13960.endtable
13961
13962
13963
13964
13965.section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
13966.table2
13967.row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
13968.endtable
13969
13970
13971
13972
13973
13974.section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
13975See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
13976
13977.table2
13978.row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domain for which DKIM ACL is run"
13979.row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13980.row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13981.row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
13982.row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
13983.row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
13984.row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
13985.row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
13986.row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13987.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13988.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13989.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13990.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13991.row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13992.row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13993 connection"
13994.row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13995.row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
13996.row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
13997.row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13998.row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13999.row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
14000.row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
14001.row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
14002.row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
14003.row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
14004.row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
14005.row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
14006.row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
14007.row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
14008.row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14009.row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14010.endtable
14011
14012
14013
14014.section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
14015.table2
14016.row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
14017.row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
14018.row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
14019.row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
14020.row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
14021.row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
14022.row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14023.row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
14024.row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
14025.row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14026.endtable
14027
14028
14029
14030.section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
14031.table2
14032.row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
14033.row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
14034.row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
14035.row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14036 words""&"
14037.row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14038.row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14039.row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
14040.row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
14041.row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
14042.row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
14043.row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14044.row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
14045.row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
14046.row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
14047.endtable
14048
14049
14050
14051.section "System filter" "SECID115"
14052.table2
14053.row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
14054.row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
14055 directory"
14056.row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
14057.row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
14058.row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
14059.row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
14060.row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
14061.endtable
14062
14063
14064
14065.section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
14066.table2
14067.row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14068.row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
14069.row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
14070.row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
14071.row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
14072.row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
14073.row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
14074.row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
14075.row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
14076.row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
14077.row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
14078.row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
14079.row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
14080.row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
14081.row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
14082.row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14083.row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
14084.row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
14085.row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
14086.row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
14087.row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14088.row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
14089.row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
14090.row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
14091.endtable
14092
14093
14094
14095.section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
14096.table2
14097.row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
14098.row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
14099.row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
14100.row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
14101.row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
14102.row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
14103.row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
14104.row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
14105.row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
14106.row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
14107.row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
14108.row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
14109.row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
14110.row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14111.row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
14112.endtable
14113
14114
14115
14116.section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
14117Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
14118&dagger;.
14119
14120.option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
14121.cindex "8BITMIME"
14122.cindex "8-bit characters"
14123.cindex "log" "selectors"
14124.cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
14125This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
14126EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
14127However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
14128takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
14129
14130Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
14131feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
14132It now defaults to true.
14133A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
14134.display
14135&url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
14136.endd
14137
14138To log received 8BITMIME status use
14139.code
14140log_selector = +8bitmime
14141.endd
14142
14143.option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
14144.cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
14145.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14146This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
14147read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14148further details.
14149
14150.option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14151This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
14152messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
14153SMTP messages.
14154
14155.option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
14156.cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
14157.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14158This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
14159non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14160
14161.option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
14162.cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
14163.cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
14164This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
14165received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14166
14167.option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
14168.cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
14169This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
14170See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14171
14172.option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
14173.cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
14174This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
14175processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
14176acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14177
14178.option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
14179.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
14180.cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
14181.cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
14182.cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
14183This option defines the ACL that,
14184if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
14185is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
14186processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
14187acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14188
14189.option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
14190.cindex DKIM "ACL for"
14191This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
14192(by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
14193of a received message.
14194See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
14195
14196.option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
14197.cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
14198This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
14199received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14200
14201.option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
14202.cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
14203This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
14204received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14205
14206.option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
14207.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
14208.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
14209This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
14210command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14211
14212
14213.option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
14214.cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
14215This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
14216received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14217
14218.option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
14219.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
14220This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
14221a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
14222&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
14223
14224.option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14225.cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
14226This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
14227extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
14228section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
14229
14230.option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
14231.cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
14232This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
14233ends without a QUIT command being received.
14234See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14235
14236.option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
14237This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
14238received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14239further details.
14240
14241.option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
14242.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
14243This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
14244received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14245
14246.option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
14247.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
14248This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
14249received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14250
14251.option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
14252.cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
14253This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
14254received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14255
14256.option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
14257.cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
14258This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
14259received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14260
14261.option add_environment main "string list" empty
14262.cindex "environment" "set values"
14263This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
14264currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use.
14265See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
14266
14267.option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
14268.cindex "admin user"
14269This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
14270current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
14271colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
14272programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
14273admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
14274not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
14275To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
14276
14277.option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
14278.cindex "domain literal"
14279If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
14280email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
14281format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
14282has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
14283
14284Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
14285format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
14286addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
14287&%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
14288domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
14289configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
14290the local host's IP addresses.
14291
14292
14293.option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
14294.cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
14295It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
14296and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
14297MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
14298that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
14299practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
14300&%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
14301recommended, except when you have no other choice.
14302
14303.option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
14304.cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
14305.cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
14306Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
14307camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
14308that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
14309experiment if they wish.
14310
14311If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
14312UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
14313letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
14314enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
14315adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
14316suitable setting is:
14317.code
14318dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
14319 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
14320.endd
14321Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
14322.code
14323dns_check_names_pattern =
14324.endd
14325That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
14326
14327
14328.option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14329.cindex "authentication" "advertising"
14330.cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
14331If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
14332response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
14333Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
14334Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
14335advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
14336authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
14337&%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
14338authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
14339
14340Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
14341and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
14342not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
14343authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
14344to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
14345which Exim advertises AUTH.
14346
14347.cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
14348If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
14349is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
14350option is expanded, with a setting like this:
14351.code
14352auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
14353.endd
14354.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14355If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
14356the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
14357expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
14358
14359
14360.option auto_thaw main time 0s
14361.cindex "thawing messages"
14362.cindex "unfreezing messages"
14363If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
14364new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
14365this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
14366being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
14367saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
14368
14369&*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
14370&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
14371thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
14372
14373
14374.option av_scanner main string "see below"
14375This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
14376It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
14377.code
14378sophie:/var/run/sophie
14379.endd
14380If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
14381before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
14382
14383
14384.option bi_command main string unset
14385.oindex "&%-bi%&"
14386This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
14387the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
14388just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
14389required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
14390
14391
14392.option bounce_message_file main string unset
14393.cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
14394.cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
14395This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
14396for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
14397chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
14398
14399
14400.option bounce_message_text main string unset
14401When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
14402message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
14403delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
14404
14405.option bounce_return_body main boolean true
14406.cindex "bounce message" "including body"
14407This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
14408bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
14409causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
14410value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
14411message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
14412error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
14413point at which the error was detected are returned.
14414.cindex "bounce message" "including original"
14415
14416.option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
14417.cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
14418.cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
14419.cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
14420This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
14421that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
14422when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
14423The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
14424If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
14425treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
14426
14427The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
14428during reception of a message.
14429In this case lines from the original are truncated.
14430
14431The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
14432
14433
14434.option bounce_return_message main boolean true
14435If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
14436bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
14437&%bounce_return_body%&.
14438
14439
14440.option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
14441.cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
14442.cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
14443.cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
14444This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
14445senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
14446limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
14447any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
14448that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
14449
14450When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
14451greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
14452added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
14453to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
14454size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
14455messages.
14456
14457.option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
14458.cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
14459.cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
14460.cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
14461This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
14462bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
14463connection. A typical setting might be:
14464.code
14465bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14466.endd
14467which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
14468.code
14469MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14470.endd
14471The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14472address.
14473
14474.option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14475.cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14476.cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14477This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14478domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14479section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14480
14481
14482.option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14483This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14484domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14485section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14486
14487
14488.option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14489This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14490address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14491section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14492
14493
14494.option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14495This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14496address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14497section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14498
14499
14500.option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14501This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14502callout verification. The default value is
14503.code
14504$primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14505.endd
14506See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14507
14508
14509.option check_log_inodes main integer 100
14510See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14511
14512
14513.option check_log_space main integer 10M
14514See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14515
14516.oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14517.cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14518.option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14519RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14520system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14521word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14522multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14523exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14524of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14525set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14526
14527
14528.option check_spool_inodes main integer 100
14529See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14530
14531
14532.option check_spool_space main integer 10M
14533.cindex "checking disk space"
14534.cindex "disk space, checking"
14535.cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14536The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14537message is accepted.
14538
14539.vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14540.vindex "&$log_space$&"
14541.vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14542.vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14543When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14544want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14545testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14546&$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14547
14548
14549&%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14550either value is greater than zero, for example:
14551.code
14552check_spool_space = 100M
14553check_spool_inodes = 100
14554.endd
14555The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14556SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14557transit.
14558
14559&%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14560files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14561&%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14562
14563If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14564incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14565error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14566SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14567&%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14568&%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14569
14570The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14571number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
14572If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14573
14574For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14575failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14576it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14577
14578There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
14579Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
14580high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
14581may wish to deliberately disable them.
14582
14583.option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14584.cindex CHUNKING advertisement
14585.cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
14586The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
14587these hosts.
14588Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
14589
14590.option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
14591.cindex "restricting access to features"
14592This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
14593administrative user.
14594This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
14595
14596.option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
14597.cindex debugging "memory corruption"
14598.cindex memory debugging
14599This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
14600management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
14601it should normally be left as default.
14602
14603.option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
14604.cindex "port" "for daemon"
14605.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14606This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
14607listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
14608backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
14609
14610.option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
14611.cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
14612This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
14613the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
14614(typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
14615defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
14616&%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
14617
14618.option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
14619See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
14620
14621.option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
14622.cindex "warning of delay"
14623.cindex "delay warning, specifying"
14624.cindex "queue" "delay warning"
14625When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
14626intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
14627after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
14628string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
14629message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
14630between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
14631with
14632.code
14633delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
14634.endd
14635the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
14636the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
14637because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
14638just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
14639.code
14640delay_warning = 6h
14641.endd
14642messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
14643a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
14644.code
14645delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
14646.endd
14647Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
14648which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
14649Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
14650
14651.option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
14652.vindex "&$domain$&"
14653The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
14654deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
14655expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
14656forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
14657&"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
14658not sent. The default is:
14659.code
14660delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
14661 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
14662 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
14663 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
14664 } {no}{yes}}
14665.endd
14666This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
14667&'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
14668&"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
14669&"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
14670
14671.option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
14672.cindex "unprivileged delivery"
14673.cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
14674If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
14675delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
14676the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
14677of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
14678chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
14679
14680.option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
14681.cindex "load average"
14682.cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
14683When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
14684becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
14685ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
14686See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14687
14688
14689.option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
14690.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
14691Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
14692message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14693handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
14694should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
14695removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
14696occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14697
14698.option disable_fsync main boolean false
14699.cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
14700This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
14701ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
14702a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
14703build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
14704really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
14705distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
14706
14707When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
14708updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
14709such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
14710Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
14711
14712
14713.option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
14714.cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14715If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14716activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14717that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
14718etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14719to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14720
14721
14722.option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
14723.cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
14724This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
14725It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
14726the ACL once for each signature in the message.
14727See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
14728
14729
14730.option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
14731.cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
14732DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
14733&"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
14734keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
14735incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
14736may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
14737anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
14738This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
14739by a setting such as this:
14740.code
14741dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
14742.endd
14743This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
14744&[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
14745since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
14746&(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
14747when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
14748options are applied after this global option.
14749
14750.option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
14751.cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
14752When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
14753names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
14754the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
14755contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
14756a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
14757done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
14758value of this option. The default pattern is
14759.code
14760dns_check_names_pattern = \
14761 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
14762.endd
14763which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
14764they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
14765permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
14766accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
14767&%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
14768empty string.
14769
14770.option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
14771This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
14772DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14773
14774.option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
14775This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
14776reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
14777section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14778
14779.new
14780.option dns_cname_loops main integer 1
14781.cindex DNS "CNAME following"
14782This option controls the following of CNAME chains, needed if the resolver does
14783not do it internally.
14784As of 2018 most should, and the default can be left.
14785If you have an ancient one, a value of 10 is likely needed.
14786
14787The default value of one CNAME-follow is needed
14788thanks to the observed return for an MX request,
14789given no MX presence but a CNAME to an A, of the CNAME.
14790.wen
14791
14792
14793.option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
14794.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14795.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14796If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14797DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
14798default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
14799
14800If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
14801
14802
14803.option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
14804.cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
14805.cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
14806.cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
14807When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
14808looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
14809(A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
14810domain matches this list.
14811
14812This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
14813not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
14814servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
14815
14816
14817.option dns_retrans main time 0s
14818.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14819.cindex timeout "dns lookup"
14820.cindex "DNS" timeout
14821The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
14822retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
14823defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
14824time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
14825totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
14826take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
14827parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
14828but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
14829to set in them.
14830See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
14831
14832
14833.option dns_retry main integer 0
14834See &%dns_retrans%& above.
14835
14836
14837.option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
14838.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14839.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14840If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
14841(Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
14842DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
14843match with this expanded domain list.
14844
14845Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
14846authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
14847bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
14848mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
14849Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
14850a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
14851
14852Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
14853to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
14854zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
14855
14856If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
14857in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
14858authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
14859authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
14860record in the authoritative section is used instead.
14861
14862.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14863.option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
14864.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14865.cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
14866.cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
14867If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14868DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
14869the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
14870on.
14871
14872If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
14873
14874OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
14875means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
14876is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
14877
14878
14879.option drop_cr main boolean false
14880This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
14881handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
14882described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
14883
14884.option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14885.cindex "bounce messages" "success"
14886.cindex "DSN" "success"
14887.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
14888DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
14889and accepted from, these hosts.
14890Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
14891and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
14892A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
14893A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
14894are sent.
14895
14896.option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
14897.cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
14898.cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
14899This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
14900bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
14901Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
14902.code
14903dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
14904.endd
14905The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
14906panic is logged, and the default value is used.
14907
14908.option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
14909.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
14910Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
14911message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14912handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
14913message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
14914be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
14915the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
14916delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14917
14918
14919.option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
14920.cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
14921.cindex "copy of bounce message"
14922Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
14923generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
14924coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
14925items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
14926a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
14927must be enclosed in double quotes.
14928
14929Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
14930(see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
14931the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
14932items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
14933are examined. For example:
14934.code
14935errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
14936 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
14937 postmaster@mydomain.example
14938.endd
14939.vindex "&$domain$&"
14940.vindex "&$local_part$&"
14941The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
14942and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
14943there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
14944.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
14945variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
14946
14947
14948.option errors_reply_to main string unset
14949.cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
14950By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
14951.display
14952&`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
14953.endd
14954.oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
14955where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
14956A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
14957&(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
14958overrides the default.
14959
14960Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
14961&%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
14962and warning messages. For example:
14963.code
14964errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
14965.endd
14966The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
14967address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
14968&%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
14969own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
14970not used.
14971
14972
14973.option event_action main string&!! unset
14974.cindex events
14975This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
14976For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
14977
14978
14979.option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
14980.cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
14981.cindex "Exim group"
14982This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14983privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
14984option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
14985of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
14986configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
14987security issues.
14988
14989
14990.option exim_path main string "see below"
14991.cindex "Exim binary, path name"
14992This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
14993needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
14994the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
14995is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
14996other place.
14997&*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
14998you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
14999where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
15000settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
15001
15002
15003.option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
15004.cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
15005.cindex "Exim user"
15006This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15007privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
15008time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
15009options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
15010
15011Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
15012&[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
15013not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
15014used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
15015
15016
15017.option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
15018This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
15019routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
15020&<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
15021
15022
15023. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15024. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15025
15026.option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
15027 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
15028.oindex "&%-t%&"
15029.cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
15030.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
15031According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
15032are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
15033envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
15034line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
15035behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
15036command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
15037&%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
15038argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
15039addresses.
15040
15041
15042.option finduser_retries main integer 0
15043.cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
15044On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
15045distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
15046related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
15047Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
15048errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
15049many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
15050retries.
15051
15052.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
15053You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
15054a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
15055search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
15056
15057
15058
15059.option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
15060.cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
15061On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
15062ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
15063delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
15064&%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
15065feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
15066warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
15067freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
15068is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
15069supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
15070message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
15071freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
15072log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
15073logging that you require.
15074
15075
15076.option gecos_name main string&!! unset
15077.cindex "HP-UX"
15078.cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
15079Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
15080password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
15081looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
15082headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
15083of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
15084it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
15085upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
15086
15087When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
15088expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
15089login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
15090user's name.
15091
15092.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
15093Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
15094pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
15095name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
15096.code
15097gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
15098gecos_name = $1
15099.endd
15100
15101.option gecos_pattern main string unset
15102See &%gecos_name%& above.
15103
15104
15105.option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
15106This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
15107server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
15108implementations of TLS.
15109
15110
15111.option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
15112This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
15113the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
15114
15115See
15116&url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
15117for documentation.
15118
15119
15120
15121.option headers_charset main string "see below"
15122This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
15123&"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
15124default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
15125ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
15126insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
15127
15128
15129
15130.option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
15131.cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
15132.cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
15133This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
15134section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
15135&_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
15136sections are rejected.
15137
15138
15139.option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
15140.cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
15141.cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
15142This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
15143all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
15144header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
15145zero means &"no limit"&.
15146
15147
15148
15149
15150.option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15151.cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
15152.cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
15153Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
15154mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
15155some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
15156this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
15157if you want to do semantic checking.
15158See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
15159set.
15160
15161
15162.option helo_allow_chars main string unset
15163.cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
15164.cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
15165.cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
15166This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
15167all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
15168hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
15169.code
15170helo_allow_chars = _
15171.endd
15172Note that the value is one string, not a list.
15173
15174
15175.option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
15176.cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15177.cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15178If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
15179list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
15180default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
15181its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
15182do.
15183
15184
15185.option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15186.cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
15187.cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
15188By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
15189&%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
15190to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
15191condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
15192Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
15193to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
15194necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
15195encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
15196Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
15197
15198When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
15199&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
15200EHLO command either:
15201
15202.ilist
15203is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
15204.next
15205.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
15206.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
15207matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
15208calling host address, or
15209.next
15210when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
15211.endlist
15212
15213However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
15214fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
15215be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
15216
15217If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
15218.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15219&$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
15220
15221.option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15222.cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
15223.cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
15224Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
15225backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
15226name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
15227&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
15228rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
15229If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
15230error.
15231
15232.option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15233.cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
15234.cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
15235This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
15236manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
15237&%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
15238verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
15239item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
15240it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
15241
15242This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
15243delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
15244configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
15245domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
15246&%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
15247
15248A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
15249messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
15250time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
15251retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
15252
15253
15254.option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
15255.cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
15256Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
15257is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
15258&%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
15259option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
15260default configuration file contains
15261.code
15262host_lookup = *
15263.endd
15264which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
15265is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
15266
15267After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
15268has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
15269this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
15270
15271.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
15272.vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
15273After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
15274unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
15275&%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
15276&`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
15277
15278
15279.option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
15280This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
15281to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
15282first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
15283if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
15284if you want.
15285
15286&*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
15287multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
15288&_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
15289case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
15290
15291
15292
15293.option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
15294.cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
15295If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
15296as soon as the connection is made.
15297This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
15298nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
15299connections immediately.
15300
15301The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
15302ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
15303sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
15304incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
15305chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
15306
15307
15308.option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
15309.cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
15310This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
15311happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
15312you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
15313127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
15314the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
15315list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
15316local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
15317.code
15318hosts_connection_nolog = :
15319.endd
15320If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
15321
15322
15323
15324.option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
15325.cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
15326This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
15327connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
15328
15329
15330.option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
15331.cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
15332.cindex "host" "treated as local"
15333If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
15334if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
15335records
15336or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
15337host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
15338
15339This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
15340&`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
15341section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
15342&(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
15343that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
15344chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
15345interfaces and recognizing the local host.
15346
15347
15348.option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
15349.cindex "InterBase" "server list"
15350This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
15351to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15352The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
15353
15354
15355
15356.option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
15357.cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
15358.cindex "discarding bounce message"
15359This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
15360that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
15361suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
15362
15363After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
15364because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
15365message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
15366the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
15367again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
15368bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
15369for frozen messages. For example,
15370.code
15371ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
15372.endd
15373retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
15374failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
15375failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
15376value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
15377dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
15378&%timeout_frozen_after%&.
15379
15380
15381.option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15382.cindex "&""From""& line"
15383.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15384Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
15385the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
15386message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
15387such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
15388match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
15389process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
15390&%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
15391
15392
15393.option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
15394See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
15395
15396.option keep_environment main "string list" unset
15397.cindex "environment" "values from"
15398This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
15399You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
15400these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
15401during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
15402installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
15403environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
15404external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
15405
15406Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
15407(&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
15408
15409WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
15410FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
15411unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
15412that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
15413
15414Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
15415&%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
15416current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
15417anymore.
15418
15419See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
15420environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
15421transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
15422details.
15423
15424
15425.option keep_malformed main time 4d
15426This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
15427have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
15428next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
15429logged.
15430
15431
15432.option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
15433.cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
15434.cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
15435This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
15436a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15437While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15438Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15439and constrained to be a directory.
15440
15441
15442.option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
15443.cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
15444.cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15445This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
15446a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15447While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15448Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15449and constrained to be a file.
15450
15451
15452.option ldap_cert_file main string unset
15453.cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
15454.cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15455This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
15456Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15457Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
15458
15459
15460.option ldap_cert_key main string unset
15461.cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
15462.cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
15463This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
15464to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15465Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
15466identity to be proven.
15467
15468
15469.option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
15470.cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
15471This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
15472the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
15473cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
15474
15475
15476.option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
15477.cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
15478This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
15479LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
15480details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
15481with LDAP support.
15482
15483
15484.option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
15485.cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
15486This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
15487A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
15488See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
15489Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
15490to hard/demand.
15491
15492
15493.option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
15494.cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
15495If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
15496connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
15497"STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
15498of SSL-on-connect.
15499In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
15500by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
15501This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
15502
15503
15504.option ldap_version main integer unset
15505.cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
15506This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
15507LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
15508-1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
15509the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
15510has been built with LDAP support.
15511
15512
15513
15514.option local_from_check main boolean true
15515.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
15516.cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
15517When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15518an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
15519checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
15520the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
15521
15522&*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
15523locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
15524&%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15525
15526You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
15527on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
15528&'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
15529and the default qualify domain.
15530
15531If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
15532and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
15533&'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
15534&%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
15535
15536.cindex "envelope sender"
15537These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
15538is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
15539&%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
15540
15541For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
15542request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
15543has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15544
15545
15546
15547
15548.option local_from_prefix main string unset
15549When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
15550matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
15551ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
15552done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
15553appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
15554&%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
15555example, if
15556.code
15557local_from_prefix = *-
15558.endd
15559is set, a &'From:'& line containing
15560.code
15561From: anything-user@your.domain.example
15562.endd
15563will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
15564matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
15565qualify domain.
15566
15567
15568.option local_from_suffix main string unset
15569See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
15570
15571
15572.option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
15573This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
15574listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
15575&<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
15576options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
15577&%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
15578&%local_interfaces%& is
15579.code
15580local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
15581.endd
15582when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
15583.code
15584local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
15585.endd
15586
15587.option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
15588.cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
15589.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
15590This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
15591&<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
15592the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
15593message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
15594non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
15595
15596
15597
15598.option local_sender_retain main boolean false
15599.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
15600When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15601an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
15602do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
15603also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
15604See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
15605&<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15606
15607
15608
15609
15610.option localhost_number main string&!! unset
15611.cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
15612.cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
15613.vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
15614Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
15615uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
15616value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
15617after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
15618host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
15619range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
15620systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
15621&$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
15622characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
15623time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
15624section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
15625
15626
15627
15628.option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
15629.cindex "log" "file path for"
15630This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
15631files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
15632when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
15633name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time,
15634or if the option is unset at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
15635they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
15636Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
15637section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
15638used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
15639variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
15640configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
15641&_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
15642early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
15643
15644
15645.option log_selector main string unset
15646.cindex "log" "selectors"
15647This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
15648writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
15649minus characters. For example:
15650.code
15651log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
15652.endd
15653A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
15654logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
15655
15656
15657.option log_timezone main boolean false
15658.cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
15659.vindex "&$tod_log$&"
15660.vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
15661By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
15662timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
15663in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
15664avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
15665&%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
15666timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
15667of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
15668&$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
15669another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
15670
15671
15672.option lookup_open_max main integer 25
15673.cindex "too many open files"
15674.cindex "open files, too many"
15675.cindex "file" "too many open"
15676.cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
15677.cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
15678This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
15679lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
15680Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
15681file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
15682recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
15683actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
15684as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
15685open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
15686&%lookup_open_max%&.
15687
15688
15689.option max_username_length main integer 0
15690.cindex "length of login name"
15691.cindex "user name" "maximum length"
15692.cindex "limit" "user name length"
15693Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
15694&[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
15695this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
15696an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
15697
15698
15699.option message_body_newlines main bool false
15700.cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
15701.cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
15702.vindex "&$message_body$&"
15703.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15704By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
15705the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
15706option is set true, this no longer happens.
15707
15708
15709.option message_body_visible main integer 500
15710.cindex "body of message" "visible size"
15711.cindex "message body" "visible size"
15712.vindex "&$message_body$&"
15713.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15714This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
15715&$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
15716
15717
15718.option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
15719.cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
15720If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
15721(domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
15722locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
15723means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
15724Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
15725Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
15726replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
15727empty string, the option is ignored.
15728
15729
15730.option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
15731If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
15732the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
15733message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
15734take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
15735the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
15736it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
15737yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
15738before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
15739that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
15740means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
15741colons will become hyphens.
15742
15743
15744.option message_logs main boolean true
15745.cindex "message logs" "disabling"
15746.cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
15747If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
15748&_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
15749Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
15750minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
15751per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
15752which is not affected by this option.
15753
15754
15755.option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
15756.cindex "message" "size limit"
15757.cindex "limit" "message size"
15758.cindex "size" "of message, limit"
15759This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
15760value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
15761to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
15762TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
15763optionally followed by K or M.
15764
15765&*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
15766other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
15767the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
15768error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
15769&%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15770
15771Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
15772exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
15773failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
15774an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
15775the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
15776message that an individual transport can process.
15777
15778If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
15779maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
15780failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
15781virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
15782probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
15783default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
15784some problems may result.
15785
15786A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
15787SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
15788SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
15789
15790
15791.option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
15792.cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
15793This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
15794.code
15795SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
15796.endd
15797in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
15798moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
15799and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
15800standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
15801lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
15802
15803
15804.option mua_wrapper main boolean false
15805Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
15806it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
15807contains a full description of this facility.
15808
15809
15810
15811.option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
15812.cindex "MySQL" "server list"
15813This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
15814be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
15815option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
15816
15817
15818.option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
15819This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
15820message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
15821recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
15822It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
15823safety precaution.
15824
15825When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
15826list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
15827the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
15828contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
15829can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
15830
15831If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
15832&%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
15833example is
15834.code
15835never_users = root:daemon:bin
15836.endd
15837Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
15838harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
15839transport driver.
15840
15841
15842.option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +single_dh_use +no_ticket"
15843.cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
15844This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
15845by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
15846each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
15847
15848This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
15849available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
15850The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
15851the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
15852list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
15853&"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
15854names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
15855
15856Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
15857SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
15858yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
15859adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
15860invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
15861
15862The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
15863
15864Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
15865"+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
15866with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
15867some now infamous attacks.
15868
15869Examples:
15870.code
15871# Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
15872openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
15873 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
15874
15875# Disable older protocol versions:
15876openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
15877.endd
15878
15879Possible options may include:
15880.ilist
15881&`all`&
15882.next
15883&`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
15884.next
15885&`cipher_server_preference`&
15886.next
15887&`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
15888.next
15889&`ephemeral_rsa`&
15890.next
15891&`legacy_server_connect`&
15892.next
15893&`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
15894.next
15895&`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
15896.next
15897&`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
15898.next
15899&`netscape_challenge_bug`&
15900.next
15901&`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
15902.next
15903&`no_compression`&
15904.next
15905&`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
15906.next
15907&`no_sslv2`&
15908.next
15909&`no_sslv3`&
15910.next
15911&`no_ticket`&
15912.next
15913&`no_tlsv1`&
15914.next
15915&`no_tlsv1_1`&
15916.next
15917&`no_tlsv1_2`&
15918.next
15919&`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
15920.next
15921&`single_dh_use`&
15922.next
15923&`single_ecdh_use`&
15924.next
15925&`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
15926.next
15927&`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
15928.next
15929&`tls_block_padding_bug`&
15930.next
15931&`tls_d5_bug`&
15932.next
15933&`tls_rollback_bug`&
15934.endlist
15935
15936As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
15937all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
15938to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
15939to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
15940release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
15941where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
15942
15943
15944.option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
15945.cindex "Oracle" "server list"
15946This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
15947to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15948The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
15949
15950
15951.option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15952.cindex "&""percent hack""&"
15953.cindex "source routing" "in email address"
15954.cindex "address" "source-routed"
15955The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
15956percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
15957replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
15958also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
15959option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
15960but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
15961an ACL.
15962
15963&*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
15964trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
15965if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
15966implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
15967routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
15968a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
15969local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
15970
15971
15972.option perl_at_start main boolean false
15973.cindex "Perl"
15974This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15975interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15976
15977
15978.option perl_startup main string unset
15979.cindex "Perl"
15980This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15981interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15982
15983.option perl_startup main boolean false
15984.cindex "Perl"
15985This Option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
15986
15987
15988.option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
15989.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
15990This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
15991data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
15992&<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
15993PostgreSQL support.
15994
15995
15996.option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
15997.cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
15998.cindex "pid file, path for"
15999This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
16000process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
16001to the host name:
16002.code
16003pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
16004.endd
16005If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
16006spool directory.
16007The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
16008option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
16009of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
16010
16011
16012.option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16013.cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
16014This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
16015PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
16016control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
16017&%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
16018for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
16019that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
16020not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
16021
16022
16023.option prdr_enable main boolean false
16024.cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
16025This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
16026to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
16027If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
16028If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
16029an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
16030is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
16031
16032.option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
16033.cindex "message logs" "preserving"
16034If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
16035completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
16036called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
16037purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
16038volume of mail. Use with care!
16039
16040
16041.option primary_hostname main string "see below"
16042.cindex "name" "of local host"
16043.cindex "host" "name of local"
16044.cindex "local host" "name of"
16045.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16046This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
16047HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
16048option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
16049The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
16050server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
16051
16052If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
16053name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
16054contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
16055&[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
16056version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
16057explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
16058
16059
16060.option print_topbitchars main boolean false
16061.cindex "printing characters"
16062.cindex "8-bit characters"
16063By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
1606432&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
16065when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
16066sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
16067is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
16068characters.
16069
16070This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
16071&(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
16072the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
16073described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
16074Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
16075standards.
16076
16077
16078.option process_log_path main string unset
16079.cindex "process log path"
16080.cindex "log" "process log"
16081.cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
16082This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
16083&"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
16084utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
16085in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
16086can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
16087different spool directories.
16088
16089
16090.option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
16091.cindex "restricting access to features"
16092.oindex "&%-M%&"
16093.oindex "&%-R%&"
16094.oindex "&%-q%&"
16095The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
16096admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
16097&%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16098
16099
16100.option qualify_domain main string "see below"
16101.cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
16102.cindex "address" "qualification"
16103This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
16104addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
16105recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
16106are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
16107also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
16108locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16109
16110Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
16111unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
16112&%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
16113addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
16114necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
16115addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
16116&%primary_hostname%& value.
16117
16118
16119.option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
16120This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
16121addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
16122
16123
16124
16125.option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16126.cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
16127.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16128.cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
16129This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
16130A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
16131domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
16132next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
16133
16134
16135.option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
16136.cindex "restricting access to features"
16137.oindex "&%-bp%&"
16138The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
16139queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
16140&%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
16141See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16142
16143
16144.option queue_only main boolean false
16145.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16146.cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
16147If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
16148whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
16149next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
16150delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
16151
16152The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
16153and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
16154&%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
16155&%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
16156
16157
16158.option queue_only_file main string unset
16159.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16160.cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
16161This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
16162one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
16163it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
16164each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
16165For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
16166&"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
16167.code
16168queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
16169.endd
16170causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
16171&_/some/file_& exists.
16172
16173
16174.option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
16175.cindex "load average"
16176.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16177.cindex "message" "queueing by load"
16178If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
16179all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
16180happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
16181the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
16182the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16183false.
16184
16185Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
16186option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
16187determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
16188&%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16189
16190
16191.option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
16192.cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
16193When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
16194because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
16195all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
16196This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
16197threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
16198connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
16199circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
16200where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16201should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
16202re-evaluated for each message.
16203
16204
16205.option queue_only_override main boolean true
16206.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16207When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
16208setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
16209&%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
16210to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
16211
16212
16213.option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
16214.cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
16215If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
16216in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
16217must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
16218single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
16219and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
16220single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
16221the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
16222avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
16223&%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
16224when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
16225large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
16226
16227
16228
16229.option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
16230.cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
16231This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
16232can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
16233but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
16234start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
16235very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
16236however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
16237started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
16238
16239Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
16240the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
16241run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
16242the daemon's command line.
16243
16244.cindex queues named
16245.cindex "named queues"
16246To set limits for different named queues use
16247an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
16248
16249.option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16250.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16251.cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
16252When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
16253received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
16254However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
16255&%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
16256message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
16257has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
16258when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
16259over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
16260SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
16261&%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
16262&%queue_domains%&.
16263
16264
16265.option receive_timeout main time 0s
16266.cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
16267This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
16268maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
16269the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
16270&%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
16271controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
16272
16273.option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
16274.cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
16275.cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
16276This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
16277added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
16278on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
16279used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
16280added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
16281&"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
16282header lines. The default setting is:
16283
16284.code
16285received_header_text = Received: \
16286 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
16287 {${if def:sender_ident \
16288 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
16289 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
16290 by $primary_hostname \
16291 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
16292 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
16293 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
16294 ${if def:sender_address \
16295 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
16296 id $message_exim_id\
16297 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
16298.endd
16299
16300The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
16301support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
16302locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
16303header lines such as the following:
16304.code
16305Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
16306by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
16307(envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
16308id 16IOWa-00019l-00
16309for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
16310Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
16311id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
16312.endd
16313Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
16314the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
16315checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
16316message was accepted.
16317
16318
16319.option received_headers_max main integer 30
16320.cindex "loop" "prevention"
16321.cindex "mail loop prevention"
16322.cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
16323When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
16324counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
16325have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
16326This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
16327
16328
16329.option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16330.cindex "unqualified addresses"
16331.cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16332This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16333recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
16334qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
16335affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
16336addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
16337host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
16338or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
16339option was not set.
16340
16341
16342.option recipients_max main integer 0
16343.cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
16344.cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
16345If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
16346original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
16347by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
16348all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
16349Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
16350done.
16351
16352.cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
16353&*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
16354RCPT commands in a single message.
16355
16356
16357.option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
16358If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
16359recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
16360error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
16361error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
16362initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
16363for the remaining recipients at a later time.
16364
16365
16366.option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
16367.cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
16368This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
16369hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
16370does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
16371message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
16372have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
16373deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
16374deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
16375each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
16376same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
16377&%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
16378with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
16379tagged with its process id.
16380
16381This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
16382message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
16383manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
16384deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
16385is received.
16386
16387.cindex "number of deliveries"
16388.cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
16389If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
16390need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
16391are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
16392daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
16393fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
16394runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
16395delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
16396then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
16397&%remote_max_parallel%&.
16398
16399If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
16400&%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
16401doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
16402host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
16403
16404
16405.option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16406.cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
16407.cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
16408When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
16409domain into the order given by this list. For example,
16410.code
16411remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
16412.endd
16413would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
16414then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
16415
16416
16417.option retry_data_expire main time 7d
16418.cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
16419This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
16420database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
16421host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
16422past failures.
16423
16424
16425.option retry_interval_max main time 24h
16426.cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
16427.cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
16428Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
16429intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
16430straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
16431retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
16432the default value.
16433
16434
16435.option return_path_remove main boolean true
16436.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
16437RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
16438&'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
16439The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
16440MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
16441in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
16442&'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
16443received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
16444the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
16445
16446
16447.option return_size_limit main integer 100K
16448This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16449
16450
16451.option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
16452.cindex "RFC 1413"
16453.cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
16454RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
16455an item in the list.
16456The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
16457for the system.
16458
16459.option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
16460.cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
16461.cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
16462This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
16463no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
16464
16465
16466.option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16467.cindex "unqualified addresses"
16468.cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16469This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16470sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
16471&%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
16472not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
16473it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
16474&%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
16475using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
16476
16477.option set_environment main "string list" empty
16478.cindex "environment"
16479This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
16480currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use. The
16481default list is empty,
16482
16483
16484.option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
16485.cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
16486.cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
16487This option controls logging of slow lookups.
16488If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
16489and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
16490Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
16491
16492
16493
16494.option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
16495.cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
16496This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
16497TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
16498connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
16499other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
16500still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
16501this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
16502connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
16503tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
16504hours to detect unreachable hosts.
16505
16506
16507
16508.option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
16509.cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
16510.cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16511.cindex "inetd"
16512This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
16513that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
16514control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
16515value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
16516non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
16517set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16518
16519A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
16520has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
16521that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
16522and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
16523
16524
16525.option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
16526.cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
16527.cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
16528Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
16529the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
16530check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
16531client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
16532client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
16533
16534When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
16535allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
16536but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
16537or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
16538starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
16539counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
16540following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
16541MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
16542
16543
16544.option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16545You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
16546check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
16547changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
16548live with.
16549
16550
16551. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
16552. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
16553. We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
16554. non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
16555. zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
16556. html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
16557. inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
16558. searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
16559. the option name to split.
16560
16561.option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
16562 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16563.cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
16564.cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
16565The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
16566prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
16567results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
16568response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
16569precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
16570seen).
16571
16572
16573.option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
16574.cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
16575.cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
16576This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
16577host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
16578expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
16579reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
16580connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
16581is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
16582of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
16583required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
16584
16585&*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
16586constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
16587happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
16588without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
16589could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
16590doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
16591
16592
16593
16594.option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
16595.cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16596.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16597.cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
16598If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
16599listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
16600on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
16601fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
16602subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
16603to all messages received in the same connection.
16604
16605A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
16606if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
16607also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
16608various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
16609
16610
16611. See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16612
16613.option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
16614 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
16615.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16616.cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
16617This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
16618automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
16619the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
16620and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
16621number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
16622are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
16623restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
16624systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
16625dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
16626
16627
16628.option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
16629.cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
16630.cindex "host" "reserved"
16631When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
16632number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
16633that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
16634&%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
16635restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
16636of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
16637of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
16638the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
16639individual host.
16640
16641For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
16642set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
16643connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
16644provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
16645
16646
16647.option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
16648.cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
16649.cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
16650.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16651This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
16652several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
16653is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
16654responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
16655incoming HELO or EHLO command.
16656
16657.vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
16658The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
16659is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
16660in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
16661
16662If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
16663expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
16664used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
16665panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
16666value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
16667For example:
16668.code
16669smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
16670 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
16671.endd
16672
16673Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
16674messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
16675verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
16676&%helo_data%& value.
16677
16678.option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
16679.cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
16680.cindex "banner for SMTP"
16681.cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
16682.cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
16683This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
16684positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
16685.code
16686smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
16687 $version_number $tod_full
16688.endd
16689Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
16690multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
16691appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
16692in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
16693multiline response).
16694
16695
16696.option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
16697.cindex "checking disk space"
16698.cindex "disk space, checking"
16699.cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
16700When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
16701option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
16702spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
16703leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
16704is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
16705
16706
16707.option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
16708.cindex "connection backlog"
16709.cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
16710.cindex "backlog of connections"
16711This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
16712this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
16713of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
16714attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
16715say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
16716out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
16717value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
16718attacks by SYN flooding.
16719
16720
16721.option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
16722.cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
16723.cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
16724The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
16725the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
16726synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
16727fewer, but they still exist.
16728
16729Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
16730for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
16731client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
16732SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
16733for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
16734input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
16735does detect many instances.
16736
16737The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
16738If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
16739hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
16740(see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
16741
16742
16743
16744.option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
16745.cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
16746.vindex "&$domain$&"
16747If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
16748command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
16749chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
16750are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
16751argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
16752example:
16753.code
16754smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
16755 $sender_host_address
16756.endd
16757A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
16758complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
16759run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
16760a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
16761receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
16762the command.
16763
16764
16765.option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
16766.cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
16767When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
16768one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
16769section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
16770
16771
16772.option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
16773.cindex "load average"
16774If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
16775accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
16776If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
16777the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
16778systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
16779&%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
16780
16781
16782
16783.option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
16784.cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
16785.cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
16786Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
16787particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
16788.code
16789RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
16790.endd
16791causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
16792(The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
16793example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
16794too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
16795dropped. The limit is set by this option.
16796
16797.cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
16798When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
16799&"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
16800Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
16801&%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
16802not count towards the limit.
16803
16804
16805
16806.option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
16807.cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
16808.cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
16809If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
16810Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
16811that subvert web
16812clients
16813into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
16814non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
16815
16816
16817
16818.option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16819.cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
16820.cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
16821.cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
16822Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
16823can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
16824recipients.
16825
16826Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
16827facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
16828&%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
16829&<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
16830
16831When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
16832&%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
16833rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
16834respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
16835values:
16836
16837.ilist
16838A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
16839.next
16840An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
16841fractional parts are allowed here.
16842.next
16843A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
16844.next
16845A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
16846because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
16847.endlist
16848
16849For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
16850first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
16851.code
16852smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
16853smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
16854.endd
16855The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
16856two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
16857seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
16858delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
16859
16860
16861.option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
16862See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16863
16864
16865.option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
16866See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16867
16868
16869.option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
16870.cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
16871.cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
16872This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
16873input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
16874data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
16875the message is abandoned.
16876A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
16877.code
16878SMTP command timeout on connection from...
16879SMTP data timeout on connection from...
16880.endd
16881The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
16882means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
16883
16884If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
16885expanded before use and may depend on
16886&$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
16887
16888
16889.oindex "&%-os%&"
16890The value set by this option can be overridden by the
16891&%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
16892this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
16893of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
16894timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
16895
16896
16897.option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16898This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
16899&%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
16900
16901
16902.option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
16903.cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
16904.cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
16905In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
16906&"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
16907reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
16908to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
16909policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
16910&%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
16911example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
16912.code
16913550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
16914550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
16915.endd
16916
16917
16918.option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16919.cindex "SMTPUTF8" "advertising"
16920When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
16921the availability thereof is advertised in
16922response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16923chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
16924
16925
16926.option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
16927This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
16928extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
16929See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
16930
16931
16932
16933.option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
16934This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
16935See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
16936
16937
16938
16939.option split_spool_directory main boolean false
16940.cindex "multiple spool directories"
16941.cindex "spool directory" "split"
16942.cindex "directories, multiple"
16943If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
16944subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
16945sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
16946subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
16947arrival of the message.
16948
16949Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
16950where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
16951directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
16952directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
16953are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
16954
16955It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
16956changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
16957&"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
16958after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
16959automatically deleted.
16960
16961When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
16962changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
16963trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
16964sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
16965sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
16966spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
16967particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
16968if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
16969entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
16970
16971
16972.option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
16973.cindex "spool directory" "path to"
16974This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
16975it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
16976configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
16977string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
16978&$primary_hostname$&.
16979
16980If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
16981that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
16982log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
16983Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
16984as failures in the configuration file.
16985
16986By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
16987tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
16988
16989.option spool_wireformat main boolean false
16990.cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
16991If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternative format
16992for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
16993Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
16994Currently it is only done for messages received using the ESMTP CHUNKING
16995option.
16996
16997The following variables will not have useful values:
16998.code
16999$max_received_linelength
17000$body_linecount
17001$body_zerocount
17002.endd
17003
17004Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
17005and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
17006(except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
17007will need to be aware of the different formats potentially available.
17008
17009Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
17010(as a Unix-mbox-format file is constructed for them).
17011The transmission benefit is maintained.
17012
17013.option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
17014.cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
17015This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
17016access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
17017
17018.option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
17019.cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
17020This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
17021variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
17022is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
17023&<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
17024
17025.option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
17026.cindex "angle brackets, excess"
17027If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
17028items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
17029treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
17030passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
17031option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
17032
17033
17034.option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
17035.cindex "trailing dot on domain"
17036.cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
17037If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
17038ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
17039MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
17040domain causes a syntax error.
17041However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
17042syntax checking.
17043
17044
17045.option syslog_duplication main boolean true
17046.cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
17047When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
17048separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
17049be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
17050separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
17051nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
17052particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
17053both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
17054containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
17055Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
17056the LOG_ALERT priority.
17057
17058
17059.option syslog_facility main string unset
17060.cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
17061This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17062syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
17063&"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
17064If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17065details of Exim's logging.
17066
17067
17068.option syslog_pid main boolean true
17069.cindex "syslog" "pid"
17070If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
17071omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
17072the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
17073to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
17074into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17075
17076
17077
17078.option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
17079.cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
17080This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17081syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
17082&<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17083
17084
17085
17086.option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
17087.cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
17088If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
17089omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17090details of Exim's logging.
17091
17092
17093.option system_filter main string&!! unset
17094.cindex "filter" "system filter"
17095.cindex "system filter" "specifying"
17096.cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
17097This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
17098the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
17099must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
17100generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
17101appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
17102which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
17103&<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
17104A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
17105
17106
17107.option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
17108.vindex "&$address_file$&"
17109This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
17110&%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
17111implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
17112During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17113
17114
17115.option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
17116.cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
17117This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
17118command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
17119the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17120
17121.option system_filter_group main string unset
17122.cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
17123This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
17124gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
17125with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
17126
17127.option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
17128.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
17129.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
17130This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
17131is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
17132contains the pipe command.
17133
17134
17135.option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
17136.cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
17137This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
17138is used in a system filter.
17139
17140
17141.option system_filter_user main string unset
17142.cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
17143If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
17144delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
17145process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
17146Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
17147is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
17148configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
17149specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
17150&%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
17151
17152If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
17153under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
17154transport option overrides.
17155
17156
17157.option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
17158.cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
17159.cindex "Nagle algorithm"
17160.cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
17161If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
17162TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
17163turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
17164performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
17165should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
17166However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
17167this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
17168daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
17169TCP_NODELAY.
17170
17171
17172.option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
17173.cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
17174.cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
17175If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
17176message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
17177is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
17178bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
17179sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
17180If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
17181frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
17182
17183&*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
17184frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
17185messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
17186
17187
17188.option timezone main string unset
17189.cindex "timezone, setting"
17190.cindex "environment" "values from"
17191The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
17192running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
17193created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
17194to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
17195.code
17196timezone = UTC
17197.endd
17198The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
17199or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
17200is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
17201time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
17202runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
17203unfortunately not all, operating systems.
17204
17205
17206.option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17207.cindex "TLS" "advertising"
17208.cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
17209.cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
17210When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
17211of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
17212response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17213chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
17214Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
17215using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
17216is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
17217
17218
17219.option tls_certificate main string list&!! unset
17220.cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
17221.cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
17222The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17223files which contains the server's certificates. Commonly only one file is
17224needed.
17225The server's private key is also
17226assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
17227&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17228
17229&*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
17230receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
17231use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
17232option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
17233
17234&*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
17235separator in the usual way to avoid confusion under IPv6.
17236
17237&*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
17238when a list of more than one
17239file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& variable is unreliable.
17240
17241&*Note*&: OCSP stapling is not usable under OpenSSL
17242when a list of more than one file is used.
17243
17244If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
17245if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
17246Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
17247&<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
17248
17249If this option is unset or empty a fresh self-signed certificate will be
17250generated for every connection.
17251
17252.option tls_crl main string&!! unset
17253.cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
17254.cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
17255This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
17256be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
17257
17258Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
17259
17260&*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
17261for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
17262For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
17263
17264See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17265
17266
17267.option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
17268.cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
17269The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
17270the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
17271interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
17272suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
17273
17274The value must be at least 1024.
17275
17276The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
17277hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
17278by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
17279
17280If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
17281number.
17282
17283Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
17284little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
17285larger prime than requested.
17286
17287
17288.option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
17289.cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
17290The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
17291to be used by Exim.
17292
17293&*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend using a filename with site-generated
17294local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
17295other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
17296"unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
17297
17298If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
17299then it names a file from which DH
17300parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
17301PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
17302OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
17303fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
17304loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
17305and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
17306
17307If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
17308loaded by Exim.
17309
17310If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
17311Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
17312does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
17313See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
17314
17315If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
17316a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
17317
17318In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
173192.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
17320in IKE is assigned number 23.
17321
17322Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
17323of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
17324sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
17325the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
17326&`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17327
17328The available standard primes are:
17329&`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
17330&`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
17331&`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
17332&`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
17333
17334The available additional primes are:
17335&`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17336
17337Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
17338Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
17339The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
17340of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
17341(the "ffdhe" identifiers).
17342
17343At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
17344they're still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
17345candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
17346
17347The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
17348to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
17349whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
17350tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
17351need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
17352userbase.
17353
17354Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
17355is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
17356applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
17357used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
17358mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
17359prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
17360acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
17361
17362
17363.option tls_eccurve main string&!! &`auto`&
17364.cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
17365This option selects a EC curve for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
17366It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS.
17367
17368After expansion it must contain a valid EC curve parameter, such as
17369&`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-512`&. Consult your OpenSSL manual
17370for valid selections.
17371
17372For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
17373&`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
17374&`auto`& tells the library to choose.
17375
17376If the option expands to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
17377
17378
17379.option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
17380.cindex TLS "certificate status"
17381.cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
17382This option
17383must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
17384status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
17385Certificate Authority.
17386
17387Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
17388
17389For GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
17390of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
17391The ordering of the two lists must match.
17392
17393
17394.option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
17395.cindex SSMTP
17396.cindex SMTPS
17397This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
17398operate the SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
17399set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
17400further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
17401
17402
17403
17404.option tls_privatekey main string list&!! unset
17405.cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
17406The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17407files which contains the server's private keys.
17408If this option is unset, or if
17409the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
17410key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
17411&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17412
17413See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17414
17415
17416.option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
17417.cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
17418.cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
17419If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
17420&"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
17421support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
17422TLS session.
17423
17424
17425.option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
17426.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
17427.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
17428This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
17429The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
17430connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
17431different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
17432permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
17433in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
17434preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
17435&<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
17436
17437
17438.option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17439.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17440.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17441See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
17442
17443
17444.option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
17445.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17446.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17447The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
17448word "system"
17449or the absolute path to
17450a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
17451match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
17452
17453The "system" value for the option will use a
17454system default location compiled into the SSL library.
17455This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
17456and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
17457must be specified.
17458
17459The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
17460preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
17461
17462With OpenSSL the certificates specified
17463explicitly
17464either by file or directory
17465are added to those given by the system default location.
17466
17467These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
17468than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
17469the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
17470connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
17471Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
17472use the explicit directory version.
17473
17474See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17475
17476A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
17477being unset.
17478
17479
17480.option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17481.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17482.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17483This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
17484certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
17485&%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
17486either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
17487&%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
17488
17489Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
17490&%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
17491present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
17492aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
17493the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
17494connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
17495ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
17496
17497A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
17498matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
17499certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
17500abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
17501state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
17502such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
17503but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
17504certificate"&.
17505
17506Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
17507certificates.
17508
17509
17510.option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
17511.cindex "trusted groups"
17512.cindex "groups" "trusted"
17513This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17514option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
17515which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
17516specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
17517details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
17518&%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
17519are trusted.
17520
17521.option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
17522.cindex "trusted users"
17523.cindex "user" "trusted"
17524This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17525option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
17526trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
17527&<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
17528If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
17529Exim user are trusted.
17530
17531.option unknown_login main string&!! unset
17532.cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
17533.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
17534This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
17535the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
17536gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
17537used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
17538can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
17539is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
17540&%-F%& option.
17541
17542.option unknown_username main string unset
17543See &%unknown_login%&.
17544
17545.option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
17546.cindex "trusted users"
17547.cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
17548.cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
17549.cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
17550.cindex "envelope sender"
17551When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
17552normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
17553default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
17554senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
17555is used) is ignored.
17556
17557However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
17558to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
17559.code
17560exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
17561.endd
17562.vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
17563The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
17564other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
17565users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
17566patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
17567identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
17568users to setting senders that start with their login ids
17569followed by a hyphen
17570by a setting like this:
17571.code
17572untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
17573.endd
17574If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
17575restriction, you can use
17576.code
17577untrusted_set_sender = *
17578.endd
17579The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
17580only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
17581to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
17582parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
17583&'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
17584necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
17585overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
17586described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
17587
17588The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
17589&"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
17590&%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
17591envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
17592sender address.
17593
17594
17595.option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
17596.cindex "&""From""& line"
17597.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
17598Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
17599an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
17600particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
17601of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
17602matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
17603&%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
17604default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
17605.code
17606From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
17607From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
17608.endd
17609The pattern can be seen by running
17610.code
17611exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
17612.endd
17613It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
17614year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
17615regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
17616&%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
17617(&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
17618&%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
17619
17620
17621.option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
17622See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
17623
17624
17625.option warn_message_file main string unset
17626.cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
17627.cindex "customizing" "warning message"
17628This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
17629for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
17630been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
17631&%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
17632&<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
17633
17634
17635.option write_rejectlog main boolean true
17636.cindex "reject log" "disabling"
17637If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
17638See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
17639.ecindex IIDconfima
17640.ecindex IIDmaiconf
17641
17642
17643
17644
17645. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17646. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17647
17648.chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
17649.scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
17650.scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
17651This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
17652Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
17653
17654For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
17655&<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
17656which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
17657provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
17658&%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
17659
17660
17661
17662.option address_data routers string&!! unset
17663.cindex "router" "data attached to address"
17664The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
17665precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
17666router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
17667&%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
17668delivery of the address to be deferred.
17669
17670.vindex "&$address_data$&"
17671When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
17672accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
17673routers, and the eventual transport.
17674
17675&*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
17676that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
17677in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
17678either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
17679put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
17680
17681Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
17682with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
17683on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
17684&$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
17685&"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
17686
17687The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
17688for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
17689you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
17690.code
17691uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
17692.endd
17693In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
17694.code
17695file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
17696.endd
17697This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
17698lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
17699
17700.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
17701.vindex "&$address_data$&"
17702The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
17703from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
17704&$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
17705ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
17706verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
17707
17708
17709
17710.option address_test routers&!? boolean true
17711.oindex "&%-bt%&"
17712.cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
17713If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
17714by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
17715your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
17716having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
17717routing.
17718
17719
17720
17721.option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
17722.cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
17723.cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
17724This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
17725routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
17726&"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
17727&%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
17728value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
17729includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
17730well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
17731you could put:
17732.code
17733cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
17734.endd
17735on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
17736and
17737.code
17738cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
17739.endd
17740on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
17741this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
17742explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
17743logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
17744
17745
17746.option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
17747.cindex "case of local parts"
17748.cindex "router" "case of local parts"
17749By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
17750manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
17751If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
17752this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
17753part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
17754turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
17755more details.
17756
17757.vindex "&$local_part$&"
17758.vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
17759.vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
17760The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
17761router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
17762an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
17763is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
17764addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
17765and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
17766
17767This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
17768recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
17769modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
17770(see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
17771
17772
17773
17774.option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
17775.cindex "local user, checking in router"
17776.cindex "router" "checking for local user"
17777.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
17778.vindex "&$home$&"
17779When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
17780address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
17781local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
17782than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
17783holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
17784user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
17785preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
17786given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
17787overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
17788the router is skipped.
17789
17790If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
17791or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
17792setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
17793two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
17794setting to achieve this. For example:
17795.code
17796local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
17797.endd
17798Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
17799up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
17800&%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
17801
17802
17803
17804.option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
17805.cindex "router" "customized precondition"
17806This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
17807router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
17808evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
17809result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
17810&"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
17811router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
17812
17813If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
17814precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
17815
17816This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
17817All &%condition%& options must succeed.
17818
17819The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
17820running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
17821the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
17822.code
17823condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17824.endd
17825Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
17826.code
17827condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
17828.endd
17829
17830A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
17831.code
17832condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17833condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
17834condition = foobar
17835.endd
17836
17837If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
17838of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
17839be specified using &%condition%&.
17840
17841Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
17842are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
17843they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
17844parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17845ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17846Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
17847Router rules processing behavior.
17848
17849This is best illustrated in an example:
17850.code
17851# If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
17852# in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
17853
17854$ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17855true {yes} {no}}
17856
17857$ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17858 {yes} {no}}
17859.endd
17860In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
17861&"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
17862default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
17863(which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
17864string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
17865with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
17866resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
17867&" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
17868
17869In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
17870&%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
17871mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
17872conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
17873string characters.
17874
17875Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
17876true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
17877match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
17878contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
17879expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
17880
17881
17882.option debug_print routers string&!! unset
17883.cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
17884If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
17885option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
17886the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
17887If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
17888output, and Exim carries on processing.
17889This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
17890so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
17891option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
17892variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
17893&%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
17894are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
17895The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
17896
17897
17898
17899.option disable_logging routers boolean false
17900If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
17901or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
17902unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
17903transport option of the same name.
17904
17905.option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17906.cindex "MX record" "security"
17907.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17908.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17909.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17910DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17911the dnssec request bit set.
17912This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17913
17914.option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17915.cindex "MX record" "security"
17916.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17917.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17918.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17919DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
17920the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
17921(AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
17922This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17923
17924
17925.option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
17926.cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
17927.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
17928If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
17929the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
17930lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
17931expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
17932a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
17933
17934
17935
17936.option driver routers string unset
17937This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
17938to be used.
17939
17940
17941.option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
17942.cindex "DSN" "success"
17943.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
17944If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
17945Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
17946instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
17947Not effective on redirect routers.
17948
17949
17950
17951.option errors_to routers string&!! unset
17952.cindex "envelope sender"
17953.cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
17954If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
17955transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
17956there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
17957message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
17958provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
17959expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
17960
17961The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
17962subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
17963settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
17964setting.
17965
17966If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
17967the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
17968address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
17969expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
17970
17971If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
17972SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
17973any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
17974sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
17975settings:
17976.code
17977errors_to =
17978errors_to = ""
17979.endd
17980An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
17981this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
17982no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
17983address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
17984overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
17985
17986.vindex "&$address_data$&"
17987If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
17988MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
17989path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
17990setting &%return_path%&.
17991
17992The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
17993manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
17994implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
17995
17996
17997
17998.option expn routers&!? boolean true
17999.cindex "address" "testing"
18000.cindex "testing" "addresses"
18001.cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
18002.cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
18003If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
18004as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
18005want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
18006on for the system alias file.
18007See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18008are evaluated.
18009
18010The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
18011&<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
18012an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
18013
18014
18015
18016.option fail_verify routers boolean false
18017.cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
18018Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
18019&%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18020
18021
18022
18023.option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
18024If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18025verifying a recipient, verification fails.
18026
18027
18028
18029.option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
18030If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18031verifying a sender, verification fails.
18032
18033
18034
18035.option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
18036.cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
18037.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
18038String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
18039colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
18040changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
18041each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
18042defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
18043&<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
18044
18045If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
18046associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
18047list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
18048randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
18049transport for further details.
18050
18051
18052.option group routers string&!! "see below"
18053.cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
18054.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18055.cindex "transport" "local"
18056.cindex "router" "setting group"
18057When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18058specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
18059process.
18060The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18061error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18062The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
18063is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
18064and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18065
18066
18067
18068.option headers_add routers list&!! unset
18069.cindex "header lines" "adding"
18070.cindex "router" "adding header lines"
18071This option specifies a list of text headers,
18072newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
18073that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18074Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18075option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18076the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
18077&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
18078message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
18079header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
18080&"see"& the added header lines.
18081
18082The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
18083&%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
18084an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
18085failures are treated as configuration errors.
18086
18087Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
18088for a router; all listed headers are added.
18089
18090&*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18091router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18092
18093.cindex "duplicate addresses"
18094.oindex "&%unseen%&"
18095&*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18096additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
18097For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
18098address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
18099modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
18100circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
18101which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
18102avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18103
18104
18105
18106.option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
18107.cindex "header lines" "removing"
18108.cindex "router" "removing header lines"
18109This option specifies a list of text headers,
18110colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
18111that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18112Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18113option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18114the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
18115section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
18116the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
18117to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
18118&"see"& the original header lines.
18119
18120The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
18121&%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
18122the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
18123errors.
18124
18125Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
18126for a router; all listed headers are removed.
18127
18128&*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18129router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18130
18131&*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18132removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
18133routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
18134warning for &%headers_add%& above.
18135
18136&*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
18137items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
18138To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18139
18140
18141
18142.option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
18143.cindex "IP address" "discarding"
18144.cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
18145Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
18146entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
18147IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
18148address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
18149like
18150.code
18151remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
18152.endd
18153by setting
18154.code
18155ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
18156.endd
18157on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
18158discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
18159attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
18160domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
18161Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
18162router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
18163
18164You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
18165means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
18166.code
18167ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
18168ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
18169.endd
18170The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
18171in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
18172
18173This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
18174addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18175is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
18176domain that is being routed.
18177
18178.vindex "&$host_address$&"
18179During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
18180checked.
18181
18182.option initgroups routers boolean false
18183.cindex "additional groups"
18184.cindex "groups" "additional"
18185.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18186.cindex "transport" "local"
18187If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
18188the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
18189&[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
18190any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
18191and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18192
18193
18194
18195.option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
18196.cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
18197.cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
18198If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
18199one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
18200section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
18201evaluated.
18202
18203The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
18204used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
18205asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
18206the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
18207some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
18208.cindex "multiple mailboxes"
18209.cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
18210Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
18211section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
18212
18213.vindex "&$local_part$&"
18214.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
18215During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
18216running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
18217expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
18218the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
18219a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
18220command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
18221This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
18222the relevant transport.
18223
18224When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
18225behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
18226means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
18227callout.
18228
18229The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
18230&%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
18231&%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
18232to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
18233immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
18234.code
18235real_localuser:
18236 driver = accept
18237 local_part_prefix = real-
18238 check_local_user
18239 transport = local_delivery
18240.endd
18241For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18242router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18243.code
18244 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18245 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18246.endd
18247
18248If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
18249both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
18250are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
18251separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
18252
18253
18254.option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
18255See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
18256
18257
18258
18259.option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
18260.cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
18261.cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
18262This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
18263local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
18264&%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
18265mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
18266character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
18267parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
18268&%username-foo%&.
18269
18270
18271.option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
18272See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
18273
18274
18275
18276.option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
18277.cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
18278.cindex "local part" "checking in router"
18279The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
18280See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18281are evaluated, and
18282section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
18283string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
18284example:
18285.code
18286local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
18287.endd
18288.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
18289If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
18290for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
18291expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
18292example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
18293send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
18294each virtual domain:
18295.code
18296postmaster:
18297 driver = redirect
18298 local_parts = postmaster
18299 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
18300.endd
18301
18302
18303.option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
18304.cindex "log" "delivery line"
18305.cindex "delivery" "log line format"
18306Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
18307deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
18308recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
18309this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
18310router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
18311router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
18312redirect addresses.
18313
18314
18315
18316.option more routers boolean&!! true
18317The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18318that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18319result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18320fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
18321delivery to be deferred.
18322
18323If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
18324further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
18325.oindex "&%self%&"
18326However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
18327means of the setting
18328.code
18329self = pass
18330.endd
18331or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
18332does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
18333case, the address is always passed to the next router.
18334
18335Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
18336expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
18337controls what happens next.
18338
18339
18340.option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
18341.cindex "timeout" "of router"
18342.cindex "router" "timeout"
18343If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
18344address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
18345router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
18346intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
18347host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
18348
18349There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
18350lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
18351applies to all of them.
18352
18353
18354
18355.option pass_router routers string unset
18356.cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
18357Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
18358&(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
18359routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
18360these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
18361router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
18362of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
18363be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
18364to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
18365&"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
18366
18367
18368
18369.option redirect_router routers string unset
18370.cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
18371Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
18372generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
18373example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
18374point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
18375
18376The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
18377It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
18378instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
18379which it is set does not generate new addresses.
18380
18381
18382
18383.option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
18384.cindex "file" "requiring for router"
18385.cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
18386This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
18387router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
18388Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
18389through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
18390
18391Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
18392be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
18393If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
18394failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
18395
18396If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
18397below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
18398&"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
18399existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
18400preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
18401
18402.cindex "NFS"
18403If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
18404the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
18405unavailable.
18406
18407This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
18408options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
18409look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
18410full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
18411these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
18412to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
18413that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
18414transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
18415
18416During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
18417facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
18418This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
18419operates as follows:
18420
18421If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
18422characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
18423comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
18424but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
18425used. For example:
18426.code
18427require_files = mail:/some/file
18428require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
18429.endd
18430If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
18431&%require_files%& condition fails.
18432
18433Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
18434checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
18435directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
18436access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
18437
18438&*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
18439incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
18440may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
18441may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
18442user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
18443
18444&*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
18445&[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
18446without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
18447is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
18448check again in that process.
18449
18450The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
18451be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
18452existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
18453circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
18454not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
18455name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
18456as if the file did not exist. For example:
18457.code
18458require_files = +/some/file
18459.endd
18460If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
18461handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
18462option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
18463
18464
18465
18466.option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
18467.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
18468.cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
18469When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
18470in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
18471domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
18472other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
18473Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
18474latter kind.
18475
18476This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
18477hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
18478router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
18479set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
18480for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
18481same name.
18482
18483The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
18484appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
18485independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
18486
18487
18488
18489.option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
18490.cindex "router" "home directory for"
18491.cindex "home directory" "for router"
18492.vindex "&$home$&"
18493This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
18494&%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
18495transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
18496sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
18497forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
18498cause the router to defer.
18499
18500Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
18501&%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
18502place.
18503(See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18504are evaluated.)
18505While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
18506&$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
18507
18508When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
18509the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
18510delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
18511of these values that is set:
18512
18513.ilist
18514The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
18515.next
18516The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
18517.next
18518The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
18519.next
18520The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
18521.endlist
18522
18523In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
18524router, but not for the transport.
18525
18526
18527
18528.option self routers string freeze
18529.cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18530.cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18531This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
18532list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
18533and &(manualroute)& routers.
18534Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
18535of remote hosts.
18536Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
18537&(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
18538host on the list turns out to be the local host.
18539The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
18540&<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18541
18542Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
18543example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
18544error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
18545reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
18546freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
18547cases:
18548
18549.vlist
18550.vitem &%defer%&
18551Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
18552
18553.vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
18554The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
18555be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
18556behaviour is essentially a redirection.
18557
18558.vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
18559The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
18560reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
18561rewritten.
18562
18563.vitem &%pass%&
18564.oindex "&%more%&"
18565.vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
18566The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
18567&%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
18568subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
18569name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
18570distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
18571combination
18572.code
18573self = pass
18574no_more
18575.endd
18576ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
18577Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
18578be passed to the next router.
18579
18580.vitem &%fail%&
18581Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
18582
18583.vitem &%send%&
18584.cindex "local host" "sending to"
18585The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
18586setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
18587makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
18588is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
18589different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
18590.endlist
18591
18592
18593
18594.option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
18595.cindex "router" "checking senders"
18596If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
18597address matches something on the list.
18598See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18599are evaluated.
18600
18601There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
18602dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
18603setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
18604to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
18605set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
18606verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
18607SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
18608matters.
18609
18610
18611.option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
18612.cindex "IP address" "translating"
18613.cindex "packet radio"
18614.cindex "router" "IP address translation"
18615There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
18616it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
18617mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
18618routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
18619is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
18620code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
18621SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
18622
18623.vindex "&$host_address$&"
18624The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
18625by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
18626expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
18627For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
18628If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
18629address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
18630up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
18631produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
18632addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
18633.code
18634translate_ip_address = \
18635 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
18636 {$value}fail}}
18637.endd
18638The file would contain lines like
18639.code
1864010.2.3.128/26 some.host
1864110.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
18642.endd
18643You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
18644are doing.
18645
18646
18647
18648.option transport routers string&!! unset
18649This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
18650and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
18651only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
18652after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
18653and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
18654delivery is deferred.
18655
18656The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
18657have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
18658(see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
18659
18660
18661
18662.option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
18663.cindex "current directory for local transport"
18664This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
18665to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
18666explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
18667file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
18668option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
18669overridden by a setting on the transport.
18670If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18671logged, and delivery is deferred.
18672See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
18673environment.
18674
18675
18676
18677
18678.option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
18679.cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
18680This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
18681local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
18682configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
18683pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
18684string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
18685setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
18686If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18687logged, and delivery is deferred.
18688
18689If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
18690&%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
18691the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
18692the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
18693is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
18694
18695See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
18696environment.
18697
18698
18699
18700
18701.option unseen routers boolean&!! false
18702.cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
18703The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18704that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18705result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18706fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
18707delivery to be deferred.
18708
18709When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
18710address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
18711overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
18712&%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
18713the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
18714sometimes true and sometimes false).
18715
18716.cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
18717Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
18718qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
18719delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
18720In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
18721&-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
18722to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
18723&%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
18724
18725&*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
18726this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
18727only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
18728no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
18729a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
18730duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
18731duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
18732&<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
18733so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
18734&%redirect%& router may be of help.
18735
18736Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
18737&%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
18738subsequent routers.
18739
18740
18741.option user routers string&!! "see below"
18742.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
18743.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18744.cindex "transport" "local"
18745.cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
18746.cindex "filter" "user for processing"
18747When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18748specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
18749The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18750error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18751This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
18752The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
18753the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
18754a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
18755See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
18756&<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18757
18758
18759
18760.option verify routers&!? boolean true
18761Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
18762&%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18763
18764
18765.option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
18766.cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
18767.oindex "&%-bv%&"
18768.cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
18769If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
18770delivering in cutthrough mode or
18771testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
18772with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
18773restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
18774&%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
18775
18776&*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
18777SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
18778accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
18779user or group.
18780
18781
18782.option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
18783If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
18784addresses,
18785delivering in cutthrough mode
18786or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
18787See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18788are evaluated.
18789See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18790
18791
18792.option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
18793If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
18794or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
18795See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18796are evaluated.
18797See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18798.ecindex IIDgenoprou1
18799.ecindex IIDgenoprou2
18800
18801
18802
18803
18804
18805
18806. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18807. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18808
18809.chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
18810.cindex "&(accept)& router"
18811.cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
18812The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
18813used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
18814be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
18815specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
18816it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
18817up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
18818.code
18819localusers:
18820 driver = accept
18821 domains = mydomain.example
18822 check_local_user
18823 transport = local_delivery
18824.endd
18825The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
18826&%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
18827When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
18828address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
18829
18830
18831
18832
18833
18834
18835. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18836. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18837
18838.chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
18839.scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
18840.scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
18841The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
18842recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
18843unless &%verify_only%& is set.
18844
18845If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
18846SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
18847MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
18848However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
18849records.
18850
18851MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
18852looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
18853When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
18854except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
18855IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18856generic option, the router declines.
18857
18858Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
18859to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
18860are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
18861
18862.cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18863.cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18864.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
18865If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
18866address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
18867happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
18868
18869
18870.section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
18871There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
18872Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
18873SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
18874MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
18875problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
18876
18877For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
18878&%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
18879&(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
18880an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
18881domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
18882such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
18883proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
18884look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
18885case routing fails.
18886
18887
18888.section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
18889.cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
18890There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
18891an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
18892domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
18893
18894The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
18895is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
18896
18897Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
18898.ilist
18899The domain does not exist in DNS
18900.next
18901The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
18902convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
18903for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
18904.next
18905Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
18906.next
18907MX record points to a non-existent host.
18908.next
18909MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
18910&%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
18911.next
18912MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
18913addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
18914.next
18915The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
18916&%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
18917.next
18918&%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
18919not be found in the MX records (see below)
18920.endlist
18921
18922
18923
18924
18925.section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
18926.cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
18927The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
18928
18929.option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
18930.cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
18931If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
18932(and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
18933process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
18934differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
18935the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18936
18937
18938.option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
18939.cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
18940The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
18941addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
18942enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
18943required. For example,
18944.code
18945check_srv = smtp
18946.endd
18947looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
18948expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
18949to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
18950submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
18951option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
18952normal way.
18953
18954When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
18955the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
18956host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
18957this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
18958SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
18959according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
18960
18961When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
18962the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
18963records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
18964this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
18965defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
18966and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
18967have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
18968trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
18969
18970See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
18971when there is a DNS lookup error.
18972
18973
18974
18975
18976.option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18977.cindex "MX record" "not found"
18978DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
18979which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
18980rather than the default behaviour of decline.
18981This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
18982domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
18983However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
18984also being queued.
18985
18986
18987.option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
18988.cindex IPv6 disabling
18989.cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
18990The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
18991or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
18992(checked without regard to the case of the letters),
18993only A records are used.
18994
18995.option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
18996.cindex IPv4 preference
18997.cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
18998The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
18999or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19000(checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19001A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
19002
19003.option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19004.cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
19005.cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
19006A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
19007record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
19008For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
19009records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
19010setting:
19011.code
19012mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
19013.endd
19014This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
19015has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
19016the address record.
19017
19018
19019.option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19020If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19021DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
19022&<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19023
19024
19025
19026
19027.option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
19028.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19029.cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
19030When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
19031lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
19032single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
19033called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
19034&'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
19035resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
19036&'resolv.conf'&.
19037
19038
19039
19040.option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
19041.cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
19042.cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
19043If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
19044qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
19045an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
19046expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
19047occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
19048&%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
19049any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
19050header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
19051
19052This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
19053ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
19054sense.
19055
19056When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
19057servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
19058making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
19059some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
19060name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
19061header rewriting.
19062
19063
19064.option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
19065.cindex "address" "copying routing"
19066Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
19067to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
19068options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19069default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19070servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19071any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19072
19073If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19074domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
19075local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19076lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
19077routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
19078message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
19079without processing them independently,
19080provided the following conditions are met:
19081
19082.ilist
19083No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
19084&%headers_remove%&.
19085.next
19086The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
19087the domain.
19088.endlist
19089
19090
19091
19092
19093.option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
19094.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19095When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
19096lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
19097applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
19098the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
19099domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
19100up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
19101&'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
19102actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
19103
19104Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
19105record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
19106local wildcard.
19107
19108
19109
19110.option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19111If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19112DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
19113&<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19114
19115
19116
19117
19118.option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
19119.cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
19120If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
19121added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
19122if
19123.code
19124widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
19125.endd
19126is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
19127&'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
19128&'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
19129and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
19130the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
19131when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
19132
19133
19134.section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
19135When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
19136of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
19137corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
19138is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
19139
19140These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
19141for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
19142such as that implied by
19143.code
19144domains = @mx_any
19145.endd
19146that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
19147entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
19148.ecindex IIDdnsrou1
19149.ecindex IIDdnsrou2
19150
19151
19152
19153
19154
19155
19156
19157
19158
19159. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19160. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19161
19162.chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
19163.cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
19164.cindex "domain literal" "routing"
19165.cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
19166This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
19167verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
19168generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
19169takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
19170router handles the address
19171.code
19172root@[192.168.1.1]
19173.endd
19174by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
19175consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
19176are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
19177.code
19178postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
19179.endd
19180Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
19181grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
19182
19183.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
19184If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
19185declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
19186&%self%& option determines what happens.
19187
19188The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
19189controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
19190also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
19191Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
19192
19193
19194
19195. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19196. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19197
19198.chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
19199.cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
19200.cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
19201The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
19202Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
19203not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
19204must set
19205.code
19206ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
19207.endd
19208in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
19209
19210The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
19211connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
19212a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
19213message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
19214this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
19215can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
19216must not be specified for it.
19217
19218.cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
19219.option hosts iplookup string unset
19220This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
19221names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
19222(or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
19223and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
19224happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
19225
19226
19227.option optional iplookup boolean false
19228If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
19229is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
19230delivery to the address is deferred.
19231
19232
19233.option port iplookup integer 0
19234.cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
19235This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
19236call.
19237
19238
19239.option protocol iplookup string udp
19240This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
19241protocols is to be used.
19242
19243
19244.option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
19245This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
19246default value is:
19247.code
19248$local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
19249.endd
19250The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
19251query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
19252
19253
19254.option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
19255If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
19256returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
19257string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
19258in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
19259&$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
19260whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
19261up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
19262
19263
19264.option response_pattern iplookup string unset
19265This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
19266returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
19267router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
19268response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
19269check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
19270address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
19271the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
19272following could be used:
19273.code
19274response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
19275reroute = $local_part@$1
19276.endd
19277
19278.option timeout iplookup time 5s
19279This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
19280machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
19281call. It does not apply to UDP.
19282
19283
19284
19285
19286. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19287. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19288
19289.chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
19290.scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
19291.scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
19292.cindex "domain" "manually routing"
19293The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
19294routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
19295route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
19296normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
19297route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
19298messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
19299
19300The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
19301it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
19302has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
19303include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
19304&"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
19305generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
19306being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
19307
19308.vindex "&$host$&"
19309In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
19310router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
19311an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
19312transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
19313with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
19314passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
19315host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
19316text string.
19317
19318The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
19319&%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
19320or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
19321any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
19322below, following the list of private options.
19323
19324
19325.section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
19326
19327.cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
19328The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
19329
19330.option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
19331See &%host_find_failed%&.
19332
19333.option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
19334This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
19335address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
19336of the following values:
19337.code
19338decline
19339defer
19340fail
19341freeze
19342ignore
19343pass
19344.endd
19345The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
19346error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
19347forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
19348&%pass_router%&),
19349.oindex "&%more%&"
19350overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
19351router only if &%more%& is true.
19352
19353The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
19354cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
19355controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
19356as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
19357
19358The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
19359state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
19360generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
19361
19362
19363.option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
19364.cindex "randomized host list"
19365.cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
19366If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
19367is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
19368overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
19369crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
19370same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
19371(even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
19372deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
19373
19374When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
19375into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
19376set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
19377item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
19378.code
19379route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
19380.endd
19381The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
19382randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
19383If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
19384randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
19385&%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
19386
19387
19388.option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
19389If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
19390Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
19391example:
19392.code
19393route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
19394.endd
19395If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
19396router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
19397deferred.
19398
19399
19400.option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
19401This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
19402unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
19403that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
19404
19405
19406.option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
19407.cindex "address" "copying routing"
19408Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
19409router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
19410router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19411default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19412servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19413any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19414
19415If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19416domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
19417local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19418lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
19419&(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
19420addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
19421same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
19422if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
19423
19424
19425
19426
19427.section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
19428The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
19429rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
19430entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
19431described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19432Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
19433.display
19434<&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
19435.endd
19436The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
19437no options:
19438.code
19439route_list = \
19440 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
19441 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19442.endd
19443The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
19444list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
19445usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
19446single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
19447pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
19448&<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
19449except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
19450That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
19451lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
19452in a &%route_list%&).
19453
19454The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
19455matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
19456then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
19457&%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
19458
19459
19460
19461.section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
19462The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
19463routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
19464hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
19465The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
19466Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
19467expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
19468like this:
19469.code
19470dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
19471thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19472.endd
19473This data can be accessed by setting
19474.code
19475route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
19476.endd
19477Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
19478decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
19479requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
19480possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
19481be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
19482
19483
19484
19485
19486.section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
19487A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
19488always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
19489declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
19490and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
19491in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
19492as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19493
19494If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
19495variables are set during its expansion:
19496
19497.ilist
19498.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19499If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
19500&$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
19501.code
19502route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
19503.endd
19504.next
19505&$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
19506.next
19507&$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
19508
19509.next
19510.vindex "&$value$&"
19511If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
19512looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
19513.code
19514route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
19515.endd
19516.endlist
19517
19518Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
19519semicolon is the default route list separator.
19520
19521
19522
19523.section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
19524Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
19525optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
19526is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
19527specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
19528by a colon. This leads to some complications:
19529
19530.ilist
19531Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
19532the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
19533be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
19534.code
19535route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
19536route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
19537.endd
19538.next
19539When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
19540colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
19541enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
19542number follows. For example:
19543.code
19544route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
19545.endd
19546.endlist
19547
19548.section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
19549When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
19550the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
19551delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
19552option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
19553transport.
19554
19555Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
19556hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
19557interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
19558records in the DNS. For example:
19559.code
19560route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
19561.endd
19562If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
19563example:
19564.code
19565route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
19566.endd
19567If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
19568randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
19569that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
19570be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
19571Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
19572happens is controlled by the
19573.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19574&%self%& option of the router.
19575
19576A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
19577hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
19578lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
19579below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
19580preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
19581randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
19582defined by MX preferences.
19583
19584If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
19585not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
19586preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
19587
19588If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
19589depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
19590is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
19591Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
19592
19593If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
19594most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
19595router.
19596
19597DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
19598failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
19599&%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
19600
19601The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
19602whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
19603
19604
19605
19606.section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
19607The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
19608One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
19609&%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
19610other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
19611per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
19612routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
19613
19614.ilist
19615&%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
19616setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19617.next
19618&%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
19619overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19620.next
19621&%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
19622find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
19623also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
19624.next
19625&%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
19626no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
19627timeout), delivery is deferred.
19628.next
19629&%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
19630.next
19631&%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
19632.endlist
19633
19634For example:
19635.code
19636route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
19637 domain2 host4:host5
19638.endd
19639If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
19640DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
19641result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
19642or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
19643call.
19644
19645&*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
19646called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
19647instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
19648lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
19649function called.
19650
19651&*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
19652inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
19653option specified.
19654
19655
19656
19657If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
19658&%host_find_failed%& option.
19659
19660.vindex "&$host$&"
19661When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
19662The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
19663
19664
19665
19666.section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
19667In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
19668transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
19669
19670.ilist
19671.cindex "smart host" "example router"
19672The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
19673&'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
19674named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
19675.code
19676domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
19677.endd
19678You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
19679your first router something like this:
19680.code
19681smart_route:
19682 driver = manualroute
19683 domains = !+local_domains
19684 transport = remote_smtp
19685 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
19686.endd
19687This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
19688&'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
19689they are tried in order
19690(but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
19691Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
19692.code
19693smart_route:
19694 driver = manualroute
19695 transport = remote_smtp
19696 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
19697.endd
19698There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
19699However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
19700example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
19701precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
19702always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
19703would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
19704always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
19705&%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
19706
19707.next
19708.cindex "mail hub example"
19709A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
19710records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
19711the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
19712machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
19713&(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
19714to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
19715using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
19716lookup is easier to manage.
19717
19718If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
19719to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
19720example:
19721.code
19722hub_route:
19723 driver = manualroute
19724 transport = remote_smtp
19725 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
19726.endd
19727This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
19728whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
19729if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
19730that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
19731domain can be used to find the host:
19732.code
19733through_firewall:
19734 driver = manualroute
19735 transport = remote_smtp
19736 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
19737.endd
19738The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
19739hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
19740data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
19741next router.
19742
19743.next
19744.cindex "batched SMTP output example"
19745.cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
19746You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
19747SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
19748storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
19749can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
19750.code
19751save_in_file:
19752 driver = manualroute
19753 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
19754 route_list = saved.domain.example
19755.endd
19756though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
19757several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
19758different transports can be listed in the routing information:
19759.code
19760save_in_file:
19761 driver = manualroute
19762 route_list = \
19763 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
19764 *.saved.domain2.example \
19765 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
19766 batch_pipe
19767.endd
19768.vindex "&$domain$&"
19769.vindex "&$host$&"
19770The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
19771doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
19772file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
19773the address if the lookup fails.
19774
19775.next
19776.cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
19777Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
19778&(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
19779one way it can be done:
19780.code
19781# Transport
19782uucp:
19783 driver = pipe
19784 user = nobody
19785 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
19786 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
19787 return_fail_output = true
19788
19789# Router
19790uucphost:
19791 transport = uucp
19792 driver = manualroute
19793 route_data = \
19794 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
19795.endd
19796The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
19797.code
19798darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
19799.endd
19800It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
19801makes clear the distinction between the domain name
19802&'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
19803.endlist
19804.ecindex IIDmanrou1
19805.ecindex IIDmanrou2
19806
19807
19808
19809
19810
19811
19812
19813
19814. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19815. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19816
19817.chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
19818.scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
19819.scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
19820.cindex "routing" "by external program"
19821The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
19822and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
19823mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
19824However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
19825&%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
19826be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
19827options:
19828.cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
19829
19830.option command queryprogram string&!! unset
19831This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
19832command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
19833expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
19834&<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
19835
19836
19837.option command_group queryprogram string unset
19838.cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
19839This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
19840address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
19841uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
19842gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
19843
19844
19845.option command_user queryprogram string unset
19846.cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
19847This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
19848command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
19849it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
19850using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
19851not set, a value for the gid also.
19852
19853&*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
19854root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
19855However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
19856usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
19857is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
19858the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
19859gid.
19860
19861
19862.option current_directory queryprogram string /
19863This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
19864before running the command.
19865
19866
19867.option timeout queryprogram time 1h
19868If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
19869is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
19870timeout.
19871
19872
19873The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
19874the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
19875containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
19876the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
19877field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
19878
19879.ilist
19880&'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
19881below).
19882.next
19883&'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
19884&%no_more%& is set.
19885.next
19886&'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
19887subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
19888of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
19889included in the SMTP response.
19890.next
19891&'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
19892subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
19893included in any SMTP response.
19894.next
19895&'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
19896.next
19897&'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
19898&%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
19899.next
19900&'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
19901new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
19902or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
19903.endlist
19904
19905When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
19906number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
19907the page):
19908.code
19909ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
19910LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
19911.endd
19912The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
19913is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
19914used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
19915an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
19916
19917The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
19918As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
19919in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
19920&`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
19921(see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
19922
19923If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
19924find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
19925anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
19926goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
19927result of the lookup is the result of that call.
19928
19929.vindex "&$address_data$&"
19930If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
19931variable. For example, this return line
19932.code
19933accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
19934.endd
19935routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
19936the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
19937.ecindex IIDquerou1
19938.ecindex IIDquerou2
19939
19940
19941
19942
19943. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19944. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19945
19946.chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
19947.scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
19948.scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
19949.cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
19950.cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
19951The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
19952common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
19953(usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
19954files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
19955redirected in several different ways:
19956
19957.ilist
19958It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
19959independently.
19960.next
19961It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
19962.next
19963It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
19964.next
19965It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
19966.next
19967It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
19968.next
19969It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
19970.next
19971It can be discarded.
19972.endlist
19973
19974The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
19975However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
19976files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
19977&%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
19978
19979If success DSNs have been requested
19980.cindex "DSN" "success"
19981.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
19982redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
19983
19984
19985
19986.section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
19987The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
19988expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
19989contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
19990options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
19991aliases, in a configuration like this:
19992.code
19993system_aliases:
19994 driver = redirect
19995 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
19996.endd
19997If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
19998expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
19999expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
20000cause delivery to be deferred.
20001
20002A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
20003&_.forward_& files, like this:
20004.code
20005userforward:
20006 driver = redirect
20007 check_local_user
20008 file = $home/.forward
20009 no_verify
20010.endd
20011If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
20012empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
20013is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
20014yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
20015comments.
20016
20017
20018
20019.section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
20020.cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
20021It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
20022&_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
20023
20024.ilist
20025When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
20026running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
20027the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
20028practice the router may not be able to operate.
20029.next
20030However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
20031is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
20032local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
20033saves some resources.
20034.endlist
20035
20036
20037
20038
20039
20040
20041.section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
20042.cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20043.cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20044The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
20045can be interpreted in two different ways:
20046
20047.ilist
20048If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
20049&"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
20050&'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
20051respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
20052in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
20053document is intended for use by end users.
20054.next
20055Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
20056described in the next section.
20057.endlist
20058
20059When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
20060in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
20061generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
20062configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
20063for the &(appendfile)& transport.
20064
20065
20066
20067.section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
20068.cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
20069When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
20070comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
20071addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
20072&<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
20073disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
20074depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
20075commas or newlines.
20076If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
20077quotes.
20078
20079Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
20080also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
20081next newline character is ignored.
20082
20083If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
20084double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
20085(but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
20086&"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
20087removed.
20088
20089.vindex "&$local_part$&"
20090&*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
20091and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
20092of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
20093special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
20094&'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
20095setting:
20096.code
20097data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
20098.endd
20099
20100
20101.section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
20102.cindex "routing" "loops in"
20103.cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
20104.cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
20105A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
20106consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
20107automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
20108is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
20109Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
20110as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
20111complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
20112
20113.cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
20114Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
20115filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
20116mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
20117&'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
20118.code
20119cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
20120.endd
20121.cindex "backslash in alias file"
20122.cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
20123For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
20124preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
20125it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
20126synonymously.
20127
20128If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
201292822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
20130domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
20131addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
20132force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
20133
20134Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
20135Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
20136contains:
20137.code
20138Sam.Reman: spqr
20139.endd
20140Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
20141messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
20142this forward file:
20143.code
20144Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20145.endd
20146With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
20147&(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
20148second time round, because it has previously routed it,
20149and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
20150should really contain
20151.code
20152spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20153.endd
20154but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
20155below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
20156&(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
20157
20158
20159
20160.section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
20161In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
20162lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
20163
20164.ilist
20165.cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
20166.cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
20167An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
20168as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
20169command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
20170Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20171which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20172
20173Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
20174the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
20175the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
20176in double quotes, for example:
20177.code
20178"|/some/command ready,steady,go"
20179.endd
20180since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
20181quote just the command. An item such as
20182.code
20183|"/some/command ready,steady,go"
20184.endd
20185is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
20186
20187Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
20188of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
20189redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
20190quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
20191string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
20192are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
20193data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
20194transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
20195an &%accept%& router.
20196
20197.next
20198.cindex "file" "in redirection list"
20199.cindex "address redirection" "to file"
20200An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
20201parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
20202.code
20203/home/world/minbari
20204.endd
20205is treated as a file name, but
20206.code
20207/s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
20208.endd
20209is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
20210the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
20211forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
20212file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
20213
20214Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20215which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20216
20217.cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
20218However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
20219bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
20220instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
20221
20222.next
20223.cindex "included address list"
20224.cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
20225If an item is of the form
20226.code
20227:include:<path name>
20228.endd
20229a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
20230point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
20231out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
20232by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
20233item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
20234the alias name. This example is incorrect:
20235.code
20236list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
20237.endd
20238It must be given as
20239.code
20240list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
20241.endd
20242.next
20243.cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
20244.cindex "delivery" "discard"
20245.cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
20246.cindex "black hole"
20247.cindex "abandoning mail"
20248Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
20249&%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
20250the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
20251.code
20252:blackhole:
20253.endd
20254can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
20255done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
20256&_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
20257
20258&*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
20259delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
20260are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
20261database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
20262&_/dev/null_&.
20263
20264.next
20265.cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
20266.cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
20267.cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
20268.cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
20269.cindex "customizing" "failure message"
20270An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
20271redirection items of the form
20272.code
20273:defer:
20274:fail:
20275.endd
20276respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
20277to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
20278text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
20279associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
20280.code
20281X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
20282.endd
20283In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
20284of a
20285.cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
20286VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
20287default.
20288.cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
20289The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
20290the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
20291
20292.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20293By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
20294&':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
20295space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
20296followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
20297code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
20298incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
20299suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
20300&%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
20301ignored.
20302
20303.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
20304In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
20305default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
20306therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
20307
20308Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
20309not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
20310normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
20311as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
20312lookup and in &':include:'& files.
20313
20314During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
20315containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
20316whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
20317subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
20318deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
20319rules still apply.
20320
20321.next
20322.cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
20323Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
20324chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
20325for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
20326&':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
20327router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
20328results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
20329.endlist
20330
20331
20332.section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
20333.cindex "duplicate addresses"
20334.cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
20335.cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
20336Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
20337to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
20338routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
20339aliasing scheme of the type
20340.code
20341pipe: |/some/command $local_part
20342localpart1: pipe
20343localpart2: pipe
20344.endd
20345does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
20346when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
20347discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
20348such as
20349.code
20350localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
20351localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
20352.endd
20353does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
20354the pipes are distinct.
20355
20356
20357
20358.section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
20359.cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
20360.cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
20361When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
20362leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
20363afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
20364delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
20365members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
20366can be used to avoid this.
20367
20368
20369.section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
20370.cindex "address redirection" "errors"
20371If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
20372error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
20373for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
20374detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
20375deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
20376
20377
20378
20379.section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
20380
20381.cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
20382The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
20383
20384
20385.option allow_defer redirect boolean false
20386Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
20387data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
20388
20389
20390.option allow_fail redirect boolean false
20391.cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
20392If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
20393and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
20394
20395
20396.option allow_filter redirect boolean false
20397.cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
20398.cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
20399Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
20400&"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
20401are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
20402lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
20403
20404It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
20405the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
20406
20407
20408The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
20409&%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
20410&%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
20411files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
20412true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
20413
20414
20415
20416.option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
20417.cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
20418Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
20419This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
20420default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
20421let ordinary users do.
20422
20423
20424
20425.option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
20426This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
20427as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
20428Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
20429configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
20430for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
20431
20432When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
20433is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
20434the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
20435and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
20436domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
20437&_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
20438.code
20439\Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
20440.endd
20441Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
20442&"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
20443originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
20444(having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
20445&"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
20446&%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
20447file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
20448original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
20449
20450
20451.option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
20452When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
20453when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
20454&%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
20455&%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
20456deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
20457is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
20458&%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
20459
20460
20461
20462.option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
20463When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
20464this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
20465permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
20466option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
20467&%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
20468
20469
20470.option data redirect string&!! unset
20471This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
20472set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
20473list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
20474expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
20475has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
20476
20477When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
20478filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
20479terminated with newline characters. For example:
20480.code
20481data = #Exim filter\n\
20482 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
20483.endd
20484If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
20485you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
20486choice into a newline.
20487
20488
20489.option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
20490A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
20491ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20492specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20493configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
20494
20495
20496.option file redirect string&!! unset
20497This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
20498is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
20499use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
20500failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
20501must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
20502data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
20503entirely of comments), the router declines.
20504
20505.cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
20506If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
20507runs a check on the containing directory,
20508unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
20509If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
20510happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
20511is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
20512not, the router declines.
20513
20514
20515.option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
20516.vindex "&$address_file$&"
20517A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
20518ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20519specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20520configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
20521it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
20522
20523
20524.option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
20525When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
20526relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
20527relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
20528relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
20529
20530
20531.option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
20532.cindex "restricting access to features"
20533.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20534If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
20535redirection list.
20536
20537
20538.option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
20539.cindex "restricting access to features"
20540.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20541If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
20542&%allow_filter%& is true.
20543
20544
20545
20546
20547.option forbid_file redirect boolean false
20548.cindex "restricting access to features"
20549.cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
20550.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20551.cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
20552.cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
20553If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
20554specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
20555conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
20556set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
20557locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
20558
20559
20560.option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
20561.cindex "restricting access to features"
20562.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20563If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20564make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
20565functions.
20566
20567.option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
20568.cindex "restricting access to features"
20569.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20570.cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
20571If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20572make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
20573
20574.option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
20575.cindex "restricting access to features"
20576.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20577If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
20578permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
20579under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
20580&_.forward_& files).
20581
20582
20583.option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
20584.cindex "restricting access to features"
20585.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20586If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20587to make use of &%lookup%& items.
20588
20589
20590.option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
20591.cindex "restricting access to features"
20592.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20593This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
20594it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
20595of the embedded Perl support.
20596
20597
20598.option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
20599.cindex "restricting access to features"
20600.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20601If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20602to make use of &%readfile%& items.
20603
20604
20605.option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
20606.cindex "restricting access to features"
20607.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20608If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20609to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
20610
20611
20612.option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
20613.cindex "restricting access to features"
20614.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20615If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
20616message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
20617files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
20618&%one_time%& is set.
20619
20620
20621.option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
20622.cindex "restricting access to features"
20623.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20624If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20625to make use of &%run%& items.
20626
20627
20628.option forbid_include redirect boolean false
20629.cindex "restricting access to features"
20630.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20631If this option is true, items of the form
20632.code
20633:include:<path name>
20634.endd
20635are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
20636
20637
20638.option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
20639.cindex "restricting access to features"
20640.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20641.cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
20642If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
20643specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
20644forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
20645
20646
20647.option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
20648.cindex "restricting access to features"
20649.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20650If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
20651&%allow_filter%& is true.
20652
20653
20654.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20655.option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
20656If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
20657of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
20658the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
20659
20660
20661
20662
20663.option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
20664.cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
20665If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
20666generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
20667generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
20668bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
20669bounce may well quote the generated address.
20670
20671
20672.option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
20673.cindex "EACCES"
20674If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
20675EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
20676file did not exist.
20677
20678
20679.option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
20680.cindex "ENOTDIR"
20681If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
20682ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
20683router behaves as if the file did not exist.
20684
20685Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
20686router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
20687(the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
20688against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
20689is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
20690is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
20691a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
20692that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
20693
20694
20695
20696.option include_directory redirect string unset
20697If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
20698redirection list must start with this directory.
20699
20700
20701.option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
20702This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
20703&%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
20704
20705
20706.option one_time redirect boolean false
20707.cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
20708.cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
20709.cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
20710.cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
20711.cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
20712Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
20713files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
20714of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
20715is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
20716but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
20717message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
20718lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
20719before they subscribed.
20720
20721If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
20722deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
20723&"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
20724&"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
20725attempt.
20726
20727&*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
20728router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
20729reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
20730permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
20731
20732&*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
20733to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
20734and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
20735
20736&*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
20737&%one_time%&.
20738
20739The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
20740addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
20741addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
20742&%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
20743typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
20744expansion.
20745
20746
20747.option owners redirect "string list" unset
20748.cindex "ownership" "alias file"
20749.cindex "ownership" "forward file"
20750.cindex "alias file" "ownership"
20751.cindex "forward file" "ownership"
20752This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
20753This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
20754See &%check_owner%& above.
20755
20756
20757.option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
20758This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
20759The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
20760&%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
20761
20762
20763.option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
20764.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
20765A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
20766starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
20767transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
20768name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
20769When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
20770
20771
20772.option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
20773.vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
20774If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
20775generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
20776in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
20777expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
20778to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
20779&$qualify_recipient$&.
20780
20781This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
20782but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
20783not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
20784addresses.
20785
20786.option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
20787.cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
20788.cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
20789.cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
20790If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
20791set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
20792without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
20793address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
20794&%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
20795this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
20796
20797
20798.option repeat_use redirect boolean true
20799If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
20800any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
20801the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
20802only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
20803&%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
20804
20805
20806.option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
20807A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
20808&%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
20809by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
20810transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
20811are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
20812
20813
20814.option rewrite redirect boolean true
20815.cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
20816If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
20817subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
20818and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
20819
20820
20821.option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
20822The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
20823:subaddress part of an address.
20824
20825.option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
20826The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
20827of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
20828(including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
20829
20830
20831.option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
20832.cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
20833To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
20834&%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
20835(do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
20836&%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
20837needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
20838
20839
20840
20841.option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
20842.cindex "forward file" "broken"
20843.cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
20844.cindex "alias file" "broken"
20845.cindex "broken alias or forward files"
20846.cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
20847.cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
20848.cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
20849If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
20850non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
20851&%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
20852giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
20853are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
20854&%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
20855be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
20856&%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
20857
20858If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
20859errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
20860the following routers.
20861
20862If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
20863error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
20864taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
20865so it is passed to the following routers.
20866
20867.cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
20868Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
20869action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
20870&%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
20871
20872&%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
20873lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
20874option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
20875notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
20876.code
20877userforward:
20878 driver = redirect
20879 allow_filter
20880 check_local_user
20881 file = $home/.forward
20882 file_transport = address_file
20883 pipe_transport = address_pipe
20884 reply_transport = address_reply
20885 no_verify
20886 skip_syntax_errors
20887 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
20888 syntax_errors_text = \
20889 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
20890 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
20891 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
20892 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
20893 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
20894 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
20895 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
20896 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
20897 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
20898 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
20899.endd
20900You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
20901&`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
20902put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
20903.code
20904real_localuser:
20905 driver = accept
20906 check_local_user
20907 local_part_prefix = real-
20908 transport = local_delivery
20909.endd
20910For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
20911router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
20912.code
20913 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
20914 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
20915.endd
20916
20917
20918.option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
20919See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20920
20921
20922.option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
20923See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20924.ecindex IIDredrou1
20925.ecindex IIDredrou2
20926
20927
20928
20929
20930
20931
20932. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20933. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20934
20935.chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
20936 "Environment for local transports"
20937.scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
20938.scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
20939.scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
20940Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
20941transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
20942in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
20943mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
20944
20945Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
20946some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
20947transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
20948&<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
20949
20950The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
20951different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
20952settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
20953or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
20954configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
20955
20956
20957
20958.section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
20959.cindex "concurrent deliveries"
20960.cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
20961If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
20962simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
20963the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
20964rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
20965time.
20966
20967However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
20968locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
20969.code
20970my_transport:
20971 driver = pipe
20972 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
20973.endd
20974This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
20975messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
20976&%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
20977file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
20978
20979
20980
20981
20982.section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
20983.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
20984.cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
20985All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
20986overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
20987set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
20988delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
20989group (set by the transport). For example:
20990.code
20991# Routers ...
20992# User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
20993local_users:
20994 driver = accept
20995 check_local_user
20996 transport = group_delivery
20997
20998# Transports ...
20999# This transport overrides the group
21000group_delivery:
21001 driver = appendfile
21002 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21003 group = mail
21004.endd
21005If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
21006address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
21007gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
21008set.
21009
21010.oindex "&%initgroups%&"
21011When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
21012function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
21013&%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
21014by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
21015for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
21016
21017.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
21018The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
21019is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
21020receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
21021original gid is also used.
21022
21023This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
21024following that is set is used:
21025
21026.ilist
21027A &%group%& setting of the transport;
21028.next
21029A &%group%& setting of the router;
21030.next
21031A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
21032&%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
21033.next
21034The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
21035.next
21036In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
21037the uid is the creator's uid;
21038.next
21039The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
21040.endlist
21041
21042If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
21043no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
21044This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
21045The first of the following that is set is used:
21046
21047.ilist
21048A &%user%& setting of the transport;
21049.next
21050In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
21051.next
21052A &%user%& setting of the router;
21053.next
21054A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
21055.next
21056The Exim uid.
21057.endlist
21058
21059Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
21060&%never_users%& list.
21061
21062
21063
21064
21065
21066.section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
21067.cindex "current directory for local transport"
21068.cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
21069.cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
21070.cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
21071Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
21072the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
21073However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
21074are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
21075for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21076
21077.ilist
21078The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
21079.next
21080The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
21081.next
21082The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
21083.next
21084The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
21085.endlist
21086
21087The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21088
21089.ilist
21090The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
21091.next
21092The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
21093.endlist
21094
21095
21096If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
21097value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
21098directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
21099
21100
21101
21102.section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
21103.vindex "&$domain$&"
21104.vindex "&$local_part$&"
21105.vindex "&$original_domain$&"
21106Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
21107variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
21108deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
21109at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
21110other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
21111never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
21112and &$original_domain$& is never set.
21113.ecindex IIDenvlotra1
21114.ecindex IIDenvlotra2
21115.ecindex IIDenvlotra3
21116
21117
21118
21119
21120
21121
21122
21123. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21124. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21125
21126.chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
21127.scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
21128.scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
21129.scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
21130The following generic options apply to all transports:
21131
21132
21133.option body_only transports boolean false
21134.cindex "transport" "body only"
21135.cindex "message" "transporting body only"
21136.cindex "body of message" "transporting"
21137If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
21138mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
21139or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
21140&%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
21141automatically suppress them.
21142
21143
21144.option current_directory transports string&!! unset
21145.cindex "transport" "current directory for"
21146This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
21147transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
21148If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
21149logged, and delivery is deferred.
21150
21151
21152.option disable_logging transports boolean false
21153If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
21154deliveries by the transport or for any
21155transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
21156what you are doing.
21157
21158
21159.option debug_print transports string&!! unset
21160.cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
21161If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
21162option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
21163transport is run.
21164If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
21165output, and Exim carries on processing.
21166This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
21167so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
21168option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
21169variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
21170one.
21171The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
21172transport and the router that called it.
21173
21174.option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
21175.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
21176If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
21177This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
21178header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
21179requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
21180safely be resent to other recipients.
21181
21182
21183.option driver transports string unset
21184This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
21185There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
21186
21187
21188.option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
21189.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21190If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
21191This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
21192delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
21193configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
21194address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
21195header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
21196its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
21197resent to other recipients.
21198
21199
21200.option event_action transports string&!! unset
21201.cindex events
21202This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
21203For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
21204
21205
21206.option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
21207.cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
21208This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
21209value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
21210&%user%& (see below).
21211
21212
21213.option headers_add transports list&!! unset
21214.cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
21215.cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
21216This option specifies a list of text headers,
21217newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
21218which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
21219portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
21220&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
21221routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21222is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21223errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21224
21225Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
21226for a transport; all listed headers are added.
21227
21228
21229.option headers_only transports boolean false
21230.cindex "transport" "header lines only"
21231.cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
21232.cindex "header lines" "transporting"
21233If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
21234exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
21235transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
21236checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
21237
21238
21239.option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
21240.cindex "header lines" "removing"
21241.cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
21242This option specifies a list of header names,
21243colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way);
21244these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
21245in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
21246routers.
21247Each list item is separately expanded.
21248If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21249is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21250errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21251
21252Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
21253for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
21254
21255&*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
21256items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
21257To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
21258
21259
21260
21261.option headers_rewrite transports string unset
21262.cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
21263.cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
21264This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
21265that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
21266option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
21267the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
21268message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
21269example,
21270.code
21271headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
21272 x@y w@z
21273.endd
21274changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
21275&'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
21276header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
21277only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
21278the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
21279filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
21280affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
21281envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
21282change envelope recipients at this time.
21283
21284
21285.option home_directory transports string&!! unset
21286.cindex "transport" "home directory for"
21287.vindex "&$home$&"
21288This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
21289overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
21290placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
21291used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
21292&%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
21293&%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
21294for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
21295deferred.
21296
21297
21298.option initgroups transports boolean false
21299.cindex "additional groups"
21300.cindex "groups" "additional"
21301.cindex "transport" "group; additional"
21302If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
21303transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
21304to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
21305
21306
21307.option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
21308.cindex limit "transport parallelism"
21309.cindex transport "parallel processes"
21310.cindex transport "concurrency limit"
21311.cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
21312If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
21313it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
21314The control does not apply to shadow transports.
21315
21316.cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
21317Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
21318incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
21319is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
21320Obviously there is scope for
21321records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
21322guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
21323
21324If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
21325relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
21326start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
21327may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
21328are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
21329
21330
21331.option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
21332.cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
21333.cindex "size" "of message, limit"
21334.cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
21335This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
21336expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
21337digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
21338including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
21339delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
21340message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
21341the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
21342ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
21343&%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
21344delivered.
21345
21346
21347
21348.option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
21349.cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
21350.cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
21351.cindex "local part" "prefix"
21352.cindex "local part" "suffix"
21353When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
21354affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
21355form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
21356that contains
21357.code
21358local_part_prefix = *-
21359.endd
21360routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
21361is delivered with
21362.code
21363RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
21364.endd
21365This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
21366recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
21367whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
21368deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
21369&(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
21370
21371
21372.option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
21373.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
21374When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
21375in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
21376is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
21377deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
21378part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
21379temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
21380deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
21381
21382However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
21383as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
21384(For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
21385this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
21386
21387For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
21388the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
21389on a remote transport in the current implementation.
21390
21391
21392.option return_path transports string&!! unset
21393.cindex "envelope sender"
21394.cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
21395.cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
21396If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
21397the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
21398that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
21399designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
21400SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
21401only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
21402header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
21403
21404&*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
21405&%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
21406
21407.vindex "&$return_path$&"
21408The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
21409either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
21410&%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
21411replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
21412option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
21413section &<<SECTverp>>&.
21414
21415&*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
21416remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
21417the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
21418This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
21419&%errors_to%& in a router.
21420
21421
21422
21423.option return_path_add transports boolean false
21424.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
21425If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
21426Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
21427mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
21428have easy access to it.
21429
21430RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
21431the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
21432header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
21433option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
21434incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
21435recipients.
21436
21437
21438.option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
21439See &%shadow_transport%& below.
21440
21441
21442.option shadow_transport transports string unset
21443.cindex "shadow transport"
21444.cindex "transport" "shadow"
21445A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
21446another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
21447
21448Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
21449&%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
21450string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
21451passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
21452expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
21453cause a log line to be written.
21454
21455The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
21456subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
21457provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
21458is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
21459ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
21460of the form
21461.code
21462ST=<shadow transport name>
21463.endd
21464If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
21465parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
21466purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
21467provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
21468headers that some sites insist on.
21469
21470
21471.option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
21472.cindex "transport" "filter"
21473.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21474This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
21475at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
21476individual users or via a system filter.
21477If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
21478
21479When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
21480&%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
21481the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
21482input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
21483command must be specified as an absolute path.
21484
21485The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
21486terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
21487SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
21488lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
21489settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
21490&(pipe)& transports.
21491
21492The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
21493standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
21494destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
21495filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
21496are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
21497
21498The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
21499care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
21500test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
21501SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
21502
21503.cindex "content scanning" "per user"
21504A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
21505at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
21506message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
21507a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
21508not possible to discard a message at this stage.
21509
21510.cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
21511A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
21512being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
21513support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
21514at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
21515more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
21516the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
21517additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
21518
21519.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21520The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
21521the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
21522parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
21523Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
21524section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
21525to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
21526of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
21527an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
21528&(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
21529
21530.vindex "&$host$&"
21531.vindex "&$host_address$&"
21532The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
21533transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
21534which the message is being sent. For example:
21535.code
21536transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
21537 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
21538.endd
21539
21540Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
21541generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
21542command is split up &'before'& expansion.
21543.ilist
21544If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
21545part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
21546expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
21547example:
21548.code
21549transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
21550.endd
21551This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
21552&(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
21553stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
21554the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
21555&`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
21556Exim tried to expand the first one.
21557.next
21558Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
21559expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
21560arguments. Consider this example:
21561.code
21562transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21563 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21564.endd
21565The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
21566if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
21567.code
21568transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21569 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21570.endd
21571.endlist
21572
21573The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
21574For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
21575normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
21576A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
21577serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
21578the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
21579bounced from a transport filter.
21580
21581If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
21582passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
21583message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
21584
21585
21586.option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
21587.cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
21588When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
21589that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
21590temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
21591&(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
21592way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
21593error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
21594becomes a temporary error.
21595
21596
21597.option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
21598.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21599.cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
21600This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
21601run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
21602given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
21603associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
21604option is not set.
21605
21606For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
21607specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
21608&%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
21609
21610.cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
21611For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
21612sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
21613to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
21614retry data.
21615.ecindex IIDgenoptra1
21616.ecindex IIDgenoptra2
21617.ecindex IIDgenoptra3
21618
21619
21620
21621
21622
21623
21624. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21625. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21626
21627.chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
21628 "Address batching"
21629.cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
21630The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
21631one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
21632remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
21633normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
21634transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
21635copy of the message is delivered each time.
21636
21637.cindex "batched local delivery"
21638.oindex "&%batch_max%&"
21639.oindex "&%batch_id%&"
21640In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
21641local transport, for example:
21642
21643.ilist
21644In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
21645delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
21646recipients saves space.
21647.next
21648In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
21649a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
21650.next
21651In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
21652to a scanner program or
21653to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
21654acceptable.
21655.endlist
21656
21657These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
21658(&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
21659repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
21660
21661The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
21662delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
21663(no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
21664&%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
21665(that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
21666to certain conditions:
21667
21668.ilist
21669.vindex "&$local_part$&"
21670If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
21671batching is possible.
21672.next
21673.vindex "&$domain$&"
21674If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
21675addresses with the same domain are batched.
21676.next
21677.cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
21678If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
21679addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
21680customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
21681including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
21682from taking place.
21683.next
21684Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
21685delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
21686group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
21687be the same.
21688.endlist
21689
21690In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
21691both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
21692is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
21693course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
21694option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
21695&"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
21696&%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
21697.code
21698check_string = "."
21699escape_string = ".."
21700.endd
21701when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
21702given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
21703&%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
21704
21705.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21706If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
21707&'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
21708that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
21709transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
21710addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
21711
21712.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
21713.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21714If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
21715transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
21716the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
21717of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
21718argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
21719delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
21720are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
21721
21722
21723
21724
21725. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21726. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21727
21728.chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
21729.scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
21730.scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
21731.cindex "directory creation"
21732.cindex "creating directories"
21733The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
21734file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
21735files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
21736format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
21737University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
21738being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
21739to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
21740delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
21741supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
21742directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
21743
21744The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
21745default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
21746SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
21747included.
21748
21749.cindex "quota" "system"
21750Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
21751also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
21752system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
21753
21754If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
21755partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
21756modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
21757creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
21758
21759Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
21760file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
21761private options.
21762
21763The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
21764users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
21765putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
21766&"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
21767option).
21768
21769
21770
21771.section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
21772The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
21773the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
21774the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
21775normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
21776
21777.vindex "&$address_file$&"
21778.vindex "&$local_part$&"
21779However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
21780directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
21781forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
21782user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
21783the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
21784name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
21785operation. There are two cases:
21786
21787.ilist
21788If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
21789must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
21790common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
21791different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
21792default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
21793name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
21794&%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
21795.next
21796If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
21797used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
21798contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
21799.endlist
21800
21801
21802.cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
21803.cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
21804As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
21805have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
21806form:
21807.code
21808save folder23
21809.endd
21810or Sieve filter commands of the form:
21811.code
21812require "fileinto";
21813fileinto "folder23";
21814.endd
21815In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
21816must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
21817case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
21818is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
21819way of handling this requirement:
21820.code
21821file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
21822 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
21823 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
21824 {$address_file} \
21825 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
21826 }} \
21827 }
21828.endd
21829With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
21830location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
21831&_mail_& directory within the home directory.
21832
21833&*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
21834&_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
21835the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
21836you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
21837&%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
21838path to the transport.
21839
21840&*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
21841the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
21842
21843
21844
21845
21846.section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
21847.cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
21848
21849
21850
21851.option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
21852.cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
21853.cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
21854.cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
21855Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
21856regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
21857delivery is deferred.
21858
21859
21860.option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
21861.cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21862.cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21863By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
21864that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
21865are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
21866what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
21867are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
21868
21869
21870.option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
21871See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21872However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
21873happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
21874file.
21875
21876
21877.option batch_max appendfile integer 1
21878See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21879
21880
21881.option check_group appendfile boolean false
21882When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
21883option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
21884delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
21885file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
21886
21887
21888.option check_owner appendfile boolean true
21889When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
21890is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
21891process is running.
21892
21893
21894.option check_string appendfile string "see below"
21895.cindex "&""From""& line"
21896As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
21897matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
21898replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
21899a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
21900contains is significant.
21901
21902If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
21903are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
21904configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
21905&">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
21906&%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
21907
21908The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
21909suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
21910&"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
21911if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
21912.cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
21913.cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
21914.code
21915check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21916escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
21917message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21918message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21919.endd
21920.option create_directory appendfile boolean true
21921.cindex "directory creation"
21922When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
21923directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
21924is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
21925
21926The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
21927operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
21928example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
21929is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
21930in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
21931
21932
21933
21934.option create_file appendfile string anywhere
21935This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
21936by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
21937directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
21938delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
21939beneath.
21940
21941The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
21942&"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
21943set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
21944given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
21945names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
21946by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
21947&%file_must_exist%&.
21948
21949
21950.option directory appendfile string&!! unset
21951This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
21952or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
21953redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
21954
21955When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
21956into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
21957appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
21958(see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
21959&<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
21960
21961
21962.option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
21963.cindex "base62"
21964.vindex "&$inode$&"
21965When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
21966&%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
21967whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
21968.code
21969q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
21970.endd
21971This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
21972inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
21973option.
21974
21975
21976.option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
21977If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
21978&%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
21979
21980
21981.option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
21982See &%check_string%& above.
21983
21984
21985.option file appendfile string&!! unset
21986This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
21987&%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
21988of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
21989specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
21990&%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
21991&%file%&.
21992
21993.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21994.cindex "locking files"
21995.cindex "lock files"
21996If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
21997mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
21998
21999The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
22000path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
22001examples:
22002.code
22003file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
22004file = /home/$local_part/inbox
22005file = $home/inbox
22006.endd
22007.cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
22008In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
22009is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
22010create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
22011deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
22012run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
22013
22014
22015
22016.option file_format appendfile string unset
22017.cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
22018This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
22019before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
22020start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
22021colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
22022second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
22023string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
22024transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
22025this added to it:
22026.code
22027file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
22028 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
22029.endd
22030Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
22031a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
22032to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
22033to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
22034is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
22035match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
22036delivery is deferred.
22037
22038
22039.option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
22040If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
22041A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
22042If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
22043
22044
22045.option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
22046.cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22047.cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
22048.cindex "locking files"
22049By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
22050when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
22051sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
22052Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
22053for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
22054deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
22055mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
22056misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
22057
22058On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
22059not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
22060is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
22061and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
22062
22063If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
22064timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
22065retries is
22066.code
22067(lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
22068.endd
22069rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
22070which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
22071&%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
22072
22073You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
22074local deliveries because of errors of the form
22075.code
22076failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
22077.endd
22078
22079.option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
22080This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
22081&%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
22082&%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
22083
22084
22085.option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
22086This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
22087for details of locking.
22088
22089
22090.option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
22091This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
22092is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
22093
22094
22095.option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22096This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
22097used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
22098
22099
22100.option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
22101.cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22102When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
22103exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
22104accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
22105
22106
22107.option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
22108.cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22109.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22110If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22111number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
22112followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
22113external source that maintains the data.
22114
22115
22116.option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
22117.cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22118.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22119If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22120size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
22121This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
22122maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
22123it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
22124
22125
22126
22127.option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
22128.cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
22129If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
22130file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
22131transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
22132&(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
22133&%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
22134directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
22135SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
22136&<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22137
22138
22139.option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
22140.cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
22141.cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
22142This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
22143a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
22144directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
22145calculation. The default value is:
22146.code
22147maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
22148.endd
22149This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
22150(directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
22151&_Trash_&
22152folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
22153.code
22154maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
22155.endd
22156This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
22157directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
22158calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
22159directly into that directory.
22160
22161
22162.option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
22163This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
22164&"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22165
22166
22167.option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
22168This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
22169section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22170
22171
22172.option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
22173.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22174The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
22175If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
22176creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
22177quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
22178value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
22179&<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22180
22181.option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
22182.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
22183.cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
22184The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
22185effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
22186matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
22187containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
22188delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
22189&_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
22190See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
22191
22192
22193.option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
22194.cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
22195If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
22196new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
22197SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
22198below for further details.
22199
22200
22201.option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
22202This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22203section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22204
22205
22206.option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
22207This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22208section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22209
22210
22211.option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
22212.cindex "locking files"
22213.cindex "file" "locking"
22214.cindex "file" "MBX format"
22215.cindex "MBX format, specifying"
22216This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22217set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
22218the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
22219traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
22220IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
22221
22222&*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
22223automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
22224empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
22225combination:
22226.code
22227mbx_format = true
22228message_prefix =
22229message_suffix =
22230.endd
22231If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
22232&%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
22233is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
22234&%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
22235interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
22236should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
22237going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
22238mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
22239
22240If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
22241the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
22242(this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
22243append messages to it.
22244
22245
22246.option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22247.cindex "&""From""& line"
22248The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22249The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22250in which case it is:
22251.code
22252message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
22253 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
22254.endd
22255&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22256&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22257
22258.option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22259The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22260The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22261in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
22262setting
22263.code
22264message_suffix =
22265.endd
22266&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22267&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22268
22269.option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22270If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
22271has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
22272permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
22273if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
22274a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
22275value, and this option is ignored.
22276
22277
22278.option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
22279This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
22280mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
22281true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
22282continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
22283
22284
22285.option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
22286If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
22287successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
22288on users about incoming mail.
22289
22290
22291.option quota appendfile string&!! unset
22292.cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
22293This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
22294or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
22295is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
22296all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
22297individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
22298&%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
22299have no shell access to their mailboxes).
22300
22301As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
22302multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
22303For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
22304
22305A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
22306may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
22307If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
22308become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
22309Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
22310the obvious value which users understand most easily.
22311
22312The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
22313(decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
22314for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
22315and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
22316large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
22317be handled.
22318
22319The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22320quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22321
22322&*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
22323
22324The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
22325the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
22326be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
22327fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
22328system quota failures.
22329
22330By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
22331mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
22332last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
22333during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
22334refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
22335message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
22336changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
22337for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
22338continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
22339delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
22340
22341
22342.option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
22343This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
22344into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
22345called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
22346delivery directory.
22347
22348
22349.option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
22350This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
22351number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
22352can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
22353failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
22354&"no quota"&.
22355
22356The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22357quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22358
22359.option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
22360See &%quota%& above.
22361
22362
22363.option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
22364This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
22365for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
22366these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
22367If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
22368captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
22369file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
22370
22371This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
22372&-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
22373facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
22374the file length to the file name. For example:
22375.code
22376maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
22377quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
22378.endd
22379An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
22380number of lines in the message.
22381
22382The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
22383file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
22384sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
22385
22386Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
22387
22388
22389.option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
22390See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
22391&%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
22392.code
22393quota_warn_message = "\
22394 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
22395 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
22396 This message is automatically created \
22397 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
22398 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
22399 a warning threshold that is\n\
22400 set by the system administrator.\n"
22401.endd
22402
22403
22404.option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
22405.cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
22406.cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
22407.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22408This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
22409resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
22410size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
22411threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
22412may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
22413sign. For example:
22414.code
22415quota = 10M
22416quota_warn_threshold = 75%
22417.endd
22418If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
22419percent sign is ignored.
22420
22421The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
22422and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
22423warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
22424the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
22425can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
22426&'From:'& line, the default is:
22427.code
22428From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
22429.endd
22430.oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
22431If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
22432option.
22433
22434The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
22435are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
22436percentage.
22437
22438
22439.option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
22440.cindex "envelope sender"
22441If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
22442format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
22443you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
22444so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
22445for details of batch SMTP.
22446
22447
22448.option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
22449.cindex "carriage return"
22450.cindex "linefeed"
22451This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22452(carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22453of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
22454of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22455
22456&*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
22457(which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
22458in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
22459carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
22460have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
22461changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22462
22463
22464.option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22465This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
22466exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
22467&%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
22468that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22469&%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
22470
22471
22472.option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
22473This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
22474the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
22475&[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
22476each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
22477
22478This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
22479&[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
22480where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
22481both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
22482
22483.cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
22484Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
22485have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
22486&[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
22487the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
22488error.
22489
22490&*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
22491is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
22492
22493
22494.option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
22495If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
22496appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
22497&[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
22498sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
22499&[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
22500delivering over NFS from more than one host.
22501
22502.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22503In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
22504necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
22505achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
22506file corruption.
22507
22508The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
22509It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
22510except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
22511
22512
22513.option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22514This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22515set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
22516locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
22517of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
22518are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
22519the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
22520rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
22521does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
22522
22523You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22524&%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
22525MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
22526without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
22527
22528
22529
22530
22531.section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
22532.cindex "appending to a file"
22533.cindex "file" "appending"
22534Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
22535
22536.ilist
22537If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
22538return is given.
22539
22540.next
22541.cindex "directory creation"
22542If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
22543&%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
22544&%directory_mode%& option.
22545
22546.next
22547If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
22548indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
22549transport.
22550
22551.next
22552.cindex "file" "locking"
22553.cindex "locking files"
22554.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22555If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
22556reliably over NFS, as follows:
22557
22558.olist
22559Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
22560current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
22561as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
22562.next
22563Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
22564.next
22565If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
22566Unlink the hitching post name.
22567.next
22568Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
22569then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
22570of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
22571restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
22572.next
22573If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
22574up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
22575mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
22576lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
22577existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
22578it before trying again.
22579.endlist olist
22580
22581.next
22582A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
22583so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
22584than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
22585
22586.next
22587.cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22588.cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22589If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
22590&%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
22591checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
22592is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
22593ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
22594directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
22595idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
22596checked.
22597
22598.next
22599If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
22600and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
22601different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
22602delivery is deferred.
22603
22604.next
22605If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
22606If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
22607is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
22608permissions.
22609
22610.next
22611The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
22612If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
22613hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
22614
22615.next
22616If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
22617changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
22618have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
22619
22620.next
22621If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
22622option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
22623directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
22624open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
22625except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
22626set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
22627the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
22628that prevents link following.
22629
22630.next
22631.cindex "loop" "while file testing"
22632If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
22633existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
22634being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
22635after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
22636
22637.next
22638If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
22639
22640.next
22641.cindex "file" "locking"
22642.cindex "locking files"
22643Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
22644are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
22645&%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
22646However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
22647file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
22648.code
22649/tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
22650.endd
22651using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
22652the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
22653the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
22654
22655If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
22656depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
22657&%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
22658
22659If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
22660&%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
22661to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
22662delivery is deferred.
22663
22664If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
22665&[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
22666waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
22667immediately. It retries up to
22668.code
22669(lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
22670.endd
22671times (rounded up).
22672.endlist
22673
22674At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
22675and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
22676
22677
22678.section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
22679.cindex "delivery" "to single file"
22680.cindex "&""From""& line"
22681When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
22682delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
22683activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
22684&%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
22685router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
22686configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
22687ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
22688
22689No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
22690locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
22691separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
22692of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
22693newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
22694&%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
22695any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
22696
22697If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
22698the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
22699different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
22700deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
22701
22702
22703.cindex "maildir format"
22704.cindex "mailstore format"
22705There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
22706done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
22707&%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
22708formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
22709SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
22710
22711.cindex "directory creation"
22712In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
22713sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
22714option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
22715constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
22716the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
22717&%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
22718deferred.
22719
22720
22721
22722.section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
22723.cindex "maildir format" "description of"
22724If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
22725it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
22726directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
22727directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
22728&_new_& subdirectory.
22729
22730In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
22731<&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
22732Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
22733before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
22734file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
22735opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
22736Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
22737
22738Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
22739called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
22740do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
22741path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
22742&%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
22743contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
22744&_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
22745&_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
22746
22747These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
22748and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
22749folders. Consider this example:
22750.code
22751maildir_format = true
22752directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
22753 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
22754 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
22755maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
22756.endd
22757If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
22758delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
22759the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
22760not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
22761&_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
22762&_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
22763
22764However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
22765delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
22766does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
22767&_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
22768directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
22769
22770&*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
22771not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
22772&_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
22773
22774.cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22775.cindex "maildir++"
22776If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
22777&%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
22778the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
22779Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
22780down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
22781the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
22782amount of space used.
22783
22784One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
22785computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
22786checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
22787needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
22788use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
22789of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
22790
22791
22792
22793
22794.section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
22795If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
22796When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
22797tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
22798name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
22799the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
22800
22801
22802.vindex "&$message_size$&"
22803Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
22804&%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
22805happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
22806variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
22807forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
22808be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
22809Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
22810empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
22811colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
22812maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
22813backwards compatibility).
22814
22815For one common implementation, you might set:
22816.code
22817maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
22818.endd
22819but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
22820
22821It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
22822as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
22823&[stat()]& each message file.
22824
22825
22826.section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
22827.cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22828.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22829If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
22830storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
22831within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
22832creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
22833the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
22834to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
22835
22836The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
22837messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
22838in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
22839value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
22840is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
22841need to know the quota.
22842
22843If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
22844file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
22845
22846A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
22847maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
22848See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
22849details.
22850
22851
22852.section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
22853.cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
22854If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
22855files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
22856message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
22857this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
22858contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
22859itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
22860
22861During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
22862&_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
22863&_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
22864mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
22865file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
22866the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
22867
22868The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
22869option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
22870the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
22871There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
22872greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
22873appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
22874
22875If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
22876failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
22877configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
22878&$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
22879
22880
22881.section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
22882If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
22883file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
22884messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
22885section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
22886.code
22887directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
22888.endd
22889might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
22890then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
22891expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
22892.ecindex IIDapptra1
22893.ecindex IIDapptra2
22894
22895
22896
22897
22898
22899
22900. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22901. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22902
22903.chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
22904.scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
22905.scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
22906The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
22907the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
22908automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
22909&'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
22910to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
22911
22912If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
22913&%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
22914delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
22915that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
22916another router can set up a normal message delivery.
22917
22918
22919The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
22920&"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
22921directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
22922message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
22923empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
22924
22925The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
22926by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
22927passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
22928transport is run as a consequence of a
22929&%mail%&
22930or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
22931supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
22932that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
22933case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
22934is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
22935&%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
22936
22937&(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
22938command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
22939gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
22940&<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
22941
22942There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
22943that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
22944&(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
22945address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
22946separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
22947the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
22948message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
22949
22950Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
22951message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
22952immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
22953the transport defers.
22954Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
22955controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
22956
22957If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
22958&%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
22959of the original message that is included in the generated message when
22960&%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
22961
22962.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22963If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
22964the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
22965as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
22966is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
22967problems. They are just discarded.
22968
22969
22970
22971.section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
22972.cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
22973
22974.option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
22975This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
22976message when the message is specified by the transport.
22977
22978
22979.option cc autoreply string&!! unset
22980This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
22981when the message is specified by the transport.
22982
22983
22984.option file autoreply string&!! unset
22985The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
22986is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
22987string comes first.
22988
22989
22990.option file_expand autoreply boolean false
22991If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
22992subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
22993
22994
22995.option file_optional autoreply boolean false
22996If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
22997option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
22998
22999
23000.option from autoreply string&!! unset
23001This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
23002specified by the transport.
23003
23004
23005.option headers autoreply string&!! unset
23006This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
23007when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
23008&"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
23009
23010
23011.option log autoreply string&!! unset
23012This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
23013the message is specified by the transport.
23014
23015
23016.option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
23017If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
23018used.
23019
23020
23021.option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
23022If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
23023item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
23024discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
23025generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
23026
23027
23028
23029.option once autoreply string&!! unset
23030This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
23031recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
23032This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
23033
23034If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
23035By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
23036is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
23037However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
23038message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
23039this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
23040prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
23041infinity.
23042
23043If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
23044and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
23045greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
23046Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
23047regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
23048
23049In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
23050which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
23051be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
23052means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
23053unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
23054file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
23055
23056
23057.option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
23058See &%once%& above.
23059
23060
23061.option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
23062See &%once%& above.
23063After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
23064
23065
23066.option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
23067This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
23068specified by the transport.
23069
23070
23071.option return_message autoreply boolean false
23072If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
23073message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
23074configuration option.
23075
23076
23077.option subject autoreply string&!! unset
23078This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
23079specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
23080automatic responses. For example:
23081.code
23082subject = Re: $h_subject:
23083.endd
23084There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
23085subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
23086bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
23087non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
23088small.
23089
23090
23091
23092.option text autoreply string&!! unset
23093This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
23094message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
23095the text comes first.
23096
23097
23098.option to autoreply string&!! unset
23099This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
23100when the message is specified by the transport.
23101.ecindex IIDauttra1
23102.ecindex IIDauttra2
23103
23104
23105
23106
23107. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23108. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23109
23110.chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
23111.cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
23112.cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
23113.cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
23114.cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
23115The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
23116specified command
23117or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
23118This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
23119transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
23120implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
23121to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
23122has it commented out. You need to ensure that
23123.code
23124TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
23125.endd
23126.cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
23127is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
23128included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
23129as follows:
23130
23131.option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
23132See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23133
23134
23135.option batch_max lmtp integer 1
23136This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23137Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
23138good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
23139batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23140
23141
23142.option command lmtp string&!! unset
23143This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
23144is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
23145arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
23146number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
23147is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
23148LMTP protocol.
23149
23150.option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
23151.cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23152If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
23153commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
23154in its response to the LHLO command.
23155
23156.option socket lmtp string&!! unset
23157This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
23158be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
23159delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
23160
23161
23162.option timeout lmtp time 5m
23163The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
23164respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
23165is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
23166LMTP transport:
23167.code
23168lmtp:
23169 driver = lmtp
23170 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
23171 batch_max = 20
23172 user = exim
23173.endd
23174This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
23175necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
23176
23177
23178
23179. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23180. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23181
23182.chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
23183.scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
23184.scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
23185The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
23186running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
23187pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
23188(such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
23189their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
23190following ways:
23191
23192.ilist
23193.vindex "&$local_part$&"
23194A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
23195transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
23196contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
23197is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
23198.next
23199.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23200If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
23201transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
23202more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
23203(because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
23204(described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
23205that are routed to the transport.
23206.next
23207.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
23208A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
23209alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
23210pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
23211&%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
23212(&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
23213this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
23214.endlist
23215
23216
23217The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
23218deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
23219implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
23220
23221In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
23222&_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
23223other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
23224transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
23225directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
23226details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
23227for a discussion of local delivery batching.
23228
23229
23230.section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
23231If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
23232delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
23233any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
23234write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
23235Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
23236of "1" to enforce serialization.
23237
23238
23239
23240
23241.section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
23242.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
23243If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
23244have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
23245the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
23246in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
23247later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
23248logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
23249&"local delivery failed"&.
23250
23251If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
23252the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
23253will be sent as normal.
23254
23255If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
23256script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
23257value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
23258apply in this case.
23259
23260If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
23261return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
23262asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
23263a non-existent command may be the problem.
23264
23265The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
23266set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
23267error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
23268return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
23269included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
23270similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
23271failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
23272&%temp_errors%&.
23273
23274
23275
23276.section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
23277.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
23278The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
23279by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
23280&%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
23281run.
23282
23283.cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
23284Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
23285double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
23286way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
23287
23288String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
23289traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
23290expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
23291For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
23292quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
23293.code
23294command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
23295.endd
23296will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
23297arguments. You have to write
23298.code
23299command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
23300.endd
23301to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
23302argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
23303result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
23304interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
23305generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
23306expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
23307example:
23308.code
23309command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
23310.endd
23311
23312.cindex "transport" "filter"
23313.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23314.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23315Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
23316&`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
23317place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
23318transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
23319inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
23320avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
23321&(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
23322
23323If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
23324for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
23325is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
23326argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
23327&'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
23328the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
23329should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
23330run while preserving the argument vector separation.
23331
23332After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
23333in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
23334message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
23335standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
23336read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
23337may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
23338control what is done with it.
23339
23340Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
23341in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
23342taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
23343explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
23344where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
23345under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
23346an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
23347works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
23348as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
23349&%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
23350with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
23351
23352
23353
23354.section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
23355.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23356.cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23357The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
23358This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
23359the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
23360environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
23361to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
23362.display
23363&`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
23364&`HOME `& the home directory, if set
23365&`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
23366&`LOCAL_PART `& see below
23367&`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
23368&`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
23369&`LOGNAME `& see below
23370&`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
23371&`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
23372&`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
23373&`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
23374&`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
23375&`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
23376&`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
23377&`USER `& see below
23378.endd
23379When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
23380router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
23381called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
23382the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
23383removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
23384LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
23385same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
23386
23387.cindex "HOST"
23388HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
23389associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
23390pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
23391the router.
23392
23393.cindex "HOME"
23394If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
23395for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
23396by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
23397user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
23398
23399
23400.section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
23401.cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
23402
23403
23404
23405.option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
23406.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
23407The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23408permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
23409permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
23410paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
23411&%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
23412in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
23413the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
23414&%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
23415otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
23416example, if
23417.code
23418allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
23419.endd
23420and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
23421&_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
23422&%use_shell%& is set.
23423
23424
23425.option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
23426See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23427
23428
23429.option batch_max pipe integer 1
23430This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23431See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23432
23433
23434.option check_string pipe string unset
23435As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
23436&%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
23437by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
23438&%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
23439any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
23440of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
23441the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
23442ignored.
23443
23444
23445.option command pipe string&!! unset
23446This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
23447obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
23448set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
23449the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
23450Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
23451&<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
23452
23453
23454.option environment pipe string&!! unset
23455.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23456.cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23457This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
23458command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
23459a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23460environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
23461
23462
23463.option escape_string pipe string unset
23464See &%check_string%& above.
23465
23466
23467.option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
23468.cindex "exec failure"
23469.cindex "failure of exec"
23470.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
23471Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
23472any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
23473is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
23474frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
23475
23476
23477.option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
23478.cindex "signal exit"
23479.cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
23480Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
23481a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
23482frozen in Exim's queue instead.
23483
23484
23485.option force_command pipe boolean false
23486.cindex "force command"
23487.cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
23488Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
23489the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
23490is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
23491useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
23492command. For example:
23493.code
23494command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
23495force_command
23496.endd
23497
23498Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
23499&%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
23500separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
23501
23502
23503.option ignore_status pipe boolean false
23504If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
23505run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
23506Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
23507from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
23508&%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
23509
23510&*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
23511See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
23512
23513
23514.option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
23515.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
23516If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
23517one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
23518and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
23519written to the main log.
23520
23521
23522.option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
23523If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
23524stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
23525the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
23526failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
23527option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
23528be set.
23529
23530
23531.option log_output pipe boolean false
23532If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
23533stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
23534the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
23535exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23536
23537
23538.option max_output pipe integer 20K
23539This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
23540standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
23541process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
23542catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
23543the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
23544&%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
23545exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
23546
23547
23548.option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
23549The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
23550The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
23551.code
23552message_prefix = \
23553 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
23554 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
23555.endd
23556.cindex "Cyrus"
23557.cindex "&%tmail%&"
23558.cindex "&""From""& line"
23559This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
23560However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
23561or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
23562setting
23563.code
23564message_prefix =
23565.endd
23566&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23567&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
23568
23569
23570.option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
23571The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
23572The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
23573The suffix can be suppressed by setting
23574.code
23575message_suffix =
23576.endd
23577&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23578&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
23579
23580
23581.option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
23582This option is expanded and
23583specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
23584variable of the subprocess.
23585If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
23586sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
23587apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
23588
23589
23590.option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
23591Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
23592a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
23593during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
23594It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
23595for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
23596resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
23597installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
23598of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
23599
23600
23601.option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
23602.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
23603If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
23604process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
23605to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
23606&%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
23607accept the message is used.
23608
23609
23610.option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
23611When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
23612contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
23613in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
23614command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
23615handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
23616
23617
23618.option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
23619If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
23620return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
23621is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
23622However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
23623message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
23624&%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23625
23626
23627
23628.option return_output pipe boolean false
23629If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
23630deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
23631is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
23632However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
23633output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
23634option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
23635of them may be set.
23636
23637
23638
23639.option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
23640.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
23641This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
23642asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
23643and &%return_output%& is not set,
23644and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
23645temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
23646numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
23647codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
23648defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
23649compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
23650and 73, respectively.
23651
23652
23653.option timeout pipe time 1h
23654If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
23655causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
23656specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
23657command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
23658and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
23659if one of the processes starts a new process group.
23660
23661.option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
23662A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
23663runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
23664treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
23665is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
23666delivery to be deferred.
23667
23668.option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
23669This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
23670
23671
23672.option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
23673.cindex "envelope sender"
23674If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
23675SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
23676commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
23677you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
23678&<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
23679
23680.option use_classresources pipe boolean false
23681.cindex "class resources (BSD)"
23682This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
23683BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
23684resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
23685limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
23686class database.
23687
23688
23689.option use_crlf pipe boolean false
23690.cindex "carriage return"
23691.cindex "linefeed"
23692This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
23693(carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
23694of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
23695of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
23696
23697The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
23698written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
23699are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
23700&%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
23701values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
23702
23703
23704.option use_shell pipe boolean false
23705.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23706If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
23707instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
23708&<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
23709where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
23710modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
23711&`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
23712command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
23713its &%-c%& option.
23714
23715
23716
23717.section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
23718.cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
23719.cindex "&'procmail'&"
23720.cindex "external local delivery"
23721.cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
23722.cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
23723The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
23724delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
23725this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
23726uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
23727by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
23728necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
23729appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
23730configuration for &%procmail%&:
23731.code
23732# transport
23733procmail_pipe:
23734 driver = pipe
23735 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
23736 return_path_add
23737 delivery_date_add
23738 envelope_to_add
23739 check_string = "From "
23740 escape_string = ">From "
23741 umask = 077
23742 user = $local_part
23743 group = mail
23744
23745# router
23746procmail:
23747 driver = accept
23748 check_local_user
23749 transport = procmail_pipe
23750.endd
23751In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
23752&'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
23753or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
23754user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
23755&%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
23756home directory is the user's home directory by default.
23757
23758&*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
23759.code
23760IFS=" "
23761.endd
23762as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
23763use a shell to run pipe commands.
23764
23765.cindex "Cyrus"
23766The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
23767deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
23768.code
23769# transport
23770local_delivery_cyrus:
23771 driver = pipe
23772 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
23773 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
23774 user = cyrus
23775 group = mail
23776 return_output
23777 log_output
23778 message_prefix =
23779 message_suffix =
23780
23781# router
23782local_user_cyrus:
23783 driver = accept
23784 check_local_user
23785 local_part_suffix = .*
23786 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
23787.endd
23788Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
23789&%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
23790sender.
23791.ecindex IIDpiptra1
23792.ecindex IIDpiptra2
23793
23794
23795. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23796. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23797
23798.chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
23799.scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
23800.scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
23801The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
23802or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
23803that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
23804explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
23805&<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
23806
23807
23808.section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
23809The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
23810two ways:
23811
23812.ilist
23813If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
23814routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
23815that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
23816the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
23817does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
23818value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
23819section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
23820.next
23821.cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
23822When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
23823looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
23824connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
23825for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
23826process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
23827process.
23828.endlist
23829
23830
23831For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
23832incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
23833no further messages are sent over that connection.
23834
23835
23836
23837.section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
23838.vindex "&$host$&"
23839.vindex "&$host_address$&"
23840At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
23841&$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
23842passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
23843specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
23844&$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
23845that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
23846&%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
23847
23848
23849.section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
23850.vindex &$tls_bits$&
23851.vindex &$tls_cipher$&
23852.vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
23853.vindex &$tls_sni$&
23854At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
23855&$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
23856are the values that were set when the message was received.
23857These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
23858SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
23859variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
23860appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
23861are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
23862&%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
23863
23864These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
23865and will be removed in a future release.
23866
23867
23868.section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
23869.cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
23870The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
23871
23872
23873.option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
23874.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
23875When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
23876is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
23877runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
23878reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
23879setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
23880problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
23881
23882.option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
23883.cindex "local host" "sending to"
23884.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23885When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
23886to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
23887deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
23888the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
23889configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
23890configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
23891
23892
23893.option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
23894.cindex "Cyrus"
23895When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
23896is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
23897overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
23898forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
23899to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
23900ignored.
23901
23902The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
23903started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
23904&$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
23905particular connection.
23906
23907If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
23908&%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
23909deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
23910unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
23911
23912This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
23913deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
23914&"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
23915.code
23916authenticated_sender = $local_part
23917.endd
23918This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
23919allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
23920
23921Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
23922domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
23923value.
23924
23925
23926.option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
23927If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
23928is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
23929authenticated as a client.
23930
23931
23932.option command_timeout smtp time 5m
23933This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
23934sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
23935remote host. Its value must not be zero.
23936
23937
23938.option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
23939This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
23940to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
23941several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
23942less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
23943systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
23944option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
23945
23946
23947.option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
23948.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
23949.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
23950.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23951This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
23952over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
23953For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
23954option.
23955
23956
23957.option dane_require_tls_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
23958.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers for DANE"
23959.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
23960.cindex DANE "TLS ciphers"
23961This option may be used to override &%tls_require_ciphers%& for connections
23962where DANE has been determined to be in effect.
23963If not set, then &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used.
23964Normal SMTP delivery is not able to make strong demands of TLS cipher
23965configuration, because delivery will fall back to plaintext. Once DANE has
23966been determined to be in effect, there is no plaintext fallback and making the
23967TLS cipherlist configuration stronger will increase security, rather than
23968counter-intuitively decreasing it.
23969If the option expands to be empty or is forced to fail, then it will
23970be treated as unset and &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used instead.
23971
23972
23973.option data_timeout smtp time 5m
23974This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
23975the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
23976of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
23977
23978
23979.option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
23980.option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
23981.option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
23982.option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
23983.option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
23984.option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
23985.option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
23986.option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
23987DKIM signing options. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
23988
23989
23990.option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
23991This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
23992domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
23993cutoff times.
23994
23995In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
23996them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
23997Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
23998retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
23999a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
24000unhappy at this prospect, so...
24001
24002If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24003addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
24004IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24005none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
24006delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
24007addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
24008continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
24009&%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
24010to them.
24011
24012
24013.option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
24014If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
24015and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
24016the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
24017in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
24018
24019
24020.option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
24021If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
24022&%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
24023See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
24024details.
24025
24026
24027.option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24028.cindex "MX record" "security"
24029.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24030.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24031.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24032DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
24033the dnssec request bit set.
24034This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
24035
24036
24037
24038.option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24039.cindex "MX record" "security"
24040.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24041.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24042.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24043DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
24044the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
24045(AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
24046This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
24047
24048
24049
24050.option dscp smtp string&!! unset
24051.cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
24052This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
24053of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
24054The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
24055Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
24056&`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
24057
24058The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
24059(for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
24060that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
24061equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
24062Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
24063
24064
24065.option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
24066.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24067String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
24068colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
24069port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
24070&<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24071item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24072in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
24073
24074Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
24075addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
24076&%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
24077not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
24078&%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
24079However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
24080
24081If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
24082the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
24083transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
24084address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
24085list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
24086
24087Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
24088re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
24089addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
24090copy of the message is sent.
24091
24092The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
24093&%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
24094both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
24095from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
24096fails"& facility.
24097
24098
24099.option final_timeout smtp time 10m
24100This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
24101line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
24102zero.
24103
24104.option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
24105If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
24106being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
24107(or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
24108instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
24109it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
24110
24111.option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
24112This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
24113server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
24114implementations of TLS.
24115
24116.option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
24117.cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
24118.cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
24119.cindex "LHLO argument setting"
24120The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
24121been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
24122command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
24123option is:
24124.code
24125$primary_hostname
24126.endd
24127During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
24128the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
24129&$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
24130used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
24131servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
24132that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
24133interface address, you could use this:
24134.code
24135helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
24136 {$primary_hostname}}
24137.endd
24138The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
24139callouts.
24140
24141.option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
24142Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
24143finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
24144&(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
24145email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
24146all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
24147
24148The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
24149processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
24150&%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
24151&%hosts_override%& is set.
24152
24153The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
24154list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
24155separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
24156&<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24157item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24158in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
24159of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
24160
24161If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
24162the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
24163well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
24164address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
24165&[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
24166&%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
24167that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
24168address are used.
24169
24170During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
24171unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
24172
24173
24174.option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24175.cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
24176.cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
24177.cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
24178.cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24179This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
24180example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
24181matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
24182start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
24183facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
24184
24185
24186.option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
24187.cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24188Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
24189that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
24190
24191
24192.option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24193.cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24194Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24195matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24196
24197.option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24198.cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24199Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
24200or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
24201to any host that matches this list.
24202
24203
24204.option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
24205.cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24206.cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
24207.cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
24208.cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
24209This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
24210delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
24211&<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
24212
24213
24214.option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
24215This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
24216tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
24217why it exists.
24218
24219
24220
24221.option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24222.cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24223.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24224.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24225For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
24226been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24227message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
24228explanation of when this might be needed.
24229
24230.option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" *
24231.cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24232.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24233.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24234For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
24235been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24236message on the same session.
24237
24238The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
24239process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
24240sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
24241instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
24242the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
24243The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
24244logging.
24245
24246
24247
24248.option hosts_override smtp boolean false
24249If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
24250attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
24251&%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
24252&%fallback_hosts%&.
24253
24254
24255.option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
24256.cindex "randomized host list"
24257.cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
24258.cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
24259If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
24260&%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
24261were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
24262router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
24263is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
24264list can be used to do crude load sharing.
24265
24266When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
24267order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
24268behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
24269&`+`& in the host list. For example:
24270.code
24271hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
24272.endd
24273The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
24274randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
24275If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
24276
24277.option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24278.cindex "authentication" "required by client"
24279This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
24280before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
24281servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
24282authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
24283temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
24284hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
24285&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24286
24287
24288.option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
24289.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24290Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
24291TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24292&%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24293
24294.option hosts_require_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
24295.cindex DANE "transport options"
24296.cindex DANE "requiring for certain servers"
24297If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
24298TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
24299and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made.
24300There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24301See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24302
24303.option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24304.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24305Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
24306TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24307&%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24308
24309.option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24310.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24311Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24312matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24313&*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
24314incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
24315
24316.option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24317.cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
24318This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24319authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
24320connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
24321unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
24322&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24323
24324.option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
24325.cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
24326.cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
24327.cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
24328This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24329CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
24330BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
24331
24332.option hosts_try_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
24333.cindex DANE "transport options"
24334.cindex DANE "attempting for certain servers"
24335If built with DANE support, Exim will lookup a
24336TLSA record for any host matching the list.
24337If found and verified by DNSSEC,
24338a DANE-verified TLS connection is made to that host;
24339there will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24340See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24341
24342.option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" unset
24343.cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
24344.cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
24345.cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
24346This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
24347the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
24348perform a TCP Fast Open.
24349No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
24350supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
24351the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
24352
24353The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
24354as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
24355
24356On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
24357in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
24358There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
24359it it is always enabled. Note that lengthy operations in the connect ACL,
24360such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
24361
24362.option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
24363.cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
24364This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24365PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
24366for multi-recipient messages.
24367The option can usually be left as default.
24368
24369.option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
24370.cindex "bind IP address"
24371.cindex "IP address" "binding"
24372.vindex "&$host$&"
24373.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24374This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
24375call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
24376&`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
24377message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
24378&$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
24379outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
24380interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
24381unknown.
24382
24383During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
24384&$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
24385during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
24386string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
24387string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
24388separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
24389.code
24390interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
24391.endd
24392The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
24393connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
24394&%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
24395interface to use if the host has more than one.
24396
24397
24398.option keepalive smtp boolean true
24399.cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
24400This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
24401connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
24402periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
24403of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
24404or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
24405that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
24406that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
24407TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
24408unreachable hosts.
24409
24410
24411.option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
24412.cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
24413If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
24414string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
24415has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
24416
24417.option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
24418.cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
24419This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
24420SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
24421so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
24422permits this.
24423
24424
24425.option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
24426.vindex "&$domain$&"
24427When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
24428addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
24429to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
24430handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
24431&$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
24432is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
24433
24434It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
24435&$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
24436&$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
24437
24438.option port smtp string&!! "see below"
24439.cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
24440.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
24441This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
24442&*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
24443received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
24444The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
24445variable that contains an outgoing port.
24446
24447If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
24448otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
24449normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
24450&"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
24451is deferred.
24452
24453
24454
24455.option protocol smtp string smtp
24456.cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
24457.cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
24458.cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
24459.vindex "&$port$&"
24460If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
24461the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
24462protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
24463deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
24464over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
24465
24466If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
24467changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
24468connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
24469The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
24470
24471
24472.option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
24473Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
24474constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
24475means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
24476tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
24477addresses is not affected.
24478
24479However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
24480each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
24481the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
24482Exim to use only the host name.
24483Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
24484
24485
24486.option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
24487.cindex "serializing connections"
24488.cindex "host" "serializing connections"
24489Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
24490host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
24491the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
24492slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
24493Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
24494&%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
24495
24496.cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
24497Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
24498written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
24499is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
24500records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
24501guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
24502
24503If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
24504relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
24505start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
24506may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
24507are used for ETRN serialization.
24508
24509See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
24510
24511
24512.option size_addition smtp integer 1024
24513.cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
24514.cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
24515.cindex "size" "of message"
24516.cindex "transport" "filter"
24517.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
24518If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
24519MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
24520an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
24521sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
24522configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
24523this if a lot of text is added to messages.
24524
24525Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
24526the use of the SIZE option altogether.
24527
24528
24529.option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
24530.cindex proxy SOCKS
24531This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
24532transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
24533
24534
24535.option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
24536.cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
24537.cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
24538.vindex "&$host$&"
24539.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24540The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24541client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
24542connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
24543address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
24544details of TLS.
24545
24546&*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
24547certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
24548name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
24549assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
24550client.
24551
24552
24553.option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
24554.cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
24555.cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
24556This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
24557be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
24558
24559
24560.option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
24561.cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
24562When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
24563key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
24564for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
24565If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
24566will fail.
24567
24568Only supported when using GnuTLS.
24569
24570
24571.option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
24572.cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
24573.vindex "&$host$&"
24574.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24575The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24576client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
24577connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
24578&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24579expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
24580result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
24581the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24582
24583
24584.option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24585.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
24586.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24587.vindex "&$host$&"
24588.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24589The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
24590when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
24591the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
24592&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24593expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
24594is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
24595&<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
24596ciphers is a preference order.
24597
24598
24599
24600.option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
24601.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
24602.vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
24603If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
24604TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
24605the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
24606certificate and private key for the session.
24607
24608See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
24609
24610Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
24611TLS extensions.
24612
24613
24614
24615
24616.option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
24617.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
24618When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
24619setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
24620to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
24621current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
24622option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
24623response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
24624TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
24625unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
24626in clear.
24627
24628
24629.option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
24630.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24631.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24632This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
24633certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
24634The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24635Note that unless the host is in this list
24636TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
24637when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
24638The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
24639certificate verification succeeds.
24640
24641
24642.option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
24643.cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
24644.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24645This option give a list of hosts for which,
24646while verifying the server certificate,
24647checks will be included on the host name
24648(note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
24649versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
24650limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
24651
24652There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
24653
24654
24655.option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
24656.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24657.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24658.vindex "&$host$&"
24659.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24660The value of this option must be either the
24661word "system"
24662or the absolute path to
24663a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
24664for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
24665
24666The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
24667This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
24668is taken as empty and an explicit location
24669must be specified.
24670
24671The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
24672preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
24673
24674With OpenSSL the certificates specified
24675explicitly
24676either by file or directory
24677are added to those given by the system default location.
24678
24679The values of &$host$& and
24680&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24681expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24682
24683For back-compatibility,
24684if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
24685(a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
24686and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
24687
24688
24689.option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
24690.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24691.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24692This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
24693certificate verification must succeed.
24694The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24695If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
24696operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
24697
24698
24699
24700
24701.section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
24702 "SECTvalhosmax"
24703.cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24704.cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
24705There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
24706tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
24707&%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
24708
24709
24710The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
24711for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
24712option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
24713multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
24714retrying.
24715
24716Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
24717multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
24718created as a result of routing one of these domains.
24719
24720Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
24721several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
24722problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
24723&%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
24724delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
24725
24726Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
24727arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
24728limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
24729some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
24730&%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
24731that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
24732see below for an exception).
24733
24734Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
24735list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
24736If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
24737but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
24738that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
24739
24740Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
24741higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
24742hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
24743which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
24744tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
24745reached their retry times.
24746
24747However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
24748large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
24749Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
24750of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
24751time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
24752without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
24753all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
24754there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
24755the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
24756every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
24757reached.
24758
24759The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
24760particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
24761out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
24762reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
24763been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
24764take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
24765
24766The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
24767Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
24768and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
24769possible IP addresses have been tried.
24770.ecindex IIDsmttra1
24771.ecindex IIDsmttra2
24772
24773
24774
24775
24776
24777. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24778. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24779
24780.chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
24781.scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
24782There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
24783addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
24784(referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
24785abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
24786
24787Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
24788messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
24789&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
24790appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
24791locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
24792unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
24793lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
24794
24795One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
24796when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
24797such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
24798do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
24799
24800
24801.section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
24802This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
24803main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
24804&%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
24805
24806Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
24807Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
24808facility; you do not have to use it.
24809
24810The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
24811configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
24812addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
24813address to which it applies.
24814
24815Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
24816the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
24817rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
24818those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
24819by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
24820are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
24821rules.
24822
24823Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
24824applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
24825well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
24826headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
24827
24828
24829In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
24830legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
24831in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
24832used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
24833Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
24834discouraged.
24835
24836There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
24837illustrated by these examples:
24838
24839.ilist
24840The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
24841exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
24842gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
24843&'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
24844.next
24845A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
24846&'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
24847.endlist
24848
24849
24850
24851.section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
24852.cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
24853.cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
24854Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
24855message's processing.
24856
24857.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24858At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
24859by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
24860ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
24861is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
24862rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
24863rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
24864RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
24865rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
24866
24867.vindex "&$domain$&"
24868.vindex "&$local_part$&"
24869Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
24870may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
24871rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
24872from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
24873for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
24874value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
24875as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
24876SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
24877
24878As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
24879recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
24880the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
24881any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
24882.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
24883before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
24884
24885When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
24886rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
24887redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
24888
24889.cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
24890.cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
24891.cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
24892At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
24893specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
24894This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
24895section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
24896header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
24897applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
24898
24899The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
24900transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
24901transport time.
24902
24903
24904
24905
24906.section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
24907.cindex "rewriting" "testing"
24908.cindex "testing" "rewriting"
24909Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
24910configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
24911&%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
249122822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
24913transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
24914appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
24915envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
24916.code
24917exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
24918.endd
24919might produce the output
24920.code
24921sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24922from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24923to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24924cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24925bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24926reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24927env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24928env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24929.endd
24930which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
24931the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
24932present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
24933set for a particular transport.
24934
24935
24936.section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
24937.cindex "rewriting" "rules"
24938The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
24939rules in the form
24940.display
24941<&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
24942.endd
24943Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
24944transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
24945takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
24946any colons must be doubled, of course).
24947
24948The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
24949Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
24950case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
24951characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
24952ignored.
24953
24954For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
24955order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
24956replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
24957
24958The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
24959releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
24960received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
24961lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
24962address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
24963(or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
24964that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
24965
24966.vindex "&$domain$&"
24967.vindex "&$local_part$&"
24968The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
24969string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
24970rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
24971.code
24972*@* ${lookup ...
24973.endd
24974where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
24975refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24976
24977
24978.section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
24979.cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
24980.cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
24981The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
24982address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
24983single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
24984against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
24985you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
24986facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
24987
24988Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
24989case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
24990can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
24991
24992.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
24993After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
24994depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
24995replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
24996refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
24997numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
24998of pattern they are set as follows:
24999
25000.ilist
25001If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
25002refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
25003the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
25004pattern
25005.code
25006*queen@*.fict.example
25007.endd
25008is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
25009.code
25010$0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
25011$1 = hearts-
25012$2 = wonderland
25013.endd
25014Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
25015does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
25016
25017.next
25018If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
25019of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
25020for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
25021rewriting rule of the form
25022.display
25023&`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
25024.endd
25025and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
25026.code
25027$1 = foo
25028$2 = bar
25029$3 = baz.example
25030.endd
25031If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
25032wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
25033&$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
25034partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
25035whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
25036.endlist
25037
25038
25039.section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
25040.cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
25041If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
25042match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
25043rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
25044.code
25045hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
25046.endd
25047specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
25048&'From:'& headers.
25049
25050.vindex "&$domain$&"
25051.vindex "&$local_part$&"
25052If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
25053yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
25054&$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25055Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
25056cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
25057matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
25058the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
25059current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
25060expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
25061entry written to the panic log.
25062
25063
25064
25065.section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
25066There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
25067
25068.ilist
25069Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
25070c, f, h, r, s, t.
25071.next
25072A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
25073.next
25074Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
25075.endlist
25076
25077For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
25078E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
25079
25080
25081
25082.section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
25083 "SECID154"
25084.cindex "rewriting" "flags"
25085If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
25086&<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
25087and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
25088transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
25089rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
25090.display
25091&`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
25092&`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
25093&`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
25094&`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
25095&`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
25096&`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
25097&`h`& rewrite all headers
25098&`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
25099&`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
25100&`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
25101.endd
25102"All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
25103individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
25104other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
25105
25106You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
25107restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
25108
25109
25110.section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
25111.cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
25112.cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
25113.cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
25114The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
25115SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
25116before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
25117required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
25118data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
25119
25120.vindex "&$domain$&"
25121.vindex "&$local_part$&"
25122This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
25123compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
25124input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
25125the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
25126expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
25127original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
25128
25129
25130.section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
25131There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
25132take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
25133correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
25134
25135.ilist
25136If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
25137unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
25138absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
25139.next
25140If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
25141even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
25142expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
25143(does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
25144.next
25145The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
25146address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
25147rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
25148.next
25149.cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
25150When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
25151to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
25152left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
25153.code
25154From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
25155.endd
25156into
25157.code
25158From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
25159.endd
25160.cindex "RFC 2047"
25161Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
25162done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
25163causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
25164replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
251652822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
25166brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
25167(except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
25168is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
25169
25170When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
25171rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
25172.endlist
25173
25174
25175.section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
25176Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
25177.code
25178*@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
25179*@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
25180 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
25181.endd
25182Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
25183the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
25184has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
25185consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
25186present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
25187explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
25188at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
25189error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
25190
25191The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
25192domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
25193.code
25194root@*.hitch.fict.example *
25195.endd
25196were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
25197local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
25198
25199Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
25200&${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
25201messages that originate outside the local host:
25202.code
25203*@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
25204 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
25205.endd
25206The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
25207space.
25208
25209.cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
25210.cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
25211Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
25212an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
25213the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
25214remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
25215sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
25216components. For example, the rule
25217.code
25218\N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
25219.endd
25220rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
25221&'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
25222a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
25223method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
25224to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
25225use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
25226can be done on the rewritten addresses.
25227.ecindex IIDaddrew
25228
25229
25230
25231
25232
25233. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25234. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25235
25236.chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
25237.scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
25238.scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
25239The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
25240retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
25241be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
25242empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
25243errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
25244general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
25245line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
25246address, domain and error.
25247
25248The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
25249host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
25250Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
25251address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
25252been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
25253tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
25254log selector is set, the message
25255.cindex "retry" "time not reached"
25256&"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
25257skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
25258the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
25259
25260Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
25261in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
25262actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
25263failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
25264the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
25265added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
25266same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
25267domain are maintained independently.
25268
25269When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
25270receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
25271always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
25272behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
25273quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
25274suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
25275subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
25276the local address is reached.
25277
25278.section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
25279If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
25280whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
25281files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
25282always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
25283
25284The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
25285rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
25286record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
25287timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
25288and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
25289messages that it should now be retaining.
25290
25291
25292
25293.section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
25294.cindex "retry" "rules"
25295Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
25296separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
25297addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
25298enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
25299in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
25300present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
25301message's sender, respectively.
25302
25303
25304The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
25305&<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
25306which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
25307has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
25308list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
25309which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
25310example,
25311.code
25312lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25313.endd
25314provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
25315whereas
25316.code
25317alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25318.endd
25319applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
25320In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
25321part.
25322
25323.cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
25324&*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
25325must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
25326expressions work in address lists.
25327.display
25328&`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
25329&`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
25330.endd
25331
25332
25333.section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
25334When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
25335example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
25336against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
25337router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
25338regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
25339A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
25340&"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
25341&%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
25342
25343Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
25344failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
25345configuration is tested against the complete address only if
25346&%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
25347local transports).
25348
25349.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
25350However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
25351suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
25352whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
25353rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
25354failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
25355recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
25356reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
25357&%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
25358lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
25359commands.
25360
25361
25362
25363.section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
25364 "SECID160"
25365For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
25366example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
25367twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
25368&"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
25369the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
25370suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
25371.code
25372a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
25373 MX 6 p.q.r.example
25374 MX 7 m.n.o.example
25375.endd
25376and the retry rules are
25377.code
25378p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
25379a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
25380.endd
25381and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
25382first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
25383rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
25384to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
25385tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
25386first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
25387
25388In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
25389first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
25390&'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
25391routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
25392
25393&*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
25394However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
25395host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
25396.code
25397route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
25398.endd
25399then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
25400textual form of the IP address.
25401
25402.section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
25403.cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
25404The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
25405asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
25406
25407.vlist
25408.vitem &%auth_failed%&
25409Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
25410&%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
25411
25412.vitem &%data_4xx%&
25413A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
25414after the command, or after sending the message's data.
25415
25416.vitem &%mail_4xx%&
25417A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
25418
25419.vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
25420A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
25421.endlist
25422
25423For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
25424as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
25425recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
25426and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
25427retry rule of this form:
25428.code
25429the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
25430.endd
25431These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
25432LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
25433
25434.vlist
25435.vitem &%lost_connection%&
25436A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
25437legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
25438for the same host, it indicates something odd.
25439
25440.vitem &%lookup%&
25441A DNS lookup for a host failed.
25442Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
25443its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
25444Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
25445its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
25446
25447.vitem &%refused_MX%&
25448A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
25449
25450.vitem &%refused_A%&
25451A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
25452
25453.vitem &%refused%&
25454A connection was refused.
25455
25456.vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
25457A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
25458
25459.vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
25460A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
25461
25462.vitem &%timeout_connect%&
25463A connection attempt timed out.
25464
25465.vitem &%timeout_MX%&
25466There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
25467obtained from an MX record.
25468
25469.vitem &%timeout_A%&
25470There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
25471obtained from an MX record.
25472
25473.vitem &%timeout%&
25474There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
25475
25476.vitem &%tls_required%&
25477The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
25478&(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
25479to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
25480
25481.vitem &%quota%&
25482A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25483transport.
25484
25485.vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
25486.cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
25487.cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
25488A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25489transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
25490&'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
25491for four days.
25492.endlist
25493
25494.cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
25495The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
25496timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
25497it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
25498However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
25499heuristic rules:
25500
25501.ilist
25502If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
25503used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
25504quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
25505.next
25506.cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
25507For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
25508subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
25509the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
25510change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
25511MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
25512time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
25513.next
25514For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
25515obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
25516.endlist
25517
25518The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
25519mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
25520when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
25521error).
25522
25523
25524
25525.section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
25526.cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
25527You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
25528specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
25529apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
25530form:
25531.display
25532&`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
25533.endd
25534The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
25535.code
25536* rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
25537.endd
25538matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
25539host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
25540For example:
25541.code
25542a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
25543.endd
25544&*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
25545(which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
25546only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
25547its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
25548all messages, not just those with specific senders.
25549
25550When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
25551&%-f%& command line option, like this:
25552.code
25553exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
25554.endd
25555If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
25556list is never matched.
25557
25558
25559
25560
25561
25562.section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
25563.cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
25564The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
25565sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
25566.display
25567<&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
25568.endd
25569The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
25570time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
25571arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
25572time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
25573relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
25574
25575.cindex "retry" "algorithms"
25576.cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
25577.cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
25578.cindex "retry" "random intervals"
25579The available algorithms are:
25580
25581.ilist
25582&'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
25583the interval.
25584.next
25585&'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
25586specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
25587is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
25588.next
25589&'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
25590retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
25591maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
25592the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
25593rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
25594members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
25595queue processing times.
25596.endlist
25597
25598When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
25599order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
25600used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
25601case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
25602current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
25603computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
25604interval is found. The main configuration variable
25605.cindex "limit" "retry interval"
25606.cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
25607.oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
25608&%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
25609cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
25610
25611A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
25612host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
25613basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
25614for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
25615generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
25616time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
25617time.
25618
25619.cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
25620Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
25621run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
25622starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
25623new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
25624If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
25625occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
25626messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
25627processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
25628your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
25629number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
25630sending everything to a smart host, for example).
25631
25632The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
25633&'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
25634&<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
25635&'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
25636are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
25637deliveries that have been deferred.
25638
25639
25640.section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
25641Here are some example retry rules:
25642.code
25643alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
25644wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
25645wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
25646lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25647* refused_A F,2h,20m;
25648* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
25649.endd
25650The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
25651&'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
25652mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
25653hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
25654parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
25655effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
25656fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
25657days.
25658
25659The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
25660happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
25661intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
25662first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
25663so on (this is a rather extreme example).
25664
25665The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
25666They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
25667all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
25668were not obtained from an MX record.
25669
25670The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
25671first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
25672not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
25673hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
256741.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
25675
25676
25677
25678.section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
25679.cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
25680.oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
25681.cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
25682.cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
25683Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
25684consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
25685set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
25686been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
25687arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
25688failing for the first time.
25689
25690This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
25691backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
25692Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
25693down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
25694
25695If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
25696every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
25697message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
25698
25699
25700
25701
25702.section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
25703.cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
25704.cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
25705Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
25706that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
25707default retry rule:
25708.code
25709* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
25710.endd
25711the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
25712long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
25713failure for the recipient address that counts.
25714
25715When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
25716addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
25717causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
25718In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
25719time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
25720
25721For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
25722messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
25723post-cutoff retry time is not used.
25724
25725If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
25726.oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
25727&%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
25728default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
25729reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
25730attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
25731those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
25732the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
25733
25734In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
25735for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
25736times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
25737behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
25738to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
25739notice.
25740
25741If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
25742addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
25743addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
25744no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
25745words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
25746addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
25747If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
25748&%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
25749deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
25750true.
25751
25752.section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
25753.cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
25754Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
25755intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
25756its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
25757because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
25758host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
25759failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
25760reached.
25761
25762Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
25763applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
25764Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
25765examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
25766commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
25767time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
25768is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
25769time out the address.
25770
25771The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
25772the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
25773given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
25774time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
25775not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
25776considered immediately.
25777.ecindex IIDretconf1
25778.ecindex IIDregconf2
25779
25780
25781
25782
25783
25784
25785. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25786. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25787
25788.chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
25789.scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
25790.scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
25791The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
25792with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
25793described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
25794to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
25795permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
25796transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
25797other.
25798
25799.cindex "AUTH" "description of"
25800Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
25801
25802.ilist
25803The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
25804the client's EHLO command.
25805.next
25806The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
25807may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
25808.next
25809The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
25810appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
25811just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
25812any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
25813with the AUTH command.
25814.next
25815The server either accepts or denies authentication.
25816.next
25817If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
25818option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
25819mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
25820connection.
25821.next
25822If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
25823authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
25824unauthenticated connection.
25825.endlist
25826
25827If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
25828mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
25829SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
25830includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
25831.display
25832&`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
25833&`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
25834&`Connected to server.example.`&
25835&`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
25836&`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
25837&*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
25838&`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
25839&`250-SIZE 52428800`&
25840&`250-PIPELINING`&
25841&`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
25842&`250 HELP`&
25843.endd
25844The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
25845authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
25846mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
25847routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
25848controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
25849included by setting
25850.code
25851AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
25852AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
25853AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
25854AUTH_GSASL=yes
25855AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
25856AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
25857AUTH_SPA=yes
25858AUTH_TLS=yes
25859.endd
25860in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
25861authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
25862the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
25863The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
25864work via a socket interface.
25865The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
25866provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
25867The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
25868supporting setting a server keytab.
25869The sixth can be configured to support
25870the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
25871not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
25872supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
25873The eighth is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
25874instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
25875
25876The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
25877section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
25878authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
25879authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
25880is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
25881messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
25882options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
25883
25884To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
25885&%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
25886either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
25887functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
25888to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
25889both sets of options, is required. For example:
25890.code
25891cram:
25892 driver = cram_md5
25893 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25894 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
25895 client_name = ph10
25896 client_secret = secret2
25897.endd
25898The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
25899&%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
25900
25901Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
25902The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
25903authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
25904in Exim.
25905
25906&*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
25907per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
25908account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
25909authenticating data.
25910
25911Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
25912&'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
25913and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
25914Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
25915used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
25916second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
25917user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
25918configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
25919&'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
25920as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
25921choose to honour.
25922
25923A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
25924to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
25925mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
25926typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
25927
25928
25929
25930.section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
25931.cindex "authentication" "generic options"
25932.cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
25933
25934.option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25935When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
25936&%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
25937used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
25938encrypted by a setting such as:
25939.code
25940client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
25941.endd
25942
25943
25944.option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25945When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
25946result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
25947Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
25948
25949
25950.option driver authenticators string unset
25951This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
25952authenticators is to be used.
25953
25954
25955.option public_name authenticators string unset
25956This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
25957implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
25958contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
25959but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
25960defaults to the driver's instance name.
25961
25962
25963.option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25964When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
25965is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
25966mechanism is not advertised.
25967If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
25968forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
25969See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
25970
25971
25972.option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25973This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
25974is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
25975for details.
25976
25977For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
25978mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
25979
25980For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
25981authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
25982authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
25983authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
25984to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
25985error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
25986string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25987expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
25988other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
25989the error text.
25990
25991
25992.option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
25993If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
25994command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
25995output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
25996out the values of variables.
25997If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
25998output, and Exim carries on processing.
25999
26000
26001.option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26002.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26003When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
26004expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
26005messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
26006lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
26007configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
26008refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
26009If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
26010
26011
26012.option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26013This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
26014as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
26015driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
26016as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
26017remembered for later use.
26018How it is used is described in the following section.
26019
26020
26021
26022
26023
26024.section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
26025.cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
26026.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26027When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
26028the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
26029message:
26030
26031.ilist
26032If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
26033than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
26034.next
26035If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
26036.next
26037.vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
26038If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
26039running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
26040from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
26041&$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
26042return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
26043given for the MAIL command.
26044.next
26045If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
26046is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
26047authenticated.
26048.next
26049If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
26050the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
26051&%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
26052valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
26053fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
26054&$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
26055the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
26056message.
26057.endlist
26058
26059
26060When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
26061hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
26062&$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
26063process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
26064
26065.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
26066Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
26067MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
26068therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
26069value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
26070ACL is run.
26071
26072
26073
26074.section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
26075.cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
26076When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
26077authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
26078conditions:
26079
26080.ilist
26081The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
26082.next
26083It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
26084yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
26085.endlist
26086
26087The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
26088the mechanisms are advertised.
26089
26090Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
26091provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
26092even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
26093set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
26094You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
26095For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
26096that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
26097.code
26098auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
26099.endd
26100so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
26101
26102The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
26103authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
26104advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
26105such as:
26106.code
26107server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
26108.endd
26109.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26110If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
26111yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
26112
26113When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
26114immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
26115command. This is the case if
26116
26117.ilist
26118The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
26119.next
26120No authenticators are configured with server options; or
26121.next
26122Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
26123server authenticators.
26124.endlist
26125
26126
26127Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
26128to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
26129AUTH is accepted from any client host.
26130
26131If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
26132server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
26133that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
26134the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
26135fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
26136rejected with a 504 error.
26137
26138.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
26139.vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
26140When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
26141&$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
26142or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
26143public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
26144client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
26145no successful authentication.
26146
26147.cindex authentication "expansion item"
26148Successful authentication sets up information used by the
26149&$authresults$& expansion item.
26150
26151
26152
26153
26154.section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
26155.cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
26156.cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
26157.cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
26158Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
26159configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
26160encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
26161script:
26162.code
26163use MIME::Base64;
26164printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
26165.endd
26166.cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
26167This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
26168interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
26169some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
26170command line to run this script on such data might be
26171.code
26172encode '\0user\0password'
26173.endd
26174Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
26175backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
26176whose code value is zero.
26177
26178&*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
26179digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
26180you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
26181interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
26182
26183&*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
26184specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
26185example, a command such as
26186.code
26187encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
26188.endd
26189gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
26190
26191If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
26192base64-encoded strings is to run the command
26193.code
26194echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
26195.endd
26196The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
26197in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
26198output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
26199should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
26200
26201
26202
26203.section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
26204.cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
26205The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
26206&%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
26207announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
26208of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
26209
26210.ilist
26211For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
26212they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
26213mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
26214of the authenticator.
26215.next
26216.vindex "&$host$&"
26217.vindex "&$host_address$&"
26218When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
26219variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
26220that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
26221any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
26222Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
26223delivery to be deferred.
26224.next
26225If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
26226Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
26227try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
26228usual way.
26229.next
26230If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
26231carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
26232possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
26233no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
26234what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
26235&%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
26236delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
26237turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
26238deliver the message unauthenticated.
26239.endlist
26240
26241Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
26242confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
26243upon and the time that the transport runs. For example, with a manualroute
26244router given a host name, and with DNS "round-robin" used by that name: if
26245the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
26246running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
26247check which does not match the connection peer IP.
26248No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
26249
26250For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
26251
26252.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26253When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
26254parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
26255the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
26256is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
26257incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
26258allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
26259to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
26260&%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
26261&%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
26262the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
26263.ecindex IIDauthconf1
26264.ecindex IIDauthconf2
26265
26266
26267
26268
26269
26270
26271. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26272. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26273
26274.chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
26275.scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
26276.scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
26277The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
26278LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
26279plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
26280security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
26281(see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
26282use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
26283connections as you do for login accounts.
26284
26285.section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
26286.cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
26287When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
26288
26289.option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26290This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
26291configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
26292
26293.option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
26294The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
26295prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
26296given.
26297
26298.section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
26299.cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26300.cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26301.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
26302 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26303.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26304.cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26305
26306When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
26307expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
26308response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
26309values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
26310a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
26311are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
26312(neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
26313
26314For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
26315the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
26316variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
26317string expansions that also use them for other things.
26318
26319If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
26320supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
26321data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
26322
26323.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26324Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
26325&%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
26326authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
26327to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
26328&"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26329expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
26330generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
26331For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
26332string as the error text
26333
26334&*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
26335password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
26336There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
26337
26338
26339
26340.section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
26341.cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
26342.cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
26343.cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26344The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
26345sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
26346separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
26347subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
26348
26349The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
26350Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
26351configured as follows:
26352.code
26353fixed_plain:
26354 driver = plaintext
26355 public_name = PLAIN
26356 server_prompts = :
26357 server_condition = \
26358 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
26359 server_set_id = $auth2
26360.endd
26361Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
26362are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
26363password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
26364or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
26365
26366The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
26367the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
26368AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
26369authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
26370.code
26371250-AUTH PLAIN
26372.endd
26373and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
26374.code
26375AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
26376.endd
26377As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
26378data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
26379.code
26380AUTH PLAIN
26381.endd
26382to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
26383prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
26384
26385The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
26386when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
26387represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
26388is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
26389second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
26390
26391Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
26392realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
26393authenticating clients it could make sense.
26394
26395A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
26396&$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
26397comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
26398this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
26399This is an incorrect example:
26400.code
26401server_condition = \
26402 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
26403.endd
26404The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
26405which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
26406incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
26407non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
26408strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
26409the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
26410name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
26411.code
26412server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
26413 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
26414.endd
26415In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
26416fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
26417used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
26418always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
26419writing the test makes the logic clearer.
26420
26421
26422.section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
26423.cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
26424.cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
26425The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
26426in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
26427user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
26428plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
26429.code
26430fixed_login:
26431 driver = plaintext
26432 public_name = LOGIN
26433 server_prompts = User Name : Password
26434 server_condition = \
26435 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
26436 server_set_id = $auth1
26437.endd
26438Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
26439with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
26440if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
26441strings are used to obtain two data items.
26442
26443Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
26444example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
26445&"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
26446strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
26447name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
26448.code
26449login:
26450 driver = plaintext
26451 public_name = LOGIN
26452 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
26453 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
26454 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
26455 ldapauth{\
26456 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
26457 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
26458 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
26459 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
26460.endd
26461We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
26462does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
26463operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
26464&%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
26465correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
26466the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
26467uninterpreted string.
26468
26469
26470.section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
26471A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
26472interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
26473traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
26474Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
26475&<<SECTexpcond>>&.
26476
26477
26478
26479
26480.section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
26481.cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
26482The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
26483
26484.option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
26485If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
26486authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
26487the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
26488usual.
26489
26490.option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
26491The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
26492string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
26493string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
26494to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
26495most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
26496with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
26497way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
26498(with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
26499so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
26500&%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
26501&$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
26502
26503&*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
26504splitting takes priority and happens first.
26505
26506Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
26507the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
26508there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
26509NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
26510the string.
26511
26512This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
26513authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
26514.code
26515fixed_plain:
26516 driver = plaintext
26517 public_name = PLAIN
26518 client_send = ^username^mysecret
26519.endd
26520The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
26521command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
26522that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
26523.code
26524fixed_login:
26525 driver = plaintext
26526 public_name = LOGIN
26527 client_send = : username : mysecret
26528.endd
26529The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
26530the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
26531prompts.
26532.ecindex IIDplaiauth1
26533.ecindex IIDplaiauth2
26534
26535
26536
26537
26538. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26539. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26540
26541.chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
26542.scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
26543.scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
26544.cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
26545.cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
26546The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
26547sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
26548name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
26549string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
26550is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
26551secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
26552available in plain text at either end.
26553
26554
26555.section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
26556.cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
26557This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
26558authenticator as a server:
26559
26560.option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26561.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
26562When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
26563the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
26564obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
26565that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
26566string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
26567fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
26568returned to the client.
26569
26570For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
26571in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
26572deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
26573numeric variables for other things.
26574
26575For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
26576client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
26577user name, authentication fails.
26578.code
26579fixed_cram:
26580 driver = cram_md5
26581 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26582 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
26583 server_set_id = $auth1
26584.endd
26585.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26586If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
26587name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
26588secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
26589.code
26590lookup_cram:
26591 driver = cram_md5
26592 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26593 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
26594 {$value}fail}
26595 server_set_id = $auth1
26596.endd
26597Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
26598because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
26599
26600As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
26601using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
26602lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
26603realm, with:
26604.code
26605cyrusless_crammd5:
26606 driver = cram_md5
26607 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26608 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
26609 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26610 server_set_id = $auth1
26611.endd
26612
26613.section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
26614.cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
26615When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
26616
26617
26618
26619.option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
26620This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
26621computing the response to the server's challenge.
26622
26623
26624.option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26625This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
26626expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
26627
26628
26629.vindex "&$host$&"
26630.vindex "&$host_address$&"
26631Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
26632to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
26633expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
26634prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
26635authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
26636send the message to the current server.
26637
26638A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
26639strings, is:
26640.code
26641fixed_cram:
26642 driver = cram_md5
26643 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26644 client_name = ph10
26645 client_secret = secret
26646.endd
26647.ecindex IIDcramauth1
26648.ecindex IIDcramauth2
26649
26650
26651
26652. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26653. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26654
26655.chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
26656.scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
26657.scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
26658.cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
26659.cindex "Kerberos"
26660The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
26661Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
26662
26663The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
26664library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
26665Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
26666including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
26667directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
26668
26669The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
26670the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
26671then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
26672name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
26673
26674Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
26675or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
26676user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
26677by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
26678depending on the driver you are using.
26679
26680The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
26681be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
26682Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
26683changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
26684layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
26685implementation.
26686
26687For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
26688may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
26689variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
26690Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
26691With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
26692environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
26693is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
26694the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
26695
26696
26697.section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
26698The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
26699(on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
26700previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
26701use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
26702confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
26703things.
26704
26705
26706.option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
26707This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26708library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
26709SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
26710
26711
26712.option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
26713This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26714default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26715you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26716example:
26717.code
26718sasl:
26719 driver = cyrus_sasl
26720 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26721 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26722 server_set_id = $auth1
26723.endd
26724
26725.option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
26726This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26727
26728
26729.option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
26730This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26731
26732
26733For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
26734private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
26735the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
26736PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
26737.code
26738sasl_cram_md5:
26739 driver = cyrus_sasl
26740 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26741 server_set_id = $auth1
26742
26743sasl_plain:
26744 driver = cyrus_sasl
26745 public_name = PLAIN
26746 server_set_id = $auth2
26747.endd
26748Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
26749not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
26750but it is present in many binary distributions.
26751.ecindex IIDcyrauth1
26752.ecindex IIDcyrauth2
26753
26754
26755
26756
26757. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26758. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26759.chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
26760.scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
26761.scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
26762This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
26763Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
26764Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
26765If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
26766to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
26767authenticator only. There is only one option:
26768
26769.option server_socket dovecot string unset
26770
26771This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
26772authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
26773mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
26774authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
26775.code
26776dovecot_plain:
26777 driver = dovecot
26778 public_name = PLAIN
26779 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
26780 server_set_id = $auth1
26781
26782dovecot_ntlm:
26783 driver = dovecot
26784 public_name = NTLM
26785 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
26786 server_set_id = $auth1
26787.endd
26788If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
26789&$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
26790option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
26791connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
26792option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
26793who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
26794.ecindex IIDdcotauth1
26795.ecindex IIDdcotauth2
26796
26797
26798. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26799. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26800.chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
26801.scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
26802.scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
26803.cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
26804.cindex "authentication" "SASL"
26805.cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26806.cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26807.cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
26808.cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
26809.cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
26810.cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
26811.cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
26812The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
26813library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
26814and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
26815scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
26816made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
26817without code changes in Exim.
26818
26819
26820.option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
26821Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
26822of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
26823authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
26824ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
26825context.
26826
26827This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
26828as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
26829see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
26830
26831This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
26832only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
26833writing, that's the SCRAM family.
26834
26835This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
26836this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
26837of Exim may switch the default to be true.
26838
26839
26840.option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
26841This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26842library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26843Some mechanisms will use this data.
26844
26845
26846.option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
26847This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26848default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26849you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26850example:
26851.code
26852sasl:
26853 driver = gsasl
26854 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26855 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26856 server_set_id = $auth1
26857.endd
26858
26859
26860.option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
26861Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
26862that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
26863the password itself.
26864
26865The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
26866In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
26867The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
26868if available, else the empty string.
26869The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
26870else the empty string.
26871
26872A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
26873
26874If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
26875option to be simply "true".
26876
26877
26878.option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
26879This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26880Some mechanisms will use this data.
26881
26882
26883.option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
26884This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26885&$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26886(This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26887
26888
26889.option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
26890This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26891&$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26892(This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26893
26894
26895.option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
26896This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26897Some mechanisms will use this data.
26898
26899
26900.section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
26901.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26902These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
26903They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
26904
26905Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
26906meanings for these variables:
26907
26908.ilist
26909.vindex "&$auth1$&"
26910&$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
26911.next
26912.vindex "&$auth2$&"
26913&$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
26914.next
26915.vindex "&$auth3$&"
26916&$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
26917.endlist
26918
26919On a per-mechanism basis:
26920
26921.ilist
26922.cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26923EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
26924the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26925.next
26926.cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26927ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
26928the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26929.next
26930.cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26931GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
26932&$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
26933the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26934.endlist
26935
26936An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
26937identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
26938email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
26939
26940
26941An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
26942and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
26943.code
26944gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
26945 driver = gsasl
26946 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26947 server_realm = imap.example.org
26948 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
26949 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26950 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
26951 server_condition = yes
26952.endd
26953
26954
26955. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26956. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26957
26958.chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
26959.scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
26960.scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
26961.cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26962.cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
26963The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
26964Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
26965reliably.
26966
26967.option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
26968This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
26969for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
26970identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26971
26972.option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
26973If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
26974&_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
26975The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
26976
26977.option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
26978This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
26979&%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
26980from the keytab.
26981
26982
26983.section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
26984Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
26985to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
26986not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
26987
26988The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
26989Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
26990Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
26991role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
26992
26993.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26994.ilist
26995.vindex "&$auth1$&"
26996&$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
26997.next
26998.vindex "&$auth2$&"
26999&$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
27000authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
27001GSS Display Name.
27002.endlist
27003
27004
27005. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27006. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27007
27008.chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
27009.scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
27010.scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
27011.cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
27012.cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
27013.cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
27014.cindex "NTLM authentication"
27015The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
27016Password Authentication'& mechanism,
27017which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
27018this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
27019taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
27020server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
27021follows:
27022
27023.ilist
27024After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
27025authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
27026.next
27027The server sends back a challenge.
27028.next
27029The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
27030and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
27031.endlist
27032
27033Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
27034
27035
27036
27037.section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
27038.cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
27039The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
27040
27041.option server_password spa string&!! unset
27042.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
27043This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
27044authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
27045compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
27046&$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
27047it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
27048for other things. For example:
27049.code
27050spa:
27051 driver = spa
27052 public_name = NTLM
27053 server_password = \
27054 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
27055.endd
27056If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27057failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27058
27059
27060
27061
27062
27063.section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
27064.cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
27065The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
27066
27067
27068
27069.option client_domain spa string&!! unset
27070This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
27071
27072
27073.option client_password spa string&!! unset
27074This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
27075
27076
27077.option client_username spa string&!! unset
27078This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
27079configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
27080&'msn.com'&:
27081.code
27082msn:
27083 driver = spa
27084 public_name = MSN
27085 client_username = msn/msn_username
27086 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
27087 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
27088.endd
27089.ecindex IIDspaauth1
27090.ecindex IIDspaauth2
27091
27092
27093
27094
27095
27096. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27097. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27098
27099.chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
27100.scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
27101.scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
27102.cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
27103.cindex "authentication" "X509"
27104.cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
27105The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
27106authentication based on client certificates.
27107
27108It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
27109advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
27110It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
27111the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
27112by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
27113the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
27114
27115The client must present a verifiable certificate,
27116for which it must have been requested via the
27117&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
27118(see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27119
27120If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
27121run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
27122and can authenticate the connection.
27123If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
27124
27125A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
27126
27127
27128.cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
27129The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
27130
27131.option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
27132.cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
27133This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
27134the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
27135If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27136failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27137
27138.option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
27139.option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
27140As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
27141
27142&%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
27143
27144
27145Example:
27146.code
27147tls:
27148 driver = tls
27149 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
27150 {$tls_in_peercert}}
27151 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth1} \
27152 {!= {0} \
27153 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
27154 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
27155 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
27156 } } } }
27157 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
27158.endd
27159This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
27160of your configured trust-anchors
27161(which usually means the full set of public CAs)
27162and which has a SAN with a good account name.
27163Note that the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
27164whereas a plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
27165
27166. An alternative might use
27167. .code
27168. server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
27169. .endd
27170. to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
27171. (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
27172. This would help for per-device use.
27173.
27174. However, for the future we really need support for checking a
27175. user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
27176
27177.ecindex IIDtlsauth1
27178.ecindex IIDtlsauth2
27179
27180
27181Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
27182the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
27183a connect- or helo-ACL.
27184
27185
27186
27187. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27188. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27189
27190.chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
27191 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
27192.scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
27193.scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
27194.cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
27195.cindex "OpenSSL"
27196.cindex "GnuTLS"
27197Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
27198Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
27199GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
27200cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
27201order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
27202version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
27203You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
27204level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
27205certificates are used.
27206
27207RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
27208connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
27209server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
27210mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
27211between them is encrypted.
27212
27213Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
27214and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
27215certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
27216possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
27217encryption state.
27218
27219&*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
27220disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
27221in order to get TLS to work.
27222
27223
27224
27225.section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
27226 "SECID284"
27227.cindex "submissions protocol"
27228.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
27229.cindex "smtps protocol"
27230.cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
27231.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
27232.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
27233The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
27234contentious. As of RFC 8314, the common practice of using the historically
27235allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
27236instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
27237by them in preference to STARTTLS.
27238
27239The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
27240clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
27241Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
27242
27243This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
27244standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
27245reassigned for other use.
27246Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
27247this port.
27248In practice, a number of mail-clients have only ever supported submissions,
27249not submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
27250Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
27251
27252Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
27253global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
27254the most common use is expected to be:
27255.code
27256tls_on_connect_ports = 465
27257.endd
27258The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
27259via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
27260the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
27261the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
27262an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
27263defined elsewhere.
27264
27265There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
27266&%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
27267
27268
27269
27270
27271
27272
27273.section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
27274.cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
27275The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
27276followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
27277to use GnuTLS, you need to set
27278.code
27279USE_GNUTLS=yes
27280.endd
27281in Local/Makefile, in addition to
27282.code
27283SUPPORT_TLS=yes
27284.endd
27285You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
27286include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
27287
27288There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
27289
27290.ilist
27291The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
27292cannot be the path of a directory
27293for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
27294(for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
27295.next
27296The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
27297.next
27298.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
27299.vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
27300Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
27301separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
27302affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
27303.next
27304OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
27305DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
27306RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
27307in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
27308for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
27309to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
27310&%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
27311option).
27312.next
27313The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
27314sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
27315.next
27316The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
27317When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
27318(If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
27319let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
27320.next
27321With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option
27322main option, it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
27323.next
27324Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
27325This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
27326explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
27327implementation, then patches are welcome.
27328.endlist
27329
27330
27331.section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
27332This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
27333an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
27334but not the chosen filename.
27335By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
27336See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
27337
27338GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
27339to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
27340Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
27341&_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
27342of bits requested.
27343The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
27344its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
27345parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
27346that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
27347renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
27348this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
27349place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
27350
27351For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
27352recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
27353If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
27354are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
27355not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
27356
27357Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
27358values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
27359parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
27360If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
27361until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
27362a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
27363
27364The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
27365in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
27366generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
27367
27368To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
27369and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
27370&(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
27371renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
27372.code
27373# ls
27374[ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
27375# rm -f new-params
27376# touch new-params
27377# chown exim:exim new-params
27378# chmod 0600 new-params
27379# certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
27380# openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
27381[ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
27382 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
27383 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
27384# chmod 0400 new-params
27385# mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
27386.endd
27387If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
27388stalling is removed.
27389
27390The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
27391Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
27392the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
27393a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
27394and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
27395failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
27396of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
27397which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
27398GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
27399to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
27400limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
27401
27402The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
27403value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
27404&%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
274052432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
27406
27407In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
27408increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
27409bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
27410procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
27411the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
27412
27413
27414.section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
27415.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
27416.oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
27417There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
27418suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
27419are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
27420DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
27421directly to this function call.
27422Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
27423&'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
27424The following quotation from the OpenSSL
27425documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
27426
27427.ilist
27428It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
27429.next
27430It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
27431or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
27432ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
27433SSL v3 algorithms.
27434.next
27435Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
27436the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
27437SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
27438algorithms.
27439.endlist
27440
27441Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
27442&`-`& or &`+`&.
27443.ilist
27444If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
27445ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
27446stated.
27447.next
27448If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
27449of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
27450.next
27451If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
27452option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
27453.endlist
27454
27455If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
27456a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
27457includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
27458not be moved to the end of the list.
27459.endlist
27460
27461The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
27462string:
27463.code
27464# note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
27465$ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
27466.endd
27467
27468This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
27469there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
27470submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
27471choice of clients used:
27472.code
27473# OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
27474tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
27475 {DEFAULT}\
27476 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
27477.endd
27478
27479This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
27480.code
27481tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
27482.endd
27483
27484
27485.section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
27486 "SECTreqciphgnu"
27487.cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
27488.cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
27489.cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
27490.cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
27491.cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
27492.cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
27493.oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
27494The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
27495as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
27496ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
27497
27498The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
27499and controls both protocols and ciphers.
27500
27501The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
27502controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
27503&(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
27504the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
27505the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
27506aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
27507
27508Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
27509"Priority strings". This is online as
27510&url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
27511but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
27512installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
27513then the example code
27514&url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
27515on that site can be used to test a given string.
27516
27517For example:
27518.code
27519# Disable older versions of protocols
27520tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
27521.endd
27522
27523Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
27524additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
27525"&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
27526
27527This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
27528there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
27529by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
27530where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
27531used:
27532.code
27533# GnuTLS variant
27534tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
27535 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
27536 {SECURE128}}
27537.endd
27538
27539
27540.section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
27541.cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
27542When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
27543the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
27544but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
27545that STARTTLS is always advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
27546this is reasonable for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
27547
27548If STARTTLS is to be used you
27549need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
27550
27551If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
27552problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
27553persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
27554with the error
27555.code
27556554 Security failure
27557.endd
27558If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
27559rejected with a 554 error code.
27560
27561To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
27562must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
27563
27564If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
27565meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
27566You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
27567from someone able to intercept the communication.
27568
27569Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
27570
27571To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
27572.code
27573tls_certificate = /some/file/name
27574tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
27575.endd
27576These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
27577the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
27578contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
27579that goes with it. These files need to be
27580PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
27581always be given as full path names.
27582The key must not be password-protected.
27583They can be the same file if both the
27584certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
27585set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
27586is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
27587certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
27588the server's certificate.
27589
27590For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
27591colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
27592algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
27593public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
27594client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
27595ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
27596
27597If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
27598source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
27599few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
27600
27601&*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
27602they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
27603Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
27604transport.
27605
27606With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
27607require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
27608this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
27609.code
27610tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
27611.endd
27612is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
27613with the parameters contained in the file.
27614Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
27615available:
27616.code
27617tls_dhparam = none
27618.endd
27619This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
27620DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
27621used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
27622documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
27623
27624See the command
27625.code
27626openssl dhparam
27627.endd
27628for a way of generating file data.
27629
27630The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
27631host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
27632for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
27633in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
27634forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
27635
27636.cindex "cipher" "logging"
27637.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
27638.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
27639The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
27640an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
27641incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
27642also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
27643&"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
27644condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
27645
27646Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
27647can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
27648cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
27649example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
27650contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
27651documentation for more details.
27652
27653For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
27654(again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
27655
27656
27657.section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
27658.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
27659.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
27660If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
27661session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
27662&%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
27663apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
27664Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
27665contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
27666expected certificates.
27667These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
27668an explicit file or,
27669depending on library version, a directory, identified by
27670&%tls_verify_certificates%&.
27671
27672A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
27673directory is used
27674(OpenSSL only),
27675each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
27676of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
27677certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
27678.code
27679openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
27680.endd
27681where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
27682
27683The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
27684what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
27685does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
27686&%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
27687attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
27688dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
27689session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
27690fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
27691example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
27692relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
27693
27694.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
27695When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
27696the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
27697&$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
27698
27699.cindex "log" "distinguished name"
27700Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
27701&'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
27702&"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
27703&%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
27704certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
27705
27706
27707.section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
27708.cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
27709.cindex "revocation list"
27710.cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
27711.cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
27712Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
27713certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
27714server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
27715an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
27716of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
27717CRL in PEM format.
27718The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
27719file from every certificate authority they know of.
27720
27721The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
27722Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
27723against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
27724usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
27725private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
27726is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
27727
27728The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
27729comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
27730connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
27731re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
27732
27733The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
27734issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
27735the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
27736negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
27737CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
27738resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
27739starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
27740proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
27741
27742Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
27743or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
27744support for OCSP stapling is included.
27745
27746There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
27747The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
27748an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
27749option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
27750contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
27751
27752Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
27753proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
27754Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
27755contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
27756on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
27757next connection.
27758
27759When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
27760in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
27761ignored.
27762
27763For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
27764also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
27765certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
27766of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
27767intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
27768file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
27769
27770Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
27771not any of the chain from CA to it.
27772
27773There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
27774
27775.code
27776 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
27777 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
27778 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
27779
27780 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
27781 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
27782 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
27783.endd
27784
27785
27786
27787
27788.section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
27789.cindex "cipher" "logging"
27790.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
27791.cindex "log" "distinguished name"
27792.cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
27793The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
27794deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
27795server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
27796within the &(smtp)& transport.
27797
27798It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
27799transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
27800server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
27801this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
27802transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
27803
27804If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
27805to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
27806&%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
27807those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
27808set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
27809usual way.
27810
27811When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
27812the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
27813a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
27814session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
27815&%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
27816delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
27817it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
27818STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
27819negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
27820unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
27821unencrypted.
27822
27823The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
27824transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
27825if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
27826&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
27827
27828If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
27829specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
27830These may be
27831the system default set (depending on library version),
27832a file,
27833or (depending on library version) a directory.
27834The client verifies the server's certificate
27835against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
27836in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
27837Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
27838&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
27839
27840The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
27841certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
27842or need not succeed respectively.
27843
27844The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
27845&%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
27846is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
27847value is empty.
27848&%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
27849a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
27850value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
27851otherwise.
27852
27853The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
27854&%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
27855for OCSP to be relevant.
27856
27857If
27858&%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
27859list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
27860the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
27861alternative hosts, if any.
27862
27863 &*Note*&:
27864These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
27865is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
27866by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
27867client.
27868
27869.vindex "&$host$&"
27870.vindex "&$host_address$&"
27871All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
27872&$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
27873which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
27874behave as if the relevant option were unset.
27875
27876.vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
27877.vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
27878.vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
27879.vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
27880Before an SMTP connection is established, the
27881&$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
27882variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
27883that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
27884successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
27885outgoing connection.
27886
27887
27888
27889.section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
27890.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
27891.vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
27892.oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
27893With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
27894information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
27895extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
27896&"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
27897client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
27898within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
27899for this session.
27900
27901This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
27902which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
27903address.
27904
27905With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
27906against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
27907provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
27908be of limited use in that environment.
27909
27910With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
27911connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
27912choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
27913wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
27914different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
27915
27916The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
27917if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
27918nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
27919only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
27920for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
27921
27922Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
27923received from a client.
27924It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
27925
27926If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
27927option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
27928during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
27929
27930.ilist
27931&%tls_certificate%&
27932.next
27933&%tls_crl%&
27934.next
27935&%tls_privatekey%&
27936.next
27937&%tls_verify_certificates%&
27938.next
27939&%tls_ocsp_file%&
27940.endlist
27941
27942Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
27943attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
27944can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
27945arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
27946Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI is arrived, so
27947an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
27948when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
27949
27950The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
27951are re-expanded.
27952
27953When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
27954for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
27955enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
27956see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
27957
27958When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
279590.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
27960built, then you have SNI support).
27961
27962
27963
27964.section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
27965 "SECTmulmessam"
27966.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
27967.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
27968Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
27969an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
27970one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
27971of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
27972connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
27973to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
27974starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
27975unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
27976
27977An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
27978&%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
27979this list the proxy process described above is not used; instead Exim
27980shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
27981before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
27982try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
27983if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
27984
27985The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
27986after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
27987just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
27988reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
27989successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
27990SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
27991should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
27992subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
27993and delay other deliveries to that host.
27994
27995To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
27996closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
27997closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
27998information is recorded.
27999
28000There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
28001&(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
28002connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
28003
28004
28005
28006
28007.section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
28008.cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
28009In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
28010certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
28011place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
28012myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
28013to Apache, currently at
28014.display
28015&url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
28016.endd
28017Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
28018links to further files.
28019Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
280200-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
28021Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
28022.display
28023&url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
28024.endd
28025
28026
28027.section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
28028The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
28029certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
28030sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
28031not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
28032First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
28033certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
28034intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
28035certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
28036The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
28037validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
28038root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
28039install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
28040
28041Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
28042even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
28043server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
28044diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
28045
28046
28047
28048.section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
28049.cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
28050You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
28051with OpenSSL, like this:
28052. ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
28053. ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
28054.code
28055openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
28056 -days 9999 -nodes
28057.endd
28058&_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
28059delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
28060specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
28061important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
28062that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
28063prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
28064this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
28065
28066. ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
28067. ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
28068. ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
28069. ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
28070. ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
28071. ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
28072. ==== -pdp, 2012
28073NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
28074epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
28075the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
28076the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
28077of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
28078writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
28079progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
28080be a sensible resolution).
28081
28082A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
28083may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
28084encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
28085
28086However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
28087user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
28088certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
28089must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
28090authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
28091signed with that self-signed certificate.
28092
28093For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
28094user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
28095Open-source PKI book, available online at
28096&url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
28097.ecindex IIDencsmtp1
28098.ecindex IIDencsmtp2
28099
28100
28101
28102.section DANE "SECDANE"
28103.cindex DANE
28104DNS-based Authentication of Named Entities, as applied to SMTP over TLS, provides assurance to a client that
28105it is actually talking to the server it wants to rather than some attacker operating a Man In The Middle (MITM)
28106operation. The latter can terminate the TLS connection you make, and make another one to the server (so both
28107you and the server still think you have an encrypted connection) and, if one of the "well known" set of
28108Certificate Authorities has been suborned - something which *has* been seen already (2014), a verifiable
28109certificate (if you're using normal root CAs, eg. the Mozilla set, as your trust anchors).
28110
28111What DANE does is replace the CAs with the DNS as the trust anchor. The assurance is limited to a) the possibility
28112that the DNS has been suborned, b) mistakes made by the admins of the target server. The attack surface presented
28113by (a) is thought to be smaller than that of the set of root CAs.
28114
28115It also allows the server to declare (implicitly) that connections to it should use TLS. An MITM could simply
28116fail to pass on a server's STARTTLS.
28117
28118DANE scales better than having to maintain (and side-channel communicate) copies of server certificates
28119for every possible target server. It also scales (slightly) better than having to maintain on an SMTP
28120client a copy of the standard CAs bundle. It also means not having to pay a CA for certificates.
28121
28122DANE requires a server operator to do three things: 1) run DNSSEC. This provides assurance to clients
28123that DNS lookups they do for the server have not been tampered with. The domain MX record applying
28124to this server, its A record, its TLSA record and any associated CNAME records must all be covered by
28125DNSSEC.
281262) add TLSA DNS records. These say what the server certificate for a TLS connection should be.
281273) offer a server certificate, or certificate chain, in TLS connections which is is anchored by one of the TLSA records.
28128
28129There are no changes to Exim specific to server-side operation of DANE.
28130Support for client-side operation of DANE can be included at compile time by defining SUPPORT_DANE=yes
28131in &_Local/Makefile_&.
28132If it has been included, the macro "_HAVE_DANE" will be defined.
28133
28134The TLSA record for the server may have "certificate usage" of DANE-TA(2) or DANE-EE(3). The latter specifies
28135the End Entity directly, i.e. the certificate involved is that of the server (and should be the sole one transmitted
28136during the TLS handshake); this is appropriate for a single system, using a self-signed certificate.
28137DANE-TA usage is effectively declaring a specific CA to be used; this might be a private CA or a public,
28138well-known one. A private CA at simplest is just a self-signed certificate which is used to sign
28139cerver certificates, but running one securely does require careful arrangement. If a private CA is used
28140then either all clients must be primed with it, or (probably simpler) the server TLS handshake must transmit
28141the entire certificate chain from CA to server-certificate. If a public CA is used then all clients must be primed with it
28142(losing one advantage of DANE) - but the attack surface is reduced from all public CAs to that single CA.
28143DANE-TA is commonly used for several services and/or servers, each having a TLSA query-domain CNAME record,
28144all of which point to a single TLSA record.
28145
28146Another approach which should be seriously considered is to use DANE with a certificate
28147from a public CA, because of another technology, "MTA-STS", described below.
28148
28149The TLSA record should have a Selector field of SPKI(1) and a Matching Type field of SHA2-512(2).
28150
28151At the time of writing, &url(https://www.huque.com/bin/gen_tlsa)
28152is useful for quickly generating TLSA records; and commands like
28153
28154.code
28155 openssl x509 -in -pubkey -noout <certificate.pem \
28156 | openssl rsa -outform der -pubin 2>/dev/null \
28157 | openssl sha512 \
28158 | awk '{print $2}'
28159.endd
28160
28161are workable for 4th-field hashes.
28162
28163For use with the DANE-TA model, server certificates must have a correct name (SubjectName or SubjectAltName).
28164
28165The use of OCSP-stapling should be considered, allowing for fast revocation of certificates (which would otherwise
28166be limited by the DNS TTL on the TLSA records). However, this is likely to only be usable with DANE-TA. NOTE: the
28167default of requesting OCSP for all hosts is modified iff DANE is in use, to:
28168
28169.code
28170 hosts_request_ocsp = ${if or { {= {0}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} \
28171 {= {4}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} } \
28172 {*}{}}
28173.endd
28174
28175The (new) variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& is a bitfield with numbered bits set for TLSA record usage codes.
28176The zero above means DANE was not in use, the four means that only DANE-TA usage TLSA records were
28177found. If the definition of &%hosts_request_ocsp%& includes the
28178string "tls_out_tlsa_usage", they are re-expanded in time to
28179control the OCSP request.
28180
28181This modification of hosts_request_ocsp is only done if it has the default value of "*". Admins who change it, and
28182those who use &%hosts_require_ocsp%&, should consider the interaction with DANE in their OCSP settings.
28183
28184
28185For client-side DANE there are three new smtp transport options, &%hosts_try_dane%&, &%hosts_require_dane%&
28186and &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%&.
28187The require variant will result in failure if the target host is not DNSSEC-secured.
28188
28189DANE will only be usable if the target host has DNSSEC-secured MX, A and TLSA records.
28190
28191A TLSA lookup will be done if either of the above options match and the host-lookup succeeded using dnssec.
28192If a TLSA lookup is done and succeeds, a DANE-verified TLS connection
28193will be required for the host. If it does not, the host will not
28194be used; there is no fallback to non-DANE or non-TLS.
28195
28196If DANE is requested and usable, then the TLS cipher list configuration
28197prefers to use the option &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%& and falls
28198back to &%tls_require_ciphers%& only if that is unset.
28199This lets you configure "decent crypto" for DANE and "better than nothing
28200crypto" as the default. Note though that while GnuTLS lets the string control
28201which versions of TLS/SSL will be negotiated, OpenSSL does not and you're
28202limited to ciphersuite constraints.
28203
28204If DANE is requested and useable (see above) the following transport options are ignored:
28205.code
28206 hosts_require_tls
28207 tls_verify_hosts
28208 tls_try_verify_hosts
28209 tls_verify_certificates
28210 tls_crl
28211 tls_verify_cert_hostnames
28212.endd
28213
28214If DANE is not usable, whether requested or not, and CA-anchored
28215verification evaluation is wanted, the above variables should be set appropriately.
28216
28217Currently the &%dnssec_request_domains%& must be active and &%dnssec_require_domains%& is ignored.
28218
28219If verification was successful using DANE then the "CV" item in the delivery log line will show as "CV=dane".
28220
28221There is a new variable &$tls_out_dane$& which will have "yes" if
28222verification succeeded using DANE and "no" otherwise (only useful
28223in combination with events; see &<<CHAPevents>>&),
28224and a new variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& (detailed above).
28225
28226.cindex DANE reporting
28227An event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "dane:fail" will be raised on failures
28228to achieve DANE-verified connection, if one was either requested and offered, or
28229required. This is intended to support TLS-reporting as defined in
28230&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-uta-smtp-tlsrpt-17).
28231The &$event_data$& will be one of the Result Types defined in
28232Section 4.3 of that document.
28233
28234Under GnuTLS, DANE is only supported from version 3.0.0 onwards.
28235
28236DANE is specified in published RFCs and decouples certificate authority trust
28237selection from a "race to the bottom" of "you must trust everything for mail
28238to get through". There is an alternative technology called MTA-STS, which
28239instead publishes MX trust anchor information on an HTTPS website. At the
28240time this text was last updated, MTA-STS was still a draft, not yet an RFC.
28241Exim has no support for MTA-STS as a client, but Exim mail server operators
28242can choose to publish information describing their TLS configuration using
28243MTA-STS to let those clients who do use that protocol derive trust
28244information.
28245
28246The MTA-STS design requires a certificate from a public Certificate Authority
28247which is recognized by clients sending to you. That selection is outside your
28248control.
28249
28250The most interoperable course of action is probably to use
28251&url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt), with automated certificate
28252renewal; to publish the anchor information in DNSSEC-secured DNS via TLSA
28253records for DANE clients (such as Exim and Postfix) and to publish anchor
28254information for MTA-STS as well. This is what is done for the &'exim.org'&
28255domain itself (with caveats around occasionally broken MTA-STS because of
28256incompatible specification changes prior to reaching RFC status).
28257
28258
28259
28260. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28261. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28262
28263.chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
28264.scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
28265.cindex "control of incoming mail"
28266.cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
28267.cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
28268Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
28269configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
28270name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
28271one very small ACL:
28272.code
28273begin acl
28274small_acl:
28275 accept hosts = one.host.only
28276.endd
28277You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
28278which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
28279
28280The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
28281certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
28282when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
28283option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
28284in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
28285local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
28286a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
28287&<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
28288
28289
28290.section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
28291The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
28292configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
28293
28294
28295.section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
28296.cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
28297In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
28298options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
28299.cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
28300.cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
28301.cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
28302.cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
28303.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
28304.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
28305.cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
28306.cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
28307.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
28308.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
28309.cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
28310.cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
28311.cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
28312.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
28313.cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
28314.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
28315
28316.table2 140pt
28317.irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
28318.irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
28319.irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
28320.irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
28321.irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
28322.irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
28323.irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
28324.irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
28325.irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
28326.irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
28327.irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
28328.irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
28329.irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
28330.irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
28331.irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
28332.irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
28333.irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
28334.irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
28335.irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
28336.irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
28337.endtable
28338
28339For example, if you set
28340.code
28341acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
28342.endd
28343the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
28344in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
28345done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
28346sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
28347command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
28348trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
28349testing as possible at RCPT time.
28350
28351
28352.section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
28353.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
28354The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
28355apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
28356really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
28357the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
28358relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
28359are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
28360&$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
28361&$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
28362in any of these ACLs.
28363
28364The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
28365non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
28366analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
28367batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
28368result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
28369really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
28370on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
28371controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
28372.code
28373control = suppress_local_fixups
28374.endd
28375This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
28376run, it is too late.
28377
28378The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28379content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28380
28381The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
28382kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
28383temporary error for these kinds of message.
28384
28385
28386.section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
28387.cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
28388.oindex &%smtp_banner%&
28389The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
28390session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
28391an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
28392accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
28393the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
28394&%smtp_banner%& option.
28395
28396
28397.section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
28398.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
28399.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
28400The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
28401EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
28402&%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
28403Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
28404session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
28405setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
28406
28407Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
28408mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
28409&$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
28410
28411If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
28412modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
28413at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
28414affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
28415an EHLO response.
28416
28417
28418.section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
28419.cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
28420Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
28421command, with two responses being sent to the client.
28422When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
28423is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
28424the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
28425response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
28426added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
28427are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
28428
28429You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
28430in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
28431tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
28432received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
28433the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
28434associated with the DATA command.
28435
28436.cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
28437.cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
28438.cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
28439If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
28440the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
28441. XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
28442The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
28443the data specified is received.
28444
28445For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
28446error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
28447MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
28448before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
28449and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
28450your resources.
28451
28452The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
28453the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
28454the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
28455and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
28456
28457.section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
28458The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
28459enabled (which is the default).
28460
28461The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
28462received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
28463otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
28464
28465This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28466
28467For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
28468
28469
28470.section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
28471The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28472content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28473
28474This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28475
28476
28477.section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
28478.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
28479.oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
28480The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
28481with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
28482It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
28483client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
28484has been accepted.
28485
28486The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
28487has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
28488with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
28489The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
28490The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
28491can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
28492for some or all recipients.
28493
28494PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
28495one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
28496content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
28497.cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
28498for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
28499is &"yes"&.
28500Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
28501ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
28502will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
28503
28504See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
28505and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
28506
28507This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28508If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
28509the feature was not requested by the client.
28510
28511.section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
28512.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
28513The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
28514does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
28515does not in fact control any access.
28516For this reason, it may only accept
28517or warn as its final result.
28518
28519This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
28520session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
28521messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
28522more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
28523
28524&*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
28525the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
28526
28527You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
28528&%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
28529response to QUIT.
28530
28531This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
28532failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
28533because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
28534client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
28535connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
28536
28537
28538.section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
28539.vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
28540The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
28541an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
28542trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
28543because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
28544situation even worse.
28545
28546Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
28547logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
28548modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
28549and &%warn%&.
28550
28551.vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
28552When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
28553to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
28554connection. The possible values are:
28555.table2
28556.irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
28557.irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
28558.irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
28559.irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
28560.irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
28561.irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
28562.irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
28563.irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
28564.irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
28565.irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
28566.endtable
28567In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
28568Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
28569With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
28570overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
28571&%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
28572used.
28573
28574
28575.section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
28576.cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
28577The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
28578you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
28579.code
28580acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
28581 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
28582.endd
28583In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
28584providing an RFC 4409 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and
28585an RFC 8314 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
28586expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
28587more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
28588
28589The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
28590configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
28591string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
28592
28593.ilist
28594If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
28595contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
28596Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
28597lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
28598If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
28599causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
28600.code
28601acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
28602 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
28603 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
28604.endd
28605This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
28606back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
28607file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
28608can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
28609.next
28610If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
28611Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
28612matches the string.
28613.next
28614If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
28615the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
28616want to have something like
28617.code
28618acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
28619.endd
28620in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
28621newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
28622.endlist
28623
28624
28625
28626
28627.section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
28628.cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
28629Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
28630section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
28631&"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
28632database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
28633return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
28634&"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
28635This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
28636
28637For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
28638&"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
28639submitters of non-SMTP messages.
28640
28641
28642ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
28643has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
28644individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
28645blackholing facility. Use it with care.
28646
28647If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
28648ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
28649RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
28650recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
28651run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
28652remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
28653&%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
28654
28655If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
28656is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
28657
28658
28659.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
28660The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
28661recipients; it may create new recipients.
28662
28663
28664
28665.section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
28666.cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
28667The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
28668all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
28669not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
28670reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
28671
28672For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
28673these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
28674used to accept or reject anything.
28675
28676For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
28677&%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
28678&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
28679when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
28680
28681For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
28682&%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
28683This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
28684messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
28685configuration file.
28686
28687
28688
28689
28690.section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
28691.cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
28692.vindex &$domain$&
28693.vindex &$local_part$&
28694.vindex &$sender_address$&
28695.vindex &$sender_host_address$&
28696.vindex &$smtp_command$&
28697When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
28698that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
28699&$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
28700statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
28701&$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
28702is available in &$smtp_command$&.
28703
28704When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
28705contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
28706set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
28707how it is used.
28708
28709.vindex "&$message_size$&"
28710The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
28711the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
28712that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
28713the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
28714received).
28715
28716.vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
28717.vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
28718The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
28719The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
28720accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
28721of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
28722&$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
28723&$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
28724
28725
28726
28727
28728
28729.section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
28730.cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
28731.vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
28732.vindex &$smtp_command$&
28733When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
28734the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
28735and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
28736These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
28737here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
28738encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
28739does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
28740unencrypted connections.
28741.code
28742acl_check_auth:
28743 accept encrypted = *
28744 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
28745 {CRAM-MD5}}
28746 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
28747.endd
28748(Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
28749that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
28750encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
28751option to do this.)
28752
28753
28754
28755.section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
28756.cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
28757.cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
28758An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
28759with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
28760Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
28761set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
28762
28763If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
28764used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
28765provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
28766example:
28767.code
28768deny dnslists = list1.example
28769 dnslists = list2.example
28770.endd
28771If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
28772the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
28773happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
28774all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
28775test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
28776
28777
28778.section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
28779The ACL verbs are as follows:
28780
28781.ilist
28782.cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
28783&%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
28784of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
28785appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
28786is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
28787after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
28788check a RCPT command:
28789.code
28790accept domains = +local_domains
28791 endpass
28792 verify = recipient
28793.endd
28794If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
28795passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
28796the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
28797fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
28798&%endpass%&.
28799
28800The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
28801use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
28802that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
28803configuration.
28804
28805.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
28806If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
28807depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
28808(when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
28809statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
28810SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
28811.display
28812&`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
28813&` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
28814.endd
28815You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
28816response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
28817same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
28818
28819If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
28820an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
28821for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
28822of &%endpass%&.
28823
28824
28825.next
28826.cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
28827&%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
28828an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
28829&%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
28830temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
28831&(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
28832be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
28833
28834
28835.next
28836.cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
28837&%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
28838the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
28839example,
28840.code
28841deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28842.endd
28843rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
28844
28845
28846.next
28847.cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
28848&%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
28849&"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
28850that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
28851the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
28852recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
28853recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
28854message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
28855do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
28856
28857If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
28858its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
28859The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
28860
28861
28862.next
28863.cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
28864&%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
28865forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
28866.code
28867drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
28868 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
28869.endd
28870There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
28871The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
28872
28873.next
28874.cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
28875&%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
28876statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
28877example, when checking a RCPT command,
28878.code
28879require message = Sender did not verify
28880 verify = sender
28881.endd
28882passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
28883verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
28884&%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
28885discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
28886
28887.next
28888.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
28889&%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
28890&%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
28891to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
28892written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
28893message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
28894duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
28895
28896If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
28897and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
28898&%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
28899first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
28900&<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
28901
28902If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
28903some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
28904This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
28905is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
28906conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
28907is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
28908onwards.
28909
28910
28911.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28912When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
28913text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
28914want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
28915.code
28916warn !verify = sender
28917 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
28918.endd
28919.endlist
28920
28921At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
28922
28923As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
28924written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
28925subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
28926continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
28927mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
28928
28929
28930
28931.section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
28932.cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
28933There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
28934can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
28935of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
28936transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
28937variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
28938an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
28939alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
28940the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
28941.ilist
28942The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
28943throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
28944while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
28945on the same SMTP connection.
28946.next
28947The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
28948while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
28949reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
28950.endlist
28951
28952When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
28953preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
28954time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
28955.code
28956accept hosts = whatever
28957 set acl_m4 = some value
28958accept authenticated = *
28959 set acl_c_auth = yes
28960.endd
28961&*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
28962be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
28963&%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
28964
28965.oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
28966What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
28967referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
28968false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
28969error is generated.
28970
28971Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
28972their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
28973
28974
28975.section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
28976.cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
28977.cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
28978An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
28979.code
28980deny domains = *.dom.example
28981 !verify = recipient
28982.endd
28983causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
28984&'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
28985negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
28986two statements are equivalent:
28987.code
28988deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
28989deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
28990.endd
28991However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
28992side negation of the whole condition is possible.
28993
28994The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
28995of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
28996condition is true. Consider these two statements:
28997.code
28998accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
28999 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
29000accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
29001 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
29002.endd
29003Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
29004the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
29005different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
29006condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
29007therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
29008the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
29009and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
29010
29011ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
29012specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
29013others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
29014warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
29015message is handled.
29016
29017The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
29018processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
29019modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
29020consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
29021.code
29022require message = Can't verify sender
29023 verify = sender
29024 message = Can't verify recipient
29025 verify = recipient
29026 message = This message cannot be used
29027.endd
29028If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
29029&"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
29030so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
29031recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
29032verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
29033because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
29034
29035For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
29036modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
29037happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
29038the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
29039.code
29040deny hosts = ...
29041 !senders = *@my.domain.example
29042 message = Invalid sender from client host
29043.endd
29044The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
29045by which time Exim has set up the message.
29046
29047
29048
29049.section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
29050.cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
29051The ACL modifiers are as follows:
29052
29053.vlist
29054.vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29055This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
29056incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
29057accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
29058
29059.vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29060.cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
29061.cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
29062This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
29063continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
29064the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
29065update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
29066write rather ugly lines like this:
29067.display
29068&`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
29069.endd
29070Instead, all you need is
29071.display
29072&`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
29073.endd
29074
29075.vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29076.cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
29077This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
29078incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
29079lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
29080lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
29081controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
29082even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
29083
29084As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
29085separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
29086in several different ways. For example:
29087
29088. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
29089. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
29090. ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
29091. ==== way.
29092
29093.ilist
29094It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
29095.code
29096 accept ...some conditions
29097 control = queue_only
29098.endd
29099In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
29100other words, when the conditions are all true.
29101
29102.next
29103It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
29104.code
29105 accept ...some conditions...
29106 control = queue_only
29107 ...some more conditions...
29108.endd
29109If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
29110statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
29111In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
29112to be relevant.
29113
29114.next
29115It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
29116decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
29117example:
29118.code
29119 warn ...some conditions...
29120 control = freeze
29121 accept ...
29122.endd
29123This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
29124&%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
29125log entry.
29126
29127.next
29128If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
29129&%require%& verb. For example:
29130.code
29131 require control = no_multiline_responses
29132.endd
29133.endlist
29134
29135.vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
29136.cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
29137.oindex "&%-bh%&"
29138This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
29139the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
29140&%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
29141output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
29142happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
29143output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
29144
29145Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
29146example:
29147.code
29148deny ...some conditions...
29149 delay = 30s
29150.endd
29151The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
29152&"deny"&. Compare this with:
29153.code
29154deny delay = 30s
29155 ...some conditions...
29156.endd
29157which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
29158can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
29159.code
29160warn ...some conditions...
29161 delay = 2m
29162 control = freeze
29163accept ...
29164.endd
29165
29166If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
29167responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
29168they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
29169delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
29170appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
29171unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
29172using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
29173
29174
29175.vitem &*endpass*&
29176.cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
29177This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
29178&%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
29179failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
29180failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
29181confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
29182&"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
29183
29184
29185.vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29186.cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
29187This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
29188ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
29189.code
29190require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
29191 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
29192.endd
29193&%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
29194example:
29195.display
29196&`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
29197&` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
29198.endd
29199When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
29200that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
29201recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
29202message.
29203
29204The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
29205the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
29206denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
29207available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
29208variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
29209&%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
29210ignored.
29211
29212.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29213If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
29214verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
29215error message.
29216
29217If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
29218the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
29219more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
29220actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
29221of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
29222is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
29223
29224If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
29225example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
29226the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
29227logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
29228both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
29229logging rejections.
29230
29231
29232.vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
29233.cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
29234.cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
29235This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
29236about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
29237be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
29238may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
29239ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
29240.display
29241&`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
29242&` log_reject_target =`&
29243.endd
29244This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
29245permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
29246current ACL.
29247
29248
29249.vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29250.cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
29251.cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
29252This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
29253processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
29254&%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
29255access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
29256ACLs. For example:
29257.display
29258&`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
29259&` control = freeze`&
29260&` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
29261.endd
29262By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
29263with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
29264another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
29265example:
29266.code
29267logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
29268logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
29269.endd
29270
29271
29272.vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29273.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
29274This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
29275message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
29276or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
29277there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
29278&%accept%& for details.)
29279
29280The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
29281to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
29282generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
29283&%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
29284the &%hosts%& condition fails:
29285.code
29286require message = Host not recognized
29287 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
29288.endd
29289(Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
29290processed.)
29291
29292.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
29293.oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
29294For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
29295of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
29296is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
29297is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
29298overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
29299accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
29300truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
29301EHLO options.
29302
29303When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
29304consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
29305of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
29306.code
29307deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
29308 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
29309.endd
29310The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
29311by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
29312access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
293132&'xx'&.
29314
29315Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
29316the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
29317
29318The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
29319literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
29320anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
29321response.
29322
29323.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29324For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
29325stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
29326
29327If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
29328specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
29329However, the original message is available in the variable
29330&$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
29331wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
29332routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
29333use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
29334
29335For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
29336is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
29337modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
29338all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
29339&%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
29340&%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
29341effect.
29342
29343
29344.vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29345.cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
29346.cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
29347This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
29348for the message.
29349It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
29350the DATA ACL).
29351This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
29352of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
29353Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
29354If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
29355
29356
29357.vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29358This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
29359 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
29360the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
29361
29362
29363.vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
29364.cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
29365This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
29366&<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
29367
29368
29369.vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
29370.cindex "UDP communications"
29371This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
29372collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
29373the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
29374of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
29375server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
29376separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
29377example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
29378when:
29379.code
29380udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
29381 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
29382.endd
29383.endlist
29384
29385
29386
29387
29388.section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
29389.cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
29390The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
29391
29392.vlist
29393.vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
29394This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
29395has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
29396apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
29397HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
29398really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
29399not work without it. For example:
29400.code
29401warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
29402 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
29403.endd
29404Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
29405the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
29406matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
29407mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
29408by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
29409
29410
29411.vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
29412 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
29413.cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
29414.cindex "case of local parts"
29415.vindex "&$local_part$&"
29416These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
29417(that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
29418are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
29419any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
29420for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
29421is encountered.
29422
29423These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
29424local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
29425in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
29426handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
29427configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
29428
29429This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
29430containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
29431spam score:
29432.code
29433warn control = caseful_local_part
29434 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
29435 $acl_m4 + \
29436 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
29437 }
29438 control = caselower_local_part
29439.endd
29440Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
29441is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
29442
29443
29444.vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
29445.cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
29446.cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
29447This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
29448
29449The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
29450If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
29451and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
29452is used for all recipients of the message,
29453then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
29454and data is copied from one to the other.
29455
29456An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
29457for a mail will be quietly ignored.
29458If a recipient-verify callout
29459(with use_sender)
29460connection is subsequently
29461requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
29462any subsequent recipients and the data,
29463otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
29464
29465Note that routers are used in verify mode,
29466and cannot depend on content of received headers.
29467Note also that headers cannot be
29468modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
29469Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
29470The &'Received-By:'& header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
29471rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
29472this will affect the timestamp.
29473
29474All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
29475rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
29476the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
29477Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
29478message body.
29479
29480Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
29481of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
29482before the entire message has been received from the source.
29483It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
29484or CHUNKING
29485options in use.
29486
29487Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
29488a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
29489If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
29490the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
29491before the acceptance "<=" line.
29492
29493If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
29494usual fashion.
29495This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
29496to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
29497&"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
29498and does not queue the message.
29499Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
29500
29501Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
29502(possibly faked)
29503sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
29504
29505
29506.vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
29507.cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
29508.cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
29509This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
29510with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
29511by default called &'debuglog'&.
29512The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
29513may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
29514the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
29515option.
29516Logging started this way may be stopped, and the file removed,
29517with the &'kill'& option.
29518Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
29519contexts):
29520.code
29521 control = debug
29522 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
29523 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
29524 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
29525 control = debug/kill
29526.endd
29527
29528
29529.vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
29530.cindex "disable DKIM verify"
29531.cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
29532This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
29533the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
29534
29535
29536.vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
29537.cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
29538.cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
29539This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
29540connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
29541strings or to numeric value.
29542The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
29543Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
29544&`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
29545
29546The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
29547(for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
29548that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
29549equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
29550Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
29551
29552
29553.vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
29554 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
29555.cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
29556.cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
29557These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
29558is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
29559state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
29560in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
29561
29562The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
29563connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
29564messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
29565&%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
29566before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
29567synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
29568work with.
29569
29570
29571.vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
29572.cindex "fake defer"
29573.cindex "defer, fake"
29574This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
29575except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
29576550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
29577messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
29578use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
29579
29580.vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
29581.cindex "fake rejection"
29582.cindex "rejection, fake"
29583This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
29584words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
29585message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
29586However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
29587only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
29588the same SMTP connection.
29589
29590The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
29591message is supplied, the following is used:
29592.code
29593550-Your message has been rejected but is being
29594550-kept for evaluation.
29595550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
29596550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
29597.endd
29598This facility should be used with extreme caution.
29599
29600.vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
29601.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
29602This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
29603other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
29604it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
29605current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
29606SMTP connection.
29607
29608This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
29609&%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
29610is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
29611are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
29612
29613.vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
29614.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
29615Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
29616avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
29617use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
29618disables such output flushing.
29619
29620.vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
29621.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
29622Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
29623avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
29624use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
29625that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
29626
29627.vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
29628This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
29629extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
29630of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
29631or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
29632needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
29633only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
29634the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
29635to be useful in production.
29636
29637.vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
29638.cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
29639This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
29640It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
29641SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
29642
29643If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
29644suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
29645one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
29646(&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
29647responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
29648sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
29649
29650.ilist
29651Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
29652sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
29653verification failed"&) is sent.
29654.next
29655If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
29656line is output.
29657.endlist
29658
29659The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
29660calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
29661
29662.vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
29663.cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
29664This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
29665the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
29666response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
29667controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
29668&%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
29669
29670.vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
29671.oindex "&%queue_only%&"
29672.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
29673This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
29674other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
29675it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
29676runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
29677effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
29678to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
29679same SMTP connection.
29680
29681.vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
29682.cindex "message" "submission"
29683.cindex "submission mode"
29684This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
29685latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
29686the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
29687operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
29688necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
29689This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
29690late (the message has already been created).
29691
29692Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
29693messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
29694submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
29695The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
29696that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
29697
29698.vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
29699.cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
29700This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
29701complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
29702normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
29703
29704.ilist
29705Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
29706dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
29707.next
29708No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
29709.next
29710There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
29711.endlist ilist
29712
29713This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
29714passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
29715used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
29716and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
29717data is read.
29718
29719&*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
29720that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
29721
29722.vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
29723This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
29724to a-label form.
29725For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
29726.endlist vlist
29727
29728
29729.section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
29730All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
29731
29732.ilist
29733Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
29734.next
29735Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
29736&`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
29737.next
29738Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
29739.next
29740Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
29741.endlist
29742
29743
29744
29745.section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
29746.cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
29747.cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
29748.cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
29749The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
29750to an incoming message, as in this example:
29751.code
29752warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29753 dialup.mail-abuse.org
29754 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
29755.endd
29756The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
29757MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
29758receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
29759&%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
29760any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
29761RCPT ACL).
29762
29763Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
29764DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
29765
29766Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
29767the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
29768contains one or more newlines that
29769are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
29770lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
29771front of any line that is not a valid header line.
29772
29773Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
29774They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
29775However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
29776is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
29777during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
29778with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
29779lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
29780In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
29781non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
29782message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
29783are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
29784
29785.cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
29786Header lines are not visible in string expansions
29787of message headers
29788until they are added to the
29789message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
29790ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
29791header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
29792ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
29793passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
29794this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
29795&<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
29796
29797The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
29798
29799The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
29800processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
29801.display
29802&`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
29803&` `&<&'some condition'&>
29804
29805&`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
29806&` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
29807.endd
29808In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
29809condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
29810condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
29811ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
29812honoured.
29813
29814.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
29815For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
29816&%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
29817effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
29818them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
29819usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
29820are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
29821specifications.
29822
29823By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
29824header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
29825be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
29826after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
29827that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
29828
29829This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
29830&":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
29831header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
29832to be a header name first.) For example:
29833.code
29834warn add_header = \
29835 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
29836.endd
29837If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
29838each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
29839you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
29840up in reverse order.
29841
29842&*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
29843added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
29844system filter or in a router or transport.
29845
29846
29847
29848.section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
29849.cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
29850.cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
29851.cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
29852The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
29853from an incoming message, as in this example:
29854.code
29855warn message = Remove internal headers
29856 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
29857.endd
29858The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
29859MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
29860receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
29861&%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
29862with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
29863any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
29864
29865Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
29866DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
29867
29868More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
29869list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
29870not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
29871create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
29872are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
29873.code
29874warn hosts = +internal_hosts
29875 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
29876warn message = Remove internal headers
29877 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
29878.endd
29879Removed header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
29880They are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
29881There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor is removing
29882a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
29883during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
29884if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
29885accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
29886all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
29887ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
29888would have been removed.
29889
29890.cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
29891Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
29892is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
29893not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
29894removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
29895this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
29896passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
29897you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
29898&<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
29899
29900The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
29901processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
29902.display
29903&`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
29904&` `&<&'some condition'&>
29905
29906&`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
29907&` remove_header = X-Internal`&
29908.endd
29909In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
29910condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
29911condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
29912same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
29913are honoured.
29914
29915&*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
29916present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
29917in a system filter or in a router or transport.
29918
29919
29920
29921
29922.section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
29923.cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
29924Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
29925compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
29926for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
29927content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29928
29929Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
29930senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
29931result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
29932done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
29933can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
29934same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
29935The conditions are as follows:
29936
29937
29938.vlist
29939.vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
29940.cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
29941.cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
29942.cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
29943.cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
29944The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
29945&%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
29946&"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
29947false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
29948condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
29949condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
29950ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
29951
29952If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
29953can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
29954and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
29955Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
29956The name and values are expanded separately.
29957Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
29958will act as argument separators.
29959
29960If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
29961the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
29962&%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
29963conditions are tested.
29964
29965ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
29966loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
29967circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
29968for different local users or different local domains.
29969
29970.vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
29971.cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
29972.cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
29973.cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
29974If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
29975the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
29976authentication by any authenticator, you can set
29977.code
29978authenticated = *
29979.endd
29980
29981.vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
29982.cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
29983.cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
29984.cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
29985.cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
29986This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
29987expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
29988&"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
29989number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
29990any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
29991&"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
29992ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
29993negative.
29994
29995.vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
29996.cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
29997This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29998content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
29999&%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
30000If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
30001problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
30002chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30003
30004.vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
30005.cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
30006.cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
30007.cindex "black list (DNS)"
30008.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
30009This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
30010&"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
30011use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
30012different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
30013&<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
30014
30015.vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
30016.cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
30017.cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
30018.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
30019.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
30020This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
30021of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
30022enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
30023lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
30024&%domains%& test.
30025
30026&*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
30027use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
30028
30029
30030.vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
30031.cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
30032.cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
30033.cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
30034If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
30035name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
30036encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
30037.code
30038encrypted = *
30039.endd
30040
30041
30042.vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
30043.cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
30044.cindex "host" "ACL checking"
30045.cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
30046This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
30047name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
30048you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
30049.code
30050accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
30051.endd
30052The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
30053the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
30054and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
30055
30056The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
30057Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
30058but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
30059find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
30060opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
30061found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
30062
30063If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
30064address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
30065.code
30066accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
30067accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
30068.endd
30069The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
30070is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
30071statement can then check the IP address.
30072
30073.vindex "&$host_data$&"
30074If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
30075of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
30076allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
30077.code
30078deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
30079message = $host_data
30080.endd
30081which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
30082
30083.vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
30084.cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
30085.cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
30086.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
30087.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
30088This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
30089part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
30090enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
30091result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
30092the next &%local_parts%& test.
30093
30094.vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
30095.cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
30096.cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
30097.cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
30098This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30099content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
30100viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30101
30102.vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30103.cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
30104.cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30105This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30106content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
30107&%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
30108with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
30109&<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30110
30111.vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
30112.cindex "rate limiting"
30113This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
30114messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
30115
30116.vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
30117.cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
30118.cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
30119.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
30120This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
30121recipient address against a list of recipients.
30122
30123.vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30124.cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
30125.cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30126This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30127content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
30128non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
30129any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30130
30131.vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
30132.cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
30133.cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
30134.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
30135.vindex "&$domain$&"
30136.vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
30137This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
30138domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
30139&$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
30140of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
30141lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
30142RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
30143influence the sender checking.
30144
30145&*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
30146relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
30147
30148.vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
30149.cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
30150.cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
30151.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
30152This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
30153for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
30154.code
30155senders = :
30156.endd
30157&*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
30158relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
30159
30160.vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
30161.cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
30162.cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
30163This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30164content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
30165SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30166
30167.vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
30168.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30169.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
30170.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
30171.cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
30172.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
30173This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
30174certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
30175server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
30176or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
30177
30178.vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
30179.cindex "CSA verification"
30180This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
30181send email. Details of how this works are given in section
30182&<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
30183
30184.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
30185.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30186.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
30187.cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
30188.cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
30189This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30190received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30191&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
30192there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
30193allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
30194
30195Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
30196problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
30197detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
30198
30199.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
30200.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30201.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
30202.cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
30203.cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
30204.cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
30205This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30206received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30207&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
30208of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
30209is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
30210However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
30211that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
30212to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
30213might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
30214
30215Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
30216section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
30217&<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
30218condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
30219.code
30220deny senders = :
30221 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
30222 !verify = header_sender
30223.endd
30224
30225.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
30226.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30227.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
30228.cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
30229.cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
30230This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30231received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30232&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
30233lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
30234and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
30235Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
30236permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
30237&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
30238appropriate.
30239
30240Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
30241ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
30242.code
30243To: @
30244.endd
30245and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
30246common as they used to be.
30247
30248.vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
30249.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30250.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
30251.cindex "HELO" "verifying"
30252.cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
30253.cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
30254.cindex "verifying" "HELO"
30255This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
30256client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
30257attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
30258condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
30259&%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
30260independently of this condition.
30261
30262For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
30263option), this condition is always true.
30264
30265
30266.vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
30267.cindex "verifying" "not blind"
30268.cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
30269This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
30270Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
30271&'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
30272case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
30273&'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
30274used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
30275
30276There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
30277recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
30278
30279
30280.vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
30281.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30282.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
30283.cindex "recipient" "verifying"
30284.cindex "verifying" "recipient"
30285.vindex "&$address_data$&"
30286This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
30287recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
30288&<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
30289of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
30290This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
30291verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
30292address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
30293value for the child address.
30294
30295.vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
30296.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30297.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
30298.cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
30299This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
30300address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
30301was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
30302Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
30303one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
30304original IP address.
30305
30306There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
30307DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
30308
30309If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
30310is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
30311
30312.vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
30313.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30314.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
30315.cindex "sender" "verifying"
30316.cindex "verifying" "sender"
30317This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
30318message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
30319the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
30320condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
30321
30322.vindex "&$address_data$&"
30323.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
30324If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
30325value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
30326value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
30327statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
30328want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
30329
30330Details of verification are given later, starting at section
30331&<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
30332to avoid doing it more than once per message.
30333
30334.vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
30335.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30336This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
30337verified as a sender.
30338
30339Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
30340(eg. is generated from the received message)
30341they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
30342.code
30343verify = sender=${sg{${address:$h_sender:}}{/}{//}}
30344.endd
30345.endlist
30346
30347
30348
30349.section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
30350.cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
30351.cindex "black list (DNS)"
30352.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
30353In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
30354is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
30355address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
30356domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
30357special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
30358address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
30359.code
30360deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
30361 dialups.mail-abuse.org
30362.endd
30363the following records are looked up:
30364.code
3036543.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
3036643.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
30367.endd
30368As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
30369Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
30370to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
30371use two separate conditions:
30372.code
30373deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30374 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
30375.endd
30376If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
30377behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
30378record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
30379processed.
30380
30381This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
30382(which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
30383blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
30384following special items in the list:
30385.display
30386&`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
30387&`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
30388&`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
30389.endd
30390.cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
30391.cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
30392.cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
30393Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
30394.code
30395deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
30396.endd
30397Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
30398warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
30399.code
30400deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30401warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
30402 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
30403.endd
30404.cindex caching "of dns lookup"
30405.cindex DNS TTL
30406DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
30407(but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
30408so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
30409connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
30410Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
30411connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
30412
30413
30414
30415.section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
30416.cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
30417By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
30418of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
30419after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
30420.code
30421deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
30422.endd
30423This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
30424use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
30425MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
30426&<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
30427
30428
30429
30430
30431.section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
30432.cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
30433There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
30434addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
30435&url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
30436with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
30437listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
30438.code
30439deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
30440 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
30441.endd
30442This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
30443RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
30444example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
30445up by this example is
30446.code
30447tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
30448.endd
30449A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
30450addresses. For example:
30451.code
30452deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30453 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
30454.endd
30455The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
30456name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
30457
30458
30459
30460
30461.section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
30462.cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
30463The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
30464names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
30465name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
30466As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
30467this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
30468either to double the separators like this:
30469.code
30470dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
30471.endd
30472or to change the separator character, like this:
30473.code
30474dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
30475.endd
30476If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
30477blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
30478occurs. Consider this condition:
30479.code
30480dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
30481.endd
30482The DNS lookups that occur are:
30483.code
304842.1.168.192.black.list.tld
30485a.domain.black.list.tld
30486.endd
30487Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
30488address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
30489are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
30490or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
30491only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
30492successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
30493error for a previous item.
30494
30495The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
30496syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
30497.code
30498dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
30499dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
30500.endd
30501However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
30502is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
30503.code
30504deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
30505 $sender_address_domain \
30506 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
30507 see $dnslist_text.
30508 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
30509 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
30510 $sender_address_domain} }} }
30511.endd
30512Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
30513multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
30514and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
30515of expanding the condition might be something like this:
30516.code
30517dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
30518.endd
30519Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
30520domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
30521
30522The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
30523&$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
30524
30525
30526
30527
30528.section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
30529.cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
30530DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
30531just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
30532RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
30533The values used on the RBL+ list are:
30534.display
30535127.1.0.1 RBL
30536127.1.0.2 DUL
30537127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
30538127.1.0.4 RSS
30539127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
30540127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
30541127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
30542.endd
30543Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
30544different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
30545see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
30546
30547
30548.section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
30549.cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
30550.cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
30551.vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
30552.vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
30553.vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
30554.vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
30555When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
30556the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
30557&`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
30558(for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
30559the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
30560&$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
30561cases, for example:
30562.code
30563deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
30564.endd
30565the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
30566&$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
30567For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
30568might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
30569.code
30570deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
30571.endd
30572If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
30573&`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
30574
30575If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
30576addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
30577The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
30578record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
30579very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
30580information.
30581
30582You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
30583&-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
30584expanded until after it has failed. For example:
30585.code
30586deny hosts = !+local_networks
30587 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
30588 at $dnslist_domain
30589 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
30590.endd
30591
30592
30593
30594.section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
30595.cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
30596You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
30597in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
30598For example,
30599.code
30600deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
30601.endd
30602rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
30603any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
30604that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
30605describes how multiple records are handled.
30606
30607More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
30608separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
30609&%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
30610.code
30611deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30612.endd
30613If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
30614addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
30615first. For example:
30616.code
30617deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
30618 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
30619.endd
30620
30621If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
30622listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
30623In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
30624true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
30625tested. For example:
30626.code
30627dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
30628.endd
30629matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
30630want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
30631being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
30632.code
30633dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
30634.endd
30635matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
30636an odd number.
30637
30638
30639
30640.section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
30641You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
30642condition. Whereas
30643.code
30644deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30645.endd
30646means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
30647IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
30648.code
30649deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30650.endd
30651means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
30652IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
30653words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
30654the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
30655
30656&*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
30657host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
30658
30659If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
30660previous example is precisely equivalent to
30661.code
30662deny dnslists = a.b.c
30663 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30664.endd
30665However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
30666Consider this example:
30667.code
30668deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30669 list.dsbl.org : \
30670 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
30671 relays.ordb.org
30672.endd
30673Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
30674.code
30675deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30676 list.dsbl.org
30677deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
30678 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
30679deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
30680.endd
30681which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
30682
30683
30684
30685
30686.section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
30687A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
30688thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
30689is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
30690the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
30691the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
30692.code
30693dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
30694.endd
30695What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
30696127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
30697condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
30698because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
30699affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
30700additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
30701
30702.ilist
30703If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
30704IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
30705condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
30706.next
30707If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
30708looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
30709changed to:
30710.code
30711dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
30712.endd
30713and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30714false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
30715.code
30716dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
30717.endd
30718for the condition to be true.
30719.endlist
30720
30721When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
30722the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
30723.ilist
30724If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
30725addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
30726.code
30727dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
30728.endd
30729If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30730false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
30731.next
30732If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
30733looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
30734.code
30735dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
30736.endd
30737If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30738true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
30739.code
30740dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
30741.endd
30742for the condition to be false.
30743.endlist
30744When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
30745between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
30746
30747
30748
30749
30750.section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
30751.cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
30752When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
30753the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
30754the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
30755address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
30756only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
30757can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
30758in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
30759lists.
30760
30761A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
30762two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
30763do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
30764If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
30765restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
30766a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
30767domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
30768.code
30769deny message = \
30770 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
30771 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
30772 dnslists = \
30773 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
30774 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
30775.endd
30776For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
30777&'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
30778match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
30779value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
30780record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
30781The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
30782
30783If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
30784given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
30785the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
30786.code
30787deny dnslists = \
30788 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
30789 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
30790 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
30791 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
30792.endd
30793In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
30794values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
30795done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
30796
30797
30798
30799.section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
30800.cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
30801.cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
30802If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
30803nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
308043ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
30805.code
308061.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
30807 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30808.endd
30809(split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
30810lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
30811IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
30812.code
30813*.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
30814.endd
30815is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
30816Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
30817
30818You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
30819&%condition%& condition, as in this example:
30820.code
30821deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
30822 dnslists = some.list.example
30823.endd
30824
30825If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
30826address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
30827(DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
30828.code
30829 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
30830.endd
30831
30832.section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
30833.cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
30834.cindex "limiting client sending rates"
30835.oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
30836The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
30837which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
30838&%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
30839commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
30840works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
30841host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
30842.display
30843&`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
30844.endd
30845If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
30846period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
30847
30848As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
30849&$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
30850configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
30851of &'p'&.
30852
30853The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
30854time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
30855means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
30856parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
30857send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
30858in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
30859constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
30860changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
30861both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
30862
30863There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
30864log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
30865when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
30866instructions when it is run with no arguments.
30867
30868The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
30869sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
30870retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
30871which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
30872By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
30873of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
30874user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
30875&$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
30876example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
30877authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
30878
30879The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
30880rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
30881&`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
30882ACL.
30883
30884Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
30885specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
30886or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
30887&%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
30888using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
30889separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
30890
30891Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
30892any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
30893stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
30894remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
30895remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
30896behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
30897the &%count=%& option.
30898
30899
30900.section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
30901.cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
30902The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
30903normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
30904&%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
30905
30906The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
30907the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
30908&%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
30909&%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
30910
30911The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
30912the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
30913in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
30914used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
30915in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
30916follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
30917in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
30918
30919The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
30920accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
30921&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
30922&%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
30923ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
30924in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
30925recipients as a large high-speed burst.
30926
30927The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
30928number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
30929last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
30930recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
30931&%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
30932
30933The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
30934condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
30935command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
30936multiple different commands.
30937
30938The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
30939measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
30940&`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
30941increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
30942other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
30943
30944The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
30945
30946
30947.section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
30948.cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
30949You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
30950control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
30951mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
30952
30953If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
30954previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
30955
30956For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
30957it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
30958can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
30959in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
30960new rate.
30961.code
30962acl_check_connect:
30963 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
30964 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
30965 (max $sender_rate_limit)
30966# ...
30967acl_check_mail:
30968 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
30969 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
30970 (max $sender_rate_limit)
30971.endd
30972
30973If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
30974processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
30975it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
30976in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
30977same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
30978multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
30979checks.
30980
30981The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
30982use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
30983update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
30984&%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
30985next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
30986
30987
30988.section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
30989.cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
30990If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
30991engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
30992&%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
30993counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
30994rest of the ACL.
30995
30996The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
30997updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
30998client's average rate of successfully sent email,
30999.new
31000up to the given limit.
31001This is appropriate if the countermeasure when the condition is true
31002consists of refusing the message, and
31003is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
31004If the action when true is anything more complex then this option is
31005likely not what is wanted.
31006.wen
31007
31008The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
31009updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
31010of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
31011actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
31012counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
31013pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
31014again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
31015attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
31016.code
31017 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
31018.endd
31019
31020
31021.section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
31022.cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
31023The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
31024rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
31025mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
31026sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
31027&`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
31028measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
31029options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
31030
31031For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
31032has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
31033rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
31034per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
31035go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
31036recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
31037
31038When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
31039&%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
31040rate.
31041
31042The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
31043other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
31044unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
31045required increases with larger limits.
31046
31047The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
31048will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
31049the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
31050the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
31051events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
31052times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
31053throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
31054limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
31055are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
31056as intended.
31057
31058
31059.section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
31060Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
31061when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
31062(for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
31063policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
31064message. For example:
31065.code
31066# Log all senders' rates
31067warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
31068 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
31069
31070# Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
31071# at the decimal point.
31072warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
31073 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
31074 $sender_rate_limit }s
31075
31076# Keep authenticated users under control
31077deny authenticated = *
31078 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
31079
31080# System-wide rate limit
31081defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
31082 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
31083
31084# Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
31085# set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
31086defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
31087 messages per $sender_rate_period
31088 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
31089 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
31090 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
31091.endd
31092&*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
31093especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
31094bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
31095making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
31096RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
31097this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
31098hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
31099
31100
31101
31102.section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
31103.cindex "verifying address" "options for"
31104.cindex "policy control" "address verification"
31105Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
31106&<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
31107&<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
31108The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
31109verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
31110other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
31111.code
31112verify = sender/callout
31113verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
31114.endd
31115The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
31116address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
31117difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
31118be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
31119(see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
31120The available options are as follows:
31121
31122.ilist
31123If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
31124remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
31125check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
31126.next
31127If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
31128normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
31129options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
31130verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
31131.next
31132The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
31133discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
31134.next
31135The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
31136immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
31137generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
31138discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
31139.endlist
31140
31141.cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
31142.vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
31143.vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
31144.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31145After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
31146error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
31147coding like this:
31148.code
31149warn !verify = sender
31150 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
31151.endd
31152If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
31153denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
31154verification failure.
31155
31156In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
31157appropriate) contains one of the following words:
31158
31159.ilist
31160&%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
31161was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
31162.next
31163&%route%&: Routing failed.
31164.next
31165&%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
31166occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
31167connection, HELO, or MAIL).
31168.next
31169&%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
31170.next
31171&%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
31172.endlist
31173
31174The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
31175rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
31176
31177.new
31178The above variables may also be set after a &*successful*&
31179address verification to:
31180
31181.ilist
31182&%random%&: A random local-part callout succeeded
31183.endlist
31184.wen
31185
31186
31187
31188
31189.section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
31190.cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
31191.cindex "callout" "verification"
31192.cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
31193For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
31194checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
31195the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
31196&'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
31197a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
31198address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
31199sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
31200deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
31201sender's domain.
31202
31203Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
31204request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
31205described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
31206lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
31207cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
31208caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
31209
31210Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
31211the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
31212callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
31213callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
31214on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
31215
31216If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
31217second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
31218one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
31219&(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
31220router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
31221&%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
31222&%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
31223supplies a host list.
31224Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
31225
31226The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
31227remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
31228specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
31229specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
31230specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
31231the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
31232&$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
31233
31234For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
31235test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
31236following SMTP commands are sent:
31237.display
31238&`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
31239&`MAIL FROM:<>`&
31240&`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
31241&`QUIT`&
31242.endd
31243LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
31244set to &"lmtp"&.
31245
31246The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
31247settings.
31248
31249A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
31250for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
31251the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
31252that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
31253do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
31254&%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
31255
31256If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
31257succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
31258Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
31259hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
31260&%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
31261
31262.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
31263A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
31264output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
31265clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
31266disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
31267
31268
31269
31270
31271.section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
31272.cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
31273The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
31274optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
31275.code
31276verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
31277.endd
31278The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
31279separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
31280deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
31281
31282
31283.vlist
31284.vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
31285.cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
31286This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
31287For example:
31288.code
31289verify = sender/callout=5s
31290.endd
31291The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
31292remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
31293the &%connect%& parameter.
31294
31295
31296.vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
31297.cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
31298This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
31299for making the SMTP connection. For example:
31300.code
31301verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
31302.endd
31303If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
31304
31305.vitem &*defer_ok*&
31306.cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
31307When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
31308of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
31309updated in this circumstance.
31310
31311.vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
31312.cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
31313This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
31314&'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
31315accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
31316unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
31317
31318
31319.vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
31320.cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
31321When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
31322verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
31323sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
31324whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
31325MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
31326as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
31327(empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
31328address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
31329.code
31330require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
31331.endd
31332This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
31333
31334
31335.vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
31336.cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
31337This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
31338For example:
31339.code
31340verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
31341.endd
31342This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
31343commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
31344be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
31345very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
31346(for example, when network connections are timing out).
31347
31348
31349.vitem &*no_cache*&
31350.cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
31351.cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
31352When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
31353
31354.vitem &*postmaster*&
31355.cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
31356When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
31357check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
31358rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
31359the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
31360used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
31361made, until the cache record expires.
31362
31363.vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
31364The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
31365You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
31366For example:
31367.code
31368require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
31369.endd
31370If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
31371one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
31372.code
31373require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
31374.endd
31375&*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
31376account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
31377a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
31378postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
31379
31380
31381.vitem &*random*&
31382.cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
31383When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
31384check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
31385really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
31386&%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
31387.code
31388$primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
31389.endd
31390The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
31391parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
31392specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
31393a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
31394succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
31395
31396.vitem &*use_postmaster*&
31397.cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
31398This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31399.code
31400deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
31401.endd
31402.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
31403It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
31404performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
31405that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
31406domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
31407
31408.vitem &*use_sender*&
31409This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31410.code
31411require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
31412.endd
31413It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
31414command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
31415need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
31416sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
31417usefulness of callout caching.
31418
31419.vitem &*hold*&
31420This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31421.code
31422require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
31423.endd
31424It causes the connection to be held open and used for any further recipients
31425and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
31426Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
31427when that is used for the connections.
31428The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
31429(which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
31430if the use_sender option is used,
31431if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
31432and if no other callouts intervene.
31433.endlist
31434
31435If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
31436command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
31437&%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
31438usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
31439that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
31440Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
31441these circumstances.
31442
31443However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
31444host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
31445callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
31446sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
31447callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
31448own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
31449is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
31450
31451Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
31452caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
31453by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
31454actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
31455
31456
31457
31458
31459.section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
31460.cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
31461.cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
31462.cindex "caching" "callout"
31463Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
31464used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
31465option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
31466different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
31467a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
31468entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
31469
31470When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
31471the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
31472is not available.
31473
31474The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
31475independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
31476(default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
31477
31478If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
31479commands up to and including
31480.code
31481MAIL FROM:<>
31482.endd
31483(but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
31484any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
31485domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
31486making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
31487separate expiry times for domain cache records:
31488&%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
31489&%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
31490
31491Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
31492cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
31493Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
31494ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
31495will eventually be noticed.
31496
31497The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
31498being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
31499behaviour will be the same.
31500
31501
31502
31503.section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
31504.cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
31505See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
31506verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
31507failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
31508relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
31509you might see:
31510.code
31511MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
31512250 OK
31513RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
31514550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
31515550-Called: 192.168.34.43
31516550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
31517550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
31518550 Sender verification failed
31519.endd
31520If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
31521only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
31522out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
31523&`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
31524example:
31525.code
31526verify = sender/no_details
31527.endd
31528
31529.section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
31530.cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
31531.cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
31532A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
31533during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
31534or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
31535it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
31536
31537.ilist
31538When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
31539continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
31540verification also fails.
31541.next
31542When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
31543verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
31544.endlist
31545
31546This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
31547way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
31548example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
31549.code
31550A.Wol: aw123
31551aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
31552.endd
31553work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
31554redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
31555mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
31556verification to succeed.
31557
31558It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
31559redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
31560generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
31561option. For example:
31562.code
31563require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
31564.endd
31565In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
31566the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
31567
31568When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
31569redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
31570also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
31571address and a report is output for each of them.
31572
31573
31574
31575.section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
31576.cindex "CSA" "verifying"
31577Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
31578which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
31579special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
31580domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
31581Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
31582.code
31583verify = csa
31584.endd
31585This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
31586valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
31587succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
31588&$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
31589&"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
31590be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
31591
31592The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
31593detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
31594looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
31595address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
31596
31597.ilist
31598The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
31599.next
31600The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
31601.next
31602The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
31603(for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
31604.next
31605The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
31606that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
31607.endlist
31608
31609The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
31610use for the DNS query. The default is:
31611.code
31612verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
31613.endd
31614This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
31615is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
31616address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
31617the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
31618meaningful to say:
31619.code
31620verify = csa/$sender_host_address
31621.endd
31622In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
31623This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
31624&%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
31625
31626If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
31627is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
31628making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
31629using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
31630default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
31631default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
31632(&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
31633of legitimate HELO domains.
31634
31635The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
31636direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
31637search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
31638addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
31639lookup such as:
31640.code
31641${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
31642.endd
31643has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
31644The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
31645authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
31646
31647
31648
31649
31650.section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
31651.cindex "BATV, verifying"
31652Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
31653of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
31654Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
31655recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
31656bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
31657spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
31658
31659There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
31660&"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
31661the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
31662address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
31663item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
31664The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
31665&<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
31666The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
31667
31668As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
31669database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
31670like this:
31671.code
31672PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
31673 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
31674 }{$value}}
31675.endd
31676Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
31677list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
31678use this:
31679.code
31680# Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
31681deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
31682 senders = :
31683 recipients = +batv_senders
31684
31685# Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
31686deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
31687 senders = :
31688 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
31689 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
31690 !condition = $prvscheck_result
31691.endd
31692The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
31693to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
31694send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
31695recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
31696the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
31697
31698A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
31699&%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
31700prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
31701the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
31702the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
31703timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
31704of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
31705
31706There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
31707you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
31708deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
31709router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
31710.code
31711batv_redirect:
31712 driver = redirect
31713 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
31714.endd
31715This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
31716of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
31717address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
31718local addresses.
31719
31720To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
31721can be used:
31722.code
31723external_smtp_batv:
31724 driver = smtp
31725 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
31726 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
31727 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
31728 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
31729 {$value}fail}}}
31730.endd
31731If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
31732
31733
31734
31735.section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
31736.cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
31737.cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
31738.cindex "policy control" "relay control"
31739An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
31740delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
31741within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
31742passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
31743.cindex "&""percent hack""&"
31744but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
31745
31746Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
31747A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
31748relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
31749a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
31750with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
31751same host is fulfilling both functions,
31752. ///
31753. as illustrated in the diagram below,
31754. ///
31755but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
31756not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
31757system to arbitrary domains.
31758
31759
31760You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
31761runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
31762Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
31763example, suppose you want to do the following:
31764
31765.ilist
31766Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
31767locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
31768&'my.dom2.example'&.
31769.next
31770Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
31771These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
31772.next
31773Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
31774Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
31775.endlist
31776
31777
31778In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
31779.code
31780domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
31781domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
31782hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
31783.endd
31784Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
31785command:
31786.code
31787acl_check_rcpt:
31788 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
31789 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
31790.endd
31791The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
31792the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
31793statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
31794hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
31795than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
31796default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
31797in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
31798
31799
31800
31801.section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
31802.cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
31803You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
31804that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
31805the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
31806.ecindex IIDacl
31807
31808
31809
31810. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31811. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31812
31813.chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
31814.scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
31815The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
31816as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
31817was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
31818maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
31819specification.
31820
31821It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
31822&[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
31823scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
31824messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
31825chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
31826
31827If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
31828Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
31829&_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
31830
31831.ilist
31832Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
31833for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
31834.next
31835Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
31836&%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
31837run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
31838.next
31839An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
31840of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
31841.next
31842Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
31843conditions.
31844.next
31845Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
31846.endlist
31847
31848Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
31849added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
31850changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
31851EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
31852this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
31853&_doc/experimental.txt_&.
31854
31855All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
31856temporarily created in a file called:
31857.display
31858<&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
31859.endd
31860The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
31861expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
31862first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
31863scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
31864removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
31865.code
31866control = no_mbox_unspool
31867.endd
31868has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
31869same directory by default.
31870
31871
31872
31873.section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
31874.cindex "virus scanning"
31875.cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
31876.cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
31877The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
31878It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
31879specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
31880in memory and thus are much faster.
31881
31882A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
31883if it expires then a defer action is taken.
31884
31885.oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
31886You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
31887to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
31888are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
31889.display
31890&`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
31891.endd
31892If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
31893.code
31894av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
31895.endd
31896If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
31897before use.
31898The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
31899The following scanner types are supported in this release,
31900though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
31901
31902.vlist
31903.vitem &%avast%&
31904.cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
31905This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
31906Security (currently at version 2.2.0).
31907You can get a trial version at &url(https://www.avast.com) or for Linux
31908at &url(https://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
31909This scanner type takes one option,
31910which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
31911or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
31912The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
31913single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
31914A list of options may follow. These options are interpreted on the
31915Exim's side of the malware scanner, or are given on separate lines to
31916the daemon as options before the main scan command.
31917
31918.cindex &`pass_unscanned`& "avast"
31919If &`pass_unscanned`&
31920is set, any files the Avast scanner can't scan (e.g.
31921decompression bombs, or invalid archives) are considered clean. Use with
31922care.
31923
31924For example:
31925.code
31926av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
31927av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:pass_unscanned:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
31928av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
31929.endd
31930If you omit the argument, the default path
31931&_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
31932is used.
31933If you use a remote host,
31934you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
31935as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
31936For information about available commands and their options you may use
31937.code
31938$ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
31939 FLAGS
31940 SENSITIVITY
31941 PACK
31942.endd
31943
31944If the scanner returns a temporary failure (e.g. license issues, or
31945permission problems), the message is deferred and a paniclog entry is
31946written. The usual &`defer_ok`& option is available.
31947
31948.vitem &%aveserver%&
31949.cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
31950This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
31951at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
31952which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
31953example:
31954.code
31955av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
31956.endd
31957
31958
31959.vitem &%clamd%&
31960.cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
31961This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
31962&url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
31963unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
31964in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
31965
31966The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
31967a UNIX socket specification,
31968a TCP socket specification,
31969or a (global) option.
31970
31971A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
31972For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
31973for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
31974and the second a port number,
31975Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
31976These per-server options are supported:
31977.code
31978retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
31979.endd
31980
31981The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
31982a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
31983
31984If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
31985
31986Examples:
31987.code
31988av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
31989av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
31990av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
31991av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
31992av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
31993.endd
31994If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
31995&`local`&
31996option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
31997to be scanned, which should normally result in less I/O happening and be
31998more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
31999Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
32000
32001The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
32002randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
32003that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
32004socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
32005unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
32006When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
32007not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
32008selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
32009email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
32010.code
320112013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
32012 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
32013 (Connection refused)
32014.endd
32015
32016If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
32017contributing the code for this scanner.
32018
32019.vitem &%cmdline%&
32020.cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
32021This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
32022used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
32023type takes 3 mandatory options:
32024
32025.olist
32026The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
32027and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
32028
32029.next
32030A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
32031virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
32032absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
32033the &"trigger"& expression.
32034
32035.next
32036Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
32037match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
32038&"name"& expression.
32039.endlist olist
32040
32041For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
32042.code
32043Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
32044.endd
32045For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
32046name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
32047for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
32048configuration setting:
32049.code
32050av_scanner = cmdline:\
32051 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
32052 found in file:'(.+)'
32053.endd
32054.vitem &%drweb%&
32055.cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
32056The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface
32057takes one option,
32058either a full path to a UNIX socket,
32059or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
32060The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
32061single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
32062For example:
32063.code
32064av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
32065av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
32066.endd
32067If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
32068is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
32069
32070.vitem &%f-protd%&
32071.cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
32072The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
32073One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
32074(or port-range).
32075For example:
32076.code
32077av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
32078.endd
32079If you omit the argument, the default values shown above are used.
32080
32081.vitem &%f-prot6d%&
32082.cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
32083The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
32084One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
32085For example:
32086.code
32087av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
32088.endd
32089If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
32090
32091.vitem &%fsecure%&
32092.cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
32093The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
32094argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
32095.code
32096av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
32097.endd
32098If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
32099Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
32100
32101.vitem &%kavdaemon%&
32102.cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
32103This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
32104Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
32105scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
32106For example:
32107.code
32108av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
32109.endd
32110The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
32111
32112.vitem &%mksd%&
32113.cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
32114This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
32115parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
32116&url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
32117the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
32118provided that mksd has
32119been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
32120.code
32121av_scanner = mksd:2
32122.endd
32123You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
32124
32125.vitem &%sock%&
32126.cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
32127This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
32128running on the local machine.
32129There are four options:
32130an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
32131a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
32132the path to the mail file to be scanned),
32133an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
32134and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
32135For example:
32136.code
32137av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
32138.endd
32139Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
32140there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
32141The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
32142Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
32143specify an empty element to get this.
32144
32145.vitem &%sophie%&
32146.cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
32147Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
32148You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
32149for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
32150client communication. For example:
32151.code
32152av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
32153.endd
32154The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
32155the option.
32156.endlist
32157
32158When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
32159the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
32160ACL.
32161
32162The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
32163makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
32164The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
32165for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
32166However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
32167which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
32168message.
32169
32170The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
32171use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
32172The first element can then be one of
32173
32174.ilist
32175&"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
32176The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
32177recommended usage.
32178.next
32179&"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
32180the condition fails immediately.
32181.next
32182A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
32183condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
32184expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
32185Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
32186unless the separator is changed (in the usual way).
32187.endlist
32188
32189You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
32190messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
32191Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
32192
32193You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
32194specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
32195For example:
32196.code
32197malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
32198.endd
32199A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
32200
32201.vindex "&$callout_address$&"
32202When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
32203is set to record the actual address used.
32204
32205.vindex "&$malware_name$&"
32206When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
32207&$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
32208&%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
32209logging data.
32210
32211Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
32212imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
32213
32214Here is a very simple scanning example:
32215.code
32216deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32217 malware = *
32218.endd
32219The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
32220.code
32221deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32222 malware = */defer_ok
32223.endd
32224The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
32225aveserver. It assumes you have set:
32226.code
32227av_scanner = $acl_m0
32228.endd
32229in the main Exim configuration.
32230.code
32231deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32232 set acl_m0 = sophie
32233 malware = *
32234
32235deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32236 set acl_m0 = aveserver
32237 malware = *
32238.endd
32239
32240
32241.section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
32242.cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
32243.cindex "spam scanning"
32244.cindex "SpamAssassin"
32245.cindex "Rspamd"
32246The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
32247score and a report for the message.
32248Support is also provided for Rspamd.
32249
32250For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
32251Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
32252&url(http://spamassassin.apache.org) and &url(http://www.rspamd.com)
32253
32254SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
32255.code
32256perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
32257.endd
32258SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
32259documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
32260nicely, however.
32261
32262.oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
32263By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
32264intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
32265&%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
32266you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
32267configuration as follows (example):
32268.code
32269spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
32270.endd
32271The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
32272If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
32273iptables firewall, consider setting
32274&%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
32275timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
32276server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
32277connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
32278soon.
32279
32280
32281To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
32282on TCP port 11333)
32283you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
32284.code
32285spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
32286.endd
32287
32288As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
32289sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
32290file name instead of an address/port pair:
32291.code
32292spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
32293.endd
32294You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
32295reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
32296&%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
32297option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way):
32298.code
32299spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
32300 192.168.2.11 783 : \
32301 192.168.2.12 783
32302.endd
32303Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
32304When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
32305servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
32306condition defers.
32307
32308Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
32309Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
32310and changeable in the usual way; take care to not double the separator.
32311
32312For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
32313subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
32314and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
32315In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
32316
32317Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
32318are options.
32319The supported options are:
32320.code
32321pri=<priority> Selection priority
32322weight=<value> Selection bias
32323time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
32324retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
32325tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
32326variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
32327.endd
32328
32329The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
32330higher values being tried first.
32331The default priority is 1.
32332
32333The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
32334Within a priority set
32335servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
32336The default value for selection bias is 1.
32337
32338Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
32339in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
32340Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
32341characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
32342
32343Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
32344are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
32345
32346The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
32347The default value is two minutes.
32348
32349The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
32350a failed connect is made.
32351The default is to not retry.
32352
32353The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
32354a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
32355used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
32356expansion.
32357
32358.vindex "&$callout_address$&"
32359When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
32360is set to record the actual address used.
32361
32362.section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
32363Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
32364.code
32365deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32366 spam = joe
32367.endd
32368The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
32369relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
32370to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
32371default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
32372Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
32373right-hand side.
32374
32375The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
32376principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
32377have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
32378&%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
32379read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
32380are not set.
32381Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
32382(e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
32383after the first),
32384or the use of PRDR,
32385.cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
32386are needed to use this feature.
32387
32388The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
32389you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
32390&"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
32391
32392
32393Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
32394large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
32395are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
32396example:
32397.code
32398deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32399 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
32400 spam = nobody
32401.endd
32402
32403The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
32404SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
32405&%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
32406it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
32407
32408.cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
32409When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
32410variables.
32411Except for &$spam_report$&,
32412these variables are saved with the received message so are
32413available for use at delivery time.
32414
32415.vlist
32416.vitem &$spam_score$&
32417The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
32418for inclusion in log or reject messages.
32419
32420.vitem &$spam_score_int$&
32421The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
32422example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
32423because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
32424The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
32425
32426.vitem &$spam_bar$&
32427A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
32428integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
32429&$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
32430headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
32431spam bar is 50 characters.
32432
32433.vitem &$spam_report$&
32434A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
32435message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
32436This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
32437Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
32438when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
32439unencoded in headers.
32440
32441.vitem &$spam_action$&
32442For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
32443spam score versus threshold.
32444For Rspamd, the recommended action.
32445
32446.endlist
32447
32448The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
32449spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
32450does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
32451
32452The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
32453the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
32454failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
32455statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
32456spam condition, like this:
32457.code
32458deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32459 spam = joe/defer_ok
32460.endd
32461This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
32462
32463Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
32464condition:
32465.code
32466# put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
32467warn spam = nobody:true
32468 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
32469 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
32470
32471# add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
32472# is over threshold
32473warn spam = nobody
32474 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
32475
32476# reject spam at high scores (> 12)
32477deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
32478 spam = nobody:true
32479 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
32480.endd
32481
32482
32483
32484.section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
32485.cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
32486.cindex "MIME content scanning"
32487.oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
32488.oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
32489The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
32490each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
32491of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
32492specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
32493options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
32494cases.
32495
32496These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
32497ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
32498the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
32499message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
32500ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
32501result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
32502&%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
32503
32504You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
32505only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
32506condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
32507&%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
32508&<<SECTscanregex>>&).
32509
32510At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
32511information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
32512of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
32513parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
32514part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
32515syntax is:
32516.display
32517&`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
32518.endd
32519The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
32520the value can be:
32521
32522.olist
32523&"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
32524.next
32525The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
32526&"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
32527a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
32528full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
32529.next
32530A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
32531directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
32532is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
32533the full path and file name.
32534.next
32535If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
32536filename, and the default path is then used.
32537.endlist
32538The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
32539errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
32540a file with its original, proposed filename using
32541.code
32542decode = $mime_filename
32543.endd
32544However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
32545anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
32546automatically unlinked.
32547
32548For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
32549content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
32550as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
32551variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
32552before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
32553
32554The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
32555used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
32556respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
32557
32558.cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
32559The following list describes all expansion variables that are
32560available in the MIME ACL:
32561
32562.vlist
32563.vitem &$mime_boundary$&
32564If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
32565have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
32566has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
32567contains the empty string.
32568
32569.vitem &$mime_charset$&
32570This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
32571&'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
32572.code
32573us-ascii
32574gb2312 (Chinese)
32575iso-8859-1
32576.endd
32577Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
32578case-insensitively.
32579
32580.vitem &$mime_content_description$&
32581This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
32582header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
32583implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
32584only used for display purposes.
32585
32586.vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
32587This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
32588header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
32589
32590.vitem &$mime_content_id$&
32591This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
32592This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
32593
32594.vitem &$mime_content_size$&
32595This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
32596successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
32597size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
32598has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
32599
32600.vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
32601This variable contains the normalized content of the
32602&'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
32603type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
32604
32605.vitem &$mime_content_type$&
32606If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
32607value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
32608are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
32609.code
32610text/plain
32611text/html
32612application/octet-stream
32613image/jpeg
32614audio/midi
32615.endd
32616If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
32617empty string.
32618
32619.vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
32620This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
32621successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
32622containing the decoded data.
32623.endlist
32624
32625.cindex "RFC 2047"
32626.vlist
32627.vitem &$mime_filename$&
32628This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
32629proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
32630&'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
32631RFC2047
32632or RFC2231
32633decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
32634 If no filename was
32635found, this variable contains the empty string.
32636
32637.vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
32638This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
32639attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
32640content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
32641
32642The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
32643cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
32644follows:
32645
32646.olist
32647The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
32648
32649.next
32650If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
32651so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
32652
32653.next
32654If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
32655and the rest are attachments.
32656
32657.next
32658All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
32659.endlist olist
32660
32661As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
32662alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
32663coverletter mail attached to non-HTML coverletter mail will also be allowed:
32664.code
32665deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
32666!condition = $mime_is_rfc822
32667condition = $mime_is_coverletter
32668condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
32669.endd
32670.vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
32671This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
32672&"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
32673Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
32674want to carry out specific actions on them.
32675
32676.vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
32677This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
32678checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
32679decoding is fully recursive.
32680
32681.vitem &$mime_part_count$&
32682This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
32683starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
32684counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
32685&$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
32686complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
32687parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
32688.endlist
32689
32690
32691
32692.section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
32693.cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
32694.cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
32695You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
32696the message, or on individual MIME parts.
32697
32698The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
32699matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
32700MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
32701linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
32702have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
32703
32704The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
32705to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
32706part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
32707is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
32708and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
3270932K characters are checked.
32710
32711The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
32712literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
32713expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
32714with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
32715Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
32716.code
32717deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
32718 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
32719.endd
32720The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
32721&$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
32722matching regular expression.
32723The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
32724are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
32725
32726&*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
32727CPU-intensive.
32728
32729.ecindex IIDcosca
32730
32731
32732
32733
32734. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32735. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32736
32737.chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
32738 "Local scan function"
32739.scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
32740.cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
32741.cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
32742In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
32743want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
32744
32745The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
32746passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
32747a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
32748condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
32749non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
32750
32751To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
32752possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
32753in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
32754can of course use a little C stub to call it.
32755
32756The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
32757when Exim is just about to accept the message.
32758It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
32759well as messages arriving via SMTP.
32760
32761Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
32762option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
32763Zero means &"no timeout"&.
32764Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
32765before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
32766are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
32767incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
32768For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
32769code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
32770
32771
32772
32773.section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
32774.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
32775To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
32776function is before building Exim, by setting
32777.new
32778both HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN and
32779.wen
32780LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
32781&_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
32782directory, so you might set
32783.code
32784HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN=yes
32785LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
32786.endd
32787for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
32788Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
32789be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
32790function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
32791commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
32792_src/local_scan.c_.
32793
32794If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
32795for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
32796.code
32797LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
32798.endd
32799in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
32800
32801
32802
32803
32804.section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
32805.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
32806You must include this line near the start of your code:
32807.code
32808#include "local_scan.h"
32809.endd
32810This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
32811prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
32812almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
32813for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
32814It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
32815strings and pointers to character strings:
32816.code
32817#define CS (char *)
32818#define CCS (const char *)
32819#define CSS (char **)
32820#define US (unsigned char *)
32821#define CUS (const unsigned char *)
32822#define USS (unsigned char **)
32823.endd
32824The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
32825.code
32826extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
32827.endd
32828The arguments are as follows:
32829
32830.ilist
32831&%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
32832(the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
32833recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
32834
32835The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
32836character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
32837id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
32838macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
32839case this changes in some future version.
32840.next
32841&%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
32842string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
32843.endlist
32844
32845The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
32846
32847.vlist
32848.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
32849.vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
32850The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
32851the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
32852newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
32853maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
32854
32855.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
32856This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
32857queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
32858
32859.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
32860This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
32861queued without immediate delivery.
32862
32863.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
32864The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
32865passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
32866they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
32867&`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
32868used.
32869
32870.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
32871The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
32872message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
32873problem"& is used.
32874
32875.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
32876This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
32877message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
32878&%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
32879&%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
32880&%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
32881same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
32882
32883.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
32884This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
32885LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
32886.endlist
32887
32888If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
32889reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
32890&%-oe%& command line options.
32891
32892
32893
32894.section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
32895.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
32896It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
32897that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
32898want to do this, you must have the line
32899.code
32900LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
32901.endd
32902in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
32903&_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
32904file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
32905to define them.
32906
32907The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
32908&`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
32909and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
32910alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
32911variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
32912entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
32913.code
32914static int my_integer_option = 42;
32915static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
32916
32917optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
32918 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
32919 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
32920};
32921
32922int local_scan_options_count =
32923 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
32924.endd
32925The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
32926configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
32927.code
32928begin local_scan
32929my_integer = 99
32930my_string = some string of text...
32931.endd
32932The available types of option data are as follows:
32933
32934.vlist
32935.vitem &*opt_bool*&
32936This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
32937variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
32938that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
32939whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
32940TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
32941values.)
32942
32943.vitem &*opt_fixed*&
32944This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
32945The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
32946multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
32947
32948.vitem &*opt_int*&
32949This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
32950&`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
32951Exim.
32952
32953.vitem &*opt_mkint*&
32954This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
32955&%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
32956printed with the suffix K or M.
32957
32958.vitem &*opt_octint*&
32959This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
32960octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
32961always output in octal.
32962
32963.vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
32964This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
32965variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
32966
32967.vitem &*opt_time*&
32968This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
32969type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
32970.endlist
32971
32972If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
32973out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
32974
32975
32976
32977.section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
32978.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
32979The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
32980are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
32981Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
32982including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
32983C variables are as follows:
32984
32985.vlist
32986.vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
32987This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
32988It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
32989
32990.vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
32991This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
32992It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
32993
32994.vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
32995This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
32996is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
32997&[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
32998
32999.ilist
33000The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
33001testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
33002other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
33003
33004.next
33005The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
33006by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
33007of debugging bits.
33008.endlist ilist
33009
33010Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
33011selected, you should use code like this:
33012.code
33013if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
33014 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
33015.endd
33016.vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
33017After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
33018variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
33019
33020.vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
33021A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
33022discussed below.
33023
33024.vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
33025A pointer to the last of the header lines.
33026
33027.vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
33028The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
33029
33030.vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
33031This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
33032&%-bh%& command line option.
33033
33034.vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
33035The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
33036is NULL for locally submitted messages.
33037
33038.vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
33039The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
33040command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
33041specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
33042
33043.vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
33044This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
33045&$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
33046
33047.vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
33048The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
33049
33050.vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
33051The number of accepted recipients.
33052
33053.vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
33054.cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
33055.cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
33056The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
33057&%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
33058can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
33059below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
33060adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
33061&%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
33062value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
33063blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
33064and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
33065
33066.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
33067The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
33068
33069.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
33070The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
33071locally-submitted messages.
33072
33073.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
33074The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
33075was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
33076
33077.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
33078The name of the sending host, if known.
33079
33080.vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
33081The port on the sending host.
33082
33083.vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
33084This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
33085
33086.vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
33087This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
33088
33089.vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
33090The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
33091requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
33092.endlist
33093
33094
33095.section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
33096The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
33097You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
33098(see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
33099their type to *.
33100
33101
33102.vlist
33103.vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
33104A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
33105
33106.vitem &*int&~type*&
33107A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
33108characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
33109Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
33110with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
33111rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
33112lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
33113
33114.vitem &*int&~slen*&
33115The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
33116internal newlines.
33117
33118.vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
33119A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
33120a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
33121.endlist
33122
33123
33124
33125.section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
33126The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
33127
33128.vlist
33129.vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
33130This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
33131
33132.vitem &*int&~pno*&
33133This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
33134the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
33135and must always contain -1 at this stage.
33136
33137.vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
33138If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
33139recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
33140envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
33141router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
33142an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
33143&%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
33144is NULL for all recipients.
33145.endlist
33146
33147
33148
33149.section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
33150.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
33151The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
33152These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
33153release:
33154
33155.vlist
33156.vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
33157 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
33158
33159This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
33160&%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
33161be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
33162for the process in &%newumask%&.
33163
33164Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
33165and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
33166standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
33167descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
33168argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
33169
33170The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
33171
33172.vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
33173This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
33174seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
33175return value is as follows:
33176
33177.ilist
33178>= 0
33179
33180The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
33181ending status.
33182
33183.next
33184< 0 and > &--256
33185
33186The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
33187signal number.
33188
33189.next
33190&--256
33191
33192The process timed out.
33193.next
33194&--257
33195
33196The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
33197.endlist
33198
33199.vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
33200This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
33201Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
33202want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
33203forks a subprocess that is running
33204.code
33205exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
33206.endd
33207and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
33208that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
33209of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
33210recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
33211
33212When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
33213finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
33214fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
33215addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
33216
33217
33218.vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
33219 *sender_authentication)*&
33220This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
33221that it runs is:
33222.display
33223&`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
33224.endd
33225The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
33226
33227
33228.vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
33229This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
33230output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
33231calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
33232conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
33233.code
33234if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
33235 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
33236.endd
33237
33238.vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
33239This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
33240expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
33241The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
33242expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
33243the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
33244block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
33245&<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
33246
33247.vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
33248This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
33249existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
33250character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
33251substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
33252if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
33253
33254.vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
33255 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
33256This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
33257chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
33258
33259If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
33260&%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
33261NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
33262matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
33263&%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
33264found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
33265marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
33266option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
33267top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
33268headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
33269.code
33270header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
33271 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
33272.endd
33273Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
33274there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
33275
33276
33277.vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
33278This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
33279occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
33280particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
33281match the specification, the function does nothing.
33282
33283
33284.vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
33285 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
33286This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
33287a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
33288colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
33289&"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
33290.code
33291if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
33292.endd
33293.vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
33294.cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
33295This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
33296The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
33297back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
33298zero-terminated.
33299
33300.vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
33301This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
33302zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
33303to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
33304string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
33305yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
33306easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
33307added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
33308
33309.vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
33310This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
33311matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
33312.display
33313&`OK `& match succeeded
33314&`FAIL `& match failed
33315&`DEFER `& match deferred
33316.endd
33317DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
33318inability to contact a database.
33319
33320.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
33321 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
33322This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
33323controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
33324&'lss_match_domain()'&.
33325
33326.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
33327 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
33328This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
33329controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
33330matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
33331
33332.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
33333 uschar&~*list)*&"
33334This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
33335expected to be
33336.code
33337lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
33338.endd
33339.vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
33340An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
33341is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
33342looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
33343values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
33344returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
33345failed.
33346
33347.vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
33348 *format,&~...)*&"
33349This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
33350is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
33351&`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
33352them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
33353arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
33354contain any newlines, not even at the end.
33355
33356
33357.vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
33358This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
33359is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
33360with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
33361
33362This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
33363described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
33364the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
33365value afterwards. For example:
33366.code
33367 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
33368 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
33369 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
33370.endd
33371
33372.vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
33373This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
33374recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
33375matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
33376address.
33377.endlist
33378
33379
33380.cindex "RFC 2047"
33381.vlist
33382.vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
33383 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
33384This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
33385these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
33386from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
33387a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
33388made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
33389binary string is returned with an error message.
33390
33391The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
33392maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
33393encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
33394
33395.cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
33396.cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
33397If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
33398contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
33399not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
33400
33401The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
33402&%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
33403which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
33404
33405If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
33406argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
33407set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
33408returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
33409with translation.
33410
33411
33412.vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
33413This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
33414below.
33415
33416.vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
33417The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
33418output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
33419stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
33420SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
33421is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
33422opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
33423test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
33424is involved.
33425
33426If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
33427output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
33428
33429Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
33430must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
33431LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
33432LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
33433initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
33434to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
33435that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
33436.code
33437smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
33438return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
33439.endd
33440Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
33441the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
33442&'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
33443multiple output lines.
33444
33445The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
33446does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
33447the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
33448detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
33449you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
33450dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
33451arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
33452is an error.
33453
33454.vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
33455This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
33456chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
33457runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
33458
33459.vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
33460This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
33461permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
33462
33463.vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
33464See below.
33465
33466.vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
33467See below.
33468
33469.vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
33470These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
33471The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
33472number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
33473and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
33474pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
33475more discussion.
33476.endlist
33477
33478
33479
33480.section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
33481.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
33482No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
33483The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
33484recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
33485to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
33486message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
33487terminates.
33488
33489Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
33490data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
33491connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
33492one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
33493
33494If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
33495in the same SMTP connection, you should set
33496.code
33497store_pool = POOL_PERM
33498.endd
33499before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
33500restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
33501the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
33502set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
33503
33504The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
33505&'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
33506There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
33507block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
33508&%store_pool%&.
33509.ecindex IIDlosca
33510
33511
33512
33513
33514. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33515. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33516
33517.chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
33518.scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
33519.scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
33520.scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
33521The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
33522that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
33523also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
33524they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
33525
33526The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
33527is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
33528It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
33529commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
33530The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
33531
33532The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
33533is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
33534the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
33535If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
33536of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
33537prevent it happening on retries.
33538
33539.vindex "&$domain$&"
33540.vindex "&$local_part$&"
33541&*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
33542specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
33543&$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
33544you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
33545independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
33546described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
33547
33548
33549.section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
33550.cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
33551.cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
33552The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
33553setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
33554other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
33555&%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
33556.code
33557system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
33558system_filter_user = exim
33559.endd
33560If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
33561&%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
33562specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
33563&%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
33564&%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
33565by the &%reply%& command.
33566
33567
33568.section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
33569You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
33570filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
33571are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
33572
33573If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
33574you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
33575
33576
33577
33578.section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
33579The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
33580files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
33581mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
33582available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
33583If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
33584they cause errors.
33585
33586.cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
33587There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
33588files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
33589is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
33590&%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
33591subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
33592manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
33593
33594&*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
33595specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
33596succeed, it will not be tried again.
33597If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
33598arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
33599
33600When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
33601&$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
33602users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
33603to which users' filter files can refer.
33604
33605
33606
33607.section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
33608.vindex "&$recipients$&"
33609The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
33610of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
33611filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
33612
33613
33614
33615.section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
33616.cindex "freezing messages"
33617.cindex "message" "freezing"
33618.cindex "message" "forced failure"
33619.cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
33620.cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
33621.cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
33622There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
33623always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
33624filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
33625for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
33626word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
33627.code
33628fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
33629.endd
33630The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
33631
33632The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
33633message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
33634and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
33635delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
33636that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
33637run.
33638
33639The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
33640not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
33641filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
33642is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
33643
33644.cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
33645.cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
33646The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
33647well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
33648up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
33649log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
33650two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
33651strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
33652message. For example:
33653.code
33654fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
33655 because it contains attachments that we are \
33656 not prepared to receive."
33657.endd
33658
33659.cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
33660Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
33661the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
33662the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
33663command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
33664Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
33665use, for example
33666.code
33667if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
33668then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
33669.endd
33670though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
33671alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
33672generated by the filter.
33673
33674The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
33675&%defer%&,
33676&%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
33677set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
33678as
33679.code
33680mail ...
33681freeze
33682.endd
33683to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
33684failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
33685take place.
33686
33687
33688
33689.section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
33690.cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
33691.cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
33692.cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
33693Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
33694.code
33695headers add <string>
33696headers remove <string>
33697.endd
33698The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
33699added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
33700filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
33701space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
33702forced to fail, the command has no effect.
33703
33704You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
33705continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
33706including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
33707example:
33708.code
33709headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
33710 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
33711 X-header-2: ...."
33712.endd
33713Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
33714be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
33715space after input continuations is ignored.
33716
33717The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
33718This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
33719those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
33720&'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
33721header with the same name, they are all removed.
33722
33723The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
33724of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
33725from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
33726modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
33727Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
33728used for all recipients of the message.
33729
33730During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
33731header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
33732that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
33733routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
33734routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
33735until the message is actually being written (see section
33736&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
33737
33738If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
33739added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
33740present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
33741present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
33742message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
33743conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
33744modified more than once.
33745
33746Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
33747use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
33748For example:
33749.code
33750headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
33751headers remove "Subject"
33752headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
33753headers remove "Old-Subject"
33754.endd
33755
33756
33757
33758.section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
33759.cindex "envelope sender"
33760In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
33761.code
33762errors_to <some address>
33763.endd
33764in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
33765delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
33766user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
33767might use
33768.code
33769unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
33770.endd
33771to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
33772address if its delivery failed.
33773
33774
33775
33776.section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
33777.vindex "&$domain$&"
33778.vindex "&$local_part$&"
33779In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
33780delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
33781operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
33782such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
33783filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
33784which implements such a filter:
33785.code
33786central_filter:
33787 check_local_user
33788 driver = redirect
33789 domains = +local_domains
33790 file = /central/filters/$local_part
33791 no_verify
33792 allow_filter
33793 allow_freeze
33794.endd
33795The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
33796&%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
33797the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
33798use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
33799
33800Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
33801specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
33802its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
33803address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
33804normal way.
33805.ecindex IIDsysfil1
33806.ecindex IIDsysfil2
33807.ecindex IIDsysfil3
33808
33809
33810
33811
33812
33813
33814. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33815. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33816
33817.chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
33818.scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
33819Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
33820all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
33821these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
33822this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
33823removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
33824before it is placed on Exim's queue.
33825
33826Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
33827&"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
33828that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
33829its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
33830set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
33831
33832&*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
33833or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
33834loopback interface specially in any way.
33835
33836If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
33837that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
33838
33839
33840
33841
33842.section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
33843.cindex "message" "submission"
33844.cindex "submission mode"
33845Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
33846&%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
33847received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
33848state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
33849.code
33850control = submission
33851.endd
33852in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
33853&<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
33854a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
33855known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
33856example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
33857interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
33858.code
33859warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
33860 control = submission
33861.endd
33862.cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
33863There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
33864is used to separate options. For example:
33865.code
33866control = submission/sender_retain
33867.endd
33868Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
33869true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
33870of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
33871the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
33872authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
33873&'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
33874attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
33875
33876When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
33877domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
33878example:
33879.code
33880control = submission/domain=some.domain
33881.endd
33882The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
33883&<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
33884that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
33885&'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
33886.code
33887accept authenticated = *
33888 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
33889 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
33890 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
33891.endd
33892Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
33893option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
33894the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
33895.code
33896bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
33897.endd
33898then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
33899line would be:
33900.code
33901Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
33902.endd
33903.cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
33904By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
33905used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
33906specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
33907
33908&*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
33909ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
33910untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
33911specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
33912does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
33913spoof another's address.
33914
33915.section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
33916.cindex "line endings"
33917.cindex "carriage return"
33918.cindex "linefeed"
33919RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
33920linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
33921SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
33922conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
33923use CRLF or just CR.
33924
33925Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
33926using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
33927receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
33928Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
33929MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
33930has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
33931that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
33932other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
33933follows:
33934
33935.ilist
33936LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
33937.next
33938CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
33939is ignored.
33940.next
33941The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
33942nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
33943terminator.
33944.next
33945If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
33946the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
33947is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
33948people trying to play silly games.
33949.next
33950If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
33951bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
33952line.
33953.endlist
33954
33955
33956
33957
33958
33959.section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
33960.cindex "unqualified addresses"
33961.cindex "address" "qualification"
33962By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
33963host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
33964SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
33965messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
33966requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
33967
33968Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
33969sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
33970&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
33971cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
33972value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
33973
33974.oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
33975.oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
33976Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
33977that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
33978line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
33979are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
33980other words, such qualification is also controlled by
33981&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
33982
33983
33984
33985
33986.section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
33987.cindex "&""From""& line"
33988.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
33989.cindex "sender" "address"
33990.oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
33991.oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
33992.cindex "envelope sender"
33993.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
33994Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
33995with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
33996&"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
33997.code
33998From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
33999From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
34000.endd
34001This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
34002Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
34003via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
34004such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
34005&%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
34006and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
34007regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
34008default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
34009that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
34010
34011.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
34012When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
34013a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
34014contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
34015then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
34016qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
34017the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
34018
34019If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
34020sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
34021that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
34022
34023Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
34024treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
34025as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
34026incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
34027
34028
34029
34030.section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
34031.cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
34032.cindex "header lines" "Resent-"
34033RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
34034&`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
34035recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
34036&'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
34037&'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
34038
34039.blockquote
34040&'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
34041processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
34042.endblockquote
34043
34044This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
34045address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
34046follows:
34047
34048.ilist
34049A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
34050is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
34051.next
34052If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
34053&%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
34054&'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
34055.next
34056For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
34057also removed.
34058.next
34059For a locally-submitted message,
34060if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
34061&'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
34062the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
34063included in log lines in this case.
34064.next
34065The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
34066&%Resent-%& header lines are present.
34067.endlist
34068
34069
34070
34071
34072.section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
34073Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
34074includes the header line:
34075.code
34076Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
34077.endd
34078
34079.section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
34080.cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
34081If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
34082message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
34083extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
34084existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
34085
34086
34087.section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
34088.cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
34089.cindex "header lines" "Date:"
34090If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
34091Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
34092&%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
34093
34094.section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
34095.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
34096.oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
34097&'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
34098set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
34099the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
34100in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
34101set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
34102messages.
34103
34104
34105.section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
34106.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
34107.cindex "header lines" "Envelope-to:"
34108.oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
34109&'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
34110Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
34111generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
34112messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
34113(the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
34114messages.
34115
34116
34117.section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
34118.cindex "&'From:'& header line"
34119.cindex "header lines" "From:"
34120.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
34121.cindex "message" "submission"
34122.cindex "submission mode"
34123If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
34124adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
34125
34126.ilist
34127The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
34128message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
34129.next
34130.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
34131The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
34132.olist
34133.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34134If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
34135&$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
34136.next
34137If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
34138part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
34139.next
34140If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
34141&$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
34142.endlist
34143.endlist
34144
34145A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
34146
34147If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
34148line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
34149containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
34150are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
34151They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
34152&%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
34153&%qualify_domain%&.
34154
34155For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
34156&'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
34157user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
34158name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
34159
34160
34161.section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
34162.cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
34163.cindex "header lines" "Message-ID:"
34164.cindex "message" "submission"
34165.oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
34166If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
34167&'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
34168&%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
34169to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
34170creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
34171message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
34172followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
34173in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
34174&%message_id_header_domain%& options.
34175
34176
34177.section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
34178.cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
34179.cindex "header lines" "Received:"
34180A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
34181contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
34182Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
34183
34184The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
34185have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
34186line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
34187that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
34188
34189Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
34190changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
34191-H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
34192
34193
34194.section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
34195.cindex "&'References:'& header line"
34196.cindex "header lines" "References:"
34197Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
34198header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
34199section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
34200header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
34201responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
34202processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
34203than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
34204incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
3420511 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
34206
34207
34208
34209.section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
34210.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
34211.cindex "header lines" "Return-path:"
34212.oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
34213&'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
34214it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
34215transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
34216transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
34217default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
34218
34219
34220
34221.section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
34222.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
34223.cindex "message" "submission"
34224.cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
34225For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
34226existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
34227these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
34228&%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
34229control setting.
34230
34231When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
34232&%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
34233control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
34234&'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
34235that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
34236&%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
34237be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
34238appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
34239line is added to the message.
34240
34241If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
34242the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
34243&%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
34244options true at the same time.
34245
34246.cindex "submission mode"
34247By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
34248received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
34249a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
34250not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
34251
34252.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
34253First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
34254authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
34255created as follows:
34256
34257.ilist
34258.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34259If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
34260&$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
34261.next
34262If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
34263is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
34264.next
34265If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
34266&$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
34267.endlist
34268
34269This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
34270are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
34271added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
34272by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
34273
34274.cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
34275&*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
34276the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
34277except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
34278
34279
34280
34281.section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
34282 "SECTheadersaddrem"
34283.cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
34284.cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
34285When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
34286specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
34287process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
34288modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
34289as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
34290
34291In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
34292specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
34293addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
34294changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
34295transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
34296they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
34297
34298&*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
34299the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
34300expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
34301
34302For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
34303option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
34304newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
34305.code
34306headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
34307 X-added-second: another added header line
34308.endd
34309Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
34310
34311Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
34312specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
34313Each header-line is separately expanded.
34314
34315The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
34316list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
34317often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
34318not part of the names. For example:
34319.code
34320headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
34321.endd
34322
34323Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
34324specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
34325Each item is separately expanded.
34326Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
34327form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
34328will act as list separators.
34329
34330When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
34331items are expanded at routing time,
34332and then associated with all addresses that are
34333accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
34334an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
34335forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
34336
34337.oindex "&%unseen%&"
34338However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
34339the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
34340&"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
34341
34342Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
34343settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
34344dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
34345requirements.
34346
34347The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
34348with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
34349these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
34350recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
34351consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
34352names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
34353instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
34354
34355After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
34356lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
34357the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
34358header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
34359
34360This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
34361the following consequences:
34362
34363.ilist
34364The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
34365remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
34366to it, at all times.
34367.next
34368Header lines that are added by a router's
34369&%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
34370expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
34371.next
34372Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
34373in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
34374.next
34375Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
34376a later router or by a transport.
34377.next
34378An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
34379removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
34380.code
34381headers_remove = subject
34382headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
34383.endd
34384.endlist
34385
34386&*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
34387for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
34388
34389
34390
34391
34392
34393.section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
34394.cindex "address" "constructed"
34395.cindex "constructed address"
34396When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
34397the form
34398.display
34399<&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
34400.endd
34401For example:
34402.code
34403Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
34404.endd
34405The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
34406otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
34407&"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
34408ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
34409upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
34410&%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
34411The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
34412there is no password file entry.
34413
34414.cindex "RFC 2047"
34415In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
34416parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
34417characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
34418including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
34419&%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
34420characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
34421&%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
34422is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
34423
34424
34425
34426.section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
34427.cindex "case of local parts"
34428.cindex "local part" "case of"
34429RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
34430be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
34431addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
34432because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
34433routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
34434original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
34435router option.
34436
34437.cindex "mixed-case login names"
34438If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
34439assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
34440your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
34441correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
34442.code
34443correct_case:
34444 driver = redirect
34445 domains = +local_domains
34446 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
34447 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
34448 @$domain
34449.endd
34450For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
34451(&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
34452up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
34453on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
34454local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
34455
34456
34457
34458.section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
34459.cindex "dot" "in local part"
34460.cindex "local part" "dots in"
34461RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
34462part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
34463middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
34464empty components for compatibility.
34465
34466
34467
34468.section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
34469.cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
34470Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
34471happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
34472in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
34473&'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
34474
34475Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
34476in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
34477routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
34478example, a header such as
34479.code
34480To: hare@teaparty
34481.endd
34482might get rewritten as
34483.code
34484To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
34485.endd
34486Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
34487does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
34488been routed.
34489
34490Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
34491addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
34492result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
34493deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
34494immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
34495routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
34496.ecindex IIDmesproc
34497
34498
34499
34500. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34501. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34502
34503.chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
34504.scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
34505.scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
34506Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
34507LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
34508closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
34509processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
34510
34511.ilist
34512SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
34513.next
34514SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
34515.next
34516Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
34517.endlist
34518
34519For mail delivery, the following are available:
34520
34521.ilist
34522SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
34523.next
34524LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
34525&"lmtp"&);
34526.next
34527LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
34528transport);
34529.next
34530Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
34531the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
34532.endlist
34533
34534&'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
34535stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
34536used to contain the envelope information.
34537
34538
34539
34540.section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
34541.cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
34542.cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
34543.cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
34544.cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
34545.cindex "EHLO"
34546.cindex "HELO"
34547.cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
34548Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
34549The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
34550processing is the same in both cases.
34551
34552If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
34553parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
34554command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
34555&%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
34556such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
34557.cindex "transport" "filter"
34558.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
34559transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
34560suppressed.
34561
34562If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
34563pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
34564required for the transaction.
34565
34566If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
34567was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
34568server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
34569Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
34570is called for verification.
34571
34572If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
34573the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
34574in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
34575
34576.cindex "carriage return"
34577.cindex "linefeed"
34578Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
34579LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
34580order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
34581line terminator.
34582
34583If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
34584characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
34585same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
34586even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
34587of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
34588they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
34589each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
34590in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
34591significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
34592
34593When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
34594message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
34595records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
34596particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
34597
34598.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
34599Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
34600a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
34601See the next section for more detail about error handling.
34602
34603.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
34604.cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
34605When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
34606looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
34607messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
34608creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
34609a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
34610so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
34611does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
34612turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
34613
34614The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
34615limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
34616
34617.cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
34618The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
34619identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
34620square bracket of the IP address.
34621
34622
34623
34624
34625.section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
34626.cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
34627.cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
34628.cindex "host" "error"
34629Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
34630message errors, and recipient errors.
34631
34632.vlist
34633.vitem "&*Host errors*&"
34634A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
34635particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
34636
34637.ilist
34638Connection refused or timed out,
34639.next
34640Any error response code on connection,
34641.next
34642Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
34643.next
34644Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
34645.next
34646I/O errors at any time,
34647.next
34648Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
34649the &"."& at the end of the data.
34650.endlist ilist
34651
34652For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
34653EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
34654error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
34655host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
34656the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
34657alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
34658host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
34659made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
34660
34661.vitem "&*Message errors*&"
34662.cindex "message" "error"
34663A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
34664particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
34665message errors are:
34666
34667.ilist
34668Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
34669the data,
34670.next
34671Timeout after MAIL,
34672.next
34673Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
34674timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
34675connection at any other time.
34676.endlist ilist
34677
34678For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
34679to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
34680temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
34681addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
34682a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
34683message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
34684that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
34685time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
34686affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
34687it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
34688
34689If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
34690to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
34691over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
34692response to MAIL.
34693
34694.vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
34695.cindex "recipient" "error"
34696A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
34697recipient errors are:
34698
34699.ilist
34700Any error response to RCPT,
34701.next
34702Timeout after RCPT.
34703.endlist
34704
34705For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
34706recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
34707sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
34708address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
34709used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
34710routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
34711operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
34712to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
34713if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
34714(&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
34715have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
34716the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
34717the retry clock is reset.
34718
34719The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
34720host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
34721other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
34722in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
34723proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
34724than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
34725if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
34726through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
34727recipient's retry time.
34728.endlist
34729
34730In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
34731current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
34732tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
34733own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
34734until the next delivery attempt.
34735
34736Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
34737MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
34738would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
34739host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
34740What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
34741is created.
34742
34743The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
34744these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
34745procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
34746response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
34747it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
34748message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
34749helpful to treat this case as a message error.
34750
34751Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
34752host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
34753or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
34754the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
34755then to be treated as a host error.
34756
34757There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
34758terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
34759reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
34760should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
34761host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
34762
34763
34764
34765
34766.section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
34767.cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
34768.cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
34769.cindex "inetd"
34770.cindex "daemon"
34771Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
34772listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
34773&_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
34774.code
34775smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
34776.endd
34777Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
34778agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
34779a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
34780the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
34781with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
34782stream and exits with an error code.
34783
34784By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
34785disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
34786unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
34787&%smtp_connection%& log selector.
34788
34789.cindex "carriage return"
34790.cindex "linefeed"
34791Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
34792LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
34793order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
34794line terminator.
34795Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
34796sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
34797sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
34798
34799.cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
34800.cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
34801One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
34802HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
34803commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
34804the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
34805Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
34806match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
34807
34808.cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
34809.cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
34810The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
34811a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
34812&%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
34813false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
34814&%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
34815value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
34816message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
34817
34818When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
34819its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
34820logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
34821
34822The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
34823prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
34824number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
34825&%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
34826rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
34827
34828The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
34829subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
34830for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
34831things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
34832processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
34833sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
34834it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
34835
34836When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
34837and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
34838high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
34839&%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
34840applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
34841
34842Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
34843can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
34844&%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
34845number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
34846SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
34847&%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
34848subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
34849a delivery process.
34850
34851The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
34852&%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
34853started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
34854handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
34855however, available with &'inetd'&.
34856
34857Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
34858are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
34859to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
34860section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
34861
34862Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
34863MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
34864&%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
34865
34866
34867
34868.section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
34869.cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
34870If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
34871commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
34872the error response to the last command. The default value for
34873&%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
34874abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
34875circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
34876
34877
34878.section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
34879.cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
34880.cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
34881A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
34882something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
34883address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
34884sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
34885&%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
34886drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
34887default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
34888broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
34889
34890
34891
34892.section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
34893.cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
34894The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
34895DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
34896many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
34897denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
34898client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
34899defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
34900
34901When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
34902allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
34903but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
34904or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
34905starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
34906counted.
34907
34908The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
34909STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
34910RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
34911
34912You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
34913&%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
34914&%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
34915the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
34916specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
34917
34918
34919
34920
34921.section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
34922When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
34923runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
34924appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
34925
34926.cindex "VRFY" "processing"
34927When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
34928setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
34929(with a 252 SMTP response code)
34930in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
34931When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
34932called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
34933SMTP response codes.
34934
34935.cindex "EXPN" "processing"
34936If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
34937When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
34938EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
34939than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
34940as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
34941of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
34942VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
34943RCPT failures.
34944
34945
34946
34947.section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
34948.cindex "ETRN" "processing"
34949RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
34950overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
34951disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
34952the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
34953should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
34954
34955The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
34956delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
34957the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
34958text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
34959specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
34960the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
34961argument. For example,
34962.code
34963ETRN #brigadoon
34964.endd
34965runs the command
34966.code
34967exim -R brigadoon
34968.endd
34969which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
34970containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
34971default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
34972for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
34973a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
34974
34975.cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
34976Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
34977record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
34978the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
34979the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
34980a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
34981left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
34982Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
34983
34984.oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
34985For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
34986used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
34987whatever the form of its argument. For
34988example:
34989.code
34990smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
34991 $sender_host_address
34992.endd
34993.vindex "&$domain$&"
34994The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
34995expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
34996and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
34997wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
34998under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
34999for it to change them before running the command.
35000
35001
35002
35003.section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
35004.cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
35005Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
35006standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
35007line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
35008&%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
35009messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
35010sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
35011an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
35012identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
35013runs for RCPT commands:
35014.code
35015accept hosts = :
35016.endd
35017This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
35018
35019
35020
35021.section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
35022.cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
35023.cindex "batched SMTP output"
35024Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
35025batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
35026be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
35027delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
35028envelope along with the message.
35029
35030The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
35031MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
35032the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
35033HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
35034can be used to specify it.
35035
35036Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
35037one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
35038to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
35039this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
35040chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
35041
35042.vindex "&$host$&"
35043When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
35044sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
35045transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
35046router:
35047.code
35048begin routers
35049route_append:
35050 driver = manualroute
35051 transport = smtp_appendfile
35052 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
35053
35054begin transports
35055smtp_appendfile:
35056 driver = appendfile
35057 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
35058 batch_max = 1000
35059 use_bsmtp
35060 user = exim
35061.endd
35062This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
35063format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
35064message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
35065
35066
35067
35068.section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
35069.cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
35070.cindex "batched SMTP input"
35071The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
35072reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
35073is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
35074sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
35075rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
35076and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
35077as NOOP; QUIT quits.
35078
35079Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
35080ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
35081
35082If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
35083the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
35084standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
35085make some use of automatically, for example:
35086.code
35087554 Unexpected end of file
35088Transaction started in line 10
35089Error detected in line 14
35090.endd
35091It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
35092file, for example:
35093.code
35094An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
35095The error message was:
35096
35097501 '>' missing at end of address
35098
35099The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
35100The error was detected in line 12.
35101The SMTP command at fault was:
35102
35103rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
35104
351051 previous message was successfully processed.
35106The rest of the batch was abandoned.
35107.endd
35108The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
35109messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
35110accepted.
35111.ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
35112.ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
35113
35114
35115
35116. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35117. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35118
35119.chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
35120 "Customizing messages"
35121When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
35122configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
35123to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
35124the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
35125string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
35126
35127The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
35128cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
35129option. Exim also adds the line
35130.code
35131Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
35132.endd
35133to all warning and bounce messages,
35134
35135
35136.section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
35137.cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
35138.cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
35139If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
35140message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
35141delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
35142&%bounce_message_file%& is set.
35143
35144When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
35145constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
35146separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
35147opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
35148logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
35149item.
35150
35151.vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
35152.vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
35153Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
35154expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
35155the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
35156&$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
35157option, rounded to a whole number.
35158
35159The items must appear in the file in the following order:
35160
35161.ilist
35162The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
35163&'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
35164.next
35165The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
35166failing addresses with their error messages.
35167.next
35168The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
35169returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
35170.next
35171The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
35172The fields exist for back-compatibility
35173.endlist
35174
35175The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
35176following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
35177other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
35178.code
35179Subject: Mail delivery failed
35180 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
35181 {: returning message to sender}}
35182****
35183This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
35184
35185A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
35186 {that you sent }{sent by
35187
35188<$sender_address>
35189
35190}}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
35191This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
35192****
35193The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
35194****
35195------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
35196 ------
35197****
35198------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
35199 only the first
35200------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
35201****
35202.endd
35203.section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
35204.cindex "customizing" "warning message"
35205.cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
35206The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
35207warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
35208text sections:
35209
35210.ilist
35211The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
35212&'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
35213.next
35214The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
35215the delayed addresses.
35216.next
35217The third item then ends the message.
35218.endlist
35219
35220The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
35221have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
35222.code
35223Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
35224 $warn_message_delay
35225****
35226This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
35227
35228A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
35229{that you sent }{sent by
35230
35231<$sender_address>
35232
35233}}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
35234more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
35235
35236The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
35237The subject of the message is: $h_subject
35238The date of the message is: $h_date
35239
35240The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
35241****
35242No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
35243continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
35244intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
35245mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
35246the message will be returned to you.
35247.endd
35248.vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
35249.vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
35250However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
35251appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
35252&$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
35253minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
35254of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
35255multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
35256handled them.
35257
35258
35259
35260
35261. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35262. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35263
35264.chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
35265This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
35266common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
35267
35268
35269
35270.section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
35271.cindex "smart host" "example router"
35272If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
35273should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
35274routing explicitly:
35275.code
35276send_to_smart_host:
35277 driver = manualroute
35278 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
35279 transport = remote_smtp
35280.endd
35281You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
35282If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
35283receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
35284synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
35285&<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
35286
35287
35288
35289
35290.section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
35291.cindex "mailing lists"
35292Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
35293requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
35294Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
35295
35296The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
35297is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
35298independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
35299lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
35300.code
35301lists:
35302 driver = redirect
35303 domains = lists.example
35304 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
35305 forbid_pipe
35306 forbid_file
35307 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
35308 no_more
35309.endd
35310This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
35311in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
35312such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
35313routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
35314
35315The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
35316expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
35317a mailing list.
35318
35319.oindex "&%errors_to%&"
35320The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
35321taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
35322original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
35323the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
35324
35325For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
35326&'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
35327&_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
35328&'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
35329There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
35330the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
35331such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
35332or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
35333&%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
35334
35335
35336
35337.section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
35338.cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
35339If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
35340delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
35341list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
35342list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
35343addresses are not rigorously checked.
35344
35345If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
35346entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
35347&%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
35348whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
35349&%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
35350
35351
35352
35353.section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
35354.cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
35355Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
35356in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
35357recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
35358cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
35359delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
35360account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
35361the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
35362message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
35363
35364If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
35365on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
35366router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
35367&"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
35368&"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
35369subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
35370failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
35371pre-existing messages.
35372
35373The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
35374addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
35375addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
35376&%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
35377one level of expansion anyway.
35378
35379
35380
35381.section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
35382.cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
35383The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
35384send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
35385from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
35386&%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
35387
35388The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
35389of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
35390.code
35391lists_request:
35392 driver = redirect
35393 domains = lists.example
35394 local_part_suffix = -request
35395 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
35396 no_more
35397
35398lists_post:
35399 driver = redirect
35400 domains = lists.example
35401 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
35402 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
35403 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
35404 forbid_pipe
35405 forbid_file
35406 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
35407 no_more
35408
35409lists_closed:
35410 driver = redirect
35411 domains = lists.example
35412 allow_fail
35413 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
35414.endd
35415All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
35416they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
35417&%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
35418mailing list.
35419
35420The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
35421checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
35422checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
35423necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
35424because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
35425not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
35426means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
35427&%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
35428&"unrouteable address"& error.
35429
35430The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
35431a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
35432the address, giving a suitable error message.
35433
35434
35435
35436
35437.section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
35438.cindex "VERP"
35439.cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
35440.cindex "envelope sender"
35441Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
35442are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
35443address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
35444the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
35445if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
35446original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
35447
35448.oindex &%errors_to%&
35449.oindex &%return_path%&
35450Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
35451facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
35452list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
35453these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
35454host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
35455of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
35456of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
35457.code
35458verp_smtp:
35459 driver = smtp
35460 max_rcpt = 1
35461 return_path = \
35462 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
35463 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
35464.endd
35465This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
35466SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
35467&"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
35468local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
35469example, that a message whose return path has been set to
35470&'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
35471&'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
35472rewritten as
35473.code
35474somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
35475.endd
35476.vindex "&$local_part$&"
35477For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
35478have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
35479achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
35480might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
35481&$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
35482
35483Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
35484probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
35485extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
35486can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
35487.code
35488dnslookup:
35489 driver = dnslookup
35490 domains = ! +local_domains
35491 transport = \
35492 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
35493 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
35494 no_more
35495.endd
35496If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
35497of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
35498routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
35499errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
35500address.
35501
35502On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
35503&(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
35504SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
35505and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
35506of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
35507.code
35508verp_dnslookup:
35509 driver = dnslookup
35510 domains = ! +local_domains
35511 transport = remote_smtp
35512 errors_to = \
35513 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
35514 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
35515 no_more
35516.endd
35517Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
35518configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
35519Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
35520router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
35521them.
35522
35523The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
35524message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
35525host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
35526a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
35527a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
35528than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
35529used).
35530
35531
35532
35533
35534
35535
35536.section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
35537.cindex "virtual domains"
35538.cindex "domain" "virtual"
35539The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
35540meanings:
35541
35542.ilist
35543A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
35544aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
35545top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
35546.next
35547One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
35548with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
35549have login accounts on that host.
35550.endlist
35551
35552The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
35553the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
35554aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
35555virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
35556whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
35557to a router of this form:
35558.code
35559virtual:
35560 driver = redirect
35561 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
35562 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
35563 no_more
35564.endd
35565The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
35566is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
35567domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
35568part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
35569setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
35570string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
35571
35572This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
35573follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
35574can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
35575a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
35576
35577The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
35578way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
35579valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
35580.code
35581my_domains:
35582 driver = accept
35583 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
35584 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
35585 transport = my_mailboxes
35586.endd
35587The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
35588can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
35589file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
35590option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
35591because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
35592follows:
35593.code
35594my_mailboxes:
35595 driver = appendfile
35596 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
35597 user = mail
35598.endd
35599This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
35600required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
35601
35602The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
35603requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
35604up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
35605information about the domains.
35606
35607
35608
35609.section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
35610.cindex "multiple mailboxes"
35611.cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
35612.cindex "local part" "prefix"
35613.cindex "local part" "suffix"
35614Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
35615incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
35616allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
35617identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
35618parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
35619&%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
35620example, consider this router:
35621.code
35622userforward:
35623 driver = redirect
35624 check_local_user
35625 file = $home/.forward
35626 local_part_suffix = -*
35627 local_part_suffix_optional
35628 allow_filter
35629.endd
35630.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
35631It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
35632&'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
35633cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
35634.code
35635if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
35636save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
35637endif
35638.endd
35639If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
35640fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
35641&%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
35642control over which suffixes are valid.
35643
35644Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
35645&_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
35646another MTA:
35647.code
35648userforward:
35649 driver = redirect
35650 check_local_user
35651 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
35652 local_part_suffix = -*
35653 local_part_suffix_optional
35654 allow_filter
35655.endd
35656If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
35657example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
35658does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
35659subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
35660&_.forward_& file to use as a default.
35661
35662
35663
35664.section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
35665.cindex "vacation processing"
35666The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
35667a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
35668(see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
35669This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
35670that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
35671
35672.ilist
35673A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
35674can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
35675alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
35676&_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
35677.code
35678spqr, vacation-spqr
35679.endd
35680.next
35681The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
35682vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
35683user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
35684ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
35685to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
35686message.
35687.endlist
35688
35689Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
35690use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
35691
35692
35693
35694.section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
35695.cindex "message" "copying every"
35696Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
35697be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
35698command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
35699each day's messages.
35700
35701There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
35702messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
35703delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
35704notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
35705
35706
35707
35708.section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
35709.cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
35710It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
35711Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
35712arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
35713permanently connected.
35714
35715Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
35716particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
35717Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
35718
35719
35720.section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
35721It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
35722host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
35723approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
35724being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
35725some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
35726to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
35727resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
35728
35729A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
35730intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
35731into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
35732format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
35733destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
35734in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
35735if required.
35736
35737On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
35738you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
35739intermittent host. For example:
35740.code
35741cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
35742.endd
35743This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
35744which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
35745online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
35746options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
35747causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
35748connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
35749immediately.
35750
35751If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
35752issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
35753mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
35754used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
35755avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
35756Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
35757arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
35758
35759
35760
35761.section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
35762The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
35763increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
35764connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
35765delivered immediately.
35766
35767.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
35768.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
35769.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
35770Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
35771not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
35772possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
35773each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
35774avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
35775&%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
35776first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
35777normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
35778destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
35779single SMTP connection.
35780
35781
35782
35783. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35784. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35785
35786.chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
35787 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
35788.cindex "client, non-queueing"
35789.cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
35790On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
35791email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
35792configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
35793However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
35794configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
35795&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
35796messages this way.
35797
35798If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
35799run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
35800any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
35801continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
35802email is not desirable.
35803
35804There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
35805&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
35806any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
35807host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
35808informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
35809to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
35810to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
35811
35812There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
35813that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
35814ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
35815before sending a message to the smart host.
35816
35817Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
35818tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
35819overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
35820
35821.oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
35822There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
35823Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
35824assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
35825just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
35826compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
35827router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
35828
35829When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
35830following ways:
35831
35832.ilist
35833A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
35834In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
35835.next
35836Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
35837assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
35838&%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
35839does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
35840successful, a zero return code is given.
35841.next
35842Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
35843be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
35844the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
35845must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
35846deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
35847are.
35848.next
35849If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
35850failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
35851successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
35852.next
35853Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
35854is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
35855smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
35856the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
35857there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
35858.next
35859If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
35860connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
35861failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
35862.next
35863When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
35864(as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
35865value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
35866are ever generated.
35867.next
35868No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
35869.next
35870A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
35871true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
35872&%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
35873.endlist
35874
35875The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
35876the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
35877deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
35878privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
35879to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
35880the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
35881
35882
35883
35884
35885. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35886. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35887
35888.chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
35889.scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
35890.cindex "log" "types of"
35891Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
35892and the panic log:
35893
35894.ilist
35895.cindex "main log"
35896The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
35897line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
35898down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
35899out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
35900them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
35901they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
35902analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
35903&<<SECTmailstat>>&).
35904.next
35905.cindex "reject log"
35906The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
35907of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
35908The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
35909the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
35910is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
35911lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
35912reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
35913host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
35914can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
35915false.
35916.next
35917.cindex "panic log"
35918.cindex "system log"
35919When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
35920error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
35921are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
35922other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
35923therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
35924regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
35925panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
35926is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
35927message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
35928.endlist
35929
35930Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
35931example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
35932In the log file, this would be all on one line:
35933.code
359342001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
35935 by QUIT
35936.endd
35937By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
35938ways of changing this:
35939
35940.ilist
35941You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
35942you set
35943.code
35944timezone = UTC
35945.endd
35946the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
35947.next
35948If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
35949example:
35950.code
359512003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
35952.endd
35953.endlist
35954
35955.cindex "log" "process ids in"
35956.cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
35957Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
35958request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
35959&<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
35960brackets, immediately after the time and date.
35961
35962
35963
35964
35965.section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
35966.cindex "log" "destination"
35967.cindex "log" "to file"
35968.cindex "log" "to syslog"
35969.cindex "syslog"
35970The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
35971should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
35972are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
35973arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
35974It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
35975need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
35976Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
35977
35978The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
35979&_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
35980configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
35981references to the host name:
35982.code
35983log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
35984.endd
35985It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
35986rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
35987start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
35988before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
35989configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
35990log at all.
35991
35992The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
35993list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
35994facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
35995colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
35996otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
35997point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
35998implying the use of a default path.
35999
36000When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
36001LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
36002&"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
36003mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
36004files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
36005equivalent to the setting:
36006.code
36007log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
36008.endd
36009If you do not specify anything at build time or run time,
36010or if you unset the option at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
36011that is where the logs are written.
36012
36013A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
36014are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
36015
36016Here are some examples of possible settings:
36017.display
36018&`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
36019&`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
36020&`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
36021&`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
36022.endd
36023If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
36024error is logged.
36025
36026
36027
36028.section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
36029.cindex "log" "cycling local files"
36030.cindex "cycling logs"
36031.cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
36032.cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
36033Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
36034log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
36035provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
36036main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
36037keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
36038
36039An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
36040and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
36041example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
36042message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
36043that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
36044something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
36045ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
36046&[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
36047does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
36048tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
36049for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
36050renamed.
36051
36052
36053
36054.section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
36055.cindex "log" "datestamped files"
36056Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
36057periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
36058for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
36059&_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
36060the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
36061point where the datestamp is required. For example:
36062.code
36063log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
36064log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
36065log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
36066log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
36067.endd
36068As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
36069examples of names generated by the above examples:
36070.code
36071/var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
36072/var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
36073/var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
36074/var/log/exim/main.200212
36075.endd
36076When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
36077files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
36078will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
36079run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
36080
36081The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
36082is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
36083When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
36084the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
36085non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
36086character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
36087log names:
36088.code
36089/var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
36090/var/log/exim-panic.log
36091/var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
36092/var/log/exim/panic
36093.endd
36094
36095
36096.section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
36097.cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
36098The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
36099except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
36100Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
36101that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
36102&"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
36103by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
36104&%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
36105SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
36106&_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
36107LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
36108the time and host name to each line.
36109The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
36110
36111.ilist
36112&'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
36113.next
36114&'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
36115.next
36116&'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
36117.endlist
36118
36119Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
36120written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
36121these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
36122by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
36123
36124Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
36125entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
36126these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
36127calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
36128870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
36129additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
36130replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
36131RFC 3164, you should set
36132.code
36133SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
36134.endd
36135in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
36136lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
36137
36138To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
36139entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
36140where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
36141components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
36142because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
36143delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
36144870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
36145&'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
36146name, and pid as added by syslog:
36147.code
36148[1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
36149[2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
36150[3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
36151[4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
36152[5/5] mple>)
36153.endd
36154The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
36155(LOG_NOTICE):
36156.code
36157[1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
36158[2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
36159[3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
36160[4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
36161[5\18] .example>)
36162[6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
36163[7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
36164[8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
36165[9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
36166[10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
36167[11\18] 09:43 +0100
36168[12\18] F From: <>
36169[13\18] Subject: this is a test header
36170[18\18] X-something: this is another header
36171[15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
36172[16\18] le>
36173[17\18] B Bcc:
36174[18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
36175.endd
36176Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
36177without modification.
36178
36179If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
36180display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
36181the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
36182where it is.
36183
36184
36185
36186.section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
36187One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
36188successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
36189picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
36190timestamp. The flags are:
36191.display
36192&`<=`& message arrival
36193&`(=`& message fakereject
36194&`=>`& normal message delivery
36195&`->`& additional address in same delivery
36196&`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
36197&`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
36198&`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
36199&`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
36200.endd
36201
36202
36203.section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
36204.cindex "log" "reception line"
36205The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
36206message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
36207several lines in order to fit it on the page:
36208.code
362092002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
36210 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
36211 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
36212.endd
36213The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
36214bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
36215generated, this is followed by an item of the form
36216.code
36217R=<message id>
36218.endd
36219which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
36220
36221.cindex "HELO"
36222.cindex "EHLO"
36223For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
36224record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
36225received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
36226host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
36227above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
36228&%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
36229by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
36230verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
36231EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
36232name in parentheses.
36233
36234Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
36235without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
36236the log containing text like these examples:
36237.code
36238H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
36239H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
36240.endd
36241This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
36242on.
36243
36244For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
36245the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
36246of Exim.
36247
36248.cindex "authentication" "logging"
36249.cindex "AUTH" "logging"
36250For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
36251message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
36252of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
36253extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
36254session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
36255suite that was used.
36256
36257.cindex log protocol
36258The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
36259hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
36260value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
36261there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
36262was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
36263&%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
36264authenticator name.
36265
36266.cindex "size" "of message"
36267The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
36268received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
36269headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
36270message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
36271other).
36272
36273The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
36274data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
36275
36276
36277
36278.section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
36279.cindex "log" "delivery line"
36280The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
36281delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
36282deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
36283to fit it on the page:
36284.code
362852002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
36286 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
362872002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
36288 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
36289 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
36290.endd
36291For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
36292after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
36293intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
36294last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
36295fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
36296
36297If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
36298followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
36299If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
36300option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
36301
36302If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
36303for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
36304.display
36305&`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
36306.endd
36307If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
36308parentheses afterwards.
36309
36310.cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
36311When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
36312SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
36313flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
36314down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
36315lines for the second and subsequent messages.
36316When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
36317DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
36318will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
36319TLS cipher information is still available.
36320
36321.cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
36322.cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
36323When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
36324line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
36325rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
36326
36327The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
36328&"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
36329
36330The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
36331data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
36332
36333
36334.section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
36335.cindex "discarded messages"
36336.cindex "message" "discarded"
36337.cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
36338When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
36339obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
36340.code
363412002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
36342 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
36343.endd
36344is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
36345because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
36346.code
363471999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
36348 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
36349.endd
36350
36351
36352.section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
36353When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
36354.code
363552002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
36356 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
36357.endd
36358In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
36359last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
36360written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
36361.code
363622002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
36363 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
36364.endd
36365When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
36366a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
36367appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
36368
36369
36370
36371.section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
36372.cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
36373If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
36374following form is logged:
36375.code
363761995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
36377 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
36378.endd
36379If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
36380the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
36381.code
363822002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
36383 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
36384 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
36385 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
36386 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
36387.endd
36388The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
36389used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
36390disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
36391flagged with &`**`&.
36392
36393
36394
36395.section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
36396.cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
36397If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
36398used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
36399&"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
36400
36401
36402
36403.section "Completion" "SECID257"
36404A line of the form
36405.code
364062002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
36407.endd
36408is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
36409at the end of its processing.
36410
36411
36412
36413
36414.section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
36415.cindex "log" "summary of fields"
36416A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
36417the following table:
36418.display
36419&`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
36420&`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
36421&` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
36422&`CV `& certificate verification status
36423&`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
36424&`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
36425&`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
36426&`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
36427&`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
36428&`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
36429&`H `& host name and IP address
36430&`I `& local interface used
36431&`K `& CHUNKING extension used
36432&`id `& message id for incoming message
36433&`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
36434&`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
36435&` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
36436&`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
36437&`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
36438&`Q `& alternate queue name
36439&`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
36440&` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
36441&`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
36442&` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
36443&`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
36444&`S `& size of message in bytes
36445&`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
36446&`ST `& shadow transport name
36447&`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
36448&`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
36449&` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
36450&`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
36451&`X `& TLS cipher suite
36452.endd
36453
36454
36455.section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
36456Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
36457self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
36458
36459.ilist
36460.cindex "retry" "time not reached"
36461&'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
36462during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
36463This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
36464during the first delivery attempt.
36465.next
36466&'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
36467temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
36468for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
36469.next
36470.cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
36471&'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
36472some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
36473common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
36474&'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
36475doing.
36476.next
36477.cindex "error" "ignored"
36478&'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
36479message:
36480.olist
36481Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
36482&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
36483.next
36484A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
36485failed. The delivery was discarded.
36486.next
36487A delivery set up by a router configured with
36488. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
36489. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
36490.code
36491 errors_to = <>
36492.endd
36493failed. The delivery was discarded.
36494.endlist olist
36495.next
36496.cindex DKIM "log line"
36497&'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
36498logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
36499.endlist ilist
36500
36501
36502
36503
36504
36505.section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
36506.cindex "log" "selectors"
36507By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
36508default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
36509&%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
36510example:
36511.code
36512log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
36513.endd
36514The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
36515selection marked by asterisks:
36516.display
36517&` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
36518&`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
36519&` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
36520&` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
36521&` arguments `& command line arguments
36522&`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
36523&`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
36524&` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
36525&` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
36526&`*dkim `& DKIM verified domain on <= lines
36527&` dkim_verbose `& separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature
36528&`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
36529&` dnssec `& DNSSEC secured lookups
36530&`*etrn `& ETRN commands
36531&`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
36532&` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
36533&` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
36534&` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
36535&`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
36536&` millisec `& millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times
36537&` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
36538&` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
36539&`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
36540&` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
36541&` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
36542&` pid `& Exim process id
36543&` proxy `& proxy address on <= and => lines
36544&` receive_time `& time taken to receive message
36545&` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
36546&` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
36547&`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
36548&`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
36549&` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
36550&` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
36551&`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
36552&`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
36553&`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
36554&`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
36555&` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
36556&` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
36557&` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
36558&` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
36559&` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
36560&` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
36561&` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
36562&`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
36563&`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
36564&` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
36565&` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
36566&` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
36567
36568&` all `& all of the above
36569.endd
36570See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
36571section &<<SECID99>>&
36572
36573More details on each of these items follows:
36574
36575.ilist
36576.cindex "8BITMIME"
36577.cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
36578&%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
36579which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
36580that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
36581&`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
36582&`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
36583.next
36584.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
36585&%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
36586its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
36587this log selector is set.
36588.next
36589.cindex "log" "rewriting"
36590.cindex "rewriting" "logging"
36591&%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
36592rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
36593such users cannot access the log).
36594.next
36595.cindex "log" "full parentage"
36596&%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
36597delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
36598parentheses between them.
36599.next
36600.cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
36601.cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
36602&%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
36603to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
36604feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
36605&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
36606privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
36607that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
36608are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
36609because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
36610only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
36611between the caller and Exim.
36612.next
36613.cindex "log" "connection rejections"
36614&%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
36615connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
36616.next
36617.cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
36618.cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
36619&%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
36620started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
36621messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
36622process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
36623.next
36624.cindex "log" "delivery duration"
36625&%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
36626perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
36627If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
36628precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
36629.next
36630.cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
36631.cindex "size" "of message"
36632&%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
36633the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
36634.next
36635.cindex log "DKIM verification"
36636.cindex DKIM "verification logging"
36637&%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signature in the header
36638verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
36639.next
36640.cindex log "DKIM verification"
36641.cindex DKIM "verification logging"
36642&%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
36643.next
36644.cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
36645.cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
36646.cindex "black list (DNS)"
36647&%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
36648DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
36649.next
36650.cindex log dnssec
36651.cindex dnssec logging
36652&%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
36653dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
36654For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
36655It does not cover helo-name verification.
36656For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
36657.next
36658.cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
36659.cindex "ETRN" "logging"
36660&%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
36661is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
36662command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
36663selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
36664.next
36665.cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
36666&%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
36667any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
36668log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
36669routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
36670.next
36671.cindex "log" "ident timeout"
36672.cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
36673&%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
36674client's ident port times out.
36675.next
36676.cindex "log" "incoming interface"
36677.cindex "log" "local interface"
36678.cindex "log" "local address and port"
36679.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
36680.cindex "interface" "logging"
36681&%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
36682to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
36683followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
36684added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, to
36685rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
36686The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
36687.next
36688.cindex log "incoming proxy address"
36689.cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
36690.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
36691&%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
36692of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
36693on a proxied connection
36694or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
36695See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
36696.next
36697.cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
36698.cindex "port" "logging remote"
36699.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
36700.vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
36701.vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
36702&%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
36703added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
36704in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
36705changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
36706&$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
36707important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
36708.next
36709.cindex "log" "dropped connection"
36710&%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
36711connection is unexpectedly dropped.
36712.next
36713.cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
36714.cindex millisecond logging
36715.cindex timestamps "millisecond, in logs"
36716&%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
36717appended to the seconds value.
36718.next
36719.cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
36720.cindex "log" "local interface"
36721.cindex "log" "local address and port"
36722.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
36723.cindex "interface" "logging"
36724&%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
36725interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
36726followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
36727off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
36728.next
36729.cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
36730.cindex "port" "logging outgoing remote"
36731.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
36732&%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
36733containing => tags) following the IP address.
36734The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
36735&%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
36736This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
36737configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
36738local port is a random ephemeral port.
36739.next
36740.cindex "log" "process ids in"
36741.cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
36742&%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
36743immediately after the time and date.
36744.next
36745.cindex "log" "queue run"
36746.cindex "queue runner" "logging"
36747&%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
36748.next
36749.cindex "log" "queue time"
36750&%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
36751local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
36752&`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
36753includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
36754This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
36755delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
36756message has been successfully received.
36757If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
36758precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
36759.next
36760&%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
36761the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
36762example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
36763message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
36764.next
36765.cindex "log" "receive duration"
36766&%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
36767perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
36768If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
36769precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
36770.next
36771.cindex "log" "recipients"
36772&%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
36773as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
36774that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
36775addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
36776has taken place.
36777Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
36778in the list.
36779.next
36780.cindex "log" "sender reception"
36781&%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
36782the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
36783&"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
36784.next
36785.cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
36786&%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
36787rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
36788log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
36789rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
36790.next
36791.cindex "log" "retry defer"
36792&%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
36793retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
36794message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
36795attempt.
36796.next
36797.cindex "log" "return path"
36798&%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
36799the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
36800This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
36801or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
36802.next
36803.cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
36804&%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
36805and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
36806This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
36807necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
36808.next
36809.cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
36810&%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
36811gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
36812the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
36813detail is lost.
36814.next
36815.cindex "log" "size rejection"
36816&%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
36817it is too big.
36818.next
36819.cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
36820.cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
36821&%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
36822queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
36823it.
36824.cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
36825The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
36826.next
36827.cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
36828.cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
36829.cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
36830&%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
36831outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
36832A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
36833response.
36834.next
36835.cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
36836.cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
36837&%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
36838established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
36839&%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
36840only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
36841processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
36842dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
36843not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
36844of connections unless this selector is enabled.
36845
36846For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
36847included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
36848reset if the daemon is restarted.
36849Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
36850subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
36851whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
36852match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
36853logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
36854.next
36855.cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
36856.cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
36857&%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
36858RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
36859and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
36860line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
36861.next
36862.cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
36863.cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
36864&%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
36865connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
36866the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
36867does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
36868an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
36869already have their own log lines.
36870
36871The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
36872way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
36873If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
36874an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
36875DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
36876the same logging options.
36877
36878Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
36879is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
36880.code
36881C=EHLO,QUIT
36882.endd
36883shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
36884than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
36885the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
36886setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
36887have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
36888.next
36889&%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
36890colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
36891log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
36892was accepted or used.
36893.next
36894.cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
36895.cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
36896&%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
36897encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
36898because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
36899been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
36900it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
36901received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
36902.next
36903.cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
36904.cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
36905.cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
36906.cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
36907.cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
36908&%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
36909encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
36910external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
36911using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
36912.next
36913.cindex "log" "subject"
36914.cindex "subject, logging"
36915&%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
36916preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
36917Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
36918specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
36919unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
36920.next
36921.cindex "log" "certificate verification"
36922.cindex log DANE
36923.cindex DANE logging
36924&%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
36925when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
36926verified
36927using a CA trust anchor,
36928&`CA=dane`& if using a DNS trust anchor,
36929and &`CV=no`& if not.
36930.next
36931.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
36932.cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
36933&%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
36934connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
36935.next
36936.cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
36937.cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
36938&%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
36939connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
36940added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
36941.next
36942.cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
36943.cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
36944&%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
36945the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
36946added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
36947.next
36948.cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
36949&%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
36950result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
36951.endlist
36952
36953
36954.section "Message log" "SECID260"
36955.cindex "message" "log file for"
36956.cindex "log" "message log; description of"
36957.cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
36958.oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
36959In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
36960that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
36961they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
36962message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
36963makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
36964to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
36965is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
36966only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
36967
36968On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
36969per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
36970&%message_logs%& option false.
36971.ecindex IIDloggen
36972
36973
36974
36975
36976. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36977. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36978
36979.chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
36980.scindex IIDutils "utilities"
36981A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
36982described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
36983the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
36984
36985.itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
36986.irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
36987 "list what Exim processes are doing"
36988.irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
36989.irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
36990.irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
36991.irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
36992 various criteria"
36993.irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
36994.irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
36995 "extract statistics from the log"
36996.irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
36997 "check address acceptance from given IP"
36998.irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
36999.irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
37000.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
37001.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
37002.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
37003.irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
37004.endtable
37005
37006Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
37007&'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
37008&url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
37009
37010
37011
37012
37013.section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
37014.cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
37015.cindex "process, querying"
37016.cindex "SIGUSR1"
37017On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
37018(most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
37019a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
37020Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
37021processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
37022second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
37023order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
37024send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
37025
37026&*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
37027use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
37028script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
37029
37030
37031Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
37032varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
37033but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
37034system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
37035it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
37036options:
37037.display
37038&`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
37039&`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
37040&`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
37041&`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
37042.endd
37043An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
37044.code
37045164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
3704610483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
3704710492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
37048 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
3704910592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
3705010628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
37051.endd
37052The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
37053been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
37054
37055
37056
37057.section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
37058.cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
37059.cindex "queue" "grepping"
37060This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
37061.code
37062exim -bpu
37063.endd
37064or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
37065.code
37066exim -bp
37067.endd
37068The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
37069contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
37070
37071to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
37072that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
37073
37074.vlist
37075.vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
37076Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
37077tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
37078.code
37079exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
37080.endd
37081.vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
37082Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
37083tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
37084
37085.vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
37086Match against the size field.
37087
37088.vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
37089Match messages that are younger than the given time.
37090
37091.vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
37092Match messages that are older than the given time.
37093
37094.vitem &*-z*&
37095Match only frozen messages.
37096
37097.vitem &*-x*&
37098Match only non-frozen messages.
37099.endlist
37100
37101The following options control the format of the output:
37102
37103.vlist
37104.vitem &*-c*&
37105Display only the count of matching messages.
37106
37107.vitem &*-l*&
37108Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
37109the default.
37110
37111.vitem &*-i*&
37112Display message ids only.
37113
37114.vitem &*-b*&
37115Brief format &-- one line per message.
37116
37117.vitem &*-R*&
37118Display messages in reverse order.
37119
37120.vitem &*-a*&
37121Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
37122.endlist
37123
37124There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
37125
37126
37127
37128.section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
37129.cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
37130.cindex "queue" "summary"
37131The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
37132-bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
37133running a command such as
37134.code
37135exim -bp | exiqsumm
37136.endd
37137The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
37138it, as in the following example:
37139.code
371403 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
37141.endd
37142Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
37143volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
37144been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
37145number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
37146
37147A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
37148domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
37149the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
37150respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
37151domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
37152separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
37153sender.
37154
37155The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
37156this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
37157generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
37158option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
37159level"& addresses).
37160
37161
37162
37163
37164.section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
37165 "SECTextspeinf"
37166.cindex "&'exigrep'&"
37167.cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
37168The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
37169files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
37170extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
37171match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
37172given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
37173The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
37174If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
37175included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
37176.display
37177&`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
37178.endd
37179If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
37180
37181The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
37182condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
37183they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
37184
37185By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
37186makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
37187large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
37188option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
37189case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
37190
37191The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
37192pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
37193regular expression.
37194
37195The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
37196if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
37197
37198The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
37199that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
37200normally.
37201
37202Example of &%-M%&:
37203user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
37204&'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
37205displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
37206the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
37207when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
37208&"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
37209search term.
37210
37211If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
37212ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
37213whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
37214If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
37215autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
37216
37217
37218.section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
37219.cindex "&'exipick'&"
37220John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
37221lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
37222of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
37223the &%--help%& option.
37224
37225
37226.section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
37227.cindex "log" "cycling local files"
37228.cindex "cycling logs"
37229.cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
37230The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
37231&'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
37232you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
37233&<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
37234for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
37235There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
37236.ilist
37237&%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
37238default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
37239.next
37240&%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
37241&%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
37242overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
37243configuration.
37244.endlist
37245
37246Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
37247the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
37248run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
37249&_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
37250&%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
37251logs are handled similarly.
37252
37253If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
37254&_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
37255to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
37256any existing log files.
37257
37258If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
37259the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
37260using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
37261setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
37262root &%crontab%& entry of the form
37263.code
372641 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
37265.endd
37266assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
37267&'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
37268
37269
37270
37271.section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
37272.cindex "statistics"
37273.cindex "&'eximstats'&"
37274A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
37275information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
37276Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
37277LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
37278
37279The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
37280latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
37281lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
37282various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
37283list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
37284.code
37285eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
37286.endd
37287By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
37288messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
37289both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
37290are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
37291addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
37292options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
37293also produced per user.
37294
37295The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
37296histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
37297hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
37298example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
37299as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
37300
37301Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
37302have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
37303messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
37304and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
37305recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
37306an entirely separate message.
37307
37308&'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
37309of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
37310each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
37311not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
37312least one address that failed.
37313
37314The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
37315or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
37316transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
37317(default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
37318a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
37319senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
37320and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
37321
37322The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
37323came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
37324without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
37325
37326There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
37327outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
37328by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
37329.code
37330perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
37331.endd
37332
37333.section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
37334.cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
37335.cindex "policy control" "checking access"
37336.cindex "checking access"
37337The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
37338debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
37339policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
37340familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
37341sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
37342access?"& without bothering with any further details.
37343
37344The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
37345two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
37346.code
37347exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
37348.endd
37349The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
37350given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
37351connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
37352is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
37353.code
37354Rejected:
37355550 Relay not permitted
37356.endd
37357When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
37358for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
37359options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
37360that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
37361you can use:
37362.code
37363exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
37364 -f himself@there.example
37365.endd
37366Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
37367mandatory arguments.
37368
37369Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
37370while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
37371&%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
37372
37373
37374
37375.section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
37376.cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
37377.cindex "building DBM files"
37378.cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
37379.cindex "lower casing"
37380.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
37381The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
37382the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
37383&<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
37384names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
37385can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
37386
37387A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
37388the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
37389&'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
37390strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
37391files.
37392
37393The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
37394single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
37395It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
37396well.
37397
37398.cindex "USE_DB"
37399If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
37400configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
37401names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
37402a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
37403.code
37404exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
37405.endd
37406reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
37407&_/etc/aliases.db_&.
37408
37409In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
37410Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
37411environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
37412&'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
37413when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
37414recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
37415
37416If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
37417finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
37418option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
37419this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
37420&%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
37421There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
37422&%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
37423return code is 2.
37424
37425
37426
37427
37428.section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
37429.cindex "retry" "times"
37430.cindex "&'exinext'&"
37431A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
37432fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
37433complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
37434information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
37435is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
37436output. For example:
37437.code
37438$ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
37439kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
37440 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
37441 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
37442 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
37443roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
37444 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
37445 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
37446 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
37447 past final cutoff time
37448.endd
37449You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
37450will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
37451A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
37452message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
37453suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
37454&'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
37455run very often.
37456
37457The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
37458of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
37459passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
37460configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
37461file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
37462environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
37463
37464
37465
37466.section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
37467.cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
37468.cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
37469Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
37470uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
37471arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
37472second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
37473
37474.ilist
37475&'retry'&: the database of retry information
37476.next
37477&'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
37478for remote hosts
37479.next
37480&'callout'&: the callout cache
37481.next
37482&'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
37483.next
37484&'misc'&: other hints data
37485.endlist
37486
37487The &'misc'& database is used for
37488
37489.ilist
37490Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
37491.next
37492Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
37493&(smtp)& transport)
37494.next
37495Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
37496in a transport)
37497.endlist
37498
37499
37500
37501.section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
37502.cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
37503The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
37504&'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
37505spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
37506.code
37507exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
37508.endd
37509Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
37510.code
37511T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
3751231-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
37513.endd
37514The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
37515of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
37516transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
37517a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
37518address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
37519transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
37520to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
37521and a textual description of the error.
37522
37523The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
37524the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
37525ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
37526exceeded.
37527
37528Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
37529consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
37530waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
37531one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
37532may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
37533may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
37534cross-references.
37535
37536
37537
37538.section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
37539.cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
37540The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
37541database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
37542days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
37543updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
37544since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
37545for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
37546updated sufficiently often.
37547
37548The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
37549followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
37550the retry database:
37551.code
37552exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
37553.endd
37554Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
37555message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
37556they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
37557are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
37558types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
37559message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
37560queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
37561&'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
37562For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
37563removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
37564whenever it removes information from the database.
37565
37566Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
37567needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
37568down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
37569first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
37570records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
37571
37572It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
37573hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
37574a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
37575work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
37576but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
37577After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
37578point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
37579tidied.
37580
37581&*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
37582databases is likely to keep on increasing.
37583
37584
37585
37586
37587.section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
37588.cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
37589The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
37590Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
37591getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
37592is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
37593key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
37594displayed.
37595
37596If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
37597except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
37598out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
37599data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
37600by new data, for example:
37601.code
37602> 4 951102:1000
37603.endd
37604resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
37605sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
37606used as optional separators.
37607
37608
37609
37610
37611.section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
37612.cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
37613.cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
37614.cindex "locking mailboxes"
37615The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
37616Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
37617&'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
37618a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
37619the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
37620argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
37621second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
37622is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
37623is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
37624
37625.vlist
37626.vitem &%-fcntl%&
37627Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
37628
37629.vitem &%-flock%&
37630Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
37631supports it.
37632
37633.vitem &%-interval%&
37634This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
37635interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
37636
37637.vitem &%-lockfile%&
37638Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
37639
37640.vitem &%-mbx%&
37641Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
37642
37643.vitem &%-q%&
37644Suppress verification output.
37645
37646.vitem &%-retries%&
37647This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
37648the lock (default 10).
37649
37650.vitem &%-restore_time%&
37651This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
37652locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
37653example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
37654subsequently sees.
37655
37656.vitem &%-timeout%&
37657This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
37658timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
37659default), a non-blocking call is used.
37660
37661.vitem &%-v%&
37662Generate verbose output.
37663.endlist
37664
37665If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
37666default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
37667mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
37668&%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
37669requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
37670file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
37671more than 30 minutes old.
37672
37673The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
37674&%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
37675to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
37676&_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
37677number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
37678can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
37679
37680The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
37681&%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
37682suppresses all output except error messages.
37683
37684A command such as
37685.code
37686exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
37687.endd
37688runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
37689.display
37690&`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
37691<&'some commands'&>
37692&`End`&
37693.endd
37694runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
37695suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
37696such as
37697.code
37698exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
37699 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
37700.endd
37701Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
37702second argument &-- hence the quotes.
37703.ecindex IIDutils
37704
37705
37706. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37707. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37708
37709.chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
37710.scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
37711.cindex "X-windows"
37712.cindex "&'eximon'&"
37713.cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
37714.cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
37715The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
37716about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
37717perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
37718such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
37719monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
37720
37721
37722
37723.section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
37724The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
37725script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
37726binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
37727be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
37728&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
37729parameters are for.
37730
37731The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
37732a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
37733preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
37734.code
37735EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
37736.endd
37737(in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
37738the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
37739overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
37740&'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
37741syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
37742
37743X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
37744way. For example, a resource setting of the form
37745.code
37746Eximon*background: gray94
37747.endd
37748changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
37749stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
37750black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
37751data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
37752&"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
37753For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
37754reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
37755.code
37756xrdb -merge <<End
37757Eximon*highlight: gray
37758End
37759.endd
37760.cindex "admin user"
37761In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
37762&'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
37763
37764The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
37765contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
37766if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
37767binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
37768versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
37769
37770The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
37771more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
37772main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
37773delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
37774different parts of the display.
37775
37776
37777
37778
37779.section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
37780.cindex "stripchart"
37781The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
37782be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
37783&_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
37784configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
37785it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
37786hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
37787received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
37788period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
37789parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
37790
37791The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
37792displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
37793title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
37794For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
37795
37796It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
37797a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
37798to a single partition.
37799
37800.cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
37801This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
37802the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
37803this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
37804100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
37805SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
37806&_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
37807
37808
37809
37810
37811.section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
37812.cindex "size" "of monitor window"
37813.cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
37814.cindex "window size"
37815Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
37816to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
37817shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
37818stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
37819the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
37820in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
37821
37822When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
37823currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
37824size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
37825remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
37826
37827The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
37828stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
37829the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
37830The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
37831&'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
37832the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37833
37834Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
37835built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
37836START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37837
37838
37839
37840.section "The log display" "SECID267"
37841.cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
37842The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
37843the main log is maintained.
37844To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
37845removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
37846The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
37847syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
37848to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
37849
37850The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
37851move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
37852scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
37853LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
37854to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
37855much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
37856a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
37857only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
37858available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
37859normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
37860configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37861
37862Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
37863and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
37864respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
37865It cannot go further back up the log.
37866
37867The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
37868normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
37869by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
37870by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
37871back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
37872the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
37873
37874Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
37875There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
37876the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
37877happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
37878&"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
37879^C is typed the search is cancelled.
37880
37881The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
37882widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
37883&"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
37884eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
37885However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
37886provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
37887come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
37888unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
37889on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
37890window.
37891
37892
37893
37894.section "The queue display" "SECID268"
37895.cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
37896The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
37897are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
37898as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
37899parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
37900at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
37901the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
37902there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
37903to force an update of the queue display at any time.
37904
37905When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
37906and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
37907with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
37908pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
37909type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
37910such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
37911of the texts, the message is not displayed.
37912
37913If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
37914are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
37915example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
37916&'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
37917has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
37918cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
37919a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
37920
37921While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
37922else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
37923queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
37924pressing the &"Hide"& button.
37925
37926The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
37927time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
37928message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
37929a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
37930recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
37931listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
37932an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
37933not shown.
37934
37935.cindex "frozen messages" "display"
37936If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
37937
37938The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
37939of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
37940The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
37941available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
37942display is updated.
37943
37944
37945
37946.section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
37947.cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
37948If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
37949pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
37950line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
37951any selected text.
37952
37953If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
37954MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
37955set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
37956value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
37957run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
37958.code
37959EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
37960.endd
37961The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
37962follows:
37963
37964.ilist
37965&'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
37966in a new text window.
37967.next
37968&'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
37969information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
37970&<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
37971.next
37972&'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
37973displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
37974amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
37975option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
37976.next
37977&'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
37978delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
37979frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
37980a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
37981up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
37982.next
37983&'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
37984that the message be frozen.
37985.next
37986.cindex "thawing messages"
37987.cindex "unfreezing messages"
37988.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
37989&'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
37990that the message be thawed.
37991.next
37992.cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
37993&'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
37994that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
37995for any remaining undelivered addresses.
37996.next
37997&'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
37998that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
37999message.
38000.next
38001&'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
38002be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
38003is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
38004Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
38005causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
38006additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
38007which case no action is taken.
38008.next
38009&'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
38010can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
38011is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
38012Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
38013causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
38014recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
38015case no action is taken.
38016.next
38017&'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
38018mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
38019.next
38020&'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
38021sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
38022&%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
38023in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
38024bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
38025not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
38026the address is qualified with that domain.
38027.endlist
38028
38029When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
38030other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
38031particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
38032output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
38033from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
38034&_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
38035if no output is generated.
38036
38037The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
38038thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
38039&_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
38040force an update of the display after one of these actions.
38041
38042In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
38043cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
38044and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
38045.ecindex IIDeximon
38046
38047
38048
38049
38050
38051. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38052. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38053
38054.chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
38055.scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
38056This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
38057which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
38058
38059For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
38060Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
38061existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
38062chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
38063security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
38064its security as compared with other MTAs.
38065
38066What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
38067have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
38068absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
38069as soon as possible.
38070
38071
38072.section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
38073.cindex "security" "build-time features"
38074There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
38075to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
38076Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
38077penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
38078
38079.ilist
38080ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
38081start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
38082names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
38083value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
38084&_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
38085default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
38086
38087If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
38088which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
38089into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
38090configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
38091.next
38092
38093If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
38094or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
38095file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
38096the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
38097root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
38098right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
38099reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
38100it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
38101privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
38102separate commands.
38103
38104.next
38105The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
38106with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
38107CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
38108requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
38109the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
38110but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
38111previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
38112.next
38113If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
38114is disabled.
38115.next
38116FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
38117never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
38118option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
38119to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
38120is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
38121.endlist
38122
38123
38124
38125.section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
38126.cindex "setuid"
38127.cindex "root privilege"
38128The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
38129privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
38130example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
38131may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
38132discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
38133is required for two things:
38134
38135.ilist
38136To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
38137the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
38138not required.
38139.next
38140To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
38141perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
38142configuration.
38143.endlist
38144
38145It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
38146receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
38147obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
38148For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
38149&_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
38150group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
38151is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
38152&'mail'& or another user name altogether.
38153
38154Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
38155abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
38156&[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
38157
38158After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
38159uid and gid in the following cases:
38160
38161.ilist
38162.oindex "&%-C%&"
38163.oindex "&%-D%&"
38164If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
38165the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
38166calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
38167the calling process.
38168However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
38169option may not be used at all.
38170If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
38171can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
38172user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
38173.next
38174.oindex "&%-be%&"
38175.oindex "&%-bf%&"
38176.oindex "&%-bF%&"
38177If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
38178(&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
38179calling process.
38180.next
38181If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
38182process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
38183uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
38184runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
38185testing address verification
38186.oindex "&%-bv%&"
38187.oindex "&%-bh%&"
38188(the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
38189option).
38190.next
38191For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
38192remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
38193.endlist
38194
38195The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
38196
38197.ilist
38198A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
38199user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
38200function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
38201will be used during message reception.
38202.next
38203A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
38204job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
38205.next
38206A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
38207but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
38208subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
38209deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
38210remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
38211subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
38212while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
38213generating bounce and warning messages.
38214
38215While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
38216process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
38217this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
38218gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
38219.next
38220A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
38221the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
38222.endlist
38223
38224
38225
38226
38227.section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
38228.cindex "privilege, running without"
38229.cindex "unprivileged running"
38230.cindex "root privilege" "running without"
38231Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
38232operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
38233by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
38234gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
38235(and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
38236routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
38237to any other uid.
38238
38239.cindex SIGHUP
38240.cindex "daemon" "restarting"
38241Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
38242that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
38243correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
38244
38245An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
38246to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
38247process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
38248when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
38249SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
38250
38251It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
38252stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
38253been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
38254effect.
38255
38256If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
38257set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
38258to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
38259
38260In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
38261those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
38262Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
38263that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
38264discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
38265have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
38266number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
38267address this problem at this time.
38268
38269For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
38270is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
38271&%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
38272be used in the most straightforward way.
38273
38274If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
38275number of restrictions on what you can do:
38276
38277.ilist
38278You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
38279&%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
38280normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
38281work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
38282explicit specification of another user causes an error.
38283.next
38284Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
38285not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
38286.next
38287Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
38288the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
38289and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
38290enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
38291.next
38292Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
38293some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
38294
38295.olist
38296They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
38297implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
38298mode of the mailbox files themselves.
38299.next
38300You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
38301owned by the Exim user.
38302.next
38303You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
38304on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
38305mailboxes need to be created manually.
38306.endlist olist
38307.endlist ilist
38308
38309
38310These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
38311However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
38312gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
38313gives more security at essentially no cost.
38314
38315If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
38316&<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
38317
38318
38319
38320
38321.section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
38322Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
38323are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
38324
38325
38326
38327.section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
38328.cindex "security" "local commands"
38329.cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
38330There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
38331commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
38332configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
38333run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
38334
38335.ilist
38336Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
38337injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
38338be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
38339allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
38340has &%use_shell%& enabled.
38341.next
38342A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
38343&%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
38344&_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
38345hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
38346NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
38347forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
38348need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
38349.next
38350The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
38351administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
38352Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
38353.next
38354Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
38355taint checking might apply to their usage.
38356.next
38357Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
38358administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
38359instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
38360.next
38361Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
38362Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
38363each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
38364of opaque strings.
38365The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
38366real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
38367injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
38368Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
38369.endlist
38370
38371
38372
38373
38374.section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
38375.cindex "security" "data sources"
38376.cindex "security" "regular expressions"
38377.cindex "regular expressions" "security"
38378.cindex "PCRE" "security"
38379If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
38380are some issues to be aware of:
38381
38382.ilist
38383Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
38384.next
38385Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
38386.next
38387Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
38388data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
38389"backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
38390expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
38391when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
38392possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
38393data.
38394.next
38395It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
38396&%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
38397items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
38398.next
38399Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
38400expected to yield one result.
38401.endlist
38402
38403
38404
38405
38406.section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
38407.cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
38408.cindex "IP source routing"
38409Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
38410some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
38411IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
38412IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
38413
38414
38415
38416.section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
38417Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
38418be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
38419
38420
38421
38422
38423.section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
38424.cindex "trusted users"
38425.cindex "admin user"
38426.cindex "privileged user"
38427.cindex "user" "trusted"
38428.cindex "user" "admin"
38429Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
38430able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
38431addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
38432local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
38433permit a remote host to be specified.
38434
38435.oindex "&%-f%&"
38436However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
38437in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
38438message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
38439but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
38440permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
38441the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
38442
38443Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
38444other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
38445the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
38446as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
38447group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
38448
38449Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
38450can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
38451them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
38452the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
38453includes the contents of files on the spool.
38454
38455.oindex "&%-M%&"
38456.oindex "&%-q%&"
38457By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
38458delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
38459restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
38460Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
38461queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
38462setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
38463
38464Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
38465the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
38466the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
38467group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
38468the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
38469unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
38470files.
38471
38472By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
38473introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
38474setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
38475This affects most of the checking options,
38476such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
38477
38478
38479.section "Spool files" "SECID275"
38480.cindex "spool directory" "files"
38481Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
38482set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
38483&_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
38484any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
38485
38486
38487
38488.section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
38489Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
38490of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
38491with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
38492to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
38493this.
38494
38495
38496
38497.section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
38498The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
38499are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
38500Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
38501converted output.
38502
38503
38504
38505.section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
38506Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
38507to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
38508does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
38509arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
38510
38511
38512
38513.section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
38514Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
38515defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
38516loading it.
38517
38518
38519.section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
38520.cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
38521A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
38522&'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
38523The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
38524that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
38525conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
38526
38527The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
38528the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
38529string.
38530
38531
38532
38533.section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
38534Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
38535formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
38536the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
38537
38538
38539
38540.section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
38541These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
38542enough to hold the result.
38543.ecindex IIDsecurcon
38544
38545
38546
38547
38548. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38549. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38550
38551.chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
38552.scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
38553.scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
38554.scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
38555.cindex "spool files" "editing"
38556A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
38557followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
38558the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
38559kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
38560two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
38561is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
38562themselves are recoverable.
38563
38564Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
38565need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
38566on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
38567
38568.ilist
38569You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
38570fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
38571which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
38572place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
38573lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
38574.next
38575.vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
38576If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
38577&$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
38578cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
38579.next
38580If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
38581.next
38582If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
38583signature.
38584.endlist
38585All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
38586
38587Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
38588its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
38589files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
38590the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
38591the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
38592is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
38593file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
38594-J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
38595attempt.
38596
38597Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
38598These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
38599They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
38600relics of crashes and can be removed.
38601
38602.section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
38603.cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
38604.cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
38605The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
38606process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
38607gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
38608message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
38609normally the Exim user.
38610
38611The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
38612transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
38613empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
38614in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
38615created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
38616&%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
38617leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
38618&"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
38619
38620The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
38621was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
38622start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
38623warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
38624
38625There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
38626order, and are omitted when not relevant:
38627
38628.vlist
38629.vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38630This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
38631&%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
38632recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
38633this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
38634identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
38635the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
38636the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
38637the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
38638newlines.
38639
38640.vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38641A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
38642defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
38643The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
38644starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
38645character. It may contain internal newlines.
38646
38647.vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38648A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
38649Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
38650length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
38651starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
38652character. It may contain internal newlines.
38653
38654.vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
38655This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
38656&$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
38657
38658.vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
38659This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
38660lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
38661transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
38662messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
38663
38664.vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
38665This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
38666(to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
38667time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
38668hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
38669
38670.vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
38671The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
38672&-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
38673
38674.vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
38675The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
38676&$authenticated_sender$& variable.
38677
38678.vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
38679This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
38680present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
38681
38682.vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
38683This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
38684present if the number is greater than zero.
38685
38686.vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
38687This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
38688file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
38689
38690.vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
38691.cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
38692The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
38693
38694.vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
38695This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
38696command.
38697
38698.vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
38699This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
38700the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
38701messages.
38702
38703.vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
38704If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
38705the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
38706&$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
38707
38708.vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
38709This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
38710address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
38711
38712.vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
38713.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
38714.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
38715This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
38716if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
38717received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
38718
38719.vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
38720For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
38721unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
38722ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
38723supplied by the remote host, if any.
38724
38725.vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
38726This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
38727which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
38728generated messages.
38729
38730.vitem &%-local%&
38731The message is from a local sender.
38732
38733.vitem &%-localerror%&
38734The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
38735
38736.vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
38737This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
38738when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
38739variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
38740
38741.vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
38742The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
38743Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
38744
38745.vitem &%-N%&
38746A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
38747actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
38748&%-N%& is assumed.
38749
38750.vitem &%-received_protocol%&
38751This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
38752the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
38753
38754.vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
38755The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
38756to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
38757
38758.vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
38759If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
38760of &$spam_score_int$&.
38761
38762.vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
38763The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
38764rather than Unix-format.
38765The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
38766There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
38767
38768.vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
38769A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
38770certificate was verified by the server.
38771
38772.vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
38773When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
38774name of the cipher suite that was used.
38775
38776.vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
38777When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
38778was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
38779certificate.
38780.endlist
38781
38782Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
38783is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
38784line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
38785is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
38786the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
38787balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
38788to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
38789original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
38790addresses are complete.
38791
38792If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
38793the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
38794Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
38795tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
38796right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
38797follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
38798.code
38799YY darcy@austen.fict.example
38800NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
38801NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38802.endd
38803After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
38804This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
38805recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
38806delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
38807example:
38808.code
388094
38810editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38811darcy@austen.fict.example
38812rdo@foundation
38813alice@wonderland.fict.example
38814.endd
38815However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
38816result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
38817line is of the following form:
38818.display
38819<&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
38820 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
38821.endd
38822The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
38823the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
38824fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
38825original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
38826envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
38827length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
38828characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
38829that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
38830
38831
38832A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
38833which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
38834when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
38835character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
38836embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
38837following:
38838
38839.table2 50pt
38840.row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
38841.row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
38842.row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
38843.row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
38844.row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
38845.row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
38846.row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
38847.row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
38848.row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
38849.row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
38850.endtable
38851
38852Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
38853purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
38854typical set of headers:
38855.code
38856111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
38857id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
38858049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
38859038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
38860042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
38861049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
38862099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
38863darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38864104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
38865darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38866038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
38867.endd
38868The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
38869&'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
38870unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
38871.ecindex IIDforspo1
38872.ecindex IIDforspo2
38873.ecindex IIDforspo3
38874
38875.section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
38876The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
38877an ASCII newline character.
38878However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
38879can have an alternate format.
38880This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
38881The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
38882suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
38883ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
38884Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
38885There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
38886
38887. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38888. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38889
38890.chapter "DKIM and SPF" "CHAPdkim" &&&
38891 "DKIM and SPF Support"
38892.cindex "DKIM"
38893
38894.section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
38895
38896DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
38897linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
38898be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
38899DKIM is documented in RFC 6376.
38900
38901As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
38902by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
38903any original DKIM signature.
38904
38905DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
38906It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
38907
38908Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
38909.olist
38910Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
38911It can co-exist with all other Exim features
38912(including transport filters)
38913except cutthrough delivery.
38914.next
38915Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
38916ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
38917different signature contexts.
38918.endlist
38919
38920In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
38921default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
38922Exim's standard controls.
38923
38924Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
38925on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
38926
38927Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
38928When set, for each signature in incoming email,
38929exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
38930signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
38931.code
389322009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
38933 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
38934 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
38935 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
38936.endd
38937
38938You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
38939or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
38940control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
38941where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
38942senders).
38943
38944
38945.section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECDKIMSIGN"
38946.cindex "DKIM" "signing"
38947
38948For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
38949Note that RFC 8301 says:
38950.code
38951rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
38952
38953Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
38954Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
38955.endd
38956
38957Note also that the key content (the 'p=' field)
38958in the DNS record is different between RSA and EC keys;
38959for the former it is the base64 of the ASN.1 for the RSA public key
38960(equivalent to the private-key .pem with the header/trailer stripped)
38961but for EC keys it is the base64 of the pure key; no ASN.1 wrapping.
38962
38963Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
38964These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
38965
38966.option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
38967The domain(s) you want to sign with.
38968After expansion, this can be a list.
38969Each element in turn is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
38970while expanding the remaining signing options.
38971If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
38972and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
38973
38974.option dkim_selector smtp string list&!! unset
38975This sets the key selector string.
38976After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
38977Each element in turn is put in the expansion
38978variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
38979option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
38980If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
38981and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
38982
38983.option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
38984This sets the private key to use.
38985You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
38986&%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
38987The result can either
38988.ilist
38989be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor (.pem file), including line breaks
38990.next
38991with GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
38992be a valid Ed25519 private key (same format as above)
38993.next
38994start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
38995the private key
38996.next
38997be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
38998be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
38999is set.
39000.endlist
39001
39002To generate keys under OpenSSL:
39003.code
39004openssl genrsa -out dkim_rsa.private 2048
39005openssl rsa -in dkim_rsa.private -out /dev/stdout -pubout -outform PEM
39006.endd
39007Take the base-64 lines from the output of the second command, concatenated,
39008for the DNS TXT record.
39009See section 3.6 of RFC6376 for the record specification.
39010
39011Under GnuTLS:
39012.code
39013certtool --generate-privkey --rsa --bits=2048 --password='' -8 --outfile=dkim_rsa.private
39014certtool --load-privkey=dkim_rsa.private --pubkey-info
39015.endd
39016
39017Note that RFC 8301 says:
39018.code
39019Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
39020Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
39021.endd
39022
39023Support for EC keys is being developed under
39024&url(https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-dcrup-dkim-crypto/).
39025They are considerably smaller than RSA keys for equivalent protection.
39026As they are a recent development, users should consider dual-signing
39027(by setting a list of selectors, and an expansion for this option)
39028for some transition period.
39029The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
39030for EC keys.
39031
39032OpenSSL 1.1.1 and GnuTLS 3.6.0 can create Ed25519 private keys:
39033.code
39034openssl genpkey -algorithm ed25519 -out dkim_ed25519.private
39035certtool --generate-privkey --key-type=ed25519 --outfile=dkim_ed25519.private
39036.endd
39037
39038To produce the required public key value for a DNS record:
39039.code
39040openssl pkey -outform DER -pubout -in dkim_ed25519.private | tail -c +13 | base64
39041certtool --load_privkey=dkim_ed25519.private --pubkey_info --outder | tail -c +13 | base64
39042.endd
39043
39044Note that the format
39045of Ed25519 keys in DNS has not yet been decided; this release supports
39046both of the leading candidates at this time, a future release will
39047probably drop support for whichever proposal loses.
39048
39049.option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
39050Can be set to any one of the supported hash methods, which are:
39051.ilist
39052&`sha1`& &-- should not be used, is old and insecure
39053.next
39054&`sha256`& &-- the default
39055.next
39056&`sha512`& &-- possibly more secure but less well supported
39057.endlist
39058
39059Note that RFC 8301 says:
39060.code
39061rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39062.endd
39063
39064.option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
39065If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
39066the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
39067syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
39068local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
39069tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
39070
39071.option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
39072This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
39073The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
39074The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
39075only supports signing with the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
39076
39077.option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
39078This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
39079should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
39080either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
39081unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
39082variables here.
39083
39084.option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
39085If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
39086list of header names.
39087Headers with these names, or the absence or such a header, will be included
39088in the message signature.
39089When unspecified, the header names listed in RFC4871 will be used,
39090whether or not each header is present in the message.
39091The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
39092"_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS".
39093
39094If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence thereof)
39095will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
39096message are signed first, if there are multiples.
39097
39098A name can be prefixed with either an '=' or a '+' character.
39099If an '=' prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
39100will be signed.
39101If a '+' prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
39102will be signed, and one signature added for a missing header with the
39103name will be appended.
39104
39105
39106.section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECDKIMVFY"
39107.cindex "DKIM" "verification"
39108
39109.new
39110Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is done for all
39111messages for which an ACL control &%dkim_disable_verify%& has not been set.
39112.cindex authentication "expansion item"
39113Performing verification sets up information used by the
39114&$authresults$& expansion item.
39115.wen
39116
39117.new The results of that verification are then made available to the
39118&%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL, &new(which can examine and modify them).
39119By default, this ACL is called once for each
39120syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
39121A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
39122If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
39123If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
39124summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
39125
39126To evaluate the &new(verification result) in the ACL
39127a large number of expansion variables
39128containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
39129runtime of the ACL.
39130
39131Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
39132more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
39133&%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
39134&%$dkim_signers%& exist.
39135
39136The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
39137list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
39138called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
39139the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
39140list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
39141&%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
39142it defaults as:
39143.code
39144dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
39145.endd
39146This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
39147DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
39148call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
39149.code
39150dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
39151.endd
39152This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
39153and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
39154You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
39155.code
39156dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
39157.endd
39158
39159If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
39160&%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
39161
39162If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
39163for each matching signature.
39164
39165
39166Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
39167available (from most to least important):
39168
39169
39170.vlist
39171.vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
39172The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
39173an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
39174&%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
39175
39176.vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
39177Within the DKIM ACL,
39178a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
39179.ilist
39180&%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
39181identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39182.next
39183&%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
39184More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
39185.next
39186&%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
39187available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
39188.next
39189&%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
39190.endlist
39191
39192This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
39193This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
39194hash-method or key-size:
39195.code
39196 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
39197 condition = ${if eq {${length_3:$dkim_algo}}{rsa}}
39198 condition = ${if or {{eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}} \
39199 {< {$dkim_key_length}{1024}}}}
39200 logwrite = NOTE: forcing DKIM verify fail (was pass)
39201 set dkim_verify_status = fail
39202 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak or key too short
39203.endd
39204
39205After all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
39206colon-separated list of the values after each run.
39207
39208.vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
39209A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
39210"fail" or "invalid". One of
39211.ilist
39212&%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
39213key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
39214.next
39215&%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
39216record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
39217.next
39218&%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
39219body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
39220means that the message body was modified in transit.
39221.next
39222&%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
39223could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
39224re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
39225DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
39226.endlist
39227
39228This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
39229
39230.vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
39231The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
39232an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
39233reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39234
39235.vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
39236The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
39237if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
39238identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39239
39240.vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
39241The key record selector string.
39242
39243.vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
39244The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
39245If running under GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
39246may also be 'ed25519-sha256'.
39247The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
39248for EC keys.
39249
39250Note that RFC 8301 says:
39251.code
39252rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39253
39254DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
39255algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
39256.endd
39257
39258To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
39259and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
39260
39261.vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
39262The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
39263
39264.vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
39265The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
39266
39267.vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
39268A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
39269(copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
39270Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
39271not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
39272strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
39273
39274.vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
39275The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
39276limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
39277that this variable always expands to an integer value.
39278.new
39279&*Note:*& The presence of the signature tag specifying a signing body length
39280is one possible route to spoofing of valid DKIM signatures.
39281A paranoid implementation might wish to regard signature where this variable
39282shows less than the "no limit" return as being invalid.
39283.wen
39284
39285.vitem &%$dkim_created%&
39286UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
39287When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
39288
39289.vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
39290UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
39291signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
39292signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
39293integer size comparisons against this value.
39294Note that Exim does not check this value.
39295
39296.vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
39297A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
39298
39299.vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
39300"1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
39301
39302.vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
39303"1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
39304
39305.vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
39306Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
39307in the key record.
39308
39309.vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
39310Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
39311in the key record.
39312
39313.vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
39314Notes from the key record (tag n=).
39315
39316.vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
39317Number of bits in the key.
39318
39319Note that RFC 8301 says:
39320.code
39321Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
39322less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
39323.endd
39324
39325To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
39326and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
39327As EC keys are much smaller, the check should only do this for RSA keys.
39328
39329.endlist
39330
39331In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
39332
39333.vlist
39334.vitem &%dkim_signers%&
39335ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
39336for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
39337(reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
39338verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
39339
39340.code
39341# Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
39342warn log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
39343 sender_domains = gmail.com
39344 dkim_signers = gmail.com
39345 dkim_status = none
39346.endd
39347
39348Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
39349for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
39350
39351.vitem &%dkim_status%&
39352ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
39353results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
39354to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
39355
39356.code
39357deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
39358 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
39359 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
39360 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
39361.endd
39362
39363The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
39364see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
39365for more information of what they mean.
39366.endlist
39367
39368
39369
39370
39371.section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
39372.cindex SPF verification
39373
39374SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
39375messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by RFC 7208.
39376For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.openspf.org).
39377
39378Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
39379This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
39380
39381SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
39382&_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
39383&url(http://www.libspf2.org/).
39384There is no Exim involvement in the transmission of messages;
39385publishing certain DNS records is all that is required.
39386
39387For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
39388.cindex authentication "expansion item"
39389Performing verification sets up information used by the
39390&$authresults$& expansion item.
39391
39392
39393.cindex SPF "ACL condition"
39394.cindex ACL "spf condition"
39395The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
39396It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
39397and will succeed for any matching outcome.
39398Valid strings are:
39399.vlist
39400.vitem &%pass%&
39401The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
39402
39403.vitem &%fail%&
39404The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
39405domain in the envelope-from address.
39406
39407.vitem &%softfail%&
39408The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
39409is a forgery.
39410
39411.vitem &%none%&
39412The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
39413
39414.vitem &%neutral%&
39415The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
39416published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
39417its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
39418
39419.vitem &%permerror%&
39420This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
39421You may deny messages when this occurs.
39422
39423.vitem &%temperror%&
39424This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
39425SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
39426.endlist
39427
39428You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
39429its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
39430"fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
39431short-circuit fashion.
39432
39433Example:
39434.code
39435deny spf = fail
39436 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
39437 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
39438 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
39439 Please see http://www.openspf.org/Why?scope=\
39440 ${if def:sender_address_domain {mfrom}{helo}};\
39441 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
39442 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
39443 ip=$sender_host_address
39444.endd
39445
39446When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
39447variables:
39448
39449.cindex SPF "verification variables"
39450.vlist
39451.vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
39452.vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
39453 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
39454 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
39455 it for logging purposes.
39456
39457.vitem &$spf_received$&
39458.vindex &$spf_received$&
39459 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header that can be
39460 added to the message. Please note that according to the SPF
39461 draft, this header must be added at the top of the header
39462 list. Please see section 10 on how you can do this.
39463
39464 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
39465 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
39466
39467.vitem &$spf_result$&
39468.vindex &$spf_result$&
39469 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
39470 one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror or
39471 temperror.
39472
39473.vitem &$spf_result_guessed$&
39474.vindex &$spf_result_guessed$&
39475 This boolean is true only if a best-guess operation was used
39476 and required in order to obtain a result.
39477
39478.vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
39479.vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
39480 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
39481 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
39482.endlist
39483
39484
39485.cindex SPF "ACL condition"
39486.cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
39487.cindex SPF "best guess"
39488In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
39489"Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
39490SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
39491capability.
39492Refer to &url(http://www.openspf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
39493for a description of what it means.
39494
39495To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
39496of the spf one. For example:
39497
39498.code
39499deny spf_guess = fail
39500 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
39501.endd
39502
39503In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
39504should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
39505is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
39506reject message.
39507
39508When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
39509variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
39510
39511Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
39512what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
39513&%spf_guess%& option.
39514For example, the following:
39515
39516.code
39517spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
39518.endd
39519
39520would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
39521
39522
39523.cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
39524.cindex lookup spf
39525A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
39526address as the key and an IP address as the database:
39527
39528.code
39529 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
39530.endd
39531
39532The lookup will return the same result strings as can appear in
39533&$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
39534Currently, only IPv4 addresses are supported.
39535
39536
39537
39538
39539. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39540. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39541
39542.chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
39543 "Proxy support"
39544.cindex "proxy support"
39545.cindex "proxy" "access via"
39546
39547A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
39548Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
39549
39550
39551.section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
39552.cindex proxy inbound
39553.cindex proxy "server side"
39554.cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
39555.cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
39556
39557Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
39558that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
39559To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
39560in Local/Makefile.
39561
39562It was built on specifications from:
39563(&url(http://haproxy.1wt.eu/download/1.5/doc/proxy-protocol.txt)).
39564That URL was revised in May 2014 to version 2 spec:
39565(&url(http://git.1wt.eu/web?p=haproxy.git;a=commitdiff;h=afb768340c9d7e50d8e)).
39566
39567The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
39568such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
39569to distribute load.
39570Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
39571the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
39572There is no logging if a host passes or
39573fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
39574recorded in an ACL (example is below).
39575
39576Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
39577main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
39578hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
39579Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
39580automatically determines which version is in use.
39581
39582The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
39583and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
39584negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
39585Exim and the proxy server.
39586
39587The following expansion variables are usable
39588(&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
39589of the proxy):
39590.display
39591&'proxy_external_address '& IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy
39592&'proxy_external_port '& Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy
39593&'proxy_local_address '& IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy
39594&'proxy_local_port '& Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy
39595&'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
39596.endd
39597If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
39598there was a protocol error.
39599
39600Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
39601per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
39602evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
39603handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
39604With the option set so high, you lose the ability
39605to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
39606In order to prevent your server from overload, you
39607need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
39608A possible solution is:
39609.display
39610 # Set max number of connections per host
39611 LIMIT = 5
39612 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
39613 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
39614
39615 defer message = Too many connections from this IP right now
39616 ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
39617.endd
39618
39619
39620
39621.section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
39622.cindex proxy outbound
39623.cindex proxy "client side"
39624.cindex proxy SOCKS
39625.cindex SOCKS proxy
39626Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
39627using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
39628The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
39629Local/Makefile.
39630
39631Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
39632on an smtp transport.
39633The option value is expanded and should then be a list
39634(colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
39635Each proxy specifier is a list
39636(space-separated by default) where the initial element
39637is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
39638
39639Options are a string <name>=<value>.
39640The list of options is in the following table:
39641.display
39642&'auth '& authentication method
39643&'name '& authentication username
39644&'pass '& authentication password
39645&'port '& tcp port
39646&'tmo '& connection timeout
39647&'pri '& priority
39648&'weight '& selection bias
39649.endd
39650
39651More details on each of these options follows:
39652
39653.ilist
39654.cindex authentication "to proxy"
39655.cindex proxy authentication
39656&%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
39657Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
39658for access to the proxy.
39659Default is &"none"&.
39660.next
39661&%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
39662Default is empty.
39663.next
39664&%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
39665Default is empty.
39666.next
39667&%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
39668Default is 1080.
39669.next
39670&%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
39671Default is 5.
39672.next
39673&%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
39674higher values being tried first.
39675The default priority is 1.
39676.next
39677&%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
39678Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
39679weighted by this value.
39680The default value for selection bias is 1.
39681.endlist
39682
39683Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
39684and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
39685overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
39686
39687.section Logging SECTproxyLog
39688To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
39689add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
39690This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
39691
39692. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39693. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39694
39695.chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
39696 "Internationalisation""
39697.cindex internationalisation "email address"
39698.cindex EAI
39699.cindex i18n
39700.cindex utf8 "mail name handling"
39701
39702Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
39703To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
39704Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
39705
39706If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
39707instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
39708requirement, upon libidn2.
39709
39710.section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
39711.cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
39712The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
39713a host list. If this matches the sending host and
39714accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
39715SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
39716
39717If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
39718international handling for the message is enabled and
39719the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
39720
39721The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
39722message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
39723whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
39724when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
39725
39726Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
39727UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
39728require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
39729the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
39730
39731HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
39732components expanded to a-label form,
39733and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
39734form of the name.
39735
39736.cindex log protocol
39737.cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
39738.cindex i18n logging
39739Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
39740prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
39741
39742The following expansion operators can be used:
39743.code
39744${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
39745${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
39746${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
39747${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
39748.endd
39749
39750.cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
39751.cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
39752The RCPT ACL
39753may use the following modifier:
39754.display
39755control = utf8_downconvert
39756control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
39757.endd
39758This sets a flag requiring that addresses are converted to
39759a-label form before smtp delivery, for use in a
39760Message Submission Agent context.
39761If a value is appended it may be:
39762.display
39763&`1 `& (default) mandatory downconversion
39764&`0 `& no downconversion
39765&`-1 `& if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host
39766.endd
39767
39768If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
39769is initially set to -1.
39770
39771
39772There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
39773Configurations supporting these should inspect
39774&$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
39775
39776There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
39777Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
39778for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
39779
39780There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
39781and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
39782
39783
39784
39785.section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
39786To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
39787the following expansion operator can be used:
39788.code
39789${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
39790.endd
39791
39792The string is converted from the charset specified by
39793the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
39794or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
39795to the
39796modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
39797with the following exception: All occurrences of <sep>
39798(which has to be a single character)
39799are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
39800<sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
39801
39802The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
39803The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
39804
39805This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
39806by many other IMAP servers.
39807
39808Examples:
39809.display
39810&`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
39811&`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
39812&`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
39813.endd
39814
39815Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
39816must be representable in UTF-16.
39817
39818
39819. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39820. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39821
39822.chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
39823 "Events"
39824.cindex events
39825
39826The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
39827of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
39828actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
39829processing actions.
39830
39831Most installations will never need to use Events.
39832The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
39833in &_Local/Makefile_&.
39834
39835There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
39836The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
39837a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
39838
39839Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
39840An example might look like:
39841.cindex logging custom
39842.code
39843event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
39844{${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
39845 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
39846 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
39847 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
39848 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
39849 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
39850 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
39851 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
39852} {}}
39853.endd
39854
39855Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
39856The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
39857expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
39858
39859The current list of events is:
39860.display
39861&`dane:fail after transport `& per connection
39862&`msg:complete after main `& per message
39863&`msg:delivery after transport `& per recipient
39864&`msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport `& per recipient per host
39865&`msg:rcpt:defer after transport `& per recipient
39866&`msg:host:defer after transport `& per attempt
39867&`msg:fail:delivery after transport `& per recipient
39868&`msg:fail:internal after main `& per recipient
39869&`tcp:connect before transport `& per connection
39870&`tcp:close after transport `& per connection
39871&`tls:cert before both `& per certificate in verification chain
39872&`smtp:connect after transport `& per connection
39873.endd
39874New event types may be added in future.
39875
39876The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
39877event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
39878or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
39879
39880The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
39881before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
39882can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
39883
39884The third column in the table above says what section of the configuration
39885should define the event action.
39886
39887An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
39888with the event type:
39889.display
39890&`dane:fail `& failure reason
39891&`msg:delivery `& smtp confirmation message
39892&`msg:rcpt:host:defer `& error string
39893&`msg:rcpt:defer `& error string
39894&`msg:host:defer `& error string
39895&`tls:cert `& verification chain depth
39896&`smtp:connect `& smtp banner
39897.endd
39898
39899The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
39900
39901For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&
39902however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
39903the course of its processing:
39904.ilist
39905variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
39906transport call
39907.next
39908acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
39909and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
39910.endlist
39911Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
39912a useful way of writing to the main log.
39913
39914The expansion of the event_action option should normally
39915return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
39916following will be forced:
39917.display
39918&`tcp:connect `& do not connect
39919&`tls:cert `& refuse verification
39920&`smtp:connect `& close connection
39921.endd
39922All other message types ignore the result string, and
39923no other use is made of it.
39924
39925For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
39926then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
39927the target system.
39928
39929For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
39930chain element received on the connection.
39931For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
39932loaded locally.
39933
39934. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39935. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39936
39937.chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
39938 "Adding drivers or lookups"
39939.cindex "adding drivers"
39940.cindex "new drivers, adding"
39941.cindex "drivers" "adding new"
39942The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
39943authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
39944
39945.olist
39946Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
39947existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
39948.next
39949Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
39950.display
39951<&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
39952.endd
39953where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
39954code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
39955should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
39956.next
39957Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
39958.code
39959#define <type>_NEWDRIVER
39960.endd
39961.next
39962Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
39963and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
39964.next
39965Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
39966near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
39967Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
39968As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
39969simple form that most lookups have.
39970.next
39971Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
39972&_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
39973driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
39974.next
39975Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
39976&_src_&.
39977.next
39978Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
39979as for other drivers and lookups.
39980.endlist
39981
39982Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
39983proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
39984occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
39985options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
39986searched using a binary chop procedure.
39987
39988There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
39989the interface that is expected.
39990
39991
39992
39993
39994. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39995. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39996
39997. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39998. These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
39999. Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
40000. PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
40001. processors.
40002. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40003
40004.literal xml
40005<?sdop
40006 format="newpage"
40007 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
40008 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
40009?>
40010.literal off
40011
40012.makeindex "Options index" "option"
40013.makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
40014.makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
40015
40016
40017. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40018. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////